2012 maxima owner's manual

453

Upload: classic-cars-nissan

Post on 18-Jan-2015

2.438 views

Category:

Automotive


3 download

DESCRIPTION

Classic Cars Nissan offers you excellent sales and service on new or used Nissan vehicles. Stop in and test drive a Nissan 2012 MAXIMA or any car or truck today! We're located Hainesport New Jersey between Cherry Hill and Mount Holly. Only 20 minutes from Philadelphia. Classic Cars Nissan 1513 Route 38 Hainesport, NJ 08036 866-CLASSIC or 866-252-7742

TRANSCRIPT

Page 1: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL
Page 2: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

®

2012 MAXIMAOWNER’S MANUAL

For your safety, read carefully and keep in this vehicle.

2012 N

ISS

AN

MA

XIM

AA

35

-D

Printing : July 2011 (09)

Publication No.:

Printed in U.S.A. A35-DOM2E 0A35U0

Page 3: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Welcome to the growing family of new NISSANowners. This vehicle is delivered to you withconfidence. It was produced using the latesttechniques and strict quality control.

This manual was prepared to help you under-stand the operation and maintenance of yourvehicle so that you may enjoy many miles (kilome-ters) of driving pleasure. Please read through thismanual before operating your vehicle.

A separate Warranty Information Bookletexplains details about the warranties cov-ering your vehicle. The “NISSAN Serviceand Maintenance Guide” explains detailsabout maintaining and servicing your ve-hicle. Additionally, a separate CustomerCare/Lemon Law Booklet (U.S. only) willexplain how to resolve any concerns youmay have with your vehicle, as well asclarify your rights under your state’s lemonlaw.

Your NISSAN dealership knows your vehiclebest. When you require any service or have anyquestions, they will be glad to assist you with theextensive resources available to them.

In addition to factory installed options, your ve-hicle may also be equipped with additional ac-cessories installed by NISSAN or by yourNISSAN dealer prior to delivery. It is importantthat you familiarize yourself with all disclosures,warnings, cautions and instructions concerningproper use of such accessories prior to operatingthe vehicle and/or accessory. See a NISSANdealer for details concerning the particular ac-cessories with which your vehicle is equipped.

Before driving your vehicle, please read thisOwner’s Manual carefully. This will ensure famil-iarity with controls and maintenance require-ments, assisting you in the safe operation of yourvehicle.

WARNING

IMPORTANT SAFETY INFORMATION RE-MINDERS FOR SAFETY!

Follow these important driving rules tohelp ensure a safe and comfortable tripfor you and your passengers!

● NEVER drive under the influence of al-cohol or drugs.

● ALWAYS observe posted speed limitsand never drive too fast for conditions.

● ALWAYS give your full attention to drivingand avoid using vehicle features or takingother actions that could distract you.

● ALWAYS use your seat belts and appro-priate child restraint systems. Preteenchildren should be seated in the rear seat.

● ALWAYS provide information about theproper use of vehicle safety features toall occupants of the vehicle.

● ALWAYS review this Owner’s Manualfor important safety information.

FOREWORD READ FIRST—THEN DRIVE SAFELY

Page 4: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

MODIFICATION OF YOUR VEHICLE

This vehicle should not be modified.Modification could affect itsperformance, safety or durability, andmay even violate governmentalregulations. In addition, damage or per-formance problems resulting from modi-fications may not be covered underNISSAN warranties.

This manual includes information for all optionsavailable on this model. Therefore, you may findsome information that does not apply to yourvehicle.

All information, specifications and illustrations inthis manual are those in effect at the time ofprinting. NISSAN reserves the right to changespecifications or design without notice and with-out obligation.

IMPORTANT INFORMATION ABOUTTHIS MANUALYou will see various symbols in this manual. Theyare used in the following ways:

WARNING

This is used to indicate the presence of ahazard that could cause death or seriouspersonal injury. To avoid or reduce therisk, the procedures must be followedprecisely.

CAUTION

This is used to indicate the presence of ahazard that could cause minor or moder-ate personal injury or damage to your ve-hicle. To avoid or reduce the risk, the pro-cedures must be followed carefully.

If you see this symbol, it means “Do not do this”or “Do not let this happen.”

If you see a symbol similar to these in an illustra-tion, it means the arrow points to the front of thevehicle.

Arrows in an illustration that are similar to theseindicate movement or action.

Arrows in an illustration that are similar to thesecall attention to an item in the illustration.

APD1005

WHEN READING THE MANUAL

Page 5: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65WARNING

WARNING

Engine exhaust, some of its constituents,and certain vehicle components containor emit chemicals known to the State ofCalifornia to cause cancer and birth de-fects or other reproductive harm. In addi-tion, certain fluids contained in vehiclesand certain products of component wearcontain or emit chemicals known to theState of California to cause cancer andbirth defects or other reproductive harm.

CALIFORNIA PERCHLORATEADVISORYSome vehicle parts, such as lithium batter-ies, may contain perchlorate material. Thefollowing advisory is provided: “PerchlorateMaterial – special handling may apply, Seewww.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate/”.

BLUETOOTH� is atrademark owned byBluetooth SIG, Inc.and licensed to Vis-teon and Clarion.

Gracenote� is a regis-tered trademark ofGracenote, Inc. TheGracenote logo andlogo type, and the“Powered byGracenote” logo aretrademarks ofGracenote.

XM Radio� requiressubscription, soldseparately. Not avail-able in Alaska, Ha-waii or Guam. Formore information,visit www.xmradio-.com.

© 2011 NISSAN NORTH AMERICA, INC.

All rights reserved. No part of this Owner’sManual may be reproduced or stored in a retrievalsystem, or transmitted in any form, or by anymeans, electronic, mechanical, photocopying,recording or otherwise, without the prior writtenpermission of Nissan North America, Inc.

Page 6: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

NISSAN CARES . . .Both NISSAN and your NISSAN dealer are dedicated to serving all your automotive needs. Your satisfaction with your vehicle and your NISSAN dealer areour primary concerns. Your NISSAN dealer is always available to assist you with all your automobile sales and service needs.

However, if there is something that your NISSANdealer cannot assist you with or you would like toprovide NISSAN directly with comments orquestions, please contact the NISSAN Con-sumer Affairs Department using our toll-freenumber:

For U.S. customers1-800-NISSAN-1(1-800-647-7261)

For Canadian customers1-800-387-0122

The Consumer Affairs Department will ask for thefollowing information:

– Your name, address, and telephone number

– Vehicle identification number (attached to thetop of the instrument panel on the driver’sside)

– Date of purchase

– Current odometer reading

– Your NISSAN dealer’s name

– Your comments or questions

OR

You can write to NISSAN with the information at:

For U.S. customersNissan North America, Inc.Consumer Affairs DepartmentP.O. Box 685003Franklin, TN 37068-5003

For Canadian customersNissan Canada Inc.5290 Orbitor DriveMississauga, Ontario L4W 4Z5

or via e-mail at:

For U.S. [email protected]

For Canadian [email protected]

We appreciate your interest in NISSAN and thank you for buying a quality NISSAN vehicle.

NISSAN CUSTOMER CARE PROGRAM

Page 7: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Table ofContents

Illustrated table of contents

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Instruments and controls

Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Starting and driving

In case of emergency

Appearance and care

Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Technical and consumer information

Index

0

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

10

Page 8: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL
Page 9: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

0 Illustrated table of contents

Air bags, seat belts and child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-2Exterior front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-3Exterior rear. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-4Passenger compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-5

Instrument panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-6Engine compartment check locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-8Warning/indicator lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-9

Page 10: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Top tether strap anchor (P. 1-33)2. Head restraints (P. 1-7)3. Rear seat belts (P. 1-11)4. Roof-mounted curtain side-impact

supplemental air bag (P. 1-37)5. Front seat-mounted side-impact

supplemental air bags (P. 1-37)6. Head Restraints (P. 1-7)7. Front seat belts (P. 1-11)8. Supplemental front-impact air bags

(P. 1-37)9. Seats (P. 1-2)10. Occupant classification sensor

(pattern sensor) (P.1-44)11. Seat belts with pretensioners (P. 1-50)12. LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for

CHildren) system (P. 1-21)See the page number indicated in paren-theses for operating details.

LII0065

AIR BAGS, SEAT BELTS AND CHILDRESTRAINTS

0-2 Illustrated table of contents

Page 11: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Engine hood (P. 3-18)2. Windshield wiper and washer switch

(P. 2-28)3. Windshield (P. 8-19)4. Moonroof (if so equipped) (P. 2-46)5. Power windows (P. 2-43)6. Door locks, NISSAN Intelligent Key™,

keys, request button(P. 3-4, 3-2, 3-2, 3-2)

7. Mirrors (P. 3-26)8. Tire pressure (P. 8-32)9. Flat tire (P. 6-2)10. Tire chains (P. 8-40)11. Headlight and turn signal switch

(P. 2-29)12. Replacing bulbs (P. 8-30)13. Fog light switch (if so equipped)

(P. 8-27)See the page number indicated in paren-theses for operating details.

WII0155

EXTERIOR FRONT

Illustrated table of contents 0-3

Page 12: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Rear window defroster switch (P. 2-29)2. Interior trunk lid release (P. 3-20)3. Trunk lid (P. 3-18)4. Vehicle loading (P. 9-12)5. Exterior trunk lid release/request button

(P. 3-13)6. Replacing bulbs (P. 8-30)7. Fuel-filler cap, fuel recommendation

(P. 3-21, P. 9-3)8. Fuel-filler door (P. 3-21)9. Child safety rear door locks (P. 3-6)See the page number indicated in paren-theses for operating details.

WII0156

EXTERIOR REAR

0-4 Illustrated table of contents

Page 13: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Interior trunk access (P. 1-5)2. Moonroof (if so equipped) (P. 2-46)3. Sun visors (P. 3-25)4. Interior lights, illuminated entry (P. 2-51)5. HomeLink� universal transceiver

(if so equipped) (P. 2-53)6. Interior mirrors (P. 3-26)7. Glove box (P. 2-41)8. Cup holders (P. 2-40)9. Console box (P. 2-42)10. Front seat (P. 1-2)11. Rear seat (P. 1-5)See the page number indicated in paren-theses for operating details.

WII0126

PASSENGER COMPARTMENT

Illustrated table of contents 0-5

Page 14: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Side and center vents (P. 4-40)2. Headlight/fog light (if so equipped)/turn

signal switch (P. 2-29)3. Steering wheel switch for audio control

and Bluetooth� Hands-Free PhoneSystem (P. 4-113, 4-116)

4. Meters and gauges (P. 2-3)5. Driver supplemental air bag/horn

(P. 1-37, P. 2-35)6. Security indicator light (P. 2-25)7. Cruise control main/set switches

(P. 5-18)

8. Shift paddles (if so equipped) (P. 5-15)9. Windshield wiper/washer switch

(P. 2-28)10. Display screen/Navigation system*

(if so equipped) (P. 4-16)11. Display screen/Navigation system*

controls (if so equipped) (P. 4-16)12. Front passenger supplemental air bag

(P. 1-51)13. Glove box (P. 2-41)14. Display screen (models without

Navigation system) (P. 4-4)15. Climate controls (models without

avigation system) (P. 4-41)16. Audio system controls (models without

Navigation system) (P. 4-47)17. Front passenger air bag status light

(P. 1-44)18. Audio system controls (P. 4-47)19. Climate controls (models with

Navigation system) (P. 4-44)20. Shift selector (P. 5-11)21. Hazard warning flasher switch (P. 2-34)22. Ignition switch (behind the steering

wheel) (P. 5-7)23. Tilt/telescopic steering wheel controls

(if so equipped) (P. 3-23)

WIC1535

INSTRUMENT PANEL

0-6 Illustrated table of contents

Page 15: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

24. Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFFswitch (P. 2-38)Outside mirror controls (P. 3-28)Heated steering wheel switch(if so equipped) (P. 2-37)Trunk lid release switch (P. 3-20)

* Refer to the separate Navigation System Own-er’s Manual (if so equipped).

See the page number indicated in paren-theses for operating details.

Illustrated table of contents 0-7

Page 16: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Power steering fluid reservoir (P. 8-12)2. Engine oil filler cap (P. 8-9)3. Brake fluid reservoir (P. 8-13)4. Air cleaner (P. 8-18)5. Fuse block (P. 8-21)6. Battery (P. 8-14)7. Fuse/fusible link box (P. 8-21)8. Engine oil dipstick (P. 8-9)9. Radiator cap (P. 8-7)10. Drive belt location (P.8-17)11. Engine coolant reservoir * (P. 8-7)12. Windshield-washer fluid reservoir *

(P. 8-14)

NOTE:

* Side covers removed for clarity.

See the page number indicated in paren-theses for operating details.

WDI0662

ENGINE COMPARTMENT CHECKLOCATIONS

0-8 Illustrated table of contents

Page 17: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Warninglight

Name Page

or

Anti-lock BrakingSystem (ABS)warning light

2-11

or

Brake warning light 2-11

Charge warninglight

2-11

Engine oil pressurewarning light

2-12

Low tire pressurewarning light

2-12

Master warning light 2-13

Warninglight

Name Page

Seat belt warninglight and chime

2-13

Supplemental airbag warning light

2-14

Indicatorlight

Name Page

Continuously Vari-able Transmission(CVT) indicator light

2-14

Continuously Vari-able Transmission(CVT) position indi-cator light

2-10

Cruise main switchindicator light

2-14

Front passenger airbag status light

2-14

Indicatorlight

Name Page

High beam indicatorlight (blue)

2-15

Malfunction Indica-tor Light (MIL)

2-15

Security indicatorlight

2-15

Side light and head-light indicator light(green)

2-16

Slip indicator light 2-16

Turn signal/hazardindicator lights

2-16

Vehicle DynamicControl OFF indica-tor light

2-16

WARNING/INDICATOR LIGHTS

Illustrated table of contents 0-9

Page 18: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

MEMO

0-10 Illustrated table of contents

Page 19: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1 Safety—Seats, seat belts andsupplemental restraint system

Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2Front power seat adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3Folding rear seat (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5Head restraints. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7

Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11Precautions on seat belt usage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11Pregnant women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14Injured persons. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14Three-point type seat belt with retractor . . . . . . . . . . 1-14Seat belt extenders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17Seat belt maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17

Child safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17Infants. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18Small children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18Larger children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18

Child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19Precautions on child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19

LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers forCHildren) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21Rear-facing child restraint installation usingLATCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23Rear-facing child restraint installation usingthe seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25Forward-facing child restraint installationusing LATCH. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-28Forward-facing child restraint installationusing the seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-29Installing top tether strap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-33Booster seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-33

Supplemental restraint system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-37Precautions on supplemental restraintsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-37Supplemental air bag warning labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-51Supplemental air bag warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-51

Page 20: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● Do not ride in a moving vehicle whenthe seatback is reclined. This can bedangerous. The shoulder belt will notbe against your body. In an accident,you could be thrown into it and receiveneck or other serious injuries. Youcould also slide under the lap belt andreceive serious internal injuries.

● For the most effective protection whenthe vehicle is in motion, the seat shouldbe upright. Always sit well back in theseat with both feet on the floor andadjust the seat properly. See “Precau-tions on seat belt usage” later in thissection.

● After adjustment, gently rock in the seatto make sure it is securely locked.

● Do not leave children unattended insidethe vehicle. They could unknowingly ac-tivate switches or controls. Unattendedchildren could become involved in seri-ous accidents.

● The seatback should not be reclinedany more than needed for comfort. Seatbelts are most effective when the pas-senger sits well back and straight up inthe seat. If the seatback is reclined, therisk of sliding under the lap belt andbeing injured is increased.

CAUTION

When adjusting the seat positions, besure not to contact any moving parts toavoid possible injuries and/or damage.

ARS1152

SEATS

1-2 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 21: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

FRONT POWER SEAT ADJUSTMENT

Operating tips

● The power seat motor has an auto-resetoverload protection circuit. If the motorstops during operation, wait 30 seconds,then reactivate the switch.

● Do not operate the power seat switch for along period of time when the engine is off.This will discharge the battery.

See “Automatic drive positioner” in “Pre-drivingchecks and adjustments” for automatic drive po-sitioner operation.

Forward and backwardMoving the switch forward or backward will slidethe seat forward or backward to the desiredposition.

RecliningMove the recline switch backward until the de-sired angle is obtained. To bring the seatbackforward again, move the switch forward andmove your body forward. The seatback will moveforward.

The reclining feature allows adjustment of theseatback for occupants of different sizes foradded comfort and to help obtain proper seatbelt fit. See “Precautions on seat belt usage” laterin this section. Also, the seatback can be reclinedto allow occupants to rest when the vehicle isstopped and the shift selector is in P (Park).

WRS0860

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-3

Page 22: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Seat lifter (driver’s seat)Push the front or rear end of the switch up ordown to adjust the angle and height of the seatcushion.

Lumbar support (driver’s seat)The lumbar support feature provides lower backsupport to the driver. Move the lever up or down(manual) or move the switch forward or backward(power) to adjust the seat lumbar area.

WRS0861Manual (if so equipped)

LRS0862

Power (if so equipped)LRS0238

1-4 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 23: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Thigh extension (driver’s side only, ifso equipped)Pull up and hold the lever to extend the frontportion to the desired position.

FOLDING REAR SEAT (if soequipped)

Interior trunk access

For models without a rear center console, thetrunk can be accessed from the passenger sideof the rear seat for loading and unloading, asshown.

�1 Press down on the button on the rear parcelshelf.

�2 Fold down the passenger side seatback.

WARNING

● Never allow anyone to ride in the cargoarea or on the rear seat when it is in thefold-down position. Use of these areasby passengers without proper restraintscould result in serious injury in an acci-dent or sudden stop.

● Properly secure all cargo with ropes orstraps to help prevent it from sliding orshifting. Do not place cargo higher thanthe seatbacks. In a sudden stop or col-lision, unsecured cargo could causepersonal injury.

LRS0863

WRS0866

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-5

Page 24: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● When returning the seatbacks to theupright position, be certain they arecompletely secured in the latched posi-tion. If they are not completely secured,passengers may be injured in an acci-dent or sudden stop.

● Closely supervise children when theyare around cars to prevent them fromplaying and becoming locked in thetrunk where they could be seriously in-jured. Keep the car locked, with the rearseatback and trunk lid securely latchedwhen not in use, and prevent children’saccess to car keys.

To fold down the driver side of the rear seat, reachthrough the opening and pull on the strap �1located behind the seat.

The rear seats can be locked using the mechani-cal key to prevent unauthorized access.

Secondary trunk lid release (if soequipped)For models with a rear center console, the trunkcan be accessed through the access panel be-tween the rear seats, as shown.

● Fold down the center arm rest.

● Insert the mechanical key into the trunk com-partment access lid lock. Fold down thetrunk compartment access lid. For more in-formation on the mechanical key, see“NISSAN Intelligent Key™” in the Pre-drivingchecks and adjustments chapter.

● Pull the rear seat trunk release handle �1 .

WRS0867 LPD0459

1-6 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 25: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Center armrest

Pull the armrest down until it is horizontal.

HEAD RESTRAINTS

WARNING

Head restraints supplement the other ve-hicle safety systems. They may provideadditional protection against injury in cer-tain rear end collisions. Adjust the headrestraints properly, as specified in thissection. Check the adjustment aftersomeone else uses the seat. Do not attachanything to the head restraint stalks orremove the head restraint. Do not use theseat if the head restraint has been re-moved. If the head restraint was removed,reinstall and properly adjust the head re-straint before an occupant uses the seat-ing position. Failure to follow these in-structions can reduce the effectiveness ofthe head restraints. This may increase therisk of serious injury or death in acollision.

The illustration shows the seating positionsequipped with head restraints. All of the headrestraints are adjustable.

� Indicates the seating position is equipped witha head restraint.

+ Indicates the seating position is not equippedwith a head restraint.

WRS0868 LRS2000

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-7

Page 26: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Components1. Head restraint

2. Adjustment notches

3. Lock knob

4. Stalks

AdjustmentAdjust the head restraint so the center is levelwith the center of the seat occupant’s ears.

To raise the head restraint, pull it up.LRS0887 WRS0134 LRS0888

1-8 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 27: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

To lower, push and hold the lock knob and pushthe head restraint down.

RemovalUse the following procedure to remove the ad-justable head restraints.

1. Pull the head restraint up to the highestposition.

2. Push and hold the lock knob.

3. Remove the head restraint from the seat.

4. Store the head restraint properly so it is notloose in the vehicle.

5. Reinstall and properly adjust the head re-straint before an occupant uses the seatingposition.

Install1. Align the head restraint stalks with the holes

in the seat. Make sure the head restraint isfacing the correct direction. The stalk withthe adjustment notches �1 must be installedin the hole with the lock knob �2 .

2. Push and hold the lock knob and push thehead restraint down.

3. Properly adjust the head restraint before anoccupant uses the seating position.

LRS0889 LRS0890 LRS0891

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-9

Page 28: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Front-seat Active Head RestraintsThe Active Head Restraint moves forward utiliz-ing the force that the seatback receives from theoccupant in a rear-end collision. The movementof the head restraint helps support the occu-pant’s head by reducing its backward movementand helping absorb some of the forces that maylead to whiplash-type injuries.

Active Head Restraints are effective for collisionsat low to medium speeds in which it is said thatwhiplash injury occurs most.

Active Head Restraints operate only in certainrear-end collisions. After the collision, the headrestraints return to their original position.

Adjust the Active Head Restraints properly asdescribed in this section.

SPA1025

1-10 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 29: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

PRECAUTIONS ON SEAT BELTUSAGEIf you are wearing your seat belt properly ad-justed and you are sitting upright and well back inyour seat with both feet on the floor, your chancesof being injured or killed in an accident and/or theseverity of injury may be greatly reduced.NISSAN strongly encourages you and all of yourpassengers to buckle up every time you drive,even if your seating position includes a supple-mental air bag.

Most U.S. states and Canadian provincesor territories specify that seat belts be wornat all times when a vehicle is being driven.

SSS0136

SEAT BELTS

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-11

Page 30: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● Every person who drives or rides in thisvehicle should use a seat belt at alltimes. Children should be properly re-strained in the rear seat and, if appro-priate, in a child restraint.

WARNING

● The seat belt should be properly ad-justed to a snug fit. Failure to do so mayreduce the effectiveness of the entirerestraint system and increase thechance or severity of injury in an acci-dent. Serious injury or death can occurif the seat belt is not worn properly.

SSS0134 SSS0016

1-12 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 31: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● Always route the shoulder belt overyour shoulder and across your chest.Never put the belt behind your back,under your arm or across your neck. Thebelt should be away from your face andneck, but not falling off your shoulder.

● Position the lap belt as low and snug aspossible AROUND THE HIPS, NOT THEWAIST. A lap belt worn too high couldincrease the risk of internal injuries inan accident.

● Be sure the seat belt tongue is securelyfastened to the proper buckle.

● Do not wear the seat belt inside out ortwisted. Doing so may reduce itseffectiveness.

● Do not allow more than one person touse the same seat belt.

● Never carry more people in the vehiclethan there are seat belts.

● If the seat belt warning light glows con-tinuously while the ignition is placed inthe ON position with all doors closedand all seat belts fastened, it may indi-cate a malfunction in the system. Havethe system checked by a NISSANdealer.

● No changes should be made to the seatbelt system. For example, do not modifythe seat belt, add material, or installdevices that may change the seat beltrouting or tension. Doing so may affectthe operation of the seat belt system.Modifying or tampering with the seatbelt system may result in serious per-sonal injury.

● Once a seat belt pretensioner has acti-vated, it cannot be reused and must bereplaced together with the retractor.See your NISSAN dealer.

● Removal and installation of preten-sioner system components should bedone by a NISSAN dealer.

● All seat belt assemblies, including re-tractors and attaching hardware,should be inspected after any collisionby a NISSAN dealer. NISSAN recom-mends that all seat belt assemblies inuse during a collision be replaced un-less the collision was minor and thebelts show no damage and continue tooperate properly. Seat belt assembliesnot in use during a collision should alsobe inspected and replaced if eitherdamage or improper operation is noted.

● All child restraints and attaching hard-ware should be inspected after any col-lision. Always follow the restraintmanufacturer’s inspection instructionsand replacement recommendations.The child restraints should be replacedif they are damaged.

SSS0014

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-13

Page 32: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

PREGNANT WOMENNISSAN recommends that pregnant women useseat belts. The seat belt should be worn snug andalways position the lap belt as low as possiblearound the hips, not the waist. Place the shoulderbelt over your shoulder and across your chest.Never run the lap/shoulder belt over your ab-dominal area. Contact your doctor for specificrecommendations.

INJURED PERSONSNISSAN recommends that injured persons useseat belts. Check with your doctor for specificrecommendations.

THREE-POINT TYPE SEAT BELTWITH RETRACTOR

WARNING

● Every person who drives or rides in thisvehicle should use a seat belt at alltimes.

● Do not ride in a moving vehicle whenthe seatback is reclined. This can bedangerous. The shoulder belt will notbe against your body. In an accident,you could be thrown into it and receiveneck or other serious injuries. Youcould also slide under the lap belt andreceive serious internal injuries.

● For the most effective protection whenthe vehicle is in motion, the seat shouldbe upright. Always sit well back in theseat with both feet on the floor andadjust the seat belt properly.

Fastening the seat belts

�1 Adjust the seat. See “Seats” earlier in thissection.

Front seat shownWRS0864

1-14 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 33: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

�2 Slowly pull the seat belt out of the retractorand insert the tongue into the buckle untilyou hear and feel the latch engage.

● The retractor is designed to lock dur-ing a sudden stop or on impact. Aslow pulling motion permits the seatbelt to move, and allows you somefreedom of movement in the seat.

● If the seat belt cannot be pulled fromits fully retracted position, firmly pullthe belt and release it. Thensmoothly pull the belt out of the re-tractor.

�3 Position the lap belt portion low and snugon the hips as shown.

�4 Pull the shoulder belt portion toward theretractor to take up extra slack. Be sure theshoulder belt is routed over your shoulderand across your chest.

The front passenger seat and the rear seatingpositions three-point seat belts have two modesof operation:

● Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR)

● Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)

The Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) modeallows the seat belt to extend and retract to allowthe driver and passengers some freedom ofmovement in the seat. The ELR locks the seat beltwhen the vehicle slows down rapidly or duringcertain impacts.

The Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode(child restraint mode) locks the seat belt for childrestraint installation.

When the ALR mode is activated, the seat beltcannot be extended again until the seat belttongue is detached from the buckle and fullyretracted. The seat belt returns to the ELR modeafter the seat belt fully retracts. See “Child re-straints” later in this section for more information.

The ALR mode should be used only forchild restraint installation. During normalseat belt use by an occupant, the ALR modeshould not be activated. If it is activated, itmay cause uncomfortable seat belt ten-sion.

WARNING

When fastening the seat belts, be certainthat the seatbacks are completely se-cured in the latched position. If they arenot completely secured, passengers maybe injured in an accident or sudden stop.

WRS0137 WRS0138

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-15

Page 34: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Unfastening the seat belts

�1 To unfasten the seat belt, press the button onthe buckle. The seat belt automatically re-tracts.

Checking seat belt operationSeat belt retractors are designed to lock seat beltmovement by two separate methods:

● When the seat belt is pulled quickly from theretractor.

● When the vehicle slows down rapidly.

To increase your confidence in the seat belts,check the operation as follows:

● Grasp the shoulder belt and pull forwardquickly. The retractor should lock and re-strict further belt movement.

If the retractor does not lock during this check orif you have any questions about seat belt opera-tion, see a NISSAN dealer.

Shoulder belt height adjustment (frontseats)

The shoulder belt anchor height should be ad-justed to the position best for you. See “Precau-tions on seat belt usage” earlier in this section. Toadjust, pull out the adjustment button �1 andmove the shoulder belt anchor to the desiredposition �2 , so the belt passes over the center ofthe shoulder. The belt should be away from yourface and neck, but not falling off your shoulder.Release the adjustment button to lock the shoul-der belt anchor into position.

WRS0139 LRS0242

1-16 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 35: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● After adjustment, release the adjust-ment button and try to move the shoul-der belt anchor up and down to makesure it is securely fixed in position.

● The shoulder belt anchor height shouldbe adjusted to the position best for you.Failure to do so may reduce the effec-tiveness of the entire restraint systemand increase the chance or severity ofinjury in an accident.

SEAT BELT EXTENDERS

If, because of body size or driving position, it isnot possible to properly fit the lap/shoulder beltand fasten it, an extender that is compatible withthe installed seat belts is available that can bepurchased. The extender adds approximately 8 in(200 mm) of length and may be used for eitherthe driver or front passenger seating position.See a NISSAN dealer for assistance with pur-chasing an extender if an extender is required.

WARNING

● Only NISSAN seat belt extenders, madeby the same company which made theoriginal equipment seat belts, shouldbe used with NISSAN seat belts.

● Adults and children who can use thestandard seat belt should not use anextender. Such unnecessary use couldresult in serious personal injury in theevent of an accident.

● Never use seat belt extenders to installchild restraints. If the child restraint isnot secured properly, the child could beseriously injured in a collision or a sud-den stop.

SEAT BELT MAINTENANCE● To clean the seat belt webbing, apply a

mild soap solution or any solution recom-mended for cleaning upholstery or carpet.Then wipe with a cloth and allow the seat beltsto dry in the shade. Do not allow the seat beltsto retract until they are completely dry.

● If dirt builds up in the shoulder beltguide of the seat belt anchors, the seatbelts may retract slowly. Wipe the shoulderbelt guide with a clean, dry cloth.

● Periodically check to see that the seatbelt and the metal components, such asbuckles, tongues, retractors, flexible wiresand anchors, work properly. If loose parts,deterioration, cuts or other damage on thewebbing is found, the entire seat belt as-sembly should be replaced.

Children need adults to help protect them.They need to be properly restrained.

In addition to the general information in thismanual, child safety information is available frommany other sources, including doctors, teachers,government traffic safety offices, and communityorganizations. Every child is different, so be sureto learn the best way to transport your child.

There are three basic types of child restraintsystems:

● Rear-facing child restraint

● Forward-facing child restraint

● Booster seat

The proper restraint depends on the child’s size.Generally, infants up to about 1 year and lessthan 20 lbs (9 kg) should be placed in rear-facingchild restraints. Forward-facing child restraintsare available for children who outgrow rear-facing child restraints and are at least 1 year old.Booster seats are used to help position a vehiclelap/shoulder belt on a child who can no longeruse a forward-facing child restraint.

CHILD SAFETY

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-17

Page 36: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

Infants and children need special protec-tion. The vehicle’s seat belts may not fitthem properly. The shoulder belt maycome too close to the face or neck. Thelap belt may not fit over their small hipbones. In an accident, an improperly fit-ting seat belt could cause serious or fatalinjury. Always use appropriate childrestraints.

All U.S. states and Canadian provinces or terri-tories require the use of approved child restraintsfor infants and small children. See “Child re-straints” later in this section.

A child restraint may be secured in the vehicle byusing either the LATCH (Lower Anchor and Teth-ers for CHildren) system or with the vehicle seatbelt. See the “Child restraints” section for moreinformation.

NISSAN recommends that all pre-teensand children be restrained in the rear seat.Studies show that children are safer whenproperly restrained in the rear seat than inthe front seat.

This is especially important because yourvehicle has a supplemental restraint sys-

tem (air bag system) for the front passen-ger. See “Supplemental restraint system”later in this section.

INFANTS

Infants up to at least 1 year old should be placedin a rear-facing child restraint. NISSAN recom-mends that infants be placed in child restraintsthat comply with Federal Motor Vehicle SafetyStandards or Canadian Motor Vehicle SafetyStandards. You should choose a child restraintthat fits your vehicle and always follow the manu-facturer’s instructions for installation and use.

SMALL CHILDREN

Children that are over 1 year old and weigh atleast 20 lbs (9 kg) should remain in a rear-facingchild restraint as long as possible up to the heightor weight limit of the child restraint. Forward-facing child restraints are available for childrenwho outgrow rear-facing child restraints and areat least 1 year old. Refer to the manufacturer’sinstructions for minimum and maximum weightand height recommendations. NISSAN recom-mends that small children be placed in childrestraints that comply with Federal Motor VehicleSafety Standards or Canadian Motor VehicleSafety Standards. You should choose a child

restraint that fits your vehicle and always followthe manufacturer’s instructions for installationand use.

LARGER CHILDREN

Children who are too large for child restraintsshould be seated and restrained by the seat beltswhich are provided. The seat belt may not fitproperly if the child is less than 4 ft 9 in (142.5cm) tall and weighs between 40 lbs (18 kg) and80 lbs (36 kg). A booster seat should be used toobtain proper seat belt fit.

NISSAN recommends that a child be placed in acommercially available booster seat if the shoul-der belt fits close to the face or neck or if the lapportion of the seat belt goes across the abdo-men. The booster seat should raise the child sothat the shoulder belt is properly positionedacross the top, middle portion of the shoulderand the lap belt is low on the hips. A booster seatcan only be used in seating positions that have athree-point type seat belt. The booster seatshould fit the vehicle seat and have a label certi-fying that it complies with Federal Motor VehicleSafety Standards or Canadian Motor VehicleSafety Standards. Once the child has grown sothe shoulder belt is no longer on or near the faceand neck, use the shoulder belt without thebooster seat.

1-18 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 37: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

Never let a child stand or kneel on anyseat and do not allow a child in the cargoarea. The child could be seriously injuredor killed in a sudden stop or collision.

PRECAUTIONS ON CHILDRESTRAINTS

WARNING

● Failure to follow the warnings and in-structions for proper use and installa-tion of child restraints could result inserious injury or death of a child orother passengers in a sudden stop orcollision:

– The child restraint must be used andinstalled properly. Always follow allof the child restraint manufacturer’sinstructions for installation and use.

ARS1098 WRS0256

CHILD RESTRAINTS

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-19

Page 38: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

– Infants and children should never beheld on anyone’s lap. Even the stron-gest adult cannot resist the forces ofa collision.

– Do not put a seat belt around both achild and another passenger.

– NISSAN recommends that all childrestraints be installed in the rearseat. Studies show that children aresafer when properly restrained in therear seat than in the front seat. If youmust install a forward-facing childrestraint in the front seat, see“Forward-facing child restraint in-stallation using the seat belts” laterin this section.

– Even with the NISSAN Advanced AirBag System, never install a rear-facing child restraint in the frontseat. An inflating air bag could seri-ously injure or kill a child. A rear-facing child restraint must only beused in the rear seat.

– Be sure to purchase a child restraintthat will fit the child and vehicle.Some child restraints may not fitproperly in your vehicle.

– Child restraint anchor points are de-signed to withstand loads from childrestraints that are properly fitted.

– Never use the anchor points for adultseat belts or harnesses.

– A child restraint with a top tetherstrap should not be used in the frontpassenger seat.

– Keep seatbacks as upright as pos-sible after fitting the child restraint.

– Infants and children should alwaysbe placed in an appropriate child re-straint while in the vehicle.

● When the child restraint is not in use,keep it secured with the LATCH systemor a seat belt. In a sudden stop or colli-sion, loose objects can injure occu-pants or damage the vehicle.

CAUTION

A child restraint in a closed vehicle canbecome very hot. Check the seating sur-face and buckles before placing a child inthe child restraint.

This vehicle is equipped with a universal childrestraint anchor system, referred to as the LATCH(Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) sys-tem. Some child restraints include rigid orwebbing-mounted attachments that can be con-nected to these anchors. For details, see “LATCH(Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) sys-tem” later in this section.

If you do not have a LATCH compatible childrestraint, the vehicle seat belts can be used.

Several manufacturers offer child restraints forinfants and children of various sizes. When se-lecting any child restraint, keep the followingpoints in mind:

● Choose only a restraint with a label certifyingthat it complies with Federal Motor VehicleSafety Standard 213 or Canadian MotorVehicle Safety Standard 213.

● Check the child restraint in your vehicle to besure it is compatible with the vehicle’s seatand seat belt system.

1-20 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 39: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● If the child restraint is compatible with yourvehicle, place your child in the child restraintand check the various adjustments to besure the child restraint is compatible withyour child. Choose a child restraint that isdesigned for your child’s height and weight.Always follow all recommended procedures.

All U.S. states and Canadian provinces orterritories require that infants and smallchildren be restrained in an approved childrestraint at all times while the vehicle isbeing operated. Canadian law requires thetop tether strap on forward-facing childrestraints be secured to the designated an-chor point on the vehicle.

LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethersfor CHildren) SYSTEM

Your vehicle is equipped with special anchorpoints that are used with LATCH (Lower Anchorsand Tethers for CHildren) system compatiblechild restraints. This system may also be referredto as the ISOFIX or ISOFIX compatible system.With this system, you do not have to use a vehicleseat belt to secure the child restraint.

LATCH lower anchor

WARNING

Failure to follow the warnings and instruc-tions for proper use and installation ofchild restraints could result in serious in-jury or death of a child or other passen-gers in a sudden stop or collision:

– Attach LATCH system compatiblechild restraints only at the locationsshown in the illustration.

– Do not secure a child restraint in thecenter rear seating position usingthe LATCH lower anchors. The childrestraint will not be secured properly.

– Inspect the lower anchors by insert-ing your fingers into the lower anchorarea. Feel to make sure there are noobstructions over the anchors suchas seat belt webbing or seat cushionmaterial. The child restraint will notbe secured properly if the lower an-chors are obstructed.

LATCH system lower anchor locationsWRS0718

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-21

Page 40: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

LATCH lower anchor locationThe LATCH lower anchors are located at the rearof the seat cushion near the seatback. A label isattached to the seatback to help you locate theLATCH lower anchors.

Installing child restraint LATCH loweranchor attachments

LATCH compatible child restraints include tworigid or webbing-mounted attachments that canbe connected to two anchors located at certainseating positions in your vehicle. With this sys-tem, you do not have to use a vehicle seat belt tosecure the child restraint. Check your child re-straint for a label stating that it is compatible withLATCH. This information may also be in the in-structions provided by the child restraint manu-facturer.

When installing a child restraint, carefully readand follow the instructions in this manual andthose supplied with the child restraint.

LATCH lower anchor locationWRS0700

LATCH webbing-mounted attachmentLRS0661

LATCH rigid-mounted attachmentLRS0662

1-22 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 41: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Top tether anchor point locationsThe child restraint top tether strap must be usedwhen installing the child restraint with the LATCHlower anchor attachments or seat belts. See “In-stalling top tether strap” later in this section.

If you have any questions when installing atop tether strap child restraint on the rearseat, consult your NISSAN dealer for de-tails.

Anchor points �1 are located on the rear parcelshelf.

REAR-FACING CHILD RESTRAINTINSTALLATION USING LATCHRefer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Childsafety” and “Child restraints” sections before in-stalling a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a rear-facing childrestraint using the LATCH system:

1. Position the child restraint on the seat. Al-ways follow the child restraint manufactur-er’s instructions.

2. Secure the child restraint anchor attach-ments to the LATCH lower anchors. Checkto make sure the LATCH attachment is prop-erly attached to the lower anchors.

LRS0243Rear-facing web-mounted – step 2

WRS0801

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-23

Page 42: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

3. For child restraints that are equipped withwebbing-mounted attachments, remove anyadditional slack from the anchor attach-ments. Press downward and rearward firmlyin the center of the child restraint with yourhand to compress the vehicle seat cushionand seatback while tightening the webbingof the anchor attachments.

4. After attaching the child restraint, test it be-fore you place the child in it. Push it from sideto side while holding the child restraint nearthe LATCH attachment path. The child re-straint should not move more than 1 inch (25mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forwardand check to see if the LATCH attachmentholds the restraint in place. If the restraint isnot secure, tighten the LATCH attachment asnecessary, or put the restraint in another seatand test it again. You may need to try adifferent child restraint or try installing byusing the vehicle seat belt (if applicable). Notall child restraints fit in all types of vehicles.

Rear-facing rigid-mounted – step 2WRS0802

Rear-facing – step 3LRS0673

Rear-facing – step 4LRS0674

1-24 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 43: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

5. Check to make sure the child restraint isproperly secured prior to each use. If thechild restraint is loose, repeat steps 1through 4.

REAR-FACING CHILD RESTRAINTINSTALLATION USING THE SEATBELTS

WARNING

The three-point seat belt with AutomaticLocking Retractor (ALR) must be usedwhen installing a child restraint. Failure touse the ALR mode will result in the childrestraint not being properly secured. Therestraint could tip over or be loose andcause injury to a child in a sudden stop orcollision. Also, it can change the opera-tion of the front passenger air bag. See“Front passenger air bag and status light”later in this section.

WRS0256

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-25

Page 44: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Childsafety” and “Child restraints” sections before in-stalling a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a rear-facing childrestraint using the vehicle seat belts in the rearseats:

1. Child restraints for infants must beused in the rear-facing direction andtherefore must not be used in the frontseat. Position the child restraint on the seat.Always follow the restraint manufacturer’sinstructions.

2. Route the seat belt tongue through the childrestraint and insert it into the buckle until youhear and feel the latch engage. Be sure tofollow the child restraint manufacturer’s in-structions for belt routing.

3. Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fullyextended. At this time, the seat belt retractoris in the Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)mode (child restraint mode). It reverts to theEmergency Locking Retractor (ELR) modewhen the seat belt is fully retracted.

Rear-facing – step 1WRS0256

Rear-facing – step 2WRS0761

Rear-facing – step 3LRS0669

1-26 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 45: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

4. Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on theshoulder belt to remove any slack in the belt.

5. Remove any additional slack from the seatbelt; press downward and rearward firmly inthe center of the child restraint to compressthe vehicle seat cushion and seatback whilepulling up on the seat belt.

6. After attaching the child restraint, test it be-fore you place the child in it. Push it from sideto side while holding the child restraint nearthe seat belt path. The child restraint shouldnot move more than 1 inch (25 mm), fromside to side. Try to tug it forward and checkto see if the belt holds the restraint in place.If the restraint is not secure, tighten the seatbelt as necessary, or put the restraint inanother seat and test it again. You may needto try a different child restraint. Not all childrestraints fit in all types of vehicles.

Rear-facing – step 4LRS0670

Rear-facing – step 5WRS0762

Rear-facing – step 6WRS0763

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-27

Page 46: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

7. Check to make sure that the child restraint isproperly secured prior to each use. If theseat belt is not locked, repeat steps 1through 6.

After the child restraint is removed and the seatbelt fully retracted, the ALR mode (child restraintmode) is canceled.

FORWARD-FACING CHILDRESTRAINT INSTALLATION USINGLATCHRefer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Childsafety” and “Child restraints” sections before in-stalling a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a forward-facingchild restraint using the LATCH system:

1. Position the child restraint on the seat. Al-ways follow the child restraint manufactur-er’s instructions.

2. Secure the child restraint anchor attach-ments to the LATCH lower anchors. Checkto make sure the LATCH attachment is prop-erly attached to the lower anchors.

If the child restraint is equipped with a toptether strap, route the top tether strap andsecure the tether strap to the tether anchorpoint. See “Installing top tether strap” in thissection. Do not install child restraints thatrequire the use of a top tether strap in seat-ing positions that do not have a top tetheranchor.

3. The back of the child restraint should besecured against the vehicle seatback.

If necessary, adjust or remove the head re-straint to obtain the correct child restraint fit. Ifthe head restraint is removed, store it in asecure place. Be sure to reinstall the headrestraint when the child restraint is re-moved. See “Head restraints” in this sectionfor head restraint adjustment information.

If the seating position does not have anadjustable head restraint and it is interferingwith the proper child restraint fit, try anotherseating position or a different child restraint.

Forward-facing web-mounted – step 2WRS0799

Forward-facing rigid-mounted – step 2WRS0800

1-28 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 47: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

4. For child restraints that are equipped withwebbing-mounted attachments, remove anyadditional slack from the anchor attach-ments. Press downward and rearward firmlyin the center of the child restraint with yourknee to compress the vehicle seat cushionand seatback while tightening the webbingof the anchor attachments.

5. Tighten the tether strap according to themanufacturer’s instructions to remove anyslack.

6. After attaching the child restraint, test it be-fore you place the child in it. Push it from sideto side while holding the child restraint nearthe LATCH attachment path. The child re-straint should not move more than 1 inch (25mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forwardand check to see if the LATCH attachmentholds the restraint in place. If the restraint isnot secure, tighten the LATCH attachmentas necessary, or put the restraint in anotherseat and test it again. You may need to try adifferent child restraint. Not all child re-straints fit in all types of vehicles.

7. Check to make sure the child restraint isproperly secured prior to each use. If thechild restraint is loose, repeat steps 1through 6.

FORWARD-FACING CHILDRESTRAINT INSTALLATION USINGTHE SEAT BELTS

WARNING

The three-point seat belt with AutomaticLocking Retractor (ALR) must be usedwhen installing a child restraint. Failure touse the ALR mode will result in the childrestraint not being properly secured. Therestraint could tip over or be loose andcause injury to a child in a sudden stop orcollision. Also, it can change the opera-tion of the front passenger air bag. See“Front passenger air bag and status light”later in this section.

Forward-facing – step 4LRS0671

Forward-facing – step 6WRS0697

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-29

Page 48: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “ChildSafety” and “Child Restraints” sections beforeinstalling a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a forward-facingchild restraint using the vehicle seat belt in therear seats or in the front passenger seat:

1. If you must install a child restraint inthe front seat, it should be placed in aforward-facing direction only. Movethe seat to the rearmost position. Childrestraints for infants must be used inthe rear-facing direction and thereforemust not be used in the front seat.

2. Position the child restraint on the seat. Al-ways follow the child restraint manufactur-er’s instructions.

The back of the child restraint should besecured against the vehicle seatback.

If necessary, adjust or remove the head re-straint to obtain the correct child restraint fit.If the head restraint is removed, store it in asecure place. Be sure to reinstall thehead restraint when the child restraintis removed. See “Head restraints” in thissection for head restraint adjustment, re-moval and installation information.

If the seating position does not have anadjustable head restraint and it is interferingwith the proper child restraint fit, try anotherseating position or a different child restraint.

3. Route the seat belt tongue through the childrestraint and insert it into the buckle until youhear and feel the latch engage. Be sure tofollow the child restraint manufacturer’s in-structions for belt routing.

If the child restraint is equipped with a toptether strap, route the top tether strap andsecure the tether strap to the tether anchorpoint (rear seat installation only). See “In-stalling top tether strap” in this section. Donot install child restraints that require the useof a top tether strap in seating positions thatdo not have a top tether anchor.

Forward-facing (front passenger seat) –step 1

WRS0699

Forward-facing – step 3WRS0680

1-30 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 49: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

4. Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fullyextended. At this time, the seat belt retractoris in the Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)mode (child restraint mode). It reverts toEmergency Locking Retractor (ELR) modewhen the seat belt is fully retracted.

5. Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on theshoulder belt to remove any slack in the belt.

6. Remove any additional slack from the seatbelt; press downward and rearward firmly inthe center of the child restraint with yourknee to compress the vehicle seat cushionand seatback while pulling up on the seatbelt.

7. Tighten the tether strap according to themanufacturer’s instructions to remove anyslack.

Forward-facing – step 4LRS0667

Forward-facing – step 5LRS0668

Forward-facing – step 6WRS0681

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-31

Page 50: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

8. After attaching the child restraint, test it be-fore you place the child in it. Push it from sideto side while holding the child restraint nearthe seat belt path. The child restraint shouldnot move more than 1 inch (25 mm), fromside to side. Try to tug it forward and checkto see if the belt holds the restraint in place.If the restraint is not secure, tighten the seatbelt as necessary, or put the restraint inanother seat and test it again. You may needto try a different child restraint. Not all childrestraints fit in all types of vehicles.

9. Check to make sure the child restraint isproperly secured prior to each use. If theseat belt is not locked, repeat steps 3through 8.

10. If the child restraint is installed in the frontpassenger seat, place the ignition switch inthe ON position. The front passenger air bagstatus light should illuminate. If thislight is not illuminated see �Front passengerair bag and status light� in this section.Move the child restraint to anotherseating position. Have the systemchecked by a NISSAN dealer.

After the child restraint is removed and the seatbelt is fully retracted, the ALR mode (child re-straint mode) is canceled.

Forward-facing – step 8WRS0698

Forward-facing – step 10LRS0865

1-32 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 51: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

INSTALLING TOP TETHER STRAPFirst, secure the child restraint with the LATCHlower anchors (rear outboard seat positions only)or the seat belt, as applicable.

1. Flip up the anchor cover �1 from the anchorpoint which is located directly behind thechild seat.

2. If necessary, raise or remove the head re-straint to position the top tether strap overthe top of the seatback. If the head restraintis removed, store it in a secure place. Besure to reinstall the head restraint when thechild restraint is removed. See “Head re-straints” in this section for head re-straint adjustment, removal and instal-lation information.

3. Secure the tether strap to the tether anchorpoint on the rear parcel shelf.

4. Refer to the appropriate child restraint in-stallation procedure steps in this sectionbefore tightening the tether strap.

If you have any questions when installing atop tether strap, consult your NISSANdealer for details.

BOOSTER SEATSPrecautions on booster seats

WARNING

If a booster seat and seat belt are not usedproperly, the risk of a child being injuredin a sudden stop or collision greatlyincreases:

– Make sure the shoulder portion ofthe belt is away from the child’s faceand neck and the lap portion of thebelt does not cross the stomach.

– Make sure the shoulder belt is notbehind the child or under the child’sarm.

– A booster seat must only be installedin a seating position that has alap/shoulder belt.

LRS0243

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-33

Page 52: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Booster seats of various sizes are offered byseveral manufacturers. When selecting anybooster seat, keep the following points in mind:

● Choose only a booster seat with a labelcertifying that it complies with Federal MotorVehicle Safety Standard 213 or CanadianMotor Vehicle Safety Standard 213.

● Check the booster seat in your vehicle to besure it is compatible with the vehicle’s seatand seat belt system.

LRS0455 LRS0453 LRS0464

1-34 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 53: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Make sure the child’s head will be properlysupported by the booster seat or vehicleseat. The seatback must be at or above thecenter of the child’s ears. For example, if alow back booster seat �1 is chosen, thevehicle seatback must be at or above thecenter of the child’s ears. If the seatback islower than the center of the child’s ears, ahigh back booster seat �2 should be used.

● If the booster seat is compatible with yourvehicle, place the child in the booster seatand check the various adjustments to besure the booster seat is compatible with thechild. Always follow all recommended pro-cedures.

All U.S. states and Canadian provinces orterritories require that infants and smallchildren be restrained in an approved childrestraint at all times while the vehicle isbeing operated.

The instructions in this section apply to boosterseat installation in the rear seats or the frontpassenger seat.

Booster seat installation

CAUTION

Do not use the lap/shoulder belt in theAutomatic Locking Retractor mode whenusing a booster seat with the seat belts.

Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “ChildSafety”, “Child Restraint” and “Booster Seats”sections before installing a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a booster seat in therear seat or in the front passenger seat:

1. If you must install a booster seat in thefront seat, move the seat to the rear-most position.

2. Position the booster seat on the seat. Onlyplace it in a front-facing direction. Alwaysfollow the booster seat manufacturer’s in-structions.

WRS0699

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-35

Page 54: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

3. The booster seat should be positioned onthe vehicle seat so that it is stable.

If necessary, adjust or remove the head re-straint to obtain the correct booster seat fit. Ifthe head restraint is removed, store it in asecure place. Be sure to reinstall thehead restraint when the booster seat isremoved. See “Head restraints” in this sec-tion for head restraint adjustment, removaland installation information.

If the seating position does not have anadjustable head restraint and it is interferingwith the proper booster seat fit, try anotherseating position or a different booster seat.

4. Position the lap portion of the seat belt lowand snug on the child’s hips. Be sure tofollow the booster seat manufacturer’s in-structions for adjusting the seat belt routing.

5. Pull the shoulder belt portion of the seat belttoward the retractor to take up extra slack.Be sure the shoulder belt is positionedacross the top, middle portion of the child’sshoulder. Be sure to follow the booster seatmanufacturer’s instructions for adjusting theseat belt routing.

6. Follow the warnings, cautions and instruc-tions for properly fastening a seat beltshown in “Three-point type seat belt withretractor” earlier in this section.

7. If the booster seat is installed in the frontpassenger seat, place the ignition switch inthe ON position. The front passenger air bagstatus light may or may not illuminate,depending on the size of the child and thetype of booster seat being used. See “Frontpassenger air bag and status light” later inthis section.

Front passenger positionLRS0454 LRS0865

1-36 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 55: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

PRECAUTIONS ON SUPPLEMENTALRESTRAINT SYSTEM

This Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) sec-tion contains important information concerningthe following systems:

● Driver and passenger supplemental front-impact air bag (NISSAN Advanced Air BagSystem)

● Front seat-mounted side-impact supple-mental air bag

● Roof-mounted curtain side-impact supple-mental air bag

● Seat belt with pretensioner

Supplemental front-impact air bag system:The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System can helpcushion the impact force to the head and chest ofthe driver and front passenger in certain frontalcollisions.

Front seat-mounted side-impact supple-mental air bag system: This system can helpcushion the impact force to the chest and pelvicarea of the driver and front passenger in certainside-impact collisions. The side air bags are de-signed to inflate on the side where the vehicle isimpacted.

Roof-mounted curtain side-impact supple-mental air bag system: This system can helpcushion the impact force to the head of occu-pants in front and rear outboard seating positionsin certain side-impact collisions. The curtain airbags are designed to inflate on the side wherethe vehicle is impacted.

These supplemental restraint systems are de-signed to supplement the crash protection pro-vided by the driver and front passenger seat beltsand are not a substitute for them. Seat beltsshould always be correctly worn and the occu-pant seated a suitable distance away from thesteering wheel, instrument panel and door finish-ers. (See “Seat belts” earlier in this section forinstructions and precautions on seat belt usage.)

The supplemental air bags operate onlywhen the ignition switch is in the ON orSTART position.

After placing the ignition switch in the ONposition, the supplemental air bag warninglight illuminates. The supplemental air bagwarning light will turn off after about 7seconds if the system is operational.

SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINTSYSTEM

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-37

Page 56: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● The front air bags ordinarily will notinflate in the event of a side impact, rearimpact, rollover, or lower severity fron-tal collision. Always wear your seatbelts to help reduce the risk or severityof injury in various kinds of accidents.

● The front passenger air bag will notinflate if the passenger air bag statuslight is lit or if the front passenger seatis unoccupied. See “Front passenger airbag and status light” later in thissection.

● The seat belts and the front air bags aremost effective when you are sitting wellback and upright in the seat. The frontair bags inflate with great force. Evenwith the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag Sys-tem, if you are unrestrained, leaningforward, sitting sideways or out of posi-tion in any way, you are at greater risk ofinjury or death in a crash. You may alsoreceive serious or fatal injuries from thefront air bag if you are up against itwhen it inflates. Always sit back againstthe seatback and as far away as practi-cal from the steering wheel or instru-ment panel. Always use the seat belts.

● The driver and front passenger seat beltbuckles are equipped with sensors thatdetect if the seat belts are fastened. TheAdvanced Air Bag System monitors theseverity of a collision and seat belt us-age then inflates the air bags asneeded. Failure to properly wear seatbelts can increase the risk or severity ofinjury in an accident.

● The front passenger seat is equippedwith an occupant classification sensor(pattern sensor) that turns the frontpassenger air bag OFF under someconditions. This sensor is only used inthis seat. Failure to be properly seatedand wearing the seat belt can increasethe risk or severity of injury in an acci-dent. See “Front passenger air bag andstatus light” later in this section.

● Keep hands on the outside of the steer-ing wheel. Placing them inside thesteering wheel rim could increase therisk that they are injured when the frontair bag inflates.

WRS0031

1-38 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 57: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● Never let children ride unrestrained orextend their hands or face out of thewindow. Do not attempt to hold them inyour lap or arms. Some examples ofdangerous riding positions are shownin the illustrations

ARS1133 ARS1041

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-39

Page 58: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● Children may be severely injured orkilled when the front air bags, side airbags or curtain air bags inflate if theyare not properly restrained. Pre-teensand children should be properly re-strained in the rear seat, if possible.

ARS1042 ARS1043 ARS1044

1-40 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 59: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● Even with the NISSAN Advanced AirBag System, never install a rear-facingchild restraint in the front seat. An in-flating front air bag could seriously in-jure or kill your child. See “Child re-straints” earlier in this section fordetails.

WARNING

Front seat-mounted side-impact supple-mental air bags and roof-mounted curtainside-impact supplemental air bags:

● The side air bags and curtain air bagsordinarily will not inflate in the event ofa frontal impact, rear impact, rollover orlower severity side collision. Alwayswear your seat belts to help reduce therisk or severity of injury in various kindsof accidents.

ARS1045 WRS0256 SSS0101

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-41

Page 60: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● The seat belts, the side air bags andcurtain air bags are most effective whenyou are sitting well back and upright inthe seat with both feet on the floor. Theside air bag and curtain air bag inflatewith great force. Do not allow anyone toplace their hand, leg or face near theside air bag on the side of the seatbackof the front seat or near the side roofrails. Do not allow anyone sitting in thefront seats or rear outboard seats toextend their hand out of the window orlean against the door. Some examplesof dangerous riding positions areshown in the previous illustrations. WARNING

● When sitting in the rear seat, do nothold onto the seatback of the front seat.If the side air bag inflates, you may beseriously injured. Be especially carefulwith children, who should always beproperly restrained. Some examples ofdangerous riding positions are shownin the illustrations.

● Do not use seat covers on the frontseatbacks. They may interfere with sideair bag inflation.

SSS0188 WRS0032

1-42 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 61: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

SSS0159 SSS0162

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-43

Page 62: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Roof-mounted curtain side-impactsupplemental air bag inflators

2. Roof-mounted curtain side-impactsupplemental air bags

3. Front seat-mounted side-impactsupplemental air bag modules

4. Air bag Control Unit (ACU)5. Supplemental front-impact air bag

modules6. Crash zone sensor7. Occupant classification system control

unit

8. Seat belt buckle switches for driver’sand passenger’s side

9. Occupant classification sensor (patternsensor)

10. Seat belt with pretensioner11. Side satellite sensor

NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System(front seats)

This vehicle is equipped with the NISSAN Ad-vanced Air Bag System for the driver and frontpassenger seats. This system is designed tomeet certification requirements under U.S. regu-lations. It is also permitted in Canada. However,all of the information, cautions and warn-ings in this manual still apply and must befollowed.

The driver supplemental front-impact air bag islocated in the center of the steering wheel. Thepassenger supplemental front-impact air bag ismounted in the instrument panel above the glovebox. The front air bags are designed to inflate inhigher severity frontal collisions, although theymay inflate if the forces in another type of collisionare similar to those of a higher severity frontalimpact. They may not inflate in certain frontalcollisions. Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is notalways an indication of proper front air bag sys-tem operation.

WRS0466

1-44 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 63: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System has dualstage inflators. It also monitors information fromthe crash zone sensor, the Air Bag Control Unit(ACU), seat belt buckle sensors and the occu-pant classification sensor (pattern sensor). Infla-tor operation is based on the severity of a colli-sion and seat belt usage for the driver. For thefront passenger, the occupant classification sen-sor is also monitored. Based on information fromthe sensors, only one front air bag may inflate in acrash, depending on the crash severity andwhether the front occupants are belted or un-belted. Additionally, the front passenger air bagmay be automatically turned OFF under someconditions, depending on the weight detected onthe passenger seat and how the seat belt is used.If the front passenger air bag is OFF, the passen-ger air bag status light will be illuminated (if theseat is unoccupied, the light will not be illumi-nated, but the air bag will be off). See “Frontpassenger air bag and status light” later in thissection for further details. One front air bag inflat-ing does not indicate improper performance ofthe system.

If you have any questions about your air bagsystem, please contact NISSAN or your NISSANdealer. If you are considering modification of yourvehicle due to a disability, you may also contactNISSAN. Contact information is contained in thefront of this Owner’s Manual.

When a front air bag inflates, a fairly loud noisemay be heard, followed by the release of smoke.This smoke is not harmful and does not indicate afire. Care should be taken to not inhale it, as it maycause irritation and choking. Those with a historyof a breathing condition should get fresh airpromptly.

Front air bags, along with the use of seat belts,help to cushion the impact force on the face andchest of the front occupants. They can help savelives and reduce serious injuries. However, aninflating front air bag may cause facial abrasionsor other injuries. Front air bags do not providerestraint to the lower body.

Even with NISSAN advanced air bags, seat beltsshould be correctly worn and the driver and pas-senger seated upright as far as practical awayfrom the steering wheel or instrument panel. Thefront air bags inflate quickly in order to helpprotect the front occupants. Because of this, theforce of the front air bag inflating can increase therisk of injury if the occupant is too close to, or isagainst, the front air bag module during inflation.

The front air bags deflate quickly after a collision.

The front air bags operate only when theignition switch is in the ON or START posi-tion.

After placing the ignition switch in the ONposition, the supplemental air bag warninglight illuminates. The supplemental air bagwarning light will turn off after about 7seconds if the system is operational.

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-45

Page 64: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Front passenger air bag and status light

WARNING

The front passenger air bag is designed toautomatically turn OFF under some con-ditions. Read this section carefully tolearn how it operates. Proper use of theseat, seat belt and child restraints is nec-essary for most effective protection. Fail-ure to follow all instructions in thismanual concerning the use of seats, seatbelts and child restraints can increase therisk or severity of injury in an accident.

Status light

The front passenger air bag status light islocated above the radio. After the ignition switchis placed in the �ON� position, the front passen-ger air bag status light on the instrument panelilluminates for about 7 seconds and then turns offor remains illuminated depending on the frontpassenger seat occupied status. The light oper-ates as follows:

● Unoccupied passenger’s seat: The isOFF and the front passenger air bag is OFFand will not inflate in a crash.

● Passenger’s seat occupied by a small adult,child or child restraint as outlined in thissection: The illuminates to indicatethat the front passenger air bag is OFF andwill not inflate in a crash.

● Occupied passenger seat and the passengermeets the conditions outlined in this section:The light is OFF to indicate that thefront passenger air bag is operational.

Front passenger air bag

The front passenger air bag is designed to auto-matically turn OFF when the vehicle is operatedunder some conditions as described below inaccordance with U.S. regulations. If the frontpassenger air bag is OFF, it will not inflate in a

crash. The driver air bag and other air bags in yourvehicle are not part of this system.

The purpose of the regulation is to help reducethe risk of injury or death from an inflating air bagto certain front passenger seat occupants, suchas children, by requiring the air bag to be auto-matically turned OFF. Certain sensors are usedto meet the requirements.

One sensor used is the occupant classificationsensor (pattern sensor). It is in the bottom of thefront passenger seat cushion and is designed todetect an occupant and objects on the seat byweight. It works together with seat belt sensorsdescribed later. For example, if a child is in the frontpassenger seat, the Advanced Air Bag System isdesigned to turn the passenger air bag OFF inaccordance with the regulations. Also, if a childrestraint of the type specified in the regulations ison the seat, its weight and the child’s weight can bedetected and cause the air bag to turn OFF. Occu-pant classification sensor operation can vary de-pending on the front passenger seat belt sensors.

The front passenger seat belt sensors are de-signed to detect if the seat belt is buckled. Basedon the weight on the seat detected by the occu-pant classification sensor, the Advanced Air BagSystem determines whether the front passengerair bag should be automatically turned OFF asrequired by the regulations.

LRS0865

1-46 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 65: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Front passenger seat adult occupants who areproperly seated and using the seat belt as out-lined in this manual should not cause the passen-ger air bag to be automatically turned OFF. Forsmall adults it may be turned OFF, however if theoccupant takes his/her weight off the seat cush-ion (for example, by not sitting upright, by sittingon an edge of the seat, or by otherwise being outof position), this could cause the sensor to turnthe air bag OFF. In addition, if the occupantimproperly uses the seat belt in the ALR mode(child restraint mode), this could cause the airbag to be turned OFF. Always be sure to beseated and wearing the seat belt properly for themost effective protection by the seat belt andsupplemental air bag.

NISSAN recommends that pre-teens and chil-dren be properly restrained in a rear seat.NISSAN also recommends that appropriate childrestraints and booster seats be properly installedin a rear seat. If this is not possible, the occupantclassification sensor and seat belt sensors aredesigned to operate as described above to turnthe front passenger air bag OFF for specifiedchild restraints as required by the regulations.Failing to properly secure child restraints and touse the ALR mode (child restraint mode) mayallow the restraint to tip or move in an accident orsudden stop. This can also result in the passen-ger air bag inflating in a crash instead of being

OFF. See “Child restraints” earlier in this sectionfor proper use and installation.

If the front passenger seat is not occupied thepassenger air bag is designed not to inflate in acrash. However, heavy objects placed on theseat could result in air bag inflation, because ofthe object’s weight detected by the occupantclassification sensor. Other conditions could alsoresult in air bag inflation, such as if a child isstanding on the seat, or if two children are on theseat, contrary to the instructions in this manual.Always be sure that you and all vehicle occupantsare seated and restrained properly.

Using the passenger air bag status light, you canmonitor when the front passenger air bag is au-tomatically turned OFF with the seat occupied.The light will not illuminate when the front pas-senger seat is unoccupied.

If an adult occupant is in the seat but the passen-ger air bag status light is illuminated (indicatingthat the air bag is OFF), it could be that theperson is a small adult, or is not sitting on the seatproperly or not using the seat belt properly.

If a child restraint must be used in the front seat,the passenger air bag status light may or may notbe illuminated, depending on the size of the childand the type of child restraint being used. If the airbag status light is not illuminated (indicating thatthe air bag might inflate in a crash), it could be

that the child restraint or seat belt is not beingused properly. Make sure that the child restraint isinstalled properly, the seat belt is used properlyand the occupant is positioned properly. If the airbag status light is not illuminated, reposition theoccupant or child restraint in a rear seat.

If the passenger air bag status light will not illu-minate even though you believe that the childrestraint, the seat belts and the occupant areproperly positioned, the system may be sensingan unoccupied seat (in which case the air bag isOFF). Your NISSAN dealer can check that thesystem is OFF by using a special tool. However,until you have confirmed with your dealer thatyour air bag is working properly, reposition theoccupant or child restraint in a rear seat.

The air bag system and passenger air bag statuslight will take a few seconds to register a changein the passenger seat status. For example, if alarge adult who is sitting in the front passengerseat exits the vehicle, the passenger air bagstatus light will go from OFF to ON for a fewseconds and then to OFF. This is normal systemoperation and does not indicate a malfunction.

If a malfunction occurs in the front passenger air bagsystem, the supplemental air bag warninglight , located in the meter and gauges area onthe driver’s side of the instrument panel, will blink.Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-47

Page 66: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Other supplemental front-impact air bagprecautions

WARNING

● Do not place any objects on the steer-ing wheel pad or on the instrumentpanel. Also, do not place any objectsbetween any occupant and the steeringwheel or instrument panel. Such ob-jects may become dangerous projec-tiles and cause injury if the front airbags inflate.

● Immediately after inflation, severalfront air bag system components will behot. Do not touch them; you may se-verely burn yourself.

● No unauthorized changes should bemade to any components or wiring ofthe supplemental air bag system. This isto prevent accidental inflation of thesupplemental air bag or damage to thesupplemental air bag system.

● Do not make unauthorized changes toyour vehicle’s electrical system, sus-pension system or front end structure.This could affect proper operation ofthe supplemental front air bag system.

● Tampering with the front air bag systemmay result in serious personal injury.Tampering includes changes to thesteering wheel and the instrumentpanel assembly by placing materialover the steering wheel pad and abovethe instrument panel or by installingadditional trim material around the airbag system.

● Modifying or tampering with the frontpassenger seat may result in seriouspersonal injury. For example, do notchange the front seats by placing mate-rial on the seat cushion or by installingadditional trim material, such as seatcovers, on the seat that are not specifi-cally designed to assure proper air bagoperation. Additionally, do not stow anyobjects under the front passenger seator the seat cushion and seatback. Suchobjects may interfere with the properoperation of the occupant classifica-tion sensor (pattern sensor).

● No unauthorized changes should bemade to any components or wiring ofthe seat belt system. This may affect thefront air bag system. Tampering withthe seat belt system may result in seri-ous personal injury.

● Work on and around the front air bagsystem should be done by a NISSANdealer. Installation of electrical equip-ment should also be done by a NISSANdealer. The Supplemental RestraintSystem (SRS) wiring should not bemodified or disconnected. Unauthor-ized electrical test equipment and prob-ing devices should not be used on theair bag system.

● A cracked windshield should be re-placed immediately by a qualified re-pair facility. A cracked windshield couldaffect the function of the supplementalair bag system.

*The SRS wiring harness connectors areyellow and orange for easy identification.

When selling your vehicle, we request that youinform the buyer about the front air bag systemand guide the buyer to the appropriate sectionsin this Owner’s Manual.

1-48 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 67: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Front seat-mounted side-impactsupplemental air bag and roof-mounted curtain side-impactsupplemental air bag systems

The side air bags are located in the outside of theseatback of the front seats. The curtain air bagsare located in the side roof rails. These systemsare designed to meet voluntary guidelines to helpreduce the risk of injury to out-of-position occu-pants. However, all of the information, cau-tions and warnings in this manual still ap-ply and must be followed. The side air bagsand curtain air bags are designed to inflate inhigher severity side collisions, although they may

inflate if the forces in another type of collision aresimilar to those of a higher severity side impact.They are designed to inflate on the side where thevehicle is impacted. They may not inflate in cer-tain side collisions.

Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is not always anindication of proper side air bag and curtain airbag operation.

When the side air bags and curtain air bagsinflate, a fairly loud noise may be heard, followedby release of smoke. This smoke is not harmfuland does not indicate a fire. Care should be takennot to inhale it, as it may cause irritation andchoking. Those with a history of a breathing con-dition should get fresh air promptly.

Side air bags, along with the use of seat belts,help to cushion the impact force on the chest andpelvic area of the front occupants. Curtain airbags help to cushion the impact force to the headof occupants in the front and rear outboard seat-ing positions. They can help save lives and re-duce serious injuries. However, an inflating sideair bag and curtain air bags may cause abrasionsor other injuries. Side air bags and curtain airbags do not provide restraint to the lower body.

The seat belts should be correctly worn and thedriver and passenger seated upright as far aspractical away from the side air bag. Rear seatpassengers should be seated as far away as

practical from the door finishers and side roofrails. The side air bags and curtain air bags inflatequickly in order to help protect the occupants.Because of this, the force of the side air bag andcurtain side-impact air bag inflating can increasethe risk of injury if the occupant is too close to, oris against, these air bag modules during inflation.The side air bag and curtain air bags will deflatequickly after the collision is over.

The side air bags and curtain air bags op-erate only when the ignition switch isplaced in the ON or START position.

After placing the ignition switch in the ONposition, the supplemental air bag warninglight illuminates. The supplemental air bagwarning light will turn off after about 7seconds if the system is operational.

WARNING

● Do not place any objects near the seat-back of the front seats. Also, do notplace any objects (an umbrella, bag,etc.) between the front door finisherand the front seat. Such objects maybecome dangerous projectiles andcause injury if a side air bag inflates.

LRS0259

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-49

Page 68: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Right after inflation, several side air bagand curtain air bag system componentswill be hot. Do not touch them; you mayseverely burn yourself.

● No unauthorized changes should bemade to any components or wiring ofthe side air bag and curtain air bagsystems. This is to prevent damage to oraccidental inflation of the side air bagand curtain air bag or damage to theside air bag and curtain air bag systems.

● Do not make unauthorized changes toyour vehicle’s electrical system, sus-pension system or side panel. Thiscould affect proper operation of theside air bag and curtain air bag system.

● Tampering with the side air bag systemmay result in serious personal injury.For example, do not change the frontseats by placing material near the seat-backs or by installing additional trimmaterial, such as seat covers, aroundthe side air bag.

● Work around and on the side air bagand curtain air bag systems should bedone by a NISSAN dealer. Installationof electrical equipment should also bedone by a NISSAN dealer. The SRS wir-ing harnesses* should not be modifiedor disconnected. Unauthorized electri-cal test equipment and probing devicesshould not be used on the side air bagor curtain air bag system.

* The SRS wiring harness connectors areyellow and orange for easy identification.

When selling your vehicle, we request that youinform the buyer about the side air bag andcurtain air bag systems and guide the buyer tothe appropriate sections in this Owner’s Manual.

Seat belts with pretensioners (frontseats)

WARNING

● The pretensioners cannot be reused af-ter activation. They must be replacedtogether with the retractor and buckleas a unit.

● If the vehicle becomes involved in acollision but a pretensioner is not acti-vated, be sure to have the pretensionersystem checked and, if necessary, re-placed by your NISSAN dealer.

● No unauthorized changes should bemade to any components or wiring ofthe pretensioner system. This is to pre-vent damage to or accidental activationof the pretensioners. Tampering withthe pretensioner system may result inserious personal injury.

● Work around and on the pretensionersystem should be done by a NISSANdealer. Installation of electrical equip-ment should also be done by a NISSANdealer. Unauthorized electrical testequipment and probing devices shouldnot be used on the pretensioner system.

● If you need to dispose of a pretensioneror scrap the vehicle, contact a NISSANdealer. Incorrect disposal procedurescould cause personal injury.

Working with the seat belt retractor, the preten-sioner helps tighten the seat belt when the ve-hicle becomes involved in certain types of colli-sions, helping to restrain front seat occupants.

1-50 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 69: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

The pretensioner is encased within the seat beltretractor. These seat belts are used the same wayas conventional seat belts.

When a pretensioner activates, smoke is re-leased and a loud noise may be heard. Thissmoke is not harmful and does not indicate a fire.Care should be taken not to inhale it, as it maycause irritation and choking. Those with a historyof a breathing condition should get fresh airpromptly.

After pretensioner activation, load limiters allowthe seat belt to release webbing (if necessary) toreduce forces against the chest.

The supplemental air bag warning light isused to indicate malfunctions in the pretensionersystem. (See �SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAGWARNING LIGHT� in this section for more de-tails.) If the operation of the supplemental air bagwarning light indicates there is a malfunction,have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

When selling your vehicle, we request that youinform the buyer about the pretensioner systemand guide the buyer to the appropriate sectionsin this Owner’s Manual.

1. SRS Air Bag Warning Labels (locatedon the sun visors)

SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAGWARNING LABELSWarning labels about the supplemental front-impact air bag system are placed in the vehicle asshown in the illustration.

SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAGWARNING LIGHTThe supplemental air bag warning light,displaying in the instrument panel, moni-tors the circuits for the air bag systems, preten-sioners and all related wiring.

When the ignition switch is placed in the ON orSTART position, the supplemental air bag warn-ing light illuminates for about 7 seconds and thenturns off. This means the system is operational.

WRS0895 LRS0100

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-51

Page 70: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

If any of the following conditions occur, the frontair bag, side air bag, curtain air bag and preten-sioner systems need servicing:

● The supplemental air bag warning light re-mains on after approximately 7 seconds.

● The supplemental air bag warning lightflashes intermittently.

● The supplemental air bag warning light doesnot come on at all.

Under these conditions, the front air bag, side airbag, curtain air bag or pretensioner systems maynot operate properly. They must be checked andrepaired. Take your vehicle to the nearestNISSAN dealer.

WARNING

If the supplemental air bag warning lightis on, it could mean that the front air bag,side air bag, curtain air bag and/or preten-sioner systems will not operate in an ac-cident. To help avoid injury to yourself orothers, have your vehicle checked by aNISSAN dealer as soon as possible.

Repair and replacement procedure

The front air bags, side air bags, curtain air bagsand pretensioners are designed to inflate on aone-time-only basis. As a reminder, unless it isdamaged, the supplemental air bag warning lightremains illuminated after inflation has occurred.Repair and replacement of these supplementalair bag systems should be done only by aNISSAN dealer.

When maintenance work is required on the ve-hicle, the front air bags, side air bags, curtain airbags, pretensioners and related parts should bepointed out to the person performing the mainte-nance. The ignition switch should always beplaced in the LOCK position when working underthe hood or inside the vehicle.

WARNING

● Once a front air bag, side air bag, orcurtain air bag has inflated, the air bagmodule will not function again andmust be replaced. Additionally, the ac-tivated pretensioner must also be re-placed. The air bag module and preten-sioner should be replaced by a NISSANdealer. The air bag module and preten-sioner cannot be repaired.

● The front air bag, side air bag, curtainair bag systems and the pretensionersystem should be inspected by aNISSAN dealer if there is any damage tothe front end or side portion of thevehicle.

● If you need to dispose of the supple-mental air bag or pretensioner systemsor scrap the vehicle, contact a NISSANdealer. Incorrect disposal procedurescould cause personal injury.

1-52 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Page 71: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

MEMO

Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-53

Page 72: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

2 Instruments and controls

Instrument panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2Meters and gauges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3

Speedometer and odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6

Compass display (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6Compass display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7

Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders . . . . . . 2-10Checking bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10Warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10Indicator lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14Audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16

Vehicle information display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17How to use the vehicle information display . . . . . . . 2-17

Security systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25Vehicle security system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26

Windshield wiper and washer switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28Switch operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28

Rear window and outside mirror (if so equipped)defroster switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29Headlight and turn signal switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29

Xenon headlights (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29Headlight control switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30Daytime running light system (Canada only) . . . . . . 2-32Instrument brightness control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33Turn signal switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33Fog light switch (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34

Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35Heated seats (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35Climate control seat switch (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . 2-36Heated steering wheel (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off switch. . . . . . . . . . . 2-38Power outlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39

Map pockets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39Seatback pockets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39Sunglasses holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39Cup holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-40Glove box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41Console box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-42Grocery hooks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-42Cargo net (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43

Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43

Page 73: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Power windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43Moonroof (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-46

Automatic moonroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-46Dual Panel Moonroof (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-48

Automatic moonroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-48Rear power sun shade (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50Interior light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-51

Console light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-52Personal lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-52Map lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-52Trunk light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53

HomeLink� universal transceiver (if so equipped). . . . . 2-53Programming HomeLink�. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-54Programming HomeLink� for Canadiancustomers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-55Operating the HomeLink� universaltransceiver. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-55Programming trouble-diagnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-55Clearing the programmed information . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-56Reprogramming a single HomeLink� button . . . . . . 2-56If your vehicle is stolen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-56

Page 74: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Side and center vents (P. 4-40)2. Headlight/fog light (if so equipped)/turn

signal switch (P. 2-29)3. Steering wheel switch for audio control

and Bluetooth� Hands-Free PhoneSystem (P. 4-113, 4-116)

4. Meters and gauges (P. 2-3)5. Driver supplemental air bag/horn

(P. 1-37, P. 2-35)6. Security indicator light (P. 2-25)7. Cruise control main/set switches

(P. 5-18)

8. Shift paddles (if so equipped) (P. 5-15)9. Windshield wiper/washer switch

(P. 2-28)10. Display screen/Navigation system*

(if so equipped) (P. 4-16)11. Display screen/Navigation system*

controls (if so equipped) (P. 4-16)12. Front passenger supplemental air bag

(P. 1-51)13. Glove box (P. 2-41)14. Display screen (models without

Navigation system) (P. 4-4)15. Climate controls (models without

Navigation system) (P. 4-41)16. Audio system controls (models without

Navigation system) (P. 4-47)17. Front passenger air bag status light

(P. 1-44)18. Audio system controls (P. 4-47)19. Climate controls (models with

Navigation system) (P. 4-44)20. Shift selector (P. 5-11)21. Hazard warning flasher switch (P. 2-34)22. Ignition switch (behind the steering

wheel) (P. 5-7)23. Tilt/telescopic steering wheel controls

(if so equipped) (P. 3-23)

WIC1535

INSTRUMENT PANEL

2-2 Instruments and controls

Page 75: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

24. Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFFswitch (P. 2-38)Outside mirror controls (P. 3-28)Heated steering wheel switch(if so equipped) (P. 2-37)Trunk lid release switch (P. 3-20)

* Refer to the separate Navigation System Own-er’s Manual (if so equipped).

See the page number indicated in paren-theses for operating details.

1. Tachometer2. Speedometer3. Warning/indicator lights4. Fuel gauge5. Odometer/twin trip odometer6. Trip odometer change button

7. Engine coolant temperature gauge8. Vehicle information display

LIC1381

METERS AND GAUGES

Instruments and controls 2-3

Page 76: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

SPEEDOMETER AND ODOMETER

SpeedometerThe speedometer indicates the vehicle speed.

Odometer/Twin trip odometer

The odometer/twin trip odometer is displayedwhen the ignition switch is placed in the ONposition.

The odometer �1 records the total distance thevehicle has been driven.

The twin trip odometer �2 records the distanceof individual trips.

Changing the display:

Press the change button �3 to change the dis-play as follows:

Trip → Trip → Trip

Resetting the trip odometer:

Press the change button �3 for more than 1second to reset the currently displayed tripodometer to zero.

Elapsed time, driving distance and averagespeed information is also available. Refer to“Control panel buttons” in the “Monitor, climate,audio, phone and voice recognition systems”section in this manual.

LIC1382 LIC1383

2-4 Instruments and controls

Page 77: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

TACHOMETERThe tachometer indicates engine speed in revo-lutions per minute (rpm). Do not rev the engineinto the red zone �1 .

CAUTION

When engine speed approaches the redzone, shift to a higher gear or reduce en-gine speed. Operating the engine in thered zone may cause serious enginedamage.

ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATUREGAUGE

The gauge indicates the engine coolant tempera-ture. The engine coolant temperature is within thenormal range �1 when the gauge needle pointswithin the zone shown in the illustration.

The engine coolant temperature varies with theoutside air temperature and driving conditions.

CAUTION

If the gauge indicates coolant tempera-ture near the hot (H) end of the normalrange, reduce vehicle speed to decreasetemperature. If the gauge is over the nor-mal range, stop the vehicle as soon assafely possible. If the engine is over-heated, continued operation of the ve-hicle may seriously damage the engine.See “If your vehicle overheats” in the “Incase of emergency”section for immediateaction required.

LIC1384 LIC1386

Instruments and controls 2-5

Page 78: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

FUEL GAUGE

The gauge indicates the approximate fuel levelin the tank.

The gauge may move slightly during braking,turning, acceleration, or going up or down hills.

The gauge needle returns to E (Empty) after theignition is placed in the OFF position.

The low fuel warning light comes on when theamount of fuel in the tank is getting low.

Refill the fuel tank before the gauge regis-ters E (Empty).

The indicates that the fuel-filler door islocated on the driver’s side of the vehicle.

CAUTION

● If the vehicle runs out of fuel,

the Malfunction Indicator Light

(MIL) may come on. Refuel as soon aspossible. After a few driving trips,

the light should turn off. If the

light remains on after a few drivingtrips, have the vehicle inspected by aNISSAN dealer.

● For additional information, see “Mal-function Indicator Light (MIL)” later inthis section.

This unit measures terrestrial magnetism and in-dicates the heading direction of the vehicle.

With the ignition placed in the ON position, pressthe button as described in the charts be-low to activate various features of the automaticanti-glare rearview mirror.

Push and hold

thebutton for about:

Feature:(Push button again for about 1 sec-ond to change settings)

1 second Compass display toggles on/off

8 secondsCompass zone can be changed tocorrect false compass readings

10 seconds Compass enters calibration mode

For information about the automatic anti-glarefeature, refer to “Automatic anti-glare rearviewmirror” in the “Pre-driving checks and adjust-ments” section.

LIC1385

COMPASS DISPLAY (if so equipped)

2-6 Instruments and controls

Page 79: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

COMPASS DISPLAY

Push the button for about 1 second whenthe ignition switch is placed in the ON position totoggle the outside temperature and compassdirection display �1 on or off. The display willindicate the direction that the vehicle is heading.

N: NorthE: EastS: SouthW: West

If the display reads “C”, calibrate the compass bydriving the vehicle in three complete circles atless than 5 MPH (8 km/h).

You can also calibrate the compass by drivingyour vehicle on your everyday route. The com-pass will be calibrated once it has tracked threecomplete circles.

LIC1487

Instruments and controls 2-7

Page 80: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Zone variation change procedure

The difference between magnetic north and geo-graphical north is known as variance. In someareas, this difference can sometimes be greatenough to cause false compass readings. Followthese instructions to set the variance for yourparticular location if this happens:

1. Press and hold the button for about 8seconds. The current zone number will ap-pear in the display. Release the button.

2. Find your current location on the zone map.Refer to the illustration.

3. Press the button repeatedly to togglethrough the zone numbers until the desirednumber appears in the display. Once youhave selected a zone number, the displaywill show a compass direction within a fewseconds.

NOTE:

Use zone number 5 for Hawaii.

Inaccurate compass direction

The compass display is equipped with automaticcorrection function. If the correct direction is notshown, follow this procedure.

WIC0355

2-8 Instruments and controls

Page 81: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. With the display turned on, press and holdthe for about 10 seconds. The “C”icon in the compass display will illuminate.

2. Calibrate the compass by driving the vehiclein three complete circles at a maximumspeed of 5 MPH (8 km/h).

3. After completing the circles, the displayshould return to normal.

CAUTION

● Do not install a ski rack, antenna, etc.,which are attached to the vehicle bymeans of a magnet. They affect the op-eration of the compass.

● When cleaning the mirror, use a papertowel or similar material dampenedwith glass cleaner. Do not spray glasscleaner directly on the mirror as it maycause the liquid cleaner to enter themirror housing.

Instruments and controls 2-9

Page 82: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

or Anti-lock Braking System (ABS)warning light

Supplemental air bag warning light Security indicator light

or Brake warning light Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) indi-cator light

Side light and headlight indicator light (green)

Charge warning light Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) po-sition indicator light

Slip indicator light

Engine oil pressure warning light Cruise main switch indicator light Turn signal/hazard indicator lights

Low tire pressure warning light Front passenger air bag status light Vehicle Dynamic Control OFF indicator light

Master warning light High beam indicator light (blue)

Seat belt warning light and chime Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)

CHECKING BULBS

With all doors closed, apply the parking brakeand place the ignition switch in the ON positionwithout starting the engine. The following lightswill come on:

, or , , , ,

If equipped, the following lights come on brieflyand then go off:

or , , , , ,

If any light fails to come on, it may indicatea burned-out bulb or an open circuit in theelectrical system. Have the system repairedpromptly.

WARNING LIGHTS

For additional information on warnings and indi-cators, see “Vehicle information display” later inthis section.

WARNING/INDICATOR LIGHTS ANDAUDIBLE REMINDERS

2-10 Instruments and controls

Page 83: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

or Anti-lock BrakingSystem (ABS)warning light

When the ignition switch is placed in the ONposition, the Anti-lock Braking System (ABS)warning light illuminates and then turns off. Thisindicates the ABS is operational.

If the ABS warning light illuminates while theengine is running, or while driving, it may indicatethe ABS is not functioning properly. Have thesystem checked by a NISSAN dealer.

If an ABS malfunction occurs, the anti-lock func-tion is turned off. The brake system then operatesnormally, but without anti-lock assistance. See“Brake system” in the “Starting and driving” sec-tion.

or Brake warning light

This light functions for both the parking brake andthe foot brake systems.

Parking brake indicator

When the ignition switch is placed in the ONposition, the light comes on when the parkingbrake is applied.

Low brake fluid warning light

When the ignition switch is placed in the ONposition, the light warns of a low brake fluid level.If the light comes on while the engine is runningwith the parking brake not applied, stop the ve-hicle and perform the following:

1. Check the brake fluid level. Add brake fluidas necessary. See “Brake fluid” in the “Main-tenance and do-it-yourself” section of thismanual.

2. If the brake fluid level is correct, have thewarning system checked by a NISSANdealer.

WARNING

● Your brake system may not be workingproperly if the warning light is on. Driv-ing could be dangerous. If you judge itto be safe, drive carefully to the nearestservice station for repairs. Otherwise,have your vehicle towed because driv-ing it could be dangerous.

● Pressing the brake pedal with the en-gine stopped and/or a low brake fluidlevel may increase your stopping dis-tance and braking will require greaterpedal effort as well as pedal travel.

● If the brake fluid level is below theMINIMUM or MIN mark on the brakefluid reservoir, do not drive until thebrake system has been checked at aNISSAN dealer.

Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warningindicator

When the parking brake is released and thebrake fluid level is sufficient, if both the brakewarning light and the Anti-lock Braking System(ABS) warning light illuminate, it may indicate theABS is not functioning properly. Have the brakesystem checked, and if necessary, repaired by aNISSAN dealer promptly. Avoid high-speed driv-ing and abrupt braking. (See “Anti-lock BrakingSystem (ABS) warning light” in this section.)

Charge warning light

If this light comes on while the engine is running,it may indicate the charging system is not func-tioning properly. Turn the engine off and checkthe generator belt. If the belt is loose, broken,missing, or if the light remains on, see a NISSANdealer immediately.

Instruments and controls 2-11

Page 84: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CAUTION

● Do not ground electrical accessoriesdirectly to the battery terminal. Doingso will bypass the variable control sys-tem and the vehicle battery may notcharge completely. Refer to “Variablevoltage control system” in the “Mainte-nance and do-it-yourself” section laterin this manual.

● Do not continue driving if the generatorbelt is loose, broken or missing.

Engine oil pressure warninglight

This light warns of low engine oil pressure. If thelight flickers or comes on during normal driving,pull off the road in a safe area, stop the engineimmediately and call a NISSAN dealer or otherauthorized repair shop.

The engine oil pressure warning light is notdesigned to indicate a low oil level. Use thedipstick to check the oil level. See “Engine oil” inthe “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section ofthis manual.

CAUTION

Running the engine with the engine oilpressure warning light on could cause se-rious damage to the engine almost imme-diately. Such damage is not covered bywarranty. Turn off the engine as soon as itis safe to do so.

Low tire pressure warning light

Your vehicle is equipped with a Tire PressureMonitoring System (TPMS) that monitors the tirepressure of all tires except the spare.

The low tire pressure warning light warns of lowtire pressure or indicates that the TPMS is notfunctioning properly.

After the ignition switch is placed in the ONposition, this light illuminates for about 1 secondand turns off.

Low tire pressure warning:

If the vehicle is being driven with low tirepressure, the warning light will illuminate.A CHECK TIRE PRESSURE warning alsoappears in the vehicle information display.

When the low tire pressure warning lightilluminates, you should stop and adjust thetire pressure of all 4 tires to the recom-mended COLD tire pressure shown on the

Tire and Loading Information label locatedin the driver’s door opening. The low tirepressure warning light does not automati-cally turn off when the tire pressure is ad-justed. After the tire is inflated to the rec-ommended pressure, the vehicle must bedriven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h)to activate the TPMS and turn off the lowtire pressure warning light. Use a tire pres-sure gauge to check the tire pressure.

The CHECK TIRE PRESSURE warning is activeas long as the low tire pressure warning lightremains illuminated.

For additional information, see “Vehicle informa-tion display” in the “Instruments and controls”section and “Tire Pressure Monitoring System(TPMS)” in the “Starting and driving” section andin the “In case of emergency” section.

TPMS malfunction:

If the TPMS is not functioning properly, the lowtire pressure warning light will flash for approxi-mately 1 minute when the ignition switch isplaced in the ON position. The light will remain onafter the 1 minute. Have the system checked by aNISSAN dealer. The CHECK TIRE PRESSUREwarning does not appear if the low tire pressurewarning light illuminates to indicate a TPMS mal-function.

2-12 Instruments and controls

Page 85: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

For additional information, see “Tire PressureMonitoring System (TPMS)” in the “Starting anddriving” section and “Tire pressure” in the “Main-tenance and do-it-yourself” section in thismanual.

WARNING

● If the light does not illuminate with theignition switch in the ON position, havethe vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealeras soon as possible.

● If the light illuminates while driving,avoid sudden steering maneuvers orabrupt braking, reduce vehicle speed,pull off the road to a safe location andstop the vehicle as soon as possible.Driving with under-inflated tires maypermanently damage the tires and in-crease the likelihood of tire failure. Se-rious vehicle damage could occur andmay lead to an accident and could re-sult in serious personal injury. Checkthe tire pressure for all four tires. Adjustthe tire pressure to the recommendedCOLD tire pressure shown on the Tireand Loading Information label locatedin the driver’s door opening to turn thelow tire pressure warning light OFF. If

the light still comes on while drivingafter adjusting the tire pressure, a tiremay be flat. If you have a flat tire, re-place it with a spare tire as soon aspossible.

● When a spare tire is mounted or a wheelis replaced, tire pressure will not beindicated, the TPMS will not functionand the low tire pressure warning lightwill flash for approximately 1 minute.The light will remain on after 1 minute.Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon aspossible for tire replacement and/orsystem resetting.

● Replacing tires with those not originallyspecified by NISSAN could affect theproper operation of the TPMS.

CAUTION

● The TPMS is not a substitute for theregular tire pressure check. Be sure tocheck the tire pressure regularly.

● If the vehicle is being driven at speedsof less than 16 MPH (25 km/h), theTPMS may not operate correctly.

● Be sure to install the specified size oftires to the 4 wheels correctly.

Master warning light

When the ignition is in the ON position, themaster warning light illuminates if any of the fol-lowing are displayed on the vehicle informationdisplay.

● No key warning

● Low fuel warning

● Low windshield-washer fluid warning

● Parking brake release warning

● Door/trunk open warning

● Loose fuel cap

● Check tire pressure warning

Seat belt warning light andchime

The light and chime remind you to fasten yourseat belts. The light illuminates whenever theignition switch is placed in the ON or STARTposition and remains illuminated until the driver’sseat belt is fastened. At the same time, the chimesounds for about 6 seconds unless the driver’sseat belt is securely fastened.

Instruments and controls 2-13

Page 86: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

The seat belt warning light may also illuminate ifthe front passenger’s seat belt is not fastenedwhen the front passenger’s seat is occupied. For7 seconds after the ignition switch is placed inthe ON position, the system does not activate thewarning light for the front passenger.

Refer to “Seat belts” in the “Safety—Seats, seatbelts and supplemental restraint system” sectionfor precautions on seat belt usage.

Supplemental air bag warninglight

When the ignition switch is placed in the ON orSTART position, the supplemental air bag warn-ing light illuminates for about 7 seconds and thenturns off if the SRS air bag systems are opera-tional. This means the system is operational.

If any of the following conditions occur, the airbags and/or pretensioner systems need servic-ing and your vehicle must be taken to a NISSANdealer:

● The supplemental air bag warning light re-mains on after approximately 7 seconds.

● The supplemental air bag warning lightflashes intermittently.

● The supplemental air bag warning light doesnot come on at all.

Unless checked and repaired, the supplementalrestraint systems (air bag systems) and/or thepretensioners may not function properly. For ad-ditional details see “Supplemental restraint sys-tem” in the “Safety—Seats, seat belts andsupplemental restraint system” section of thismanual.

WARNING

If the supplemental air bag warning lightis on, it could mean that the front air bag,side air bag, curtain air bag systemsand/or pretensioner systems will not op-erate in an accident. To help avoid injuryto yourself or others, have your vehiclechecked by a NISSAN dealer as soon aspossible.

INDICATOR LIGHTS

Continuously VariableTransmission (CVT) indicatorlight

When the ignition switch is placed in the ONposition, the light comes on for 2 seconds.

Continuously VariableTransmission (CVT) positionindicator light

When the ignition switch is placed in the ONposition, the indicator light shows the shift selec-tor position. See “Driving the vehicle” in the“Starting and driving” section of this manual.

Cruise main switch indicatorlight

The light comes on when the cruise control mainswitch is pushed. The light goes out when themain switch is pushed again. When the cruisemain switch indicator light comes on, the cruisecontrol system is operational.

Front passenger air bag statuslight

The front passenger air bag status light will be litand the passenger front air bag will be OFFdepending on how the front passenger seat isbeing used.

For front passenger air bag status light operation,see “Front passenger air bag and status light” inthe “Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplementalrestraint system” section of this manual.

2-14 Instruments and controls

Page 87: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

High beam indicator light(blue)

This blue light comes on when the headlight highbeams are on and goes out when the low beamsare selected.

The high beam indicator light also comes onwhen the passing signal is activated.

Malfunction indicator light(MIL)

If the malfunction indicator light comes on steadyor blinks while the engine is running, it may indi-cate a potential emission control and/or CVTmalfunction.

The malfunction indicator light may also come onsteady if the fuel-filler cap is loose or missing, or ifthe vehicle runs out of fuel. Check to make surethe fuel-filler cap is installed and closed tightly,and that the vehicle has at least 3 gallons (11.4liters) of fuel in the fuel tank.

After a few driving trips, the light shouldturn off if no other potential emission controlsystem malfunction exists.

If this indicator light comes on steady for 20seconds and then blinks for 10 seconds whenthe engine is not running, it indicates that thevehicle is not ready for an emission control sys-

tem inspection/maintenance test. See “Readi-ness for inspection/maintenance (I/M) test” in the“Technical and consumer information” section ofthis manual.

Operation

The malfunction indicator light will come on inone of two ways:

● Malfunction indicator light on steady — Anemission control system and/or CVT mal-function has been detected. Check the fuel-filler cap if the LOOSE FUEL CAP warningappears in the vehicle information display. Ifthe fuel-filler cap is loose or missing, tightenor install the cap and continue to drive thevehicle. The light should turn off aftera few driving trips. If the light does notturn off after a few driving trips, have thevehicle inspected by a NISSAN dealer. Youdo not need to have your vehicle towed tothe dealer.

● Malfunction indicator light blinking — An en-gine misfire has been detected which maydamage the emission control system. To re-duce or avoid emission control system dam-age:

– do not drive at speeds above 45 MPH(72 km/h).

– avoid hard acceleration or deceleration.

– avoid steep uphill grades.

– if possible, reduce the amount of cargobeing hauled or towed.

The malfunction indicator light may stop blinkingand come on steady. Have the vehicle inspectedby a NISSAN dealer. You do not need to haveyour vehicle towed to the dealer.

CAUTION

Continued vehicle operation without hav-ing the emission control system checkedand repaired as necessary could lead topoor driveability, reduced fuel economy,and possible damage to the emission con-trol system.

Security indicator light

This light blinks when the ignition switch isplaced in the OFF, LOCK or ACC position.

The blinking security indicator light indicates thatthe security systems equipped on the vehicle areoperational.

For additional information, see “Security sys-tems” later in this section.

Instruments and controls 2-15

Page 88: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Side light and headlightindicator light (green)

The side light and headlight indicator light illumi-nates when the side light or headlight position isselected. See “Headlight and turn signal switch”later in this section for further details.

Slip indicator light

This indicator will blink when the VDC system orthe traction control system is operating, thusalerting that the vehicle is nearing its tractionlimits. The road surface may be slippery.

Turn signal/hazard indicatorlights

The appropriate light flashes when the turn signalswitch is activated.

Both lights flash when the hazard switch is turnedon.

Vehicle Dynamic Control(VDC) OFF indicator light

This indicator light comes on when the VehicleDynamic Control off switch is pushed to OFF.This indicates the Vehicle Dynamic Control hasbeen turned off.

Push the Vehicle Dynamic Control off switchagain or restart the engine and the system will bereactivated. See “Vehicle Dynamic Control(VDC) system” in the “Starting and driving” sec-tion of this manual.

The Vehicle Dynamic Control light also comes onwhen you push the push-button ignition switch tothe ON position. The light will turn off after about2 seconds if the system is operational. If the lightstays on or comes on along with the indi-cator light while you are driving, have the VehicleDynamic Control system checked by a NISSANdealer.

While the Vehicle Dynamic Control system isoperating, you might feel slight vibration or hearthe system working when starting the vehicle oraccelerating, but this is normal.

AUDIBLE REMINDERS

Brake pad wear warning

The disc brake pads have audible wear warnings.When a disc brake pad requires replacement, itmakes a high pitched scraping sound when thevehicle is in motion, whether or not the brakepedal is depressed. Have the brakes checked assoon as possible if the warning sound is heard.

Key reminder chimeA chime sounds if the driver’s door is openedwhile the ignition switch is placed in the ACC orOFF position or placed in the OFF or LOCKposition with the Intelligent Key left in the Intelli-gent Key port. Make sure the ignition switch isplaced in the LOCK position, and take the Intel-ligent Key with you when leaving the vehicle.

Light reminder chimeWith the ignition switch placed in the OFF posi-tion, a chime sounds when the driver’s door isopened if the headlights or parking lights are on.

Turn the headlight control switch off before leav-ing the vehicle.

NISSAN Intelligent Key™ door buzzerThe Intelligent Key door buzzer sounds if theIntelligent Key is left inside the vehicle whenlocking the doors. When the buzzer sounds, besure to check both the vehicle and the IntelligentKey. See “NISSAN Intelligent Key™” in the “Pre-driving checks and adjustments” section.

2-16 Instruments and controls

Page 89: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

The vehicle information display �1 is located onthe bottom of the speedometer. It displays suchitems as:

● Intelligent Key operation information

● some indicators and warnings

● other information

For details about the Intelligent Key, see“NISSAN Intelligent Key™” in the “Pre-drivingchecks and adjustments” section.

HOW TO USE THE VEHICLEINFORMATION DISPLAY

Press the button, located on the instru-ment panel just behind the steering wheel, todisplay the following modes:

MPG → MPG/MPH → Time/Miles → Range →Tire Pressure → Exterior Temperature → Setting→ Warning

Fuel economy mode

The fuel economy mode can be selected to dis-play the instant fuel economy since the last reset.

WIC1102 WIC1406 LIC2171

VEHICLE INFORMATION DISPLAY

Instruments and controls 2-17

Page 90: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Average speed mode

The average speed mode can be selected todisplay the average miles per gallon and miles perhour since the last reset.

Time/Miles (km) mode

The time/miles (km) mode can be selected toshow the time and distance driven since the lastreset.

Range mode

The range mode can be selected to give you anestimation of the distance that can be drivenbefore refueling. The range is constantly calcu-lated based on the amount of fuel in the fuel tankand the actual fuel consumption.

LIC2172 LIC2173 LIC2174

2-18 Instruments and controls

Page 91: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Tire pressure mode

The tire pressure mode displays the tire pressureinformation for your tires in the *** area of thevehicle information display.

The order of tire pressure figures displayed onthe screen does not correspond with the actualorder of the tire position.

If the vehicle has been off for awhile, the pres-sures will not be displayed immediately. Whenthe vehicle is driven, the pressures will automati-cally be displayed.

In case of a low tire pressure, a warning messagewill also appear in the vehicle information display.See “Check tire pressure warning” later in thissection.

Exterior temperature mode

The exterior temperature mode can be selectedto provide you with the temperature outside ofyour vehicle.

LIC2175 LIC2176

Instruments and controls 2-19

Page 92: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Setting mode

The setting mode allows you to set reminders orpreferences for alerts, maintenance intervals orlanguage displays.

In the setting mode screen press to moveto:

● Alert

● Maintenance

● Options

and press to select the menu.

Alert mode

The alert mode allows you to set alerts notifyingyou of time to rest or icy conditions.

The time to rest alert lets you know when youhave been traveling for a long time and may needa break.

The icy alert notifies you that icy driving condi-tions may exist.

Reset mode

The reset mode can be selected in any screenthat allows for preferences to be programmed.Once the screen is selected, you have the optionto reset the selected distances or time to a newsetting.

LIC1541 LIC1044 LIC1046

2-20 Instruments and controls

Page 93: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Maintenance mode

The maintenance mode allows you to set alertsfor the reminding of maintenance intervals for thefollowing:

● engine oil

● oil filter

● tires

● other

Set a desired interval by pushing to high-light the maintenance field and pressing .The reset mode will open up and allow you toenter the desired distance.

Options mode

The LANGUAGE/UNIT/EFFECTS screen willappear when selecting the“Language/Unit/Effects” key andpressing .

Language: English, French or Spanish

Unit: US — mile, °F, MPGMetric — km, °C, L/100 km

Effects: This changes effects of the indicatorneedles when ON. The needles in the metersweep and the ring illumination will be brightenedgradually when the engine is started.

You can select the language, unit or change thedial effects by using the button andpressing .

The settings are automatically saved when youexit the menu by pressing the BACK button orany other mode button.

LIC2177 LIC2178

Instruments and controls 2-21

Page 94: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Warning mode

The warning mode can be selected to view anywarnings that may be present. Once the screen isselected you have the option of skipping thewarning or viewing it in detail.

Warnings can be present for issues such as anopen door or low fuel. For more information aboutpotential warnings see “Vehicle information dis-play warnings and indicators” later in this section.

If more than one warning is active, the screen willcycle between the active warnings every 8 sec-onds.

LIC1098

2-22 Instruments and controls

Page 95: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Vehicle information display warningsand indicators

1. Door and trunk open warning

2. Push warning

3. Low fuel warning

4. Low windshield-washer fluid warning

5. No key warning

6. Parking brake warning

7. Shift P warning

8. Engine start operation indicator

9. NISSAN Intelligent Key™ insertion indicator

10. NISSAN Intelligent Key™ removal indicator

11. NISSAN Intelligent Key™ battery dischargeindicator

LIC2185

Instruments and controls 2-23

Page 96: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

12. Loose fuel cap warning

13. Check tire pressure warning

14. Tire pressure warning

Door and trunk open warning

This warning illuminates when a door or the trunkhas been opened when the engine is running.

Push warning

After the Shift P warning illuminates, the Pushwarning will illuminate if the ignition switch isplaced in the ACC position when the shift selec-tor is moved to the P (Park) position.

See “Shift P warning” in this section for additionalinformation.

To turn off the Push warning, place the ignitionswitch in the ON position and then to the LOCKposition.

Low fuel warning

This warning illuminates when the fuel level in thefuel tank is getting low. Refuel as soon as it isconvenient, preferably before the fuel gaugereaches E (Empty). There will be a small re-serve of fuel in the tank when the fuelgauge needle reaches E (Empty).

Low windshield-washer fluid warning

This warning illuminates when the windshield-washer fluid is at a low level. Add windshield-washer fluid as necessary. See “Windshield-washer fluid” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual.

No key warning

This warning illuminates following two conditions:

1. When the ignition switch is pushed and theIntelligent Key cannot be recognized by thesystem. If this warning illuminates, you can-not start the engine.

Check for the following causes and performthe assigned remedies:

– The battery of the Intelligent Key carriedwith you is discharged completely. Re-place the battery with a new one.

– The Intelligent Key carried with you is notregistered to the system. Use the regis-tered Intelligent Key.

– You do not have an Intelligent Key withyou. Carry an Intelligent Key with you.

2. When the door is closed with the IntelligentKey left outside the vehicle and the ignitionswitch is placed in the ACC or ON position.A chime will also sound.

Parking brake warning

This warning illuminates when the parking brakeis set and the vehicle is driven.

SHIFT P warning

This warning illuminates when the ignition switchis pushed to stop the engine with the shift selec-tor in any position except in the P (Park) position.

If this warning illuminates, the ignition switch is inthe OFF position. Move the shift selector to the P(Park) position or push the ignition switch to theON position.

An inside warning chime will also sound.

If the shift selector is moved to the P (Park)position, the Push warning will appear. Refer to“Push warning” in this section.

For additional information about Intelligent Key,see “NISSAN Intelligent Key™” in the “Pre-drivingchecks and adjustments” section.

Engine start operation indicator

This indicator illuminates when the ignition switchis in the LOCK, OFF, ACC or ON position withthe shift selector in the P (Park) position.

This indicator means that the engine will start bypushing the push-button ignition switch with thebrake pedal depressed.

2-24 Instruments and controls

Page 97: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

NISSAN Intelligent Key™ insertion indica-tor

This indicator illuminates when the Intelligent Keyneeds to be inserted into the Intelligent Key port.(For example, the Intelligent Key battery is dis-charged.)

If this indicator illuminates, insert the IntelligentKey into the Intelligent Key port in the correctdirection. See “Push-button ignition switch” inthe “Starting and driving” section.

NISSAN Intelligent Key™ removal indica-tor

This indicator illuminates when the driver’s dooris opened with the ignition switch placed in theOFF position and the Intelligent Key placed in theIntelligent Key port. A key reminder chime alsosounds.

If this indicator illuminates, remove the IntelligentKey from the Intelligent Key port and take it withyou when leaving the vehicle.

NISSAN Intelligent Key™ battery dis-charge indicator

This indicator illuminates when the Intelligent Keybattery is running out of power.

If this indicator illuminates, replace the batterywith a new one. See “NISSAN Intelligent Key™” inthe “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section.

Loose fuel cap warning

This warning appears when the fuel-filler cap isnot tightened correctly after the vehicle has beenrefueled. See “Fuel-filler cap” in the “Pre-drivingchecks and adjustments” section.

Check tire pressure warning

This warning appears when the low tire pressurewarning light in the meter illuminates and low tirepressure is detected. If this warning appears,stop the vehicle and adjust the tire pressure tothe recommended COLD tire pressure shown onthe Tire and Loading Information label. See “Lowtire pressure warning light” earlier in this sectionand “Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)”in the “Starting and driving” section.

Tire pressure warning

This screen will show the actual pressure of eachtire. Any low tire pressure will be highlighted. Thescreen does not indicate which pressure corre-sponds with which tire.

The numbers do not automatically update aftertire pressure is adjusted. After the tire is inflatedto the recommended pressure, the vehicle mustbe driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h) toupdate the numbers. Refer to “Tire PressureMonitoring System” in the “Starting and driving”section.

Your vehicle has two types of security systems:

● Vehicle security system

● NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System

VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEMThe vehicle security system provides visual andaudible alarm signals if someone opens the doorsor trunk lid when the system is armed. It is not,however, a motion detection type system thatactivates when a vehicle is moved or when avibration occurs.

The system helps deter vehicle theft but cannotprevent it, nor can it prevent the theft of interior orexterior vehicle components in all situations. Al-

LIC0301

SECURITY SYSTEMS

Instruments and controls 2-25

Page 98: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

ways secure your vehicle even if parking for abrief period. Never leave your Intelligent Key inthe vehicle, and always lock the vehicle whenunattended. Be aware of your surroundings, andpark in secure, well-lit areas whenever possible.

Many devices offering additional protection, suchas component locks, identification markers, andtracking systems, are available at auto supplystores and specialty shops. Your NISSAN dealermay also offer such equipment. Check with yourinsurance company to see if you may be eligiblefor discounts for various theft protection features.

How to arm the vehicle securitysystem

1. Close all windows. (The system can bearmed even if the windows are open.)

2. Remove the Intelligent Key from the vehicle.

3. Close all doors, hood and trunk. Lock alldoors. The doors can be locked with theIntelligent Key, door handle request switchor power door lock switch.

4. Confirm that the security indicator lightcomes on. The security light stays on forabout 30 seconds. The vehicle security sys-tem is now pre-armed. After about 30 sec-onds the vehicle security system automati-cally shifts into the armed phase. The

security light begins to flash once every 3seconds. If, during the 30-second pre-armtime period, the driver’s door is unlocked bythe key or the keyfob, or the ignition switch isplaced in the ACC or ON position, the sys-tem will not arm.

● Even when the driver and/or passen-gers are in the vehicle, the system willactivate with all the doors, hood andtrunk lid locked with the ignitionswitch placed in the LOCK position.When placing the ignition switch in theACC or ON position, the system will bereleased.

Vehicle security system activationThe vehicle security system will give the followingalarm:

● The headlights blink and the horn soundsintermittently.

● The alarm automatically turns off after a pe-riod of time. However, the alarm reactivates ifthe vehicle is tampered with again. The alarmcan be shut off by unlocking the driver’s dooror trunk lid with the key, or by pressingthe button on the Intelligent Key.

The alarm is activated by:

● opening the door or trunk lid without usingthe key or Intelligent Key (even if the door isunlocked by releasing the door inside lockswitch).

How to stop an activated alarm

The alarm stops only by unlocking the driver’sdoor or the trunk lid with the key, pressingthe button on the Intelligent Key, or press-ing the request switch on the driver’s or passen-ger’s door with the Intelligent Key in range of thedoor handle.

NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZERSYSTEM

The NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System will notallow the engine to start without the use of aregistered key.

If the engine fails to start using a registered key(for example, when interference is caused byanother registered key, an automated toll roaddevice or automatic payment device on the keyring), restart the engine using the following pro-cedures:

1. Leave the ignition switch placed in the ONposition for approximately 5 seconds.

2-26 Instruments and controls

Page 99: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

2. Place the ignition switch in the OFF orLOCK position and wait approximately 10seconds.

3. Repeat steps 1 and 2.

4. Restart the engine while holding the device(which may have caused the interference)separate from the registered key.

If the no start condition re-occurs, NISSAN rec-ommends placing the registered key on a sepa-rate key ring to avoid interference from otherdevices.

Statement related to Section 15 of FCCRules for NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer Sys-tem (CONT ASSY — IMMOBILIZER, ANTASSY — IMMOBILIZER)

This device complies with part 15 of theFCC Rules and RSS-210 of IndustryCanada. Operation is subject to the follow-ing two conditions;

(1) This device may not cause harmful in-terference, and (2) this device must acceptany interference received, including inter-ference that may cause undesired opera-tion of the device.

CHANGES OR MODIFICATIONS NOT EX-PRESSLY APPROVED BY THE PARTY RE-SPONSIBLE FOR COMPLIANCE COULDVOID THE USER’S AUTHORITY TO OPER-ATE THE EQUIPMENT.

Security indicator light

The security indicator light blinks whenever theignition switch is placed in the OFF, LOCK or ACCposition. This function indicates the NISSAN Ve-hicle Immobilizer System is operational.

If the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System is mal-functioning, the light will remain on while theignition switch is placed in the ON position.

If the light still remains on and/or the en-gine will not start, see a NISSAN dealer forNISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System ser-vice as soon as possible. Please bring allregistered keys that you have when visitingyour NISSAN dealer for service.

LIC0474

Instruments and controls 2-27

Page 100: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

SWITCH OPERATION

The windshield wiper and washer operates whenthe ignition switch is in the ON position.

Push the lever down to operate the wiper at thefollowing speed:

�1 Intermittent — intermittent operation can beadjusted by turning the knob toward �A(Slower) or �B (Faster). Also, the intermit-tent operation speed varies in accordancewith the vehicle speed. (For example, whenthe vehicle speed is high, the intermittentoperation speed will be faster.)

NOTE:

You can turn on or turn off the drivingspeed dependent intermittent wiper func-tion for vehicles with navigation system.Refer to “Comfort settings” in the “Monitor,climate, audio, phone and voice recogni-tion systems” section.

�2 Low — continuous low speed operation

�3 High — continuous high speed operation

Push the lever up �4 to have one sweep opera-tion of the wiper.

Pull the lever toward you �5 to operate thewasher. The wiper will also operate several times.

WARNING

In freezing temperatures the washer solu-tion may freeze on the windshield andobscure your vision which may lead to anaccident. Warm the windshield with thedefroster before you wash the windshield.

CAUTION

● Do not operate the washer continu-ously for more than 30 seconds.

● Do not operate the washer if thewindshield-washer fluid reservoir isempty.

● Do not fill the windshield-washer fluidreservoir with washer fluid concen-trates at full strength. Some methyl al-cohol based washer fluid concentratesmay permanently stain the grille ifspilled while filling the windshield-washer fluid reservoir.

● Pre-mix washer fluid concentrates withwater to the manufacturer’s recom-mended levels before pouring the fluidinto the windshield-washer fluid reser-voir. Do not use the windshield-washerfluid reservoir to mix the washer fluidand water.

WIC1434

WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHERSWITCH

2-28 Instruments and controls

Page 101: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

To defrost the rear window glass and outsidemirrors (if so equipped), start the engine andpush the rear window defroster switch on. Therear window defroster indicator light on theswitch comes on. Push the switch again to turnthe defroster off.

The rear window defroster automatically turns offafter approximately 15 minutes.

CAUTION

When cleaning the inner side of the rearwindow, be careful not to scratch or dam-age the rear window defroster.

NOTE:

The top few rows of wires on the rear win-dow are not part of the rear window de-froster system. These wires make up theantenna for the audio system.

XENON HEADLIGHTS (if soequipped)

WARNING

cHIGH VOLTAGE

● When xenon headlights are on, theyproduce a high voltage. To prevent anelectric shock, never attempt to modifyor disassemble. Always have your xe-non headlights replaced at a NISSANdealer.

● Xenon headlights provide considerablymore light than conventional head-lights. If they are not correctly aimed,they might temporarily blind an oncom-ing driver or the driver ahead of you andcause a serious accident. If headlightsare not aimed correctly, immediatelytake your vehicle to a NISSAN dealerand have the headlights adjustedcorrectly.

When the xenon headlight is initially turned on, itsbrightness or color varies slightly. However, thecolor and brightness will soon stabilize.

Type ALIC1387

Type BLIC1388

REAR WINDOW AND OUTSIDEMIRROR (if so equipped)DEFROSTER SWITCH

HEADLIGHT AND TURN SIGNALSWITCH

Instruments and controls 2-29

Page 102: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● The life of xenon headlights will beshortened by frequent on-off opera-tion. It is generally desirable not to turnoff the headlights for short intervals(for example, when the vehicle stops ata traffic signal).

● If the xenon headlight bulb is close toburning out, the brightness will drasti-cally decrease, the light will start blink-ing, or the color of the light will be-come reddish. If one or more of theabove signs appear, contact a NISSANdealer.

HEADLIGHT CONTROL SWITCH

Lighting

�1 When turning the switch to the posi-tion, the front parking, tail, license plate andinstrument panel lights come on.

�2 When turning the switch to the posi-tion, the headlights come on and all the otherlights remain on.

Type AWIC1435

Type BWIC1436

2-30 Instruments and controls

Page 103: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CAUTION

Use the headlights with the engine run-ning to avoid discharging the vehiclebattery.

Autolight systemThe autolight system allows the headlights to beset so they turn on and off automatically. Theautolight system can:

● Turn on the headlights, front parking, tail,license plate and instrument panel lights au-tomatically when it is dark.

● Turn off all the lights when it is light.

● Keep all the lights on for a period of time afteryou place the ignition switch in the OFFposition and all doors are closed.

To turn on the autolight system:

1. Place the headlight switch in the AUTO po-sition �1 .

2. Place ignition in the ON position.

3. The autolight system automatically turns theheadlights on and off.

Initially, if the ignition switch is placed in the OFFposition and a door is opened and left open, theheadlights remain ON for a period of time. Ifanother door is opened while the headlights areon, then the timer is reset.

To turn the autolight system off, turn the switch to

the OFF, , or position.LIC1086

Instruments and controls 2-31

Page 104: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Be sure you do not put anything on top ofthe autolight sensor located on the top sideof the instrument panel. The autolight sen-sor controls the autolight; if it is covered,the autolight sensor reacts as if it is darkout and the headlights will illuminate. Ifthis occurs while parked with the engineoff and the ignition switch placed in the ONposition, your vehicle’s battery could be-come discharged.

Headlight beam select

�1 To select the high beam function, push thelever forward. The high beam lights come onand the light illuminates.

�2 Pull the lever back to select the low beam.

�3 Pulling and releasing the lever flashes theheadlight high beams on and off.

Battery saver systemIf the ignition switch is placed in the OFF positionwhile the headlight switch is in theor position, the headlights will turn off aftera period of time.

CAUTION

Even though the battery saver feature au-tomatically turns off the headlights after aperiod of time, you should turn the head-light switch to the OFF position when theengine is not running to avoid dischargingthe vehicle battery.

DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM(Canada only)

The headlights automatically illuminate at a re-duced intensity when the engine is started withthe parking brake released. The daytime runninglights operate with the headlight switch in theOFF position or in the position. Turn theheadlight switch to the position for fullillumination when driving at night.

If the parking brake is applied before the engine isstarted, the daytime running lights do not illumi-nate. The daytime running lights illuminate whenthe parking brake is released. The daytime run-ning lights will remain on until the ignition switchis placed in the OFF position.

WHA1170 WIC1438

2-32 Instruments and controls

Page 105: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

When the daytime running light system isactive, tail lights on your vehicle are noton. It is necessary at dusk to turn on yourheadlights. Failure to do so could causean accident injuring yourself and others.

INSTRUMENT BRIGHTNESSCONTROLThe instrument cluster illuminates when the igni-tion switch is in the ON position.

The instrument brightness control operates whenthe headlight control switch is in the

AUTO, or position.

Turn the control left or right to adjust the bright-ness of the instrument panel lights when drivingat night.

The instrument brightness control will not adjustthe brightness when the headlights or parkinglights are off.

TURN SIGNAL SWITCH

Turn signal

�1 Move the lever up or down to signal theturning direction. When the turn is com-pleted, the turn signals cancel automatically.

Lane change signal

�2 To signal a lane change, move the lever up ordown to the point where the indicator lightbegins to flash, but the lever does not latch.

WIC1412 WIC1439

Instruments and controls 2-33

Page 106: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

FOG LIGHT SWITCH (if so equipped)

To turn the fog lights on, turn the headlight switchto the position, then turn the fog lightswitch to the position.

To turn the fog lights on with the headlight switch inthe AUTO position, the headlights must be on, thenturn the fog light switch to the position.

To turn the fog lights off, turn the fog light switchto the OFF position.

The headlights must be on and the low beamsselected for the fog lights to operate. The foglights automatically turn off when the high beamheadlights are selected.

Push the switch on to warn other drivers whenyou must stop or park under emergency condi-tions. All turn signal lights flash.

WARNING

● If stopping for an emergency, be sure tomove the vehicle well off the road.

● Do not use the hazard warning flasherswhile moving on the highway unlessunusual circumstances force you todrive so slowly that your vehicle mightbecome a hazard to other traffic.

● Turn signals do not work when the haz-ard warning flasher lights are on.

The flashers will operate with the ignition switchplaced in any position.

Some state laws may prohibit the use ofthe hazard warning flasher switch whiledriving.

WIC1440 LIC0394

HAZARD WARNING FLASHERSWITCH

2-34 Instruments and controls

Page 107: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

To sound the horn, push near the horn icon of thesteering wheel.

WARNING

Do not disassemble the horn. Doing socould affect proper operation of thesupplemental front air bag system. Tam-pering with the supplemental front air bagsystem may result in serious personalinjury.

The front seats are warmed by built-in heaters.The switch is located on the center console.

1. Start the engine.

2. Push the LO or HI position of the switch, asdesired. The indicator light in the switch willilluminate.

The heater is controlled by a thermostat,automatically turning the heater on and off.The indicator light will remain on as long asthe switch is on.

3. When the seat is warmed or before youleave the vehicle, be sure to turn the switchoff.

WARNING

Do not use or allow occupants to use theseat heater if you or the occupants cannotmonitor elevated seat temperatures orhave an inability to feel pain in body partsthat contact the seat. Use of the seatheater by such people could result in se-rious injury.

CAUTION

● Do not use the seat heater for extendedperiods or when no one is using theseat.

● Do not put anything on the seat whichinsulates heat, such as a blanket, cush-ion, seat cover, etc. Otherwise, the seatmay become overheated.

● Do not place anything hard or heavy onthe seat or pierce it with a pin or similarobject. This may result in damage to theheater.

● Any liquid spilled on the heated seatshould be removed immediately with adry cloth.

● When cleaning the seat, never usegasoline, benzine, thinner, or any simi-lar materials.

LIC1389 LIC1543

HORN HEATED SEATS (if so equipped)

Instruments and controls 2-35

Page 108: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● If any malfunctions are found or theheated seat does not operate, turn theswitch off and have the system checkedby your NISSAN dealer.

● The battery could run down if the seatheater is operated while the engine isnot running.

The climate controlled seat warms up or coolsdown the front seat by blowing warm or cool airfrom the surface of the seat. The climate controlswitch is located on the center console.

The climate controlled seat can be operated asfollows:

1. Start the engine.

2. Turn the control knob to the H (Heat) side orto the C (Cool) side, as desired. The indica-tor light on the control knob will illuminate.

3. Adjust the desired amount of air using thecontrol knob. The climate controlled seatblower remains on low speed for approxi-

mately 60 seconds after turning the switchon or selecting the desired temperature.

4. When the vehicle’s interior is warmed orcooled, or before you leave the vehicle, besure to turn the control knob to the Off(center) position

To check the air filter for the climate controlledseat, contact a NISSAN dealer.

WARNING

Do not use or allow occupants to use theseat heater if you or the occupants cannotmonitor elevated seat temperatures orhave an inability to feel pain in body partsthat contact the seat. Use of the seatheater by such people could result in se-rious injury.

CAUTION

● The battery could run down if the cli-mate control seat is operated while theengine is not running.

● Do not use the climate control seat forextended periods or when no one isusing the seat.

LIC1410

CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT SWITCH (ifso equipped)

2-36 Instruments and controls

Page 109: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Do not put anything on the seat whichinsulates heat, such as a blanket, cush-ion, seat cover, etc. Otherwise, the seatmay become overheated.

● Do not place anything hard or heavy onthe seat or pierce it with a pin or similarobjects. This may result in damage tothe climate controlled seat.

● Any liquid spilled on the seat should beremoved immediately with a dry cloth

● The climate controlled seat has an airfilter. Do not operate the climate con-trolled seat without an air filter. Thismay result in damage to the system.

● When cleaning the seat, never usegasoline, benzine, thinner, or any simi-lar materials.

● If any malfunctions are found or theclimate controlled seat does not oper-ate, turn the switch off and have thesystem checked by your NISSAN dealer.

The heated steering wheel system is designed tooperate only when the surface temperature of thesteering wheel is below 68°F (20°C).

Push the heated steering wheel switch to warmthe steering wheel after the engine starts. Theindicator light will come on.

If the surface temperature of the steering wheel isbelow 68°F (20°C), the system will heat thesteering wheel and cycle off and on to maintain atemperature above 68°F (20°C). The indicatorlight will remain on as long as the system is on.

Push the switch again to turn the heated steeringwheel system off manually. The indicator light willgo off.

NOTE:

If the surface temperature of the steeringwheel is above 68°F (20°C) when the switchis turned on, the system will not heat thesteering wheel. This is not a malfunction.

LIC0421

HEATED STEERING WHEEL (if soequipped)

Instruments and controls 2-37

Page 110: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

The vehicle should be driven with the VehicleDynamic Control (VDC) system on for most driv-ing conditions.

If the vehicle is stuck in mud or snow, the VDCsystem reduces the engine output to reducewheel spin. The engine speed will be reducedeven if the accelerator is depressed to the floor. Ifmaximum engine power is needed to free a stuckvehicle, turn the VDC system off.

To turn off the VDC system, push the VDC OFFswitch. The indicator will come on.

Push the VDC OFF switch again or restart theengine to turn on the system. See “Vehicle Dy-namic Control (VDC) system” in the “Starting anddriving” section.

The power outlets are for powering electricalaccessories such as cellular telephones. Theyare rated at 12 Volt, 120 W (10A) maximum.

The power outlet in the front console box ispowered directly by the vehicle battery. The out-let on the center console near the shift selector ispowered only when the ignition switch is in theACC or ON position.

CAUTION

● The outlet and plug may be hot duringor immediately after use.

● The power outlets are not designed foruse with a cigarette lighter.

● Do not use with accessories that ex-ceed a 12 volt, 120W (10A) power draw.Do not use double adapters or morethan one electrical accessory.

● Use power outlets with the engine run-ning to avoid discharging the vehiclebattery.

● Avoid using power outlets when the airconditioner, headlights or rear windowdefroster is on.

● Before inserting or disconnecting aplug, be sure the electrical accessorybeing used is turned OFF.

● Push the plug in as far as it will go. Ifgood contact is not made, the plug mayoverheat or the internal temperaturefuse may open.

● When not in use, be sure to close thecap. Do not allow water or any otherliquids to contact the outlet.

LIC1548Front center console

LIC1392

VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL (VDC)OFF SWITCH

POWER OUTLET

2-38 Instruments and controls

Page 111: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

MAP POCKETS SEATBACK POCKETSThe seatback pockets are located on the back ofthe driver’s and passenger’s seats. The pocketscan be used to store maps.

SUNGLASSES HOLDERTo open the sunglasses holder, push and release.

Only store one pair of sunglasses in the holder.

WARNING

Keep the sunglasses holder closed whiledriving to prevent an accident.

LIC1393 LIC0016 WIC1551

STORAGE

Instruments and controls 2-39

Page 112: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CAUTION

● Do not use for anything other thansunglasses.

● Do not leave sunglasses in the sun-glasses holder while parking in directsunlight. The heat may damage thesunglasses.

CUP HOLDERS

CAUTION

● Avoid abrupt starting and braking whenthe cup holder is being used to preventspilling the drink. If the liquid is hot, itcan scald you or your passenger.

● Use only soft cups in the cup holder.Hard objects can injure you in anaccident.

To open the front cup holders, push the cupholder lid. To close, lower the cup holder lid andpush down until it clicks in place.

The rear cup holders are located in the fold-downarmrest in the rear seat back.

FrontLIC1395

2-40 Instruments and controls

Page 113: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

To open the cup holders on the rear fold-downarmrest, lift the cup holder lid. To close, lower thelid.

Soft bottle holder

CAUTION

● Do not use bottle holder for any otherobjects that could be thrown about inthe vehicle and possibly injure peopleduring sudden braking or an accident.

● Do not use bottle holder for open liquidcontainers.

GLOVE BOXOpen the glove box by pulling the handle. Use themechanical key when locking �1 or unlocking �2the glove box.

WARNING

Keep glove box lid closed while driving tohelp prevent injury in an accident or asudden stop.

RearLIC0423

Soft bottle holderWIC1216 LIC1396

Instruments and controls 2-41

Page 114: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CONSOLE BOX

Upper halfPull up on the driver’s side latch to open theupper half of the console box.

The upper half of the console box may be used forstorage of cellular phones. An access hole isprovided at the front of the upper half of theconsole box for a phone or iPod� cord routing tothe power outlet.

Lower halfPull up on the lever to open the lower half of theconsole box. A power outlet is located inside theconsole box and there is storage for compactdiscs.

GROCERY HOOKSThe grocery hooks are located in the trunk andcan be used to hang a standard size plasticgrocery bag.

CAUTION

Do not apply a total load of more than 20lbs (9 kg) to a single grocery hook.

WIC1120 WIC1121 LIC0748

2-42 Instruments and controls

Page 115: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CARGO NET (if so equipped)

WARNING

● Properly secure all cargo with ropes orstraps to help prevent it from sliding orshifting. In a sudden stop or collision,unsecured cargo could cause personalinjury.

The cargo net helps keep packages in the cargoarea from moving around while the vehicle is inmotion.

To install a cargo net, attach the net to the retain-ers.

To remove a cargo net, detach the net from theretainers.

POWER WINDOWS

WARNING

● Make sure that all passengers havetheir hands, etc. inside the vehicle whileit is in motion and before closing thewindows. Use the window lock switchto prevent unexpected use of the powerwindows.

● Do not leave children unattended insidethe vehicle. They could unknowingly ac-tivate switches or controls and becometrapped in a window. Unattended chil-dren could become involved in seriousaccidents.

The power windows operate when the ignitionswitch is placed in the ON position, or for aperiod of time after the ignition switch is placed inthe OFF position. If the driver’s or passenger’sdoor is opened during this period of time, thepower to the windows is canceled.

LIC1226 LIC0802

WINDOWS

Instruments and controls 2-43

Page 116: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Window lock button2. Power door lock switch3. Front passenger’s side automatic win-

dow switch4. Right rear passenger’s side window

switch (automatic if so equipped)5. Left rear passenger’s side window

switch (automatic if so equipped)6. Driver’s side automatic window switch

Driver’s side power window switchThe driver’s side control panel is equipped withswitches to open or close all of the windows.

To open a window, push the switch to the firstdetent and continue to hold down until the de-sired window position is reached. To close awindow, pull the switch to the first detent andcontinue to hold up until the desired windowposition is reached.

Front passenger’s power windowswitchThe passenger’s window switch operates onlythe corresponding passenger’s window. To openthe window, push the switch to the first detentand continue to hold it down until the desiredposition is reached �1 . To close the window, pullthe switch to the first detent and continue to holdup until the desired window position is reached�2 .

WIC1124 WIC1265

2-44 Instruments and controls

Page 117: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Rear power window switchThe rear power window switches open or closeonly the corresponding windows. To open thewindow, push the switch to the first detent andcontinue to hold it down until the desired windowposition is reached �1 . To close the window, pullthe switch to the first detent and continue to holdup until the desired window position is reached�2 .

Locking passengers’ windowsWhen the window lock button is depressed, onlythe driver’s side window can be opened orclosed. Push it again to cancel the window lockfunction.

Automatic operation

To fully open a window equipped with automaticoperation, press the window switch down (onlydriver’s side shown) to the second detent andrelease it; it need not be held. The window auto-matically opens all the way. To stop the window,lift the switch up while the window is opening.

To fully close a window equipped with automaticoperation, pull the switch up to the second detentand release it; it need not be held. To stop thewindow, press the switch down while the windowis closing.

Auto-reverse function

The auto-reverse function can be activated whena window is closed by automatic operation.

Depending on the environment or drivingconditions, the auto-reverse function maybe activated if an impact or load similar tosomething being caught in the window oc-curs.

WARNING

There are some small distances immedi-ately before the closed position whichcannot be detected. Make sure that allpassengers have their hands, etc., insidethe vehicle before closing the window.

If the vehicle’s battery is disconnected, replaced,or jump started, the power window auto-reversefunction may not operate properly. If this occurs,please contact the dealer to re-initialize thepower window auto-reverse system.

If the control unit detects something caught in awindow equipped with automatic operation as itis closing, the window will be immediately low-ered.

LIC0718 LIC0410

Instruments and controls 2-45

Page 118: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

If the windows do not closeautomaticallyIf the power window automatic function (closingonly) does not operate properly, perform the fol-lowing procedure to initialize the power windowsystem.

1. Place the ignition switch in the ON position.

2. Close the door.

3. Open the window more than halfway byoperating the power window switch.

4. Pull the power window switch and hold it toclose the window, and then hold the switchfor more than 3 seconds after the window isclosed completely.

5. Release the power window switch. Operatethe window by automatic function to confirmthe initialization is complete.

6. Perform steps 2 through 5 above for otherwindows.

If the power window automatic function does notoperate properly after performing the above pro-cedure, have your vehicle checked by a NISSANdealer.

AUTOMATIC MOONROOF

The moonroof will only operate when the ignitionswitch is placed in the ON position. The auto-matic moonroof is operational for a period of time,even if the ignition switch is placed in the ACC orOFF position. If the driver’s door or the frontpassenger’s door is opened during this period oftime, the power to the moonroof is canceled.

Sliding the moonroofTo fully open the moonroof, push the switchtoward �1 .

To fully close the moonroof, push the switchtoward �2 .

To open or close the moonroof part way, push theswitch in any direction while the moonroof issliding to stop it in the desired position.

Tilting the moonroofClose the moonroof by pushing the switchtoward �2 . Release the switch, then pushthe switch toward �2 again to tilt themoonroof up.

To tilt the moonroof down, push the switchtoward �1 .

WARNING

● In an accident you could be thrown fromthe vehicle through an open moonroof.Always use seat belts and childrestraints.

● Do not allow anyone to stand up orextend any portion of their body out ofthe moonroof opening while the vehicleis in motion or while the moonroof isclosing.

LIC1408

MOONROOF (if so equipped)

2-46 Instruments and controls

Page 119: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CAUTION

● Remove water drops, snow, ice or sandfrom the moonroof before opening.

● Do not place heavy objects on themoonroof or surrounding area.

Auto-reverse function (when closing ortilting down the moonroof)

The auto-reverse function can be activated whenthe moonroof is closed or tilted down by auto-matic operation when the ignition switch isplaced in the ON position or for a period of timeafter the ignition switch is placed in the OFFposition.

Depending on the environment or drivingconditions, the auto-reverse function maybe activated if an impact or load similar tosomething being caught in the moonroofoccurs.

WARNING

There are some small distances immedi-ately before the closed position whichcannot be detected. Make sure that allpassengers have their hands, etc., insidethe vehicle before closing the moonroof.

When closing:

If the control unit detects something caught in themoonroof as it moves to the front, the moonroofwill immediately open backward.

When tilting down:

If the control unit detects something caught in themoonroof as it tilts down, the moonroof will im-mediately tilt up.

If the auto-reverse function malfunctions and re-peats opening or tilting up the moonroof, keeppushing the tilt down switch within 5 secondsafter it happens; the moonroof will fully closegradually. Make sure nothing is caught in themoonroof.

WARNING

● In an accident you could be thrown fromthe vehicle through an open moonroof.Always use seat belts and childrestraints.

● Do not allow anyone to stand up orextend any portion of their body out ofthe moonroof opening while the vehicleis in motion or while the moonroof isclosing.

CAUTION

● Remove water drops, snow, ice or sandfrom the moonroof before opening.

● Do not place heavy objects on themoonroof or surrounding area.

SunshadeOpen and close the sunshade by sliding it for-ward or backward.

If the moonroof does not closeHave your NISSAN dealer check and repair themoonroof.

Instruments and controls 2-47

Page 120: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

AUTOMATIC MOONROOFThe moonroof will only operate when the ignitionswitch is in the ON position. The automaticmoonroof is operational for a period of time, evenif the ignition switch is placed in the ACC or OFFposition. If the driver’s door or the front passen-ger’s door is opened during this period of time,the power to the moonroof is canceled.

Sliding the moonroof

To slide the moonroof:

● To fully open the moonroof, push the switch�1 toward the open position until it reachesthe second detent. If the switch �1 ispushed to the first detent, only the sunshadewill open.

● To fully close the moonroof, push the switch�2 toward the close position until it reachesthe second detent. If the switch �2 ispushed to the first detent, the moonroof willclose but the sunshade will remain open.

● To open or close the moonroof part way,release the switch �1 or �2 while the moon-roof is sliding open or closed. The moonroofwill stop at the desired position.

Tilting the moonroof

To tilt the moonroof:

● To tilt the moonroof up, push and release thetilt switch �3 . When the moonroof is open, itwill automatically close and then tilt up.

● To tilt the moonroof down, push and releasethe tilt switch �3 or push the switch �2toward the close position until it reaches thefirst detent.

● To tilt the moonroof down and close thesunshade at the same time, push the switch�2 to the close position until it reaches thesecond detent.

Auto-reverse function (when closing ortilting down the moonroof)The auto-reverse function can be activated whenthe moonroof is closed or tilted down by auto-matic operation when the ignition switch isplaced in the ON position or for a period of timeafter the ignition switch is placed in the OFFposition. Depending on the environment ordriving conditions, the auto-reverse func-tion may be activated if an impact or loadsimilar to something being caught in themoonroof occurs.

WARNING

There are some small distances immedi-ately before the closed position whichcannot be detected. Make sure that allpassengers have their hands, etc., insidethe vehicle before closing the moonroof.

LIC1411

DUAL PANEL MOONROOF (if soequipped)

2-48 Instruments and controls

Page 121: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

When closing:

If the control unit detects something caught in themoonroof as it moves to the front, the moonroofwill immediately open backward.

When tilting down:

If the control unit detects something caught in themoonroof as it tilts down, the moonroof will im-mediately tilt up.

If the auto-reverse function malfunctions and re-peats opening or tilting up the moonroof, keeppushing the tilt down switch within 5 secondsafter it happens; the moonroof will fully closegradually. Make sure nothing is caught in themoonroof.

WARNING

● In an accident you could be thrown fromthe vehicle through an open moonroof.Always use seat belts and childrestraints.

● Do not allow anyone to stand up orextend any portion of their body out ofthe moonroof opening while the vehicleis in motion or while the moonroof isclosing.

CAUTION

● Remove water drops, snow, ice or sandfrom the moonroof before opening.

● Do not place heavy objects on themoonroof or surrounding area.

SunshadeTo open the sunshade:

● To fully open the sunshade, push the switch�1 toward the open position until it reachesthe first detent.

● To fully open the sunshade and the moon-roof together, push the switch �1 toward theopen position until it reaches the seconddetent.

WIC1445

Instruments and controls 2-49

Page 122: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

To close the sunshade:

● To fully close the sunshade, push the switch�2 toward the close position until it reachesthe second detent.

● Pushing the switch �2 to the first detent willclose the moonroof only.

If the moonroof does not closeHave your NISSAN dealer check and repair themoonroof.

The rear sun shade operates when the ignitionswitch is in the ACC or ON position.

The rear sun shade switch is located on the frontconsole.

● To raise the sun shade, push the upper sideof the switch �1 .

● To lower the sun shade, push the lower sideof the switch �2 .

● The switch need not be held down.

CAUTION

● Do not place objects (such as newspa-pers, handkerchiefs, etc.) on the screeninlet port. Doing so may entangle theseobjects in the screen when it is extend-ing or retracting, causing improper op-eration or damage to the screen.

● Do not push the sun shade arm withyour hands, etc., as this may deform it.Improper operation or damage to thescreen may result.

● Do not hang any object on the arm railas this may result in improper operationor damage the screen.

● Do not forcefully pull the screen. Doingso may elongate the screen. Improperoperation or damage to the screen mayresult.

● To avoid personal injury, keep yourhands, fingers and head away from thesun shade arm, arm rail and screen inletport.

● Do not allow children near the rear sunshade system. They could be injured.

● Do not pull or push the rear sun shade.This could cause improper operation ordamage it.

WIC1443

REAR POWER SUN SHADE (if soequipped)

2-50 Instruments and controls

Page 123: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

The interior light has a three-position switch andoperates regardless of ignition switch position.

● When the switch is in the ON position �1 ,the front and rear personal lights will illumi-nate, regardless of door position. The lightwill go off after a period of time unless theignition switch is placed in the ON position.

● When the switch is in the center DOORposition �2 , the front and rear personallights will illuminate under the following con-ditions:

– Driver’s door is unlocked while the igni-tion switch is placed in the OFF position.Lights remain on for a period of time.

– Driver’s door is opened.Lights remain on for a period of time afterdriver’s door is closed.

– Ignition switch is placed in the OFF posi-tion.

The lights will go off when the ignition switch is inthe ON position, or the driver’s door is closed andlocked.

The lights will also go off after a period of timewhen all doors are open.

● When the switch is in the OFF position �3 ,the front and rear personal lights will notilluminate, regardless of door position.

NOTE:

The footwell and doorstep lights illuminatewhen the driver and passenger doors areopened regardless of the interior lightswitch position. These lights will turn offautomatically after a period of time whiledoors are open to prevent the battery frombecoming discharged.

CAUTION

Do not use for extended periods of timewith the engine stopped. This could resultin a discharged battery.

WIC1550

INTERIOR LIGHT

Instruments and controls 2-51

Page 124: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CONSOLE LIGHTThe console light will turn on whenever the park-ing lights or headlights are illuminated.

The console light brightness can be adjustedwith the illumination brightness control.

To turn on the personal lights, press and releasethe switch �1 .

To turn the personal lights off, press and releasethe switch �1 .

To turn the map lights on, press the switches. Toturn them off, press the switches again.

CAUTION

Do not use for extended periods of timewith the engine stopped. This could resultin a discharged battery.

WIC1476 LIC1413Models without moonroof

WIC1494

PERSONAL LIGHTS MAP LIGHTS

2-52 Instruments and controls

Page 125: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

The light illuminates when the trunk lid is opened.When the trunk lid is closed, the light goes off.

The light will go off after a period of time if thetrunk lid is left open, unless the ignition switch isin the ON position.

For bulb replacement procedures, refer to “Exte-rior and interior lights” in the “Maintenance anddo-it-yourself” section of this manual.

The HomeLink� Universal Transceiver provides aconvenient way to consolidate the functions of upto three individual hand-held transmitters intoone built-in device.

HomeLink� Universal Transceiver:

● Will operate most Radio Frequency (RF)devices such as garage doors, gates, homeand office lighting, entry door locks and se-curity systems.

● Is powered by your vehicle’s battery. Noseparate batteries are required. If the vehi-cle’s battery is discharged or is discon-nected, HomeLink� will retain all program-ming.

Once the HomeLink� Universal Transceiveris programmed, retain the original trans-mitter for future programming procedures(Example: new vehicle purchases). Uponsale of the vehicle, the programmedHomeLink� Universal Transceiver buttonsshould be erased for security purposes. Foradditional information, refer to “Program-ming HomeLink�” later in this section.

Models with moonroofWIC1494

Models with dual panel moonroofLIC1409

TRUNK LIGHT HOMELINK� UNIVERSALTRANSCEIVER (if so equipped)

Instruments and controls 2-53

Page 126: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● Do not use the HomeLink� UniversalTransceiver with any garage dooropener that lacks safety stop and re-verse features as required by federalsafety standards. (These standards be-came effective for opener modelsmanufactured after April 1, 1982). A ga-rage door opener which cannot detectan object in the path of a closing garagedoor and then automatically stop andreverse, does not meet current federalsafety standards. Using a garage dooropener without these features in-creases the risk of serious injury ordeath.

● During the programming procedureyour garage door or security gate willopen and close (if the transmitter iswithin range). Make sure that people orobjects are clear of the garage door,gate, etc. that you are programming.

● Your vehicle’s engine should be turnedoff while programming the HomeLink�Universal Transceiver.

PROGRAMMING HOMELINK�

1. To begin, press and hold the two outerHomeLink� buttons (to clear the memory)until the indicator light �1 blinks (after 20seconds). Release both buttons.

2. Position the end of the hand-held transmitter1 - 3 inches (26 - 76 mm) away from theHomeLink� surface.

3. Using both hands, simultaneously press andhold both the HomeLink� button you want toprogram and the hand-held transmitter but-ton.

DO NOT release the buttons until step 4 hasbeen completed.

4. Hold down both buttons until the indicatorlight on the HomeLink� flashes, changingfrom a “slow blink” to a “rapidly flashingblink”. This could take up to 90 seconds.When the indicator light flashes rapidly, bothbuttons may be released. The rapidly flash-ing light indicates successful programming.To activate the garage door or other pro-

WIC0986 WIC0987

2-54 Instruments and controls

Page 127: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

grammed device, press and hold the pro-grammed HomeLink� button — releasingwhen the device begins to activate.

5. If the indicator light on the HomeLink� blinksrapidly for 2 seconds and then turns solid,HomeLink� has picked up a “rolling code”garage door opener signal. You will need toproceed with the next steps to train theHomeLink� to complete the programmingwhich may require a ladder and another per-son for convenience.

6. Press and release the “smart” or “learn” pro-gram button located on the garage dooropener’s motor to activate the “trainingmode”. This button is usually located nearthe antenna wire that hangs down from themotor. If the wire originates from under alight lens, you will need to remove the lens toaccess the program button.

NOTE:

Once you have pressed and released theprogram button on the garage door open-er’s motor and the “training light” is lit, youhave 30 seconds in which to perform step 7.Use the help of a second person for conve-nience to assist when performing this step.

7. Within 30 seconds of pressing and releas-ing the garage door opener’s program but-

ton, quickly and firmly press and release theHomeLink� button you’ve just programmed.Press and release the HomeLink� button upto 3 times to complete the training.

8. Your HomeLink� button should now be pro-grammed. (To program the remainingHomeLink� buttons for additional door orgate openers, follow steps 2-4 only.)

NOTE:

Do not repeat step 1 unless you want to“clear” all previously programmedHomeLink� buttons.

If you have any questions or are having difficultyprogramming your HomeLink� buttons, refer tothe HomeLink� web site at: www.homelink.comor call 1-800-355-3515.

PROGRAMMING HOMELINK� FORCANADIAN CUSTOMERSPrior to 1992, D.O.C. regulations required hand-held transmitters to stop transmitting after 2 sec-onds. To program your hand-held transmitter toHomeLink�, continue to press and hold theHomeLink� button (see steps 2 - 4 under “Pro-gramming HomeLink�”) while you press and re-press (“cycle”) your hand-held transmitters every2 seconds until the indicator light flashes rapidly(indicating successful programming).

NOTE:

When programming a garage door opener,etc., it is advised to unplug the device dur-ing the “cycling” process to prevent pos-sible damage to the garage door openercomponents.

OPERATING THE HOMELINK�UNIVERSAL TRANSCEIVERThe HomeLink� Universal Transceiver (once pro-grammed) may now be used to activate the ga-rage door, etc. To operate, simply press the ap-propriate programmed HomeLink� UniversalTransceiver button. The red indicator light willilluminate while the signal is being transmitted.

PROGRAMMING TROUBLE-DIAGNOSISIf the HomeLink� does not quickly learn the hand-held transmitter information:

● replace the hand-held transmitter batterieswith new batteries.

● position the hand-held transmitter with itsbattery area facing away from theHomeLink� surface.

● press and hold both the HomeLink� andhand-held transmitter buttons without inter-ruption.

Instruments and controls 2-55

Page 128: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● position the hand-held transmitter 1 - 3inches (26 - 76 mm) away from theHomeLink� surface. Hold the transmitter inthat position for up to 15 seconds. IfHomeLink� is not programmed within thattime, try holding the transmitter in anotherposition – keeping the indicator light in viewat all times.

If you continue to have programming difficulties,please contact the NISSAN Consumer AffairsDepartment. The phone numbers are located inthe Foreword of this manual.

CLEARING THE PROGRAMMEDINFORMATION

Individual buttons cannot be cleared. However,to clear all programming, press and hold the twooutside buttons and release when the indicatorlight begins to flash (approximately 20 seconds).

REPROGRAMMING A SINGLEHOMELINK� BUTTON

To reprogram a HomeLink� Universal Transceiverbutton, complete the following.

1. Press and hold the desired HomeLink� but-ton. Do not release the button until step 4has been completed.

2. When the indicator light begins to flashslowly (after 20 seconds), position thehand-held transmitter 1 - 3 inches (26 - 76mm) away from the HomeLink� surface.

3. Press and hold the hand-held transmitterbutton.

4. The HomeLink� indicator light will flash, firstslowly and then rapidly. When the indicatorlight begins to flash rapidly, release bothbuttons.

The HomeLink� Universal Transceiver button hasnow been reprogrammed. The new device canbe activated by pushing the HomeLink� buttonthat was just programmed. This procedure willnot affect any other programmed HomeLink�buttons.

IF YOUR VEHICLE IS STOLEN

If your vehicle is stolen, you should change thecodes of any non-rolling code device that hasbeen programmed into HomeLink�. Consult theOwner’s Manual of each device or call the manu-facturer or dealer of those devices for additionalinformation.

When your vehicle is recovered, you willneed to reprogram the HomeLink� Univer-sal Transceiver with your new transmitterinformation.

FCC Notice:

For USA:

This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC Rules. Operation is subject to the fol-lowing two conditions: (1) This device maynot cause harmful interference, and (2) thisdevice must accept any interference re-ceived, including interference that maycause undesired operation. Note: Changesor modifications not expressly approved bythe party responsible for compliance couldvoid the user’s authority to operate theequipment.

For Canada:

This device complies with RSS-210 of In-dustry Canada. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) this devicemay not cause interference, and (2) thisdevice must accept any interference, in-cluding interference that may cause unde-sired operation of the device.

2-56 Instruments and controls

Page 129: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

3 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2NISSAN Intelligent Key™ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System keys . . . . . . . . . 3-3

Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4Locking with key. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4Locking with inside lock knob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5Locking with power door lock switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5Automatic door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6Child safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6

NISSAN Intelligent Key™ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7Operating range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9Door locks/unlocks precaution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9NISSAN Intelligent Key™ Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10How to use the remote keyless entryfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13Warning signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17

Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18Trunk lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18

Opener operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19Interior trunk lid release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20Secondary trunk lid release (if so equipped) . . . . . . 3-20

Fuel-filler door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21Opening the fuel-filler door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21Fuel-filler cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21

Tilt/telescopic steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23Manual operation (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24Automatic operation (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24

Sun visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25Vanity mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25

Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26Automatic anti-glare rearview mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26Outside mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28

Automatic drive positioner (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . 3-29Memory storage function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-30Entry/exit function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31System operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31

Page 130: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Two Intelligent Keys2. Mechanical keys with built-in transpon-

der chip (inside Intelligent Keys)3. Key number plate

NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY™

Your vehicle can only be driven with the IntelligentKeys which are registered to your vehicle’s Intel-ligent Key system components and NISSAN Ve-hicle Immobilizer System components.

Never leave these keys in the vehicle.

As many as 4 Intelligent Keys can be registeredand used with one vehicle. The new keys must beregistered by a NISSAN dealer prior to use with

the Intelligent Key system and NISSAN VehicleImmobilizer System of your vehicle. Since theregistration process requires erasing all memoryin the Intelligent Key components when register-ing new keys, be sure to take all Intelligent Keysthat you have to the NISSAN dealer.

A key number plate is supplied with your keys.Record the key number and keep it in a safe place(such as your wallet), not in the vehicle. If you loseyour keys, see a NISSAN dealer for duplicates byusing the key number. NISSAN does not recordkey numbers so it is very important to keep trackof your key number plate.

A key number is only necessary when you havelost all keys and do not have one to duplicatefrom. If you still have a key, your NISSAN dealercan duplicate it.

CAUTION

Listed below are conditions or occur-rences which will damage the IntelligentKey:

● Do not allow the Intelligent Key, whichcontains electrical components, tocome into contact with water or saltwater. This could affect the systemfunction.

● Do not drop the Intelligent Key.

● Do not strike the Intelligent Key sharplyagainst another object.

● Do not change or modify the IntelligentKey.

● Wetting may damage the IntelligentKey. If the Intelligent Key gets wet, im-mediately wipe until it is completely dry.

● Do not place the Intelligent Key for anextended period in an area where tem-peratures exceed 140°F (60°C).

● Do not attach the Intelligent Key with akey holder that contains a magnet.

● Do not place the Intelligent Key nearequipment that produces a magneticfield, such as a TV, audio equipment andpersonal computers.

WPD0363

KEYS

3-2 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Page 131: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Mechanical key

The Intelligent Key contains the mechanical key,which can be used in case of a discharged bat-tery.

To remove the mechanical key, release the lockknob on the back of the Intelligent Key.

To install the mechanical key, firmly insert it intothe Intelligent Key until the lock knob returns tothe lock position.

The mechanical key can be used for operation inthe same way as an ordinary key.

CAUTION

Always carry the mechanical key installedin the Intelligent Key slot.

See “Doors” in this section and “Storage” in the“Instruments and controls”section of this manual.

Valet hand-offWhen you have to leave a key with a valet, givethem the Intelligent Key itself and keep the me-chanical key with you to protect your belongings.

To prevent the glove box and the trunk from beingopened during valet hand-off, follow the proce-dures below.

1. Push the trunk cancel switch to the OFFposition.

2. Remove the mechanical key from the Intelli-gent Key.

3. Lock the glove box and the trunk pass-through with the mechanical key.

4. Hand the Intelligent Key to the valet andkeep the mechanical key with you.

See “Trunk lid” in this section, “Storage” in the“Instruments and controls” section and “Seats” inthe “Safety — seats, seat belts and supplementalrestraint system” section of this manual.

NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZERSYSTEM KEYS

You can only drive your vehicle using the masterkeys which are registered to the NISSAN VehicleImmobilizer System components in your vehicle.These keys have a transponder chip in the keyhead.

The master key can be used for all the locks.

To protect belongings when you leave a key withsomeone, give them the Intelligent Key only, notthe mechanical key.

Never leave these keys in the vehicle.

Additional or replacement keys:

If you still have a key, the key number is notnecessary when you need extra NISSAN VehicleImmobilizer System keys. Your dealer can dupli-cate your existing key. As many as four NISSANVehicle Immobilizer System keys can be usedwith one vehicle. You should bring all NISSANVehicle Immobilizer System keys that you have toyour NISSAN dealer for registration. This is be-cause the registration process will erase thememory of all key codes previously registeredinto the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System.After the registration process, these componentswill only recognize keys coded into the NISSANVehicle Immobilizer System during registration.

SPA1951

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-3

Page 132: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Any key that is not given to your dealer at the timeof registration will no longer be able to start yourvehicle.

Do not allow the immobilizer system key, whichcontains an electrical transponder, to come intocontact with salt water. This could affect systemfunction.

When the doors are locked using one of thefollowing methods, the doors can not be openedusing the inside or outside door handles. Thedoors must be unlocked to open the doors.

WARNING

● Always have the doors locked whiledriving. Along with the use of seat belts,this provides greater safety in the eventof an accident by helping to preventpersons from being thrown from thevehicle. This also helps keep childrenand others from unintentionally open-ing the doors, and will help keep outintruders.

● Before opening any door, always lookfor and avoid oncoming traffic.

● Do not leave children unattended insidethe vehicle. They could unknowingly ac-tivate switches or controls. Unattendedchildren could become involved in seri-ous accidents.

LOCKING WITH KEY

The power door lock system allows you to lock orunlock all doors at the same time.

Turning the key toward the front �1 of the vehiclelocks all doors.

Turning the key one time toward the rear �2 of thevehicle unlocks that door. From that position,returning the key to neutral �3 (where the key canonly be removed and inserted) and turning ittoward the rear again within 60 seconds unlocksall doors �4 .

Driver’s sideLPD0461

DOORS

3-4 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Page 133: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Opening and closing windowsThe driver’s door key operation allows you toopen and close windows equipped with auto-matic operation at the same time.

● To open the windows, turn the driver’s doorkey toward the rear of the vehicle for longerthan 1 second after the door is unlocked.

● To close the windows, turn the driver’s doorkey toward the front of the vehicle for longerthan 1 second after the door is locked.

Windows stop when the key cylinder is released.

LOCKING WITH INSIDE LOCKKNOBTo lock the door without the key, move the insidelock knob to the lock position �1 , then close thedoor.

To unlock the door without the key, move theinside lock knob to the unlock position �2 .

LOCKING WITH POWER DOORLOCK SWITCHTo lock all the doors without a key, push the doorlock switch (driver’s or front passenger’s side) tothe lock position �1 . When locking the door thisway, be certain not to leave the key inside thevehicle.

To unlock all the doors without a key, push thedoor lock switch (driver’s or front passenger’sside) to the unlock position �2 .

Inside lockWPD0291 WPD0381

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-5

Page 134: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Lockout protection

When the power door lock switch (driver’s orfront passenger’s side) is moved to the lockposition with the Intelligent Key in the port andany door open, all doors will lock and unlockautomatically. With the Intelligent Key left in thevehicle (not in the Intelligent Key port) and anydoor open, all doors will unlock automatically anda chime will sound after the door is closed.

AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS

● All doors lock automatically when the vehiclespeed reaches 15 MPH (24 km/h).

● All doors unlock automatically when the ig-nition is placed in the OFF position.

The automatic unlock function can be de-activated or activated. To deactivate or acti-vate the automatic door unlock system, performthe following procedure:

1. Close all doors.

2. Place the ignition switch in the ON position.

3. Within 20 seconds of performing Step 2,push and hold the power door lock switch tothe position (UNLOCK) for more than5 seconds.

4. When activated, the hazard indicator willflash twice. When deactivated, the hazardindicator will flash once.

5. The ignition switch must be placed in theOFF and ON position again between eachsetting change.

When the automatic door unlock system is deac-tivated, the doors do not unlock when the ignitionswitch is placed in the OFF position. To unlockthe door manually, use the inside lock knob or thepower door lock switch (driver’s or front passen-ger’s side).

CHILD SAFETY REAR DOOR LOCKChild safety locks help prevent the rear doorsfrom being opened accidentally, especially whensmall children are in the vehicle.

The child safety lock levers are located on theedge of the rear doors.

When the lever is in the unlock position �1 , thedoor can be opened from the outside or theinside.

When the lever is in the LOCK position �2 ,the door can be opened only from the out-side.

LIC0716

3-6 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Page 135: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● Radio waves could adversely affectelectric medical equipment. Those whouse a pacemaker should contact theelectric medical equipment manufac-turer for the possible influences beforeuse.

● The Intelligent Key transmits radiowaves when the buttons are pushed.The FAA advises the radio waves mayaffect aircraft navigation and communi-cation systems. Do not operate the In-telligent Key while on an airplane. Makesure the buttons are not operated unin-tentionally when the unit is stored for aflight.

The Intelligent Key system can operate all thedoor locks using the remote controller function orpushing the request switch on the vehicle withouttaking the key out from a pocket or purse. Theoperating environment and/or conditions may af-fect the Intelligent Key system operation.

Be sure to read the following before using theIntelligent Key system.

CAUTION

● Be sure to carry the Intelligent Key withyou when operating the vehicle.

● Never leave the Intelligent Key in thevehicle when you leave the vehicle.

The Intelligent Key is always communicating withthe vehicle as it receives radio waves. The Intel-ligent Key system transmits weak radio waves.Environmental conditions may interfere with theoperation of the Intelligent Key system under thefollowing operating conditions.

● When operating near a location wherestrong radio waves are transmitted, such asa TV tower, power station and broadcastingstation.

● When in possession of wireless equipment,such as a cellular telephone, transceiver,and CB radio.

● When the Intelligent Key is in contact with orcovered by metallic materials.

● When any type of radio wave remote controlis used nearby.

● When the Intelligent Key is placed near anelectric appliance such as a personal com-puter.

● When the vehicle is parked near a parkingmeter.

In such cases, correct the operating conditionsbefore using the Intelligent Key function or usethe mechanical key.

Although the life of the battery varies dependingon the operating conditions, the battery’s life isapproximately 2 years. If the battery is dis-charged, replace it with a new one.

When the Intelligent Key battery is almost dis-charged, insert the Intelligent Key into the Intelli-gent Key port to start the engine. Replace thedischarged battery with a new one as soon aspossible. For additional information, see “PushButton Ignition Switch “ in the “Starting andDriving” section.

Since the Intelligent Key is continuously receivingradio waves, if the key is left near equipmentwhich transmits strong radio waves, such as sig-nals from a TV and personal computer, the bat-tery life may become shorter.

For information regarding replacement of a bat-tery, see “Battery replacement” in the “Mainte-nance and do-it-yourself” section.

As many as four Intelligent Keys can be regis-tered and used with one vehicle. For informationabout the purchase and use of additional Intelli-gent Keys, contact a NISSAN dealer.

NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY™

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-7

Page 136: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CAUTION

Listed below are conditions or occur-rences which will damage the IntelligentKey:

● Do not allow the Intelligent Key, whichcontains electrical components, tocome into contact with water or saltwater. This could affect the systemfunction.

● Do not drop the Intelligent Key.

● Do not strike the Intelligent Key sharplyagainst another object.

● Do not change or modify the IntelligentKey.

● Wetting may damage the IntelligentKey. If the Intelligent Key gets wet, im-mediately wipe until it is completely dry.

● Do not place the Intelligent Key for anextended period in an area where tem-peratures exceed 140°F (60°C).

● Do not attach the Intelligent Key with akey holder that contains a magnet.

● Do not place the Intelligent Key nearequipment that produces a magneticfield, such as a TV, audio equipment andpersonal computers.

If an Intelligent Key is lost or stolen, NISSANrecommends erasing the ID code of that Intelli-gent Key from the vehicle. This may prevent theunauthorized use of the Intelligent Key to operatethe vehicle. For information regarding the erasingprocedure, contact a NISSAN dealer.

3-8 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Page 137: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

OPERATING RANGE

The Intelligent Key functions can only be usedwhen the Intelligent Key is within the specifiedoperating range from the request switch �1 .

When the Intelligent Key battery is discharged orstrong radio waves are present near the operat-ing location, the Intelligent Key operating rangebecomes narrower, and the Intelligent Key maynot function properly.

The operating range is within 31.50 in (80 cm)from each request switch �1 .

If the Intelligent Key is too close to the door glass,handle or rear bumper, the request switches maynot function.

When the Intelligent Key is within the operatingrange, it is possible for anyone, even someonewho does not carry the Intelligent Key, to push therequest switch to lock/unlock the doors.

DOOR LOCKS/UNLOCKSPRECAUTION

● Do not push the door handle request switchwith the Intelligent Key held in your hand asillustrated. The close distance to the doorhandle will cause the Intelligent Key systemto have difficulty recognizing that the Intelli-gent Key is outside the vehicle.

● After locking with the door handle requestswitch, verify the doors are securely lockedby testing them.

SPA2038 WPD0375

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-9

Page 138: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● To prevent the Intelligent Key from being leftinside the vehicle, make sure you carry theIntelligent Key with you and then lock thedoors.

● Do not pull the door handle before pushingthe door handle request switch. The doorwill be unlocked but will not open. Releasethe door handle once and pull it again toopen the door.

NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY™OPERATIONYou can lock or unlock the doors without takingthe Intelligent Key out of your pocket or bag.

When you carry the Intelligent Key with you, youcan lock or unlock all doors by pushing the doorhandle request switch within the range of opera-tion.

Locking doors

1. Move the shift selector to the “P” position.Place the ignition switch in the LOCK posi-tion. Make sure the Intelligent Key is not leftin the vehicle.

2. Close all doors.

3. Push any door handle request switch �1while carrying the Intelligent Key with you.

4. All doors and the trunk will lock.

5. The hazard warning lights flash twice andthe outside buzzer sounds twice.

WPD0376 WPD0377

3-10 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Page 139: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

NOTE:

● Doors lock with the door handle requestswitch when the ignition switch is placed inthe ON position.

● Doors lock with the door handle requestswitch while the ignition switch is not in theLOCK position.

● Doors do not lock by pushing the doorhandle request switch while any door isopen. However, doors lock with the me-chanical key even if any door is open.

● Doors do not lock with the door handlerequest switch with the Intelligent Key insidethe vehicle and a beep sounds to warn you.However, when an Intelligent Key is insidethe vehicle, doors can be locked with an-other Intelligent Key.

CAUTION

● After locking the doors using the re-quest switch, make sure that the doorshave been securely locked by operatingthe door handles or the trunk openerswitch.

● When locking the doors using the re-quest switch, make sure to have theIntelligent Key in your possession be-fore operating the request switch toprevent the Intelligent Key from beingleft in the vehicle.

● The request switch is operational onlywhen the Intelligent Key has been de-tected by the Intelligent Key system.

Lockout protection

To prevent the Intelligent Key from being acci-dentally locked in the vehicle, lockout protectionis equipped with the Intelligent Key.

When the driver’s side door is open, the doorsare locked, and then the Intelligent Key is put

inside the vehicle and all the doors are closed;the lock will automatically unlock and the doorbuzzer sounds.

NOTE:

The doors may not lock when the Intelli-gent Key is in the same hand that is oper-ating the request switch to lock the door.Put the Intelligent Key in a purse, pocket oryour other hand.

CAUTION

The lockout protection may not functionunder the following conditions:

● When the Intelligent Key is placed ontop of the instrument panel.

● When the Intelligent Key is placed ontop of the rear parcel shelf.

● When the Intelligent Key is placed in-side the glove box or a storage bin.

● When the Intelligent Key is placed in-side the door pockets.

● When the Intelligent Key is placed on orunder the spare tire area.

● When the Intelligent Key is placed in-side or near metallic materials.

WPD0369

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-11

Page 140: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Unlocking doors

1. Carry the Intelligent Key.

2. Push the door handle request switch �1 .

3. The hazard warning lights flash once and theoutside buzzer sounds once.

4. Push the door handle request switch �1again within 60 seconds to unlock all doors.

If a door handle is pulled while unlocking thedoors, that door may not be unlocked. Returningthe door handle to its original position will unlockthe door. If the door does not unlock after return-ing the door handle, push the door handle re-quest switch to unlock the door.

All doors will be locked automatically unless oneof the following operations is performed within 60seconds after pushing the request switch.

● Opening any door.

● Pushing the ignition switch.

The interior light timer illuminates for a period oftime when a door is unlocked and the room lightswitch is in the DOOR position.

The interior light can be turned off without waitingby performing one of the following operations.

● Placing the ignition switch in the ON posi-tion.

● Locking the doors with the remote controller.

● Switching the room light switch to the OFFposition.

WPD0377 WPD0369

3-12 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Page 141: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Opening the trunk lid

1. Push the trunk opener request switch �A formore than 1 second while carrying the Intel-ligent Key with you.

2. The trunk will unlatch. A chime will sound 4times.

3. Raise the trunk lid to open the trunk.

Lockout protection

To prevent the Intelligent Key from being acci-dentally locked in the trunk, lockout protection isequipped with the Intelligent Key.

When all doors are locked and the trunk lid isclosed with the Intelligent Key inside the trunk,the outside buzzer will sound and the trunk willopen.

HOW TO USE THE REMOTEKEYLESS ENTRY FUNCTIONThe remote keyless entry function can operate alldoor locks using the remote keyless function ofthe Intelligent Key. The remote keyless functioncan operate at a distance of 33 ft (10 m) awayfrom the vehicle. The operating distance de-pends upon the conditions around the vehicle.

The remote keyless entry function will not func-tion under the following conditions:

● When the Intelligent Key is not within theoperational range.

● When the doors or the trunk are open or notclosed securely.

● When the Intelligent Key battery is dis-charged.

CAUTION

When locking the doors using the Intelli-gent Key, be sure not to leave the key inthe vehicle.

Locking doors

1. Place the ignition switch in the LOCK posi-tion.

2. Close all doors.

3. Press the button on the IntelligentKey.

4. The hazard warning lights flash twice andthe horn beeps once.

5. All doors will be locked.

LPD0478 WPD0359

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-13

Page 142: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CAUTION

After locking the doors using the Intelli-gent Key, be sure that the doors have beensecurely locked by operating the doorhandles.

Unlocking doors

1. Press the button on the IntelligentKey.

2. The hazard warning lights flash once.

3. Press the button again within 60 sec-onds to unlock all doors.

All doors will be locked automatically unless oneof the following operations is performed within 1minute after pressing the button.

● Opening any doors.

● Pushing the ignition switch.

The interior light illuminates for a period of timewhen a door is unlocked and the room lightswitch is in the DOOR position.

The light can be turned off without waiting byperforming one of the following operations.

● Placing the ignition switch in the ON posi-tion.

● Locking the doors with the remote controller.

● Switching the room light switch to the OFFposition.

Opening windowsThe Intelligent Key allows you to open windowsequipped with automatic operation simultane-ously.

● To open the windows, press the but-ton on the Intelligent Key for longer than 3seconds after all doors are unlocked.

The door windows will open while pressingthe button on the Intelligent Key.

The door windows cannot be closed byusing the Intelligent Key.

WPD0360

3-14 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Page 143: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Releasing the trunk lid

Press the button for longer than 0.5 sec-onds to open the trunk lid. The trunk releasebutton will not operate when the ignition switch isin the ON position or when the trunk cancelswitch is in the OFF position. See “Cancelswitch” in this section.

Using the panic alarmIf you are near your vehicle and feel threatened,you may activate the panic alarm to call attentionby pressing and holding the button on theIntelligent Key for longer than 0.5 seconds.

The panic alarm and headlights will stay on for aperiod of time.

The panic alarm stops when:

● It has run for a period of time, or

● Any button is pressed on the Intelligent Key.

● Pushing the request switch on the driver orpassenger door with the Intelligent Key inrange of the door handle.

WPD0364 WPD0361

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-15

Page 144: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Silencing the horn beep feature

If desired, the horn beep feature can be deacti-vated using the Intelligent Key.

To deactivate: Press and hold theand buttons for at least 2 seconds.

The hazard warning lights will flash 3 times toconfirm that the horn beep feature has beendeactivated.

To activate: Press and hold theand buttons for at least 2 secondsonce more.

The hazard warning lights will flash once and thehorn will sound once to confirm that the hornbeep feature has been reactivated.

Deactivating the horn beep feature does not si-lence the horn if the alarm is triggered.

WARNING SIGNALSTo help prevent the vehicle from moving unex-pectedly by erroneous operation of the IntelligentKey or to help prevent the vehicle from beingstolen, a chime or buzzer sounds from inside andoutside the vehicle and a warning is displayed inthe instrument panel.

When a chime or beep sounds or a warning isdisplayed, be sure to check the vehicle and theIntelligent Key.

See the “Troubleshooting guide” that follows and“Vehicle information display” in the “Instrumentsand controls” section of this manual.

WPD0362

3-16 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Page 145: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDEVerify the location of all Intelligent Keys that areprogrammed for the vehicle. If another IntelligentKey is in range or inside the vehicle, the vehiclesystem may respond differently than expected.

Symptom Possible Cause Remedy

When pushing the ignition switch to stopthe engine

The SHIFT P warning appears on the dis-play and the inside warning chime soundscontinuously.

The shift selector is not in the P (Park)position.

Shift the shift selector to the P (Park)position.

When opening the driver’s door to get outof the vehicle

The inside warning chime soundscontinuously.

The ignition switch is placed in the ACCposition.

Place the ignition switch in the OFFposition.

The Intelligent Key is in the Intelligent Keyport.

Remove the Intelligent Key from the Intelli-gent Key port.

When closing the door after getting out ofthe vehicle

The NO KEY warning appears on thedisplay, the outside chime sounds 3 timesand the inside warning chime sounds forapproximately 3 seconds.

The ignition switch is placed in the ACC orON position.

Place the ignition switch in the OFFposition.

The NO KEY warning appears on the dis-play and the outside chime soundscontinuously.

The ignition switch is placed in the ACCposition and the shift selector is not in the P(Park) position.

Move the shift selector to the P (Park) posi-tion and place the ignition switch in theOFF position.

The shift “P” warning light appears on thedisplay and the outside chime soundscontinuously.

The ignition switch is placed in the OFFposition and the shift selector is not in the P(Park) position.

Move the shift selector to the P (Park)position.

When closing the door with the inside lockknob placed in the LOCK position

The outside chime sounds for approximately3 seconds and all the doors unlock.

The Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle ortrunk.

Carry the Intelligent Key with you.

When pushing the door handle requestswitch to lock the door

The outside chime sounds for approximately2 seconds.

The Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle ortrunk.

Carry the Intelligent Key with you.

A door is not closed securely. Close the door securely.The door handle request switch is pushedbefore the door is closed.

Push the door handle request switch afterthe door is closed.

When closing the trunk lid The outside chime sounds for approximately10 seconds and the trunk lid opens. The Intelligent Key is inside the trunk. Carry the Intelligent Key with you.

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-17

Page 146: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

�1 Pull the hood lock release handle locatedbelow the driver side instrument panel. Thehood will spring up slightly.

�2 Push the lever at the front of the hood to theside as illustrated with your fingertips andraise the hood.

When closing the hood, lower it slowly and makesure it locks into place.

WARNING

● Make sure the hood is completelyclosed and latched before driving. Fail-ure to do so could cause the hood to flyopen and result in an accident.

● If you see steam or smoke coming fromthe engine compartment, to avoid injurydo not open the hood.

WARNING

● Do not drive with the trunk lid open. Thiscould allow dangerous exhaust gasesto be drawn into the vehicle. See “Ex-haust gas” in the “Starting and driving”section of this manual.

● Closely supervise children when theyare around cars to prevent them fromplaying and becoming locked in thetrunk where they could be seriously in-jured. Keep the car locked, with the rearseatback and trunk lid securely latchedwhen not in use, and prevent children’saccess to car keys.LRS2008

HOOD TRUNK LID

3-18 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Page 147: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

OPENER OPERATION

WARNING

● Do not drive with the trunk lid open. Thiscould allow dangerous exhaust gasesto be drawn into the vehicle. See “Ex-haust gas” in the “Starting and driving”section of this manual.

● Closely supervise children when theyare around cars to prevent them fromplaying and becoming locked in thetrunk where they could be seriously in-jured. Keep the car locked, with the rearseatback and trunk lid securely latchedwhen not in use, and prevent children’saccess to car keys.

To open the trunk lid, push the opener switchdown.

To close the trunk lid, lower and push the trunk liddown securely.

NOTE:

You can open the trunk lid with the Intelli-gent Key. Refer to “NISSAN IntelligentKey™” in this section.

Cancel switchWhen the cancel switch located inside the glovebox is OFF, the trunk lid cannot be opened withthe trunk lid release switch or with the IntelligentKey.

LPD0394 LPD0186

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-19

Page 148: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

INTERIOR TRUNK LID RELEASE

WARNING

Closely supervise children when they arearound cars to prevent them from playingand becoming locked in the trunk wherethey could be seriously injured. Keep thecar locked, with the rear seatback andtrunk lid securely latched when not in use,and prevent children’s access to car keys.

The interior trunk lid release mechanism providesa means of escape for children and adults in theevent they become locked inside the trunk.

To open the trunk from the inside, pull the illumi-nated release handle until the lock releases andpush up on the trunk lid. The release handle ismade of a material that glows in the dark after abrief exposure to ambient light.

The handle is located inside the trunk compart-ment on the interior of the trunk lid.

SECONDARY TRUNK LID RELEASE(if so equipped)For models with a rear center console, the trunkcan be accessed through the access panel be-tween the rear seats, as shown. To open the trunklid from the rear seat:

● Fold down the center arm rest.● Insert the mechanical key into the trunk com-

partment access lid lock. Fold down thetrunk compartment access lid. For more in-formation on the mechanical key, see“NISSAN Intelligent Key™” in this section.

● Pull the rear seat trunk release handle �1 .

To close, push the trunk lid down securely.

WIC1401 LPD0459

3-20 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Page 149: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

OPENING THE FUEL-FILLER DOOR

The fuel-filler door automatically unlocks whenthe driver’s door is unlocked.

1. Unlock the fuel-filler door using one of thefollowing operations.

● Unlock the driver’s door with the keyfob.

● Push the power door lock switch to theunlock position.

● Push the door handle request switch.

2. To open the fuel filler door, push the rightside of the fuel filler door to release.

To lock, close the fuel-filler door securely andlock the doors.

NOTE:

The fuel-filler door will unlock using thekey only when all doors are unlocked. Un-locking the driver’s door will not unlock thefuel-filler door.

FUEL-FILLER CAP

WARNING

● Gasoline is extremely flammable andhighly explosive under certain condi-tions. You could be burned or seriouslyinjured if it is misused or mishandled.Always stop the engine and do notsmoke or allow open flames or sparksnear the vehicle when refueling.

● Do not attempt to top off the fuel tankafter the fuel pump nozzle shuts offautomatically. Continued refueling maycause fuel overflow, resulting in fuelspray and possibly a fire.

● Use only an original equipment typefuel-filler cap as a replacement. It has abuilt-in safety valve needed for properoperation of the fuel system and emis-sion control system. An incorrect capcan result in a serious malfunction andpossible injury. It could also cause

the Malfunction Indicator Light

(MIL) to come on.

● Never pour fuel into the throttle body toattempt to start your vehicle.

● Do not fill a portable fuel container inthe vehicle or trailer. Static electricitycan cause an explosion of flammableliquid, vapor or gas in any vehicle ortrailer. To reduce the risk of seriousinjury or death when filling portable fuelcontainers:

– Always place the container on theground when filling.

– Do not use electronic devices whenfilling.

– Keep the pump nozzle in contactwith the container while you are fill-ing it.

– Use only approved portable fuel con-tainers for flammable liquid.

WPD0454

FUEL-FILLER DOOR

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-21

Page 150: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CAUTION

● The LOOSE FUEL CAP warning will ap-pear if the fuel-filler cap is not properlytightened. It may take a few driving tripsfor the message to be displayed. Failureto tighten the fuel-filler cap properlyafter the LOOSE FUEL CAP warning ap-

pears may cause the Malfunc-

tion Indicator Light (MIL) to illuminate.

● Failure to tighten the fuel-filler cap

properly may cause the Mal-

function Indicator Light (MIL) to illumi-

nate. If the light illuminates be-

cause the fuel-filler cap is loose ormissing, tighten or install the cap andcontinue to drive the vehicle.

The light should turn off after a

few driving trips. If the light

does not turn off after a few drivingtrips, have the vehicle inspected by aNISSAN dealer.

● For additional information, see the“Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)” inthe “Instruments and Controls” sectionin this manual.

● If fuel is spilled on the vehicle body,flush it away with water to avoid paintdamage.

To remove the fuel-filler cap:

1. Turn the fuel-filler cap counterclockwise toremove.

2. Put the fuel-filler cap on the cap holder �1while refueling.

To install the fuel-filler cap:

1. Insert the fuel-filler cap straight into the fuel-filler tube.

2. Turn the fuel-filler cap clockwise until asingle click is heard.

LPD0482

3-22 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Page 151: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Loose Fuel Cap warningThe LOOSE FUEL CAP warning appears in thevehicle information display when the fuel-fillercap is not tightened correctly after the vehicle hasbeen refueled. It may take a few driving trips forthe message to be displayed. To turn off thewarning, perform the following:

1. Remove and install the fuel-filler cap as soonas possible. See “Fuel-filler cap”.

2. Tighten the fuel-filler cap until it clicks.

3. Press the next button �A on the in-strument panel located behind the steeringwheel for about 1 second to turn off theLOOSE FUEL CAP warning �B after tight-ening the fuel-filler cap.

WARNING

Do not adjust the steering wheel whiledriving. You could lose control of yourvehicle and cause an accident.

CAUTION

Do not adjust the steering wheel anycloser to you than is necessary for propersteering operation and comfort. The driv-er’s air bag inflates with great force. If youare unrestrained, leaning forward, sittingsideways or out of position in any way, youare at greater risk of injury or death in acrash. You may also receive serious orfatal injuries from the air bag if you are upagainst it when it inflates. Always sit backagainst the seatback and as far away aspractical from the steering wheel. Alwaysuse the seat belts.

LRS2007

TILT/TELESCOPIC STEERING

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-23

Page 152: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

MANUAL OPERATION (if soequipped)

Tilt and telescopic operationPull the lock lever �1 all the way towards you:

● Adjust the steering wheel forward or back-ward in direction �2 to the desired position.

● Adjust the steering wheel up or down indirection �3 to the desired position.

Lock the steering wheel by releasing the locklever. Make sure the lock lever has returned to itsoriginal position to lock the steering wheel inplace.

AUTOMATIC OPERATION (if soequipped)

Tilt operationPush the switch �1 up or down to adjust thesteering wheel to the desired position.

Telescopic operationPush the switch �1 forward or backward to ad-just the steering wheel to the desired position.

Entry/Exit functionThe automatic drive positioner system will makethe steering wheel move up automatically whenthe driver’s door is opened and the ignitionswitch is in the LOCK position. This lets the driverget into and out of the seat more easily. Thesteering wheel moves back into position whenthe driver’s door is closed and the ignition switchis pushed.

For more information, see “Automatic drive posi-tioner” in this section.

LPD0457 LPD0458

3-24 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Page 153: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

�1 To block glare from the front, swing down themain sun visor.

�2 To block glare from the side, remove themain sun visor from the center mount andswing the visor to the side.

�3 Slide the extension sun visor in or out asneeded.

CAUTION

● Do not store the sun visor before return-ing the extension to its originalposition.

● Do not pull the extension sun visorforcedly downward. VANITY MIRRORS

To access the vanity mirror, pull the sun visordown and flip open the mirror cover. The vanitymirror will illuminate when the mirror cover isopen.

WPD0297

WPD0324

SUN VISORS

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-25

Page 154: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

AUTOMATIC ANTI-GLAREREARVIEW MIRRORThe inside mirror is designed so that it automati-cally dims during night time conditions and ac-cording to the intensity of the headlights of thevehicle following you. The automatic anti-glarefeature is activated when the ignition switch isplaced in the ON position.

NOTE:

Do not hang any objects over the sensors�1 or apply glass cleaner to the sensors.Doing so will reduce the sensitivity of thesensors, resulting in improper operation.

Type A

The indicator light �2 will illuminate when theautomatic anti-glare feature is operating.

With the ignition switch placed in the ON posi-tion, press the button as described:

● To turn off the anti-glare feature, pressthe button for 8 seconds. The indica-tor light will turn off.

● To turn on the anti-glare feature, pressthe button again for 8 seconds. Theindicator light will turn on.

For information on the compass display (if soequipped), see “Compass display” in the “Instru-ments and controls” section of this manual.

Type AWPD0446

MIRRORS

3-26 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Page 155: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Type B and Type CThe indicator light �2 will illuminate when theautomatic anti-glare feature is operating.

To turn off the automatic anti-glare feature, press:

● the O button for inside mirrors withoutcompass.

● the button for inside mirrors withcompass.

The indicator light will turn off.

To turn on the automatic anti-glare feature again,press:

● the | button for inside mirrors withoutcompass.

● the button for inside mirrors withcompass.

The indicator light will turn on.

Some vehicles are also equipped with automaticanti-glare outside mirrors. For additional informa-tion, see “Automatic anti-glare outside mirrors” inthis section.

For information on HomeLink� Universal Trans-ceiver operation, see the “HomeLink� UniversalTransceiver” in the “Instruments and controls”section of this manual.

For information on the compass display (if soequipped), see “Compass display” in the “Instru-ments and controls” section of this manual.

Type B-Without compassLPD0469

Type C-With compassLPD0470

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-27

Page 156: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

OUTSIDE MIRRORS

The outside mirror remote control will operateonly when the ignition switch is in the ACC or ONposition.

Move the small switch �1 to select the right or leftmirror. Adjust each mirror to the desired positionusing the large switch �2 .

WARNING

● Objects viewed in the outside mirror onthe passenger side are closer than theyappear. Be careful when moving to theright. Using only this mirror could causean accident. Use the inside mirror orglance over your shoulder to properlyjudge distances to other objects.

● Do not adjust the mirrors while driving.You could lose control of your vehicleand cause an accident.

Automatic anti-glare outside mirror(Driver’s side only) (if so equipped)

The driver’s outside mirror will automatically dimduring nighttime conditions to reduce the glarefrom the headlights of trailing vehicles. The auto-matic anti-glare feature operates only when theignition switch is placed in the ON position.

The automatic anti-glare feature will be on whenstarting the vehicle. The indicator light on theautomatic anti-glare rearview mirror will illuminatewhen the automatic anti-glare feature is on.

To turn off the automatic anti-glare feature, press:

● the O button on rearview mirror withoutcompass (Type B).

● the button on rearview mirror withcompass (Type C).

The indicator light will turn off.

To turn on the automatic anti-glare feature again,press:

● the | button on rearview mirror withoutcompass (Type B).

● the button on rearview mirrorequipped with compass (Type C).

The indicator light will turn on.

For information on the automatic anti-glare rear-view mirror, see “Automatic anti-glare rearviewmirror” in this section.

Reverse tilt-down feature (if soequipped)The reverse tilt-down feature will turn both out-side mirror surfaces downward to provide betterrear visibility close to the vehicle when the smallswitch is in either the L or R position.

NOTE:

If the outside mirror control switch is in theneutral position, neither mirror will turndownward when the shift selector is movedto R (Reverse).

LPD0237

3-28 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Page 157: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Move the shift selector to R (Reverse). Bothmirrors will turn downward.

The mirror surfaces will return to their originalposition when any of the following have occurred:

● The shift selector is moved to any positionother than R (Reverse).

● The outside mirror control switch is set to theneutral or center position.

● The ignition switch is placed in the OFFposition.

Heated mirrors (if so equipped)The electric control type outside mirrors can beheated to defrost, defog, or de-ice for improvedvisibility. Push the rear window defogger switchto activate the heating function. Push the switchagain to deactivate, or the heating function willautomatically turn off after approximately 15 min-utes.

Foldable outside mirrorsPull the outside mirror toward the door to fold it.

The automatic drive positioner system has twofeatures:

● Memory storage function

● Entry/exit function

MPA0008

AUTOMATIC DRIVE POSITIONER (ifso equipped)

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-29

Page 158: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

MEMORY STORAGE FUNCTION

Two positions for the driver’s seat, steering col-umn, and outside mirrors can be stored in theautomatic drive positioner memory. Follow theseprocedures to use the memory system.

1. Set the Continuously Variable Transmission(CVT) shift selector to the P (Park) position.

2. Place the ignition in the ON position.

3. Adjust the driver’s seat, steering column,and outside mirrors to the desired positionsby manually operating each adjustingswitch. For additional information, see“Seats” in the “Safety—Seats, seat belts and

supplemental restraint system” section and“Outside mirrors” in this section.

During this step, do not place the ignitionswitch in any position other than ON.

4. Push the SET switch and, within 5 seconds,push the memory switch (1 or 2).

The indicator light for the pushed memoryswitch will come on and stay on for approxi-mately 5 seconds after pushing the switch.After the indicator light goes off, the se-lected positions are stored in the selectedmemory (1 or 2).

If a new memory is stored in the same memoryswitch, the previous memory will be deleted.

Linking a keyfob to a stored memoryposition

Each keyfob can be linked to a stored memoryposition (memory switch 1 or 2) with the follow-ing procedure.

1. Follow the steps for storing a memory posi-tion.

2. While the indicator light for the memoryswitch being set is illuminated for 5 sec-onds, press the button on the keyfob.

The indicator light will blink. After the indica-tor light goes off, the keyfob is linked to thatmemory setting.

With the ignition switch placed in the OFF posi-tion, press the button on the keyfob. Thedriver’s seat and outside mirrors will move to thememorized position.

NOTE:

If a new memory position is saved to thememory switch, the keyfob automaticallyre-links.

Confirming memory storage● Place the ignition switch in the ON position

and push the SET switch. If the main memoryhas not been stored, the indicator light willcome on for approximately 0.5 seconds.When the memory has stored the position,the indicator light will stay on for approxi-mately 5 seconds.

● If the battery cable is disconnected, or if thefuse opens, the memory storage function willbe canceled and must be restarted before astored memory position can be set again.Drive the vehicle over 25 MPH (40 km/h) torestart the memory storage function. Youcan also restart the memory storage functionusing the following procedure.

LRS2009

3-30 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Page 159: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Connect the battery cable or replace thefuse.

2. Open and close the driver’s door more than2 times with the ignition switch in the LOCKposition.

Once the memory storage function has beenrestarted, you can store a memory position.See “Memory storage function” in this sec-tion.

Selecting the memorized positionSet the shift selector to the P (Park) position,then:

● Within 45 seconds of opening the driver’sdoor, push the memory switch (1 or 2) or

● Place the ignition switch in the ON positionand push the memory switch (1 or 2).

The driver’s seat, steering column, and outsidemirrors will move to the memorized position withthe indicator light blinking, and then the light willstay on for approximately 5 seconds.

ENTRY/EXIT FUNCTIONThis system is designed so that the driver’s seatand automatic operation steering column will au-tomatically move when the shift selector is in theP (Park) position. This allows the driver to get intoand out of the driver’s seat more easily.

The driver’s seat will slide backward and thesteering wheel will move up when the driver’sdoor is opened and the ignition switch is in theLOCK position.

The driver’s seat and steering wheel will return tothe previous position when the driver’s door isclosed and the ignition switch is pushed.

The entry/exit function can be adjusted or can-celed. See “Comfort & Convenience settings” inthe “Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voicerecognition systems” section of this manual.

Restarting the entry/exit functionIf the battery cable is disconnected or if the fuseopens, the entry/exit function will be disabled.Drive the vehicle over 25 MPH (40 km/h) torestart the entry/exit function. You can also restartthe entry/exit function using the following proce-dure.

1. Connect the battery cable or replace thefuse.

2. Open and close the driver’s door more than2 times with the ignition switch in the LOCKposition.

The entry/exit function should now work properly.

SYSTEM OPERATIONThe automatic drive positioner system will notwork or will stop operating under the followingconditions:

● When the vehicle speed is above 4 MPH (7km/h).

● When any of the memory switches arepushed while the automatic drive positioneris operating.

● When the adjusting switch for the driver’sseat is turned on while the automatic drivepositioner is operating.

● When the seat has been already moved tothe memorized position.

● When no seat position is stored in thememory switch.

● When the shift selector is moved from P(Park) to any other position.

● When the driver’s door remains open morethan 45 seconds and the ignition switch isnot in the ON position.

The automatic drive positioner system can be ad-justed and canceled for vehicles with navigationsystem. See “Comfort & Convenience settings” inthe “Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice rec-ognition systems” section of this manual.

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-31

Page 160: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

MEMO

3-32 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Page 161: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

4 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voicerecognition systems

Control panel buttons — color screen withoutNavigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4

How to use the NISSAN controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5How to select menus on the screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6How to use the STATUS button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6How to use the INFO button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6How to use the SETTING button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9

OFF button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15Control panel buttons — color screen withNavigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16

How to use the NISSAN controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17How to use the touch screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17How to select menus on the screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19How to use the STATUS button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20How to use the INFO button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20How to use the SETTING button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24

OFF button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31Image viewer (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32

Using the image viewer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32RearView Monitor (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34

How to read the displayed lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35

How to park with predicted course lines. . . . . . . . . . 4-35Difference between predicted and actualdistances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-37How to adjust the screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39Operating tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39

Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40Heater and air conditioner (automatic) (Type A) . . . . . . 4-41

Automatic operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-41Manual operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-42Operating tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-43

Heater and air conditioner (automatic) (Type B) . . . . . . 4-44Automatic operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-44Manual operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-45Operating tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46

Servicing air conditioner. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-47Audio system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-47

Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-47FM radio reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-47AM radio reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48Satellite radio reception (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . 4-48Audio operation precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48

Page 162: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

FM/AM radio with compact disc (CD)changer (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-63FM/AM/SAT radio with compact disc (CD)player (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-68FM/AM/SAT radio with CD/DVD player(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-75Digital Versatile Disc (DVD) PlayerOperation (models with Navigation System) . . . . . . 4-84USB interface (models without NavigationSystem) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-87USB interface(models with Navigation System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-88iPod�* player operation without NavigationSystem (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-92iPod�* player operation with NavigationSystem (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-93Music Box� without Navigation System(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-96Music Box� with Navigation System(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-102Bluetooth� streaming audio (if so equipped) . . . . .4-109CD care and cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-112Steering wheel switch for audio control . . . . . . . . .4-113Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-115

Car phone or CB radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-115Bluetooth� Hands-Free Phone System withoutNavigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-116

Regulatory Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-118Using the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-118Control buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-120Getting started . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-121List of voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-123Voice Adaptation (VA) mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-127Manual control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-128Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-129

Bluetooth� Hands-Free Phone System withNavigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-130

Regulatory Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-132Voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-132Connecting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-132Vehicle phonebook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-134Handset phonebook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-136Making a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-137Receiving a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-137During a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-138Ending a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-139Phone settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-139

Page 163: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Bluetooth settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-140Call volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-141

NISSAN Voice Recognition System(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-141

NISSAN Voice Recognition Standard Mode . . . . .4-142Using the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-145Before starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-145

Giving voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-145NISSAN Voice Recognition AlternateCommand Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-153Using the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-158Speaker Adaptation function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-161Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-163

Page 164: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● Positioning of the heating or air condi-tioning controls and display controlsshould not be done while driving in or-der that full attention may be given tothe driving operation.

● Do not disassemble or modify this sys-tem. If you do, it may result in accidents,fire, or electrical shock.

● Do not use this system if you notice anyabnormality, such as a frozen screen orlack of sound. Continued use of thesystem may result in accident, fire orelectric shock.

● In case you notice any foreign object inthe system hardware, spill liquid on it,or notice smoke or smell coming fromit, stop using the system immediatelyand contact your nearest NISSANdealer. Ignoring such conditions maylead to accidents, fire or electricalshock.

1. STATUS button (P. 4-6)

2. INFO button (P. 4-6)

3. NISSAN controller (P. 4-5)

4. OFF brightness control button(P. 4-15)

5. BRIGHT + (brightness control) button

6. BRIGHT – (brightness control) button

7. BACK (previous) button (P. 4-5)

8. SETTING button (P. 4-9)

LHA1146

CONTROL PANEL BUTTONS — COLORSCREEN WITHOUT NAVIGATIONSYSTEM (if so equipped)

4-4 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 165: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CAUTION

● The glass display screen may break if itis hit with a hard or sharp object. If theglass screen breaks, do not touch it.Doing so could result in an injury.

● To clean the display, never use a roughcloth, alcohol, benzine, thinner or anykind of solvent or paper towel with achemical cleaning agent. They willscratch or deteriorate the panel.

● Do not splash any liquid such as wateror car fragrance on the display. Contactwith liquid will cause the system tomalfunction.

When you use this system, make sure the engineis running.

If you use the system with the engine notrunning (ignition ON or ACC) for a longtime, it will discharge the battery, and theengine will not start.

Reference symbols:

ENTER button — This is a button on the controlpanel.

“Example” — Words marked in quotes refer to akey shown on the display. These keys can only beselected using the NISSAN controller.

HOW TO USE THE NISSANCONTROLLERUse the NISSAN controller to choose an item onthe display screen. Highlight an item on the dis-play using the main directional buttons �2 or thecenter dial �3 . Then press the ENTER button �1to select the item or perform the action.

The BACK button �4 has two functions:

● Go back to the previous display (cancel).

If you press the BACK button �4 during setup,the setup will be canceled and/or the display willreturn to the previous screen.

● Finish setup.

In some screens pressing the BACK button �4accepts the changes made during setup.

WHA0883

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-5

Page 166: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

HOW TO SELECT MENUS ON THESCREENVehicle functions are viewed on the center dis-play screen in menus. Whenever a menu selec-tion is made or menu item is highlighted, differentareas on the screen provide you with importantinformation. See the following for details:

1. Header:Shows the path used to get to the currentscreen (for example, press the SETTINGbutton > then select the “Clock” key, thenselect the “Time Zone” key).

2. Menu Selections:Shows the options to choose within thatmenu screen (for example, Pacific time zone,Mountain time zone, etc.).

3. UP/DOWN Movement Indicator:Shows that the NISSAN controller may beused to move UP/DOWN on the screen andselect more options.

4. Screen Count:Shows the number of menu selections avail-able for that screen (for example, 1/9).

5. Footer/Information Line:Provides more information (if available)about the menu selection currently high-lighted (for example, Manually set the timezone).

HOW TO USE THE STATUSBUTTONTo display the status of the audio, climate controlsystem and fuel consumption, press the STATUSbutton.

The following information will appear when theSTATUS button is pressed multiple times:

Audio → Audio and climate control system →Audio and fuel consumption → Audio

HOW TO USE THE INFO BUTTONPress the INFO button. The display screenshows vehicle information for your convenience.

The information shown on the screen should be aguide to determine the condition of the vehicle.See the following for details.

LHA1300 WHA1149

4-6 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 167: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Fuel economy

Press the INFO button, then select the “FuelEconomy” key using the NISSAN controller todisplay Average Fuel Economy, Distance toEmpty and Fuel Economy History.

Distance to empty (MI or km)

The Distance to Empty (DTE) mode provides youwith an estimation of the distance that can bedriven before refueling. The DTE is constantlycalculated based on the amount of fuel in the fueltank and the actual fuel consumption. The displayis updated every 30 seconds. When the fuel levelis low, the DTE display will change to (*).

NOTE:

● If the amount of fuel added while theignition switch is OFF is small, the dis-play just before the ignition switch isplaced in the OFF position may con-tinue to be displayed.

● When driving uphill or rounding curves,the fuel in the tank shifts, which maymomentarily change the display.

Average fuel economy (MPG or L/100 km)

The Average Fuel Economy is calculated basedon fuel consumption since the last reset. Thedisplay is updated every 30 seconds and 1/3 mi(500 m). After a reset or connecting the batterycables, the display might show (**.*).

Resetting fuel economy

The average fuel economy calculation can bereset to 0. Press the INFO button and select the“Fuel Economy” key, then select the “Reset” keyusing the NISSAN controller.

Fuel economy record

Press the INFO button, then select the “FuelEconomy” key, then select the “View” key usingthe NISSAN controller.

The average fuel consumption history will bedisplayed in a graph form along with the averagefuel for the previous reset-to-reset period.

LHA1301 LHA0922

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-7

Page 168: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Maintenance itemsPress the INFO button and select the “Mainte-nance” key using the NISSAN controller; themaintenance information will be displayed on thescreen.

Changing the maintenance interval

Select one of the Reminder keys (Engine Oil, OilFilter, Tire or Other Reminder) using the NISSANcontroller to display the screen to change themaintenance interval.

Select the “Interval” key using the NISSAN con-troller. Use the NISSAN controller to change themaintenance interval. To accept the changes,press the BACK button.

Resetting the maintenance interval

To reset the reminder schedule (distance) to 0 mi(km), select the “Reset Distance” key using theNISSAN controller.

Displaying the maintenance notice reminder

Select the “Interval Reminder ON” key to displaythe MAINTENANCE INFORMATION automati-cally at the set maintenance interval. The indica-tor light will illuminate when it is ON.

The MAINTENANCE NOTICE screen will be au-tomatically displayed as shown when both of thefollowing conditions are met:

● The vehicle is driven the set distance and theignition switch is placed in the OFF position.

● The ignition switch is placed in the ON po-sition the next time the vehicle will be driven.

LHA1302 LHA1303 LHA0839

4-8 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 169: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

To return to the previous display after the MAIN-TENANCE NOTICE screen is displayed, pressthe BACK button.

The MAINTENANCE NOTICE screen displayseach time the key is turned ON until one of thefollowing conditions are met:

● The “Reset” key is selected.

● The “Interval Reminder ON” key is set toOFF (indicator light not illuminated).

● The maintenance interval is set again.

HOW TO USE THE SETTINGBUTTONWhen the SETTING button is pressed, the Set-tings screen will appear on the display. You canselect and/or adjust several functions, featuresand modes that are available for your vehicle. Usethe NISSAN controller to select each item to beset.

Audio settingsFor audio settings, refer to “Audio System” in thissection.

Display settingsSelect the “Display” key. The Display settingsscreen will appear.

LHA1304 LHA0929

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-9

Page 170: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Brightness/contrast:

Select the “Brightness” key or the “Contrast” keyto adjust the brightness or contrast of the mapbackground. Use the NISSAN controller to adjustthe brightness to darker or brighter and the con-trast to lower or higher.

The new settings are automatically saved whenyou exit the setting screen by pressing the BACKbutton or any other mode button.

Display off:

Select the “Display ON” key. The amber indicatornext to “Display ON” turns off and the messageabove will be displayed briefly. When the audio,HVAC (Heater and air conditioner), or any modebutton on the control panel is operated, the dis-play turns on for that operation. If one of thecontrol panel buttons is pressed, the display willnot automatically turn off until that operation isfinished. Otherwise, the screen turns off auto-matically after 5 seconds.

To turn the screen on:

● Press the SETTING button, select the “Dis-play” key and then select the “Display ON”key. Then set the screen to on by pressingthe ENTER button, or

● Hold the OFF button for approxi-mately 2 seconds and the message “resum-ing display”will appear and the “Display ON”key will be automatically turned on (no am-ber indicator).

Background color:

Select the “Background Color” key; the displaycolor changes between day and night.

The new settings are automatically saved whenyou exit the setting screen by pressing the BACKbutton or any other mode button.

LHA0930 WHA0823

4-10 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 171: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Switch beeps settingsSelect the “Switch Beeps” key. The SwitchesBeeps settings screen will appear.

With this option on (indicator light illuminated), abeep will sound if any control panel button ispressed.

Camera settingsSelect the “Camera” key. The Camera settingsscreen will appear.

When this option is on (indicator light illumi-nated), predictive course lines will be displayedwhen the RearView monitor is displayed on thescreen. See “RearView Monitor” in this sectionfor more information.

ClockThe following display will appear after pressingthe SETTING button, then selecting the “Clock”key using the NISSAN controller.

On-screen Clock:

When this item is enabled (indicator light illumi-nated), a clock is always displayed in the upperright corner of the screen.

Clock Format:

Choose either the 12h (12-hour) clock display orthe 24h (24-hour) clock display.

LHA1305 LHA1306 LHA1307

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-11

Page 172: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Daylight Savings Time:

When this item is enabled (indicator light illumi-nated), daylight savings time is on. To turn off thedaylight savings time, touch the “ON” key; theamber indicator light will go out.

Time Zone:

Select the “Time Zone” key; the Time Zonescreen will appear.

Select one of the following zones, depending onthe current location, by selecting the correct timezone key to enable that time zone (indicator lightwill illuminate for that location).

● Pacific

● Mountain

● Central

● Eastern

● Atlantic

● Newfoundland

● Aleutian

● Hawaii

● Alaska

LHA0933

4-12 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 173: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Adjust Clock:

To adjust the time, select the + or - key for thehour until the desired number is reached. Repeatthe process for the minutes on the line below.

To accept the changes made and return to theClocks Settings screen, select the OK key.

Comfort & Convenience settingsSelect the “Comfort & Conv.” key by using theNISSAN controller. The comfort and conve-nience option screen will be displayed.

You can set the following operating conditions byhighlighting the desired item using the NISSANcontroller. The amber indicator (box at the right ofthe selected item) alternately turns on and offeach time the ENTER button is pressed.

Indicator light is illuminated — ON

Indicator light is not illuminated — OFF

Auto Interior Illumination: Select to turn on orturn off the illumination of the interior lights whenany door is unlocked.

Auto Headlights Sensitivity: Select to adjustthe sensitivity of the automatic headlights higher(right) or lower (left).

Auto Headlights Off Delay: Select to changethe duration of the automatic headlight off timerfrom 0-, 30-, 45-, 60-, 90-, 120-, 150- and180-second periods.

LHA1308 WHA1151 WHA1152

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-13

Page 174: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Speed Sensing Wiper Interval: Select to turnon or turn off the wiper interval adjusted automati-cally according to the vehicle speed.

Selective Door Unlock: When this item isturned on, only the driver’s door is unlocked firstafter the door unlock operation. When the doorhandle request switch on the driver’s or frontpassenger’s side door is pushed to be unlocked,only the corresponding door is unlocked first. Allthe doors can be unlocked if the door unlockoperation is performed again within 1 minute.

When this item is turned to off, all the doors willbe unlocked after the door unlock operation isperformed once.

Intelligent Key Lock / Unlock: Select to turnon or turn off the door lock/unlock function bypushing the door handle request switch.

Lift Steering Wheel on Exit: Select to turn onor turn off the steering wheel moving upward foreasy exit when the ignition switch is in the OFFposition and the driver’s door is opened. Aftergetting into the vehicle and pushing the ignitionswitch to the ACC position, the steering wheelmoves to the previous position.

Slide Driver Seat Back on Exit: Select to turnon or turn off the driver’s seat moving backwardfor easy exit when the ignition switch is in the OFFposition and the driver’s door is opened. Aftergetting into the vehicle and pushing the ignitionswitch to the ACC position, the driver’s seatmoves to the previous position.

Return All Settings to Default: Select tochange all the comfort and convenience systemsto their default settings.

Language / UnitsUse the NISSAN controller to select the “Lan-guage / Units” key. Select which setting you wantto change using the NISSAN controller.

LHA0934

4-14 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 175: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Select Language:

Select the “English” key, the “Français” key or the“Español” key to change the language shown onthe display.

Select Units:

Select the “US” (mi, °F, MPG) key or the “Metric”(km, °C, L/100 km) key to change the unitsshown on the display.

OFF BUTTON

To change the display brightness, pressthe OFF button. Pressing the button againwill change the display to the day or thenight display. The brightness can then beadjusted using the NISSAN controller.

The display brightness can also be adjusted us-ing the + (brighter) button or the � (dimmer)button.

If no operation is done within 10 seconds, thedisplay will return to the previous display.

Press and hold the OFF button for morethan 2 seconds to turn the display off. Press thebutton again to turn the display on.

LHA0935 LHA0936

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-15

Page 176: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. ZOOM OUT button*

2. STATUS button (P. 4-20)

3. DEST button*

4. ROUTE button*

5. NISSAN controller (P. 4-17)

6. INFO button (P. 4-20)

7. PHONE button**

8. + (brightness control) button

9. OFF brightness control button(P. 4-31)

10. - (brightness control) button

11. VOICE button*

12. SETTING button (P. 4-24)

13. MAP button*

14. BACK (previous) button (P. 4-17)

15. ZOOM IN button*

*For Navigation system control buttons, refer tothe separate Navigation System Owner’sManual.

**For information on the PHONE button, see“Bluetooth� Hands-Free Phone System withNavigation System” in this section.

When you use this system, make sure the engineis running.

If you use the system with the engine notrunning (ignition ON or ACC) for a longtime, it will discharge the battery, and theengine will not start.

LHA1147

CONTROL PANEL BUTTONS —COLOR SCREEN WITH NAVIGATIONSYSTEM (if so equipped)

4-16 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 177: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Reference symbols:

ENTER button — This is a button on the controlpanel.

“Example” — Words marked in quotes refer to akey shown only on the display. These keys can beselected by touching the screen or using theNISSAN controller.

HOW TO USE THE NISSANCONTROLLERUse the NISSAN controller to choose an item onthe display screen. Highlight an item on the dis-play using the main directional buttons �2 (cer-tain Navigation System functions use the addi-tional directional buttons �6 ) or the center dial�3 . Then press the ENTER button �1 to selectthe item or perform the action.

The BACK button �4 has two functions:

● Go back to the previous display (cancel).

If you press the BACK button �4 during setup,the setup will be canceled and/or the display willreturn to the previous screen.

● Finish setup.

In some screens, pressing the BACK button �4accepts the changes made during setup.

For the VOICE button �5 functions, refer to theseparate Navigation System Owner’s Manual.

HOW TO USE THE TOUCHSCREEN

CAUTION

● The glass display screen may break if itis hit with a hard or sharp object. If theglass screen breaks, do not touch it.Doing so could result in an injury.

● To clean the display, never use a roughcloth, alcohol, benzine, thinner or anykind of solvent or paper towel with achemical cleaning agent. They willscratch or deteriorate the panel.

WHA1210

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-17

Page 178: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Do not splash any liquid such as wateror car fragrance on the display. Contactwith liquid will cause the system tomalfunction.

To help ensure safe driving, some functions can-not be operated while driving.

The on-screen functions that are not availablewhile driving will be “grayed out” or muted.

Park the vehicle in a safe location and then oper-ate the navigation system.

WARNING

● ALWAYS give your full attention todriving.

● Avoid using vehicle features that coulddistract you. If distracted, you couldlose control of your vehicle and causean accident.

Touch screen operationWith this system, the same operations as thosefor the NISSAN controller are possible using thetouch screen operation.

Selecting the item:

Touch an item to select. To select the “Naviga-tion” key, touch the “Navigation” key �1 on thescreen. Touch the “BACK” key �2 to return to theprevious screen.

Adjusting the item:

Touch the “+” key �1 or the “�” key �2 to adjustthe settings of an item.

Touch the up arrow �3 to scroll up the page oneitem at a time, or touch the double up arrow �4 toscroll up an entire page.

Touch the down arrow �5 to scroll down thepage one item at a time, or touch the doubledown arrow �6 to scroll down an entire page.

LHA1227 LHA1228

4-18 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 179: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Inputting characters:

Touch the letter or number key �1 .

There are some options available when inputtingcharacters.

● Uppercase:Shows uppercase characters.

● Lowercase:Shows lowercase characters.

● Space:Inserts a space.

● Delete:Deletes the last inputted character with onetouch. Touch and hold the “Delete” key todelete all of the characters.

● OK:Completes the character input.

Touch screen maintenanceIf you clean the display screen, use a dry, softcloth. If additional cleaning is necessary, use asmall amount of neutral detergent with a softcloth. Never spray the screen with water or de-tergent. Dampen the cloth first, and then wipe thescreen.

HOW TO SELECT MENUS ON THESCREEN

Vehicle functions are viewed on the center dis-play screen in menus. Whenever a menu selec-tion is made or menu item is highlighted, differentareas on the screen provide you with importantinformation. See the following for details.

1. Header:Shows the path used to get to the currentscreen (for example, press the SETTINGbutton > then select the “Comfort” key).

LHA1230 LHA1229

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-19

Page 180: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

2. Menu Selections:Shows the options to choose within thatmenu screen (for example, Auto Interior Illu-mination, etc.).

3. Up/Down Movement Indicator:Shows that the NISSAN controller may beused to move up or down on the screen andselect more options.

4. Screen Count:Shows the number of menu selections avail-able for the current menu, even if they are onmultiple pages (for example, 1/9).

5. Footer/Information Line:Provides more information (if available)about the menu selection currently high-lighted (for example, Cabin lighting whenunlocking doors).

HOW TO USE THE STATUSBUTTONThe STATUS button is used to display systeminformation. Three different split screens of infor-mation are available. Press the STATUS buttonmultiple times to cycle through these screens asfollows:

Audio with Turn Information for Navigation →Audio with Fuel Economy Information → Audiowith Climate Control Information → Audio withTurn Information for Navigation

HOW TO USE THE INFO BUTTONPress the INFO button; the display screen showsvehicle and navigation information for your con-venience.

The information shown on the screen should be aguide to determine the condition of the vehicle.See the following for details.

LHA1231

4-20 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 181: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Fuel economy

Press the INFO button, then select the “FuelEconomy” key using the NISSAN controller todisplay Distance to Empty, Average FuelEconomy and Fuel Economy History.

Distance to empty (MI or km)

The Distance to Empty (DTE) mode provides youwith an estimation of the distance that can bedriven before refueling. The DTE is constantlycalculated based on the amount of fuel in the fueltank and the actual fuel consumption. The displayis updated every 30 seconds. When the fuel levelis low, the DTE display will change to (*).

NOTE:

● If the amount of fuel added while theignition switch is OFF is small, the dis-play just before the ignition switch isplaced in the OFF position may con-tinue to be displayed.

● When driving uphill or rounding curves,the fuel in the tank shifts, which maymomentarily change the display.

Average fuel economy (MPG or L/100 km)

The Average Fuel Economy is calculated basedon fuel consumption since the last reset. Thedisplay is updated every 30 seconds and 1/3 mi(500 m). After a reset or connecting the batterycables, the display might show (**.*).

Resetting fuel economy

The average fuel economy calculation can bereset to 0. Press the INFO button and select the“Fuel Economy” key, then select the “Reset FuelEco” key using the NISSAN controller.

Fuel economy record

Press the INFO button, then select the “FuelEconomy” key, then select the “Fuel Eco History”key using the NISSAN controller.

The average fuel consumption history will bedisplayed in a graph form along with the averagefuel for the previous Reset-to-Reset period.

LHA1232 LHA1233

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-21

Page 182: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Maintenance itemsPress the INFO button and select the “Mainte-nance” key using the NISSAN controller; themaintenance information will be displayed on thescreen.

Changing the maintenance interval

Select one of the maintenance reminder keysusing the NISSAN controller to display thescreen to change the maintenance interval. Youcan choose between Engine Oil, Oil Filter, Tireand Other Reminder.

Select the “Interval” key using the NISSAN con-troller. Touch the “+” or “-” keys or turn theNISSAN controller to choose the desired dis-tance. To accept the changes, press the BACKbutton.

Resetting the maintenance interval

To reset the reminder schedule (distance) to 0 mi(km), select the “Reset Distance” key using theNISSAN controller.

LHA1234 LHA1235

4-22 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 183: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Displaying the maintenance notice reminder

Select the “Interval Reminder ON” key to displaythe MAINTENANCE INFORMATION automati-cally at the set maintenance interval. The indica-tor light will illuminate when it is ON.

The MAINTENANCE NOTICE screen will be au-tomatically displayed as shown when both of thefollowing conditions are met:

● The vehicle is driven the set distance and theignition switch is placed in the OFF position.

● The ignition switch is placed in the ON po-sition the next time the vehicle will be driven.

To return to the previous display after the MAIN-TENANCE NOTICE screen is displayed, pressthe BACK button.

The MAINTENANCE NOTICE screen displayseach time the key is turned ON until one of thefollowing conditions are met:

● The “Reset” key is selected.

● The “Interval Reminder ON” key is set toOFF (indicator light not illuminated).

● The maintenance interval is set again.

Where am I?

Refer to the separate Navigation System Own-er’s Manual for information regarding this item.

Traffic Info

Refer to the separate Navigation System Own-er’s Manual for information regarding this item.

Weather Info

Refer to the separate Navigation System Own-er’s Manual for information regarding this item.

Map Update

Refer to the separate Navigation System Own-er’s Manual for information regarding this item.

Navigation VersionRefer to the separate Navigation System Own-er’s Manual for information regarding this item.

Other optionsFor Voice Recognition settings, refer to “NISSANVoice Recognition system” in this section.

For GPS Position, refer to the separate Naviga-tion System Owner’s Manual.

LHA0839

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-23

Page 184: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

HOW TO USE THE SETTINGBUTTONWhen the SETTING button is pressed, the Set-tings screen will appear on the display. You canselect and/or adjust several functions, featuresand modes that are available for your vehicle. Usethe NISSAN controller to select each item to beset.

Display settingsSelect the “Display” key. On the screen above,select the “Display Adjustment” key. The DisplayAdjustment screen will appear.

LHA1236 LHA1237 WHA1502

4-24 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 185: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Brightness/contrast:

Select the “Brightness” key or the “Contrast” keyto adjust the brightness or contrast of the displaybackground. Use the NISSAN controller to adjustthe brightness to darker or brighter and the con-trast to lower or higher.

The new settings are automatically saved whenyou exit the setting screen by pressing the BACKbutton or any other mode button.

Display off:

Select the “Display ON” key. The indicator of the“Display ON” turns off and the message abovewill be displayed briefly. When the audio, HVAC(Heater and air conditioner), or any mode buttonon the control panel is operated, the display turnson for that operation. If one of the control panelbuttons is pressed, the display will not automati-cally turn off until that operation is finished. Oth-erwise, the screen turns off automatically after 5seconds.

To turn the screen on:

● Press the SETTING button and select the“Display” key and then select the “DisplayON” key, or

● Press the OFF button and the mes-sage “resuming display” will appear and the“Display ON” key will be automaticallyturned on (no amber indicator).

Background color:

Select the “Background Color” key; the displaycolor changes between day and night.

The new settings are automatically saved whenyou exit the setting screen by pressing the BACKbutton or any other mode button.

LHA1239 LHA1242

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-25

Page 186: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Color theme:

Select the “Display” key, then select the “ColorTheme” key. The Color Theme select screen willappear.

Select the key for the desired color. The appear-ance of the background, arrows and bars willchange for all screens accordingly. You canchoose a black, blue or red color theme.

ClockThe following display will appear after pressingthe SETTING button, then selecting the “Clock”key using the NISSAN controller.

On-screen Clock:

When this item is enabled (indicator light illumi-nated), a clock is always displayed in the upperright corner of the screen.

This clock will indicate the time almost exactlybecause it is always adjusted by the GPS system.

Clock Format (24h):

When this item is enabled (indicator light illumi-nated), the clock format will change from thedefault 12-hour display to a 24-hour display.

Offset (hour):

Adjust the time by increasing or decreasing thehours.

Offset (minute):

Adjust the time by increasing or decreasing theminutes.

Daylight Savings Time:

When this item is enabled (indicator light illumi-nated), daylight savings time is on. To turn off thedaylight savings time, touch the “ON” key; theamber indicator light will go out.

LHA1240 LHA1241

4-26 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 187: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Time Zone:

Select the “Time Zone” key; the Time Zonescreen will appear.

Select one of the following zones, depending onthe current location, by selecting the correct timezone key to enable that time zone (indicator lightwill illuminate for that location).

● Pacific

● Mountain

● Central

● Eastern

● Atlantic

● Newfoundland

● Hawaii

● Alaska

After selection/settings, press the BACK buttonor any other mode button to accept the changes.

Others settingsSelect the “Others” key using the NISSAN con-troller. Voice recognition, language and units set-ting screen will be displayed.

LHA1243 LHA1248

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-27

Page 188: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Comfort settings

Select the “Others” key using the NISSAN con-troller, then select the “Comfort” key. The Com-fort settings screen will be displayed.

You can set the following operating conditions byselecting the desired item using the NISSANcontroller. The indicator light (box at the right ofthe selected item) alternately turns on and offeach time the item is touched or the ENTERbutton is pressed.

Indicator light is illuminated — ON

Indicator light is not illuminated — OFF

Auto Interior Illumination: Select to turn on orturn off the illumination of the interior lights whenany door is unlocked.

Light Sensitivity: Select to adjust the sensitivityof the automatic headlights higher (right) or lower(left). After selecting the item, turn the NISSANcontroller or touch the “+” or “-” key to changethe setting.

Light Off Delay: Select to change the durationof the automatic headlight off timer. After select-ing the item, turn the NISSAN controller or touchthe “+” or “-” key to change the setting. Theavailable delays are 0, 30, 45, 60, 90, 120, 150and 180 seconds.

Speed Sensing Wiper Interval: Select to turnon or turn off the wiper interval adjusted automati-cally according to the vehicle speed.

Selective Door Unlock: When this item isturned on, only the driver’s door is unlocked firstafter the door unlock operation. When the doorhandle request switch on the driver’s or frontpassenger’s side door is pushed to be unlocked,only the corresponding door is unlocked first. Allthe doors can be unlocked if the door unlockoperation is performed again within one minute.

When this item is turned to off, all the doors willbe unlocked after the door unlock operation isperformed once.

Intelligent Key Lock / Unlock: Select to turnon or turn off the door lock/unlock function bypushing the door handle request switch.

Lift Steering Wheel on Exit: Select to turn onor turn off the steering wheel moving upward foreasy exit when the ignition switch is in the OFFposition and the driver’s door is opened. Aftergetting into the vehicle and placing the ignitionswitch in the ACC position, the steering wheelmoves to the previous position.

LHA1246 LHA1247

4-28 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 189: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Slide Driver Seat Back on Exit: Select to turnon or turn off the driver’s seat moving backwardfor easy exit when the ignition switch is in the OFFposition and the driver’s door is opened. Aftergetting into the vehicle and placing the ignitionswitch in the ACC position, the driver’s seatmoves to the previous position.

Return All Settings to Default: Select tochange all the comfort and convenience systemsto their default settings.

Language & Units:

Use the NISSAN controller to select the “Lan-guage & Units” key. Select which setting youwant to change using the NISSAN controller andselecting either the “Select Language” key or the“Select Units” key.

Select Language:

Select the “English” key or the “Français” key tochange the language shown on the display.

If you select the “Français” key, French languagewill be displayed, so please use the French Own-er’s Manual. To obtain a French Owner’s Manual,please see “Owner’s Manual/Service Manual Or-der Information” in the “Technical and consumerinformation” section.

LHA1250 LHA1251

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-29

Page 190: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Select Units:

Select the “US” (mi, °F, MPG) key or the “Metric”(km, °C, L/100 km) key to change the unitsshown on the display.

Voice Recognition:

For Voice Recognition settings, refer to “NISSANVoice Recognition system” in this section.

Camera settings

Select the “Camera” key. The Camera settingsscreen will appear.

When this option is on (indicator light illumi-nated), predictive course lines will be displayedwhen the RearView monitor is displayed on thescreen. See “RearView Monitor” in this sectionfor more information.

Image viewer settings

For information about these settings, refer to“Image viewer” in this section.

Navigation settingsRefer to the separate Navigation System Own-er’s Manual for information regarding these set-tings.

Audio settingsFor audio settings, refer to “Audio System” in thissection.

Phone settingsFor phone settings refer to “Bluetooth� Hands-Free Phone System with Navigation System” inthis section.

Bluetooth� settingsFor Bluetooth� phone settings, refer to“Bluetooth� Hands-Free Phone System withNavigation System” in this section.

For Bluetooth� audio settings, refer to“Bluetooth� streaming audio” in this section.

Volume & beeps settingsNavigation volume

For navigation volume settings, refer to the sepa-rate Navigation System Owner’s Manual for infor-mation regarding these settings.

LHA1252 LHA1249

4-30 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 191: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Phone volume

For phone volume settings refer to “Bluetooth�Hands-Free Phone System with Navigation Sys-tem” in this section.

Switch beeps

With this option on (indicator light illuminated), abeep will sound if any control panel button ispressed.

OFF BUTTON

To change the display brightness, pressthe OFF button. Pressing the button againwill change the display to the day or thenight display. The brightness can then beadjusted using the NISSAN controller.

If no operation is performed within 5 seconds, thedisplay will return to the previous display.

Press and hold the OFF button for morethan two seconds to turn the display off. Pressthe button again to turn the display on.

LHA1253 LHA1254

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-31

Page 192: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

USING THE IMAGE VIEWERWhen a compatible portable storage device isplugged into the USB jack located in the centerconsole, compatible image files stored on thedevice can be viewed on the control panel de-vice.

Connecting the portable storagedeviceTo connect a portable storage device to the sys-tem so that images stored on it can be viewed,insert the device into the USB jack located in thecenter console.

Viewing images

To view an image, press the SETTING button andthen select the “Image Viewer” key with theNISSAN controller. The Image Viewer screen willbe displayed.

A list of compatible images on the storage deviceis displayed on the left side of the screen, whilethe selected image is displayed on the right sideof the screen. To choose a different picture fromthe list, use the NISSAN controller to scrollthrough the list once the desired image is high-lighted.

Select the “Full Screen Display” key and pressthe ENTER button to view a full screen version ofthe image.

Image requirements:

● Image type: JPEG

● File extensions: *.jpg, *.jpeg

● Maximum resolution: 2048 x 1536

● Maximum size: 2 MB

● Colors: 32,768 (15-bit)

● Maximum file name length: 253 bytes (dis-play only shows first 8 characters)

● Maximum folders: 500

● Maximum images per folder: 1024

LHA1309

IMAGE VIEWER (if so equipped)

4-32 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 193: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Viewing images in a slideshowTo view all of the images on the device in a slide-show, first enter the full screen mode while viewingone of the images. The slideshow control buttonsare located on the right side of the screen.

Select the play key to begin the slideshow.The images shown on the screen will periodicallychange at a given interval of time. To skip throughthe images without waiting for them to changeautomatically, select the key to skip back-ward or the key to skip forward. Select thestop key to end the slideshow and returnto the full screen display of the image currently onthe screen.

Slideshow settingsWhile in slideshow mode, select the “Settings”key. The Slideshow Settings screen will be dis-played. The following settings can be accessed:

Slideshow speed:

To change the interval of time at which images arechanged during a slideshow, select the desiredinterval key. The indicator light to the right of theinterval will come on to show that it is selected.

If the option “No Auto Change” is chosen, theslideshow will not change images automatically.The slideshow can then only be operated usingthe manual controls.

To return to the slideshow screen, select the“Back” key or press the BACK button on thecontrol panel.

LHA1310 LHA1311 LHA1312

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-33

Page 194: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Slideshow order:

To change the order in which images are dis-played during a slideshow, select one of theoptions.

If the “Random” key is selected, images will bedisplayed in a random order during a slideshow. Ifthe “Order List” key is selected, images will bedisplayed in the order in which they are stored onthe storage device.

To return to the slideshow screen, select the“Back” key or press the BACK button on thecontrol panel.

When the shift selector is shifted into the R(Reverse) position, the monitor display shows arearward view from the vehicle.

The system is designed as an aid to the driver indetecting large stationary objects to help avoiddamaging the vehicle. The system will not detectsmall objects below the bumper and may notdetect objects close to the bumper or on theground.

WARNING

● The rear view camera is a conveniencebut it is not a substitute for proper back-ing up. Always turn and check that it issafe to do so before backing up. Alwaysback up slowly.

● Objects viewed in the RearView Moni-tor differ from actual distance becausea wide-angle lens is used.

● Make sure that the trunk is securelyclosed when backing up.

● Underneath the bumper and the cornerareas of the bumper cannot be viewedon the RearView Monitor because of itsmonitoring range limitation.

● Do not put anything on the rear viewcamera. The rear view camera is in-stalled above the license plate.

● When washing the vehicle with high-pressure water, be sure not to spray itaround the camera. Otherwise, watermay enter the camera unit causing wa-ter condensation on the lens, a mal-function, fire or an electric shock.

● Do not strike the camera. It is a preci-sion instrument. Otherwise, it may mal-function or cause damage resulting in afire or an electric shock.

CAUTION

Do not scratch the camera lens whencleaning dirt or snow from the lens.LHA1313

REARVIEW MONITOR (if soequipped)

4-34 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 195: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

HOW TO READ THE DISPLAYEDLINES

Guiding lines which indicate the vehicle widthand distances to objects with reference to thevehicle body line �A are displayed on the monitor.

Distance guide lines:

Indicate distances from the vehicle body.

● Red line �1 : approx. 1.5 ft (0.5 m)

● Yellow line �2 : approx. 3 ft (1 m)

● Green line �3 : approx. 7 ft (2 m)

● Green line �4 : approx. 10 ft (3 m)

Vehicle width guide lines �5 :

Indicate the vehicle width when backing up.

Predicted course lines �6 :

Indicate the predicted course when backing up.The predicted course lines will be displayed onthe monitor when the shift selector is in the R(Reverse) position and the steering wheel isturned. The predicted course lines will move de-pending on how much the steering wheel isturned and will not be displayed while the steer-ing wheel is in the neutral position.

HOW TO PARK WITH PREDICTEDCOURSE LINES

WARNING

● Always turn and check that it is safe todo so before backing up. Always backup slowly.

● Use the displayed lines as a reference.The lines are highly affected by thenumber of occupants, fuel level, vehicleposition, road conditions and roadgrade.

● If the tires are replaced with differentsized tires, the predicted course linesmay be displayed incorrectly.

● On a snow-covered or slippery road,there may be a difference between thepredicted course line and the actualcourse line.

● If the battery is disconnected or be-comes discharged, the predictedcourse lines may be displayed incor-rectly. If this occurs, please perform thefollowing procedures:

– Turn the steering wheel from lock tolock while the engine is running.

– Drive the vehicle on a straight roadfor more than 5 minutes.

● When the steering wheel is turned withthe ignition switch in the ACC position,the predicted course lines may be dis-played incorrectly.

● The distance guide line and the vehiclewidth line should be used as a refer-ence only when the vehicle is on a levelpaved surface. The distance viewed onthe monitor is for reference only andmay be different than the actual dis-tance between the vehicle and dis-played objects.

LHA1196

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-35

Page 196: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● When backing up the vehicle up a hill,objects viewed in the monitor are fur-ther than they appear. When backing upthe vehicle down a hill, objects viewedin the monitor are closer than they ap-pear. Use the inside mirror or glanceover your shoulder to properly judgedistances to other objects.

The vehicle width and predicted courselines are wider than the actual width andcourse.

1. Visually check that the parking space is safebefore parking your vehicle.

2. The rear view of the vehicle is displayed onthe screen �A when the shift selector ismoved to the R (Reverse) position.

3. Slowly back up the vehicle adjusting thesteering wheel so that the predicted courselines �B enter the parking space �C .

LHA1197 LHA1198

4-36 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 197: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

4. Maneuver the steering wheel to make thevehicle width guide lines �D parallel to theparking space �C while referring to the pre-dicted course lines.

5. When the vehicle is parked in the spacecompletely, move the shift selector to the P(Park) position and apply the parking brake.

DIFFERENCE BETWEENPREDICTED AND ACTUALDISTANCESThe distance guide line and the vehicle widthguide line should be used as a reference onlywhen the vehicle is on a level, paved surface. Thedistance viewed on the monitor is for referenceonly and may be different than the actual distancebetween the vehicle and displayed objects.

Backing up on a steep uphill

When backing up the vehicle up a hill, the dis-tance guide lines and the vehicle width guidelines are shown closer than the actual distance.For example, the display shows 3 ft (1.0 m) to theplace �A , but the actual 3 ft (1.0 m) distance on

the hill is the place �B . Note that any object onthe hill is further than it appears on the monitor.

WHA1504

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-37

Page 198: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Backing up on a steep downhill

When backing up the vehicle down a hill, thedistance guide lines and the vehicle width guidelines are shown farther than the actual distance.For example, the display shows 3 ft (1.0 m) to theplace �A , but the actual 3 ft (1.0 m) distance on

the hill is the place �B . Note that any object onthe hill is closer than it appears on the monitor.

Backing up near a projecting objectThe predicted course lines �A do not touch theobject in the display. However, the vehicle may hitthe object if it projects over the actual backing upcourse.

WHA1505 LHA1201

4-38 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 199: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Backing up behind a projecting objectThe position �C is shown farther than the position�B in the display. However, the position �C isactually at the same distance as the position �A .The vehicle may hit the object when backing up tothe position �A if the object projects over theactual backing up course.

HOW TO ADJUST THE SCREEN

To adjust the Display ON/OFF, Brightness, Tint,Color, Contrast and Black Level of the RearViewMonitor, press the SETTING button with theRearView Monitor on and select the “Display”key. Select one of the items and change the valueby touching the “+” or “-” key or by turning theNISSAN controller.

Do not adjust the Brightness, Tint, Color, Contrastand Black Level of the RearView Monitor while thevehicle is moving. Make sure the parking brake isfirmly applied and the engine is not running.

OPERATING TIPS

● When the shift selector is shifted to the R(Reverse) position, the display screen auto-matically changes to the RearView Monitormode. However, the radio can be heard.

● It may take some time until the RearViewMonitor or the normal screen is displayed afterthe shift selector has been shifted to R (Re-verse) from another position or to anotherposition from R (Reverse). Objects may bedistorted momentarily until the RearViewMonitor screen is displayed completely.

● When the temperature is extremely high orlow, the screen may not clearly display ob-jects. This is not a malfunction.

● When strong light directly enters the cam-era, objects may not be displayed clearly.This is not a malfunction.

● Vertical lines may be seen in objects on thescreen. This is due to strong reflected lightfrom the bumper. This is not a malfunction.

● The screen may flicker under fluorescentlight. This is not a malfunction.

● The colors of objects on the RearView Moni-tor may differ somewhat from those of theactual object.

● Objects on the monitor may not be clear in adark place or at night. This is not a malfunction.

● If dirt, rain or snow attaches to the camera,the RearView Monitor may not clearly displayobjects. Clean the camera.

● Do not use alcohol, benzine or thinner toclean the camera. This will cause discolor-ation. To clean the camera, wipe with a clothdampened with diluted mild cleaning agentand then wipe with a dry cloth.

● Do not damage the camera as the monitorscreen may be adversely affected.

● Do not use wax on the camera window.Wipe off any wax with a clean cloth damp-ened with mild detergent diluted with water.

WHA1506

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-39

Page 200: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Adjust air flow direction by moving the ventslides.

Open or close the vents by using the dial. Movethe dial toward the to open the vents ortoward the to close them.

CenterLHA1132

SideLHA1133

RearLHA1134

VENTS

4-40 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 201: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Temperature control buttons (driver’sside)

2. AUTO climate control ON button3. (front defroster) button4. Air recirculation button5. MODE (manual air flow control) button6. Temperature control buttons (passen-

ger’s side)7. DUAL (passenger side temperature

control) ON/OFF button8. Fresh air intake button

9. (fan speed control) dial/ON/OFFbutton

10. (rear window defroster) button11. A/C (air conditioner) ON/OFF button

WARNING

● The air conditioner cooling function op-erates only when the engine is running.

● Do not leave children or adults whowould normally require the assistanceof others alone in your vehicle. Petsshould also not be left alone. Theycould accidentally injure themselves orothers through inadvertent operation ofthe vehicle. Also, on hot, sunny days,temperatures in a closed vehicle couldquickly become high enough to causesevere or possibly fatal injuries topeople or animals.

● Do not use the recirculation mode forlong periods as it may cause the interiorair to become stale and the windows tofog up.

Start the engine and operate the controls toactivate the air conditioner.

AUTOMATIC OPERATION

Cooling and/or dehumidified heating(AUTO)This mode may be used all year round as thesystem automatically works to keep a constanttemperature. Air flow distribution and fan speedare also controlled automatically.

1. Press the AUTO button on. (The indicator onthe button will illuminate and AUTO will bedisplayed.)

Type ALHA1139

HEATER AND AIR CONDITIONER(automatic) (Type A)

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-41

Page 202: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

2. Operate the driver’s side temperature con-trol buttons.

● Adjust the temperature display to about75°F (24°C) for normal operation.

● The temperature of the passenger compart-ment will be maintained automatically. Airflow distribution and fan speed are also con-trolled automatically.

● A visible mist may be seen coming from theventilators in hot, humid conditions as the airis cooled rapidly. This does not indicate amalfunction.

3. You can individually set driver’s and frontpassenger’s side temperature using eachtemperature control button. When the DUALbutton or passenger’s side temperature but-ton is pressed, the DUAL indicator will comeon. To turn off the passenger’s side tempera-ture control, press the DUAL button.

Heating (A/C OFF)The air conditioner does not activate. When youneed to heat only, use this mode.

1. Press the A/C button. (A/C OFF will bedisplayed and A/C indicator will turn off.)

2. Operate the temperature control buttons toset the desired temperature.

● The temperature of the passenger compart-ment will be maintained automatically. Airflow distribution and fan speed are also con-trolled automatically.

● Do not set the temperature lower than theoutside air temperature. Otherwise the sys-tem may not work properly.

● Not recommended if windows fog up.

Dehumidified defrosting or defogging

1. Press the front defroster button on.(The indicator light on the button will comeon.)

2. Operate the temperature control buttons toset the desired temperature.

● To quickly remove ice from the outside of thewindows, use the fan speed control dial toset the fan speed to maximum.

● As soon as possible after the windshield isclean, press the AUTO button to return tothe automatic mode.

● When the front defroster button ispressed, the air conditioner will automati-cally be turned on at outside temperaturesabove 36°F (2°C). The air recirculate modeautomatically turns off, allowing outside airto be drawn into the passenger compart-ment to further improve the defogging per-formance.

MANUAL OPERATION

Fan speed control

Turn the fan speed control dial to manuallycontrol the fan speed.

Press the AUTO button to return to automaticcontrol of the fan speed.

Air recirculation

Push the air recirculation button to recir-culate interior air inside the vehicle. Theindicator light on the button will come on.

The air recirculation cannot be activated whenthe air conditioner is in the front defrostingmode or the front defrosting and foot out-let mode.

4-42 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 203: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Fresh air intake

Press the fresh air intake button to drawoutside air into the passenger compartment.The indicator light on the button will come on.

Automatic intake air control

In the AUTO mode, the intake air will be con-trolled automatically. To manually control the in-take air, press the air recirculation button.To return to the automatic control mode, pressand hold the air recirculation button orpress and hold the fresh air intake buttonfor about 2 seconds. The indicator lights (both airrecirculation and fresh air intake buttons) willflash twice, and then the intake air will be con-trolled automatically.

Air flow controlPressing the MODE button manually controls airflow and selects the air outlet:

— Air flows from center and side vents.— Air flows from center and side vents

and foot outlets.— Air flows mainly from foot outlets.— Air flows from defroster and foot

outlets.— Air flows from defroster outlets.

To turn system offPress the OFF button.

OPERATING TIPS● When the engine coolant temperature and

outside air temperature are low, the air flowfrom the foot outlets may not operate for amaximum of 150 seconds. However, this isnot a malfunction. After the coolant tempera-ture warms up, air flow from the foot outletswill operate normally.

The sunload sensor, located on the top driver’sside of the instrument panel, helps the systemmaintain a constant temperature. Do not put any-thing on or around this sensor.

LHA1136

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-43

Page 204: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Air recirculation button2. A/C (air conditioner) ON/OFF button3. MODE (manual air flow control) button4. Fresh air intake button5. Temperature control buttons (passen-

ger’s side)/DUAL (passenger’s sidetemperature control) ON/OFF button

6. (rear window defroster) button7. (fan speed control) dial/ON/OFF

button8. (front defroster) button

9. Temperature control dial (driver’s side)/AUTO (automatic) climate control ONbutton

WARNING

● The air conditioner cooling function op-erates only when the engine is running.

● Do not leave children or adults whowould normally require the assistanceof others alone in your vehicle. Petsshould also not be left alone. Theycould accidentally injure themselves orothers through inadvertent operation ofthe vehicle. Also, on hot, sunny days,temperatures in a closed vehicle couldquickly become high enough to causesevere or possibly fatal injuries topeople or animals.

● Do not use the recirculation mode forlong periods as it may cause the interiorair to become stale and the windows tofog up.

Start the engine and operate the controls toactivate the air conditioner.

AUTOMATIC OPERATION

Cooling and/or dehumidified heating(AUTO)This mode may be used all year round as thesystem automatically works to keep a constanttemperature. Air flow distribution and fan speedare also controlled automatically.

1. Press the AUTO button on. (The indicator onthe button will illuminate and AUTO will bedisplayed.)

Type BLHA2018

HEATER AND AIR CONDITIONER(automatic) (Type B)

4-44 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 205: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

2. Turn the temperature control dial to the leftor right to set the desired temperature.

● Adjust the temperature display to about75°F (24°C) for normal operation.

● The temperature of the passenger compart-ment will be maintained automatically. Airflow distribution and fan speed are also con-trolled automatically.

● A visible mist may be seen coming from thevents in hot, humid conditions as the air iscooled rapidly. This does not indicate a mal-function.

3. You can individually set driver’s and frontpassenger’s side temperature using eachtemperature control dial. When the DUALbutton or passenger’s side temperature dialis turned, the DUAL indicator will come on.To turn off the passenger’s side temperaturecontrol, press the DUAL button.

Heating (A/C OFF)The air conditioner does not activate. When youneed to heat only, use this mode.

1. Press the A/C button. (A/C OFF will bedisplayed and A/C indicator will turn off.)

2. Turn the temperature control dial to set thedesired temperature.

● The temperature of the passenger compart-ment will be maintained automatically. Airflow distribution and fan speed are also con-trolled automatically.

● Do not set the temperature lower than theoutside air temperature. Otherwise the sys-tem may not work properly.

● Not recommended if windows fog up.

Dehumidified defrosting or defogging

1. Press the front defroster button on.(The indicator light on the button will comeon.)

2. Turn the temperature control dial to set thedesired temperature.

● To quickly remove ice from the outside of thewindows, use the fan speed control dial toset the fan speed to maximum.

● As soon as possible after the windshield isclean, press the AUTO button to return tothe automatic mode.

● When the front defroster button ispressed, the air conditioner will automati-cally be turned on at outside temperaturesabove 36°F (2°C). The air recirculate modeautomatically turns off, allowing outside airto be drawn into the passenger compart-ment to further improve the defogging per-formance.

MANUAL OPERATION

Fan speed control

Turn the fan speed control dial to manuallycontrol the fan speed.

Press the AUTO button to return to automaticcontrol of the fan speed.

Air recirculation

Push the air recirculation button to recir-culate interior air inside the vehicle. Theindicator light on the button will come on.

The air recirculation cannot be activated whenthe air conditioner is in the front defrostingmode or the front defrosting and foot out-let mode.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-45

Page 206: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Fresh air intake

Press the fresh air intake button to drawoutside air into the passenger compartment.The indicator light on the button will come on.

Automatic intake air control

In the AUTO mode, the intake air will be con-trolled automatically. To manually control the in-take air, press the air recirculation button.To return to the automatic control mode, pressand hold the air recirculation button orpress and hold the fresh air intake buttonfor about 2 seconds. The indicator lights (both airrecirculation and fresh air intake buttons) willflash twice, and then the intake air will be con-trolled automatically.

Air flow controlPressing the MODE button manually controls airflow and selects the air outlet:

— Air flows from center and side vents.— Air flows from center and side vents

and foot outlets.— Air flows mainly from foot outlets.— Air flows from defroster and foot

outlets.— Air flows from defroster outlets.

To turn system offPress the OFF button.

OPERATING TIPS● When the engine coolant temperature and

outside air temperature are low, the air flowfrom the foot outlets may not operate for amaximum of 150 seconds. However, this isnot a malfunction. After the coolant tempera-ture warms up, air flow from the foot outletswill operate normally.

The sunload sensor, located on the top driver’sside of the instrument panel, helps the systemmaintain a constant temperature. Do not put any-thing on or around this sensor.

LHA1136

4-46 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 207: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

The air conditioner system in your NISSAN ve-hicle is charged with a refrigerant designed withthe environment in mind.

This refrigerant does not harm the earth’sozone layer.

Special charging equipment and lubricant is re-quired when servicing your NISSAN air condi-tioner. Using improper refrigerants or lubricantswill cause severe damage to your air conditionersystem. See “Air conditioner system refrigerantand oil recommendations” in the “Technical andconsumer information” section of this manual.

A NISSAN dealer is able to service your “environ-mentally friendly” air conditioning system.

WARNING

The air conditioner system contains re-frigerant under high pressure. To avoidpersonal injury, any air conditioner ser-vice should be done only by an experi-enced technician with proper equipment.

RADIO

Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ONposition and press the VOL (volume)/ON·OFF(power) knob to turn the radio on. If you listen tothe radio with the engine not running, the ignitionswitch should be placed in the ACC position.

Radio reception is affected by station signalstrength, distance from radio transmitter, build-ings, bridges, mountains and other external influ-ences. Intermittent changes in reception qualitynormally are caused by these external influences.

Using a cellular phone in or near the ve-hicle may influence radio reception quality.

Radio reception

Your NISSAN radio system is equipped withstate-of-the-art electronic circuits to enhance ra-dio reception. These circuits are designed toextend reception range, and to enhance the qual-ity of that reception.

However, there are some general characteristicsof both FM and AM radio signals that can affectradio reception quality in a moving vehicle, evenwhen the finest equipment is used. These char-acteristics are completely normal in a given re-ception area and do not indicate any malfunctionin your NISSAN radio system.

Reception conditions will constantly change be-cause of vehicle movement. Buildings, terrain,signal distance and interference from other ve-hicles can work against ideal reception. De-scribed below are some of the factors that canaffect your radio reception.

Some cellular phones or other devices maycause interference or a buzzing noise to comefrom the audio system speakers. Storing the de-vice in a different location may reduce or elimi-nate the noise.

FM RADIO RECEPTIONRange: FM range is normally limited to 25 – 30 mi(40 – 48 km), with monaural (single channel) FMhaving slightly more range than stereo FM. Exter-nal influences may sometimes interfere with FMstation reception even if the FM station is within25 mi (40 km). The strength of the FM signal isdirectly related to the distance between thetransmitter and receiver. FM signals follow a line-of-sight path, exhibiting many of the same char-acteristics as light. For example, they will reflectoff objects.

Fade and drift: As your vehicle moves away froma station transmitter, the signals will tend to fadeand/or drift.

SERVICING AIR CONDITIONER AUDIO SYSTEM

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-47

Page 208: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Static and flutter: During signal interference frombuildings, large hills or due to antenna position(usually in conjunction with increased distancefrom the station transmitter), static or flutter canbe heard. This can be reduced by adjusting thetreble control to reduce treble response.

Multipath reception: Because of the reflectivecharacteristics of FM signals, direct and reflectedsignals reach the receiver at the same time. Thesignals may cancel each other, resulting in mo-mentary flutter or loss of sound.

AM RADIO RECEPTIONAM signals, because of their low frequency, canbend around objects and skip along the ground.In addition, the signals can be bounced off theionosphere and bent back to earth. Because ofthese characteristics, AM signals are also sub-ject to interference as they travel from transmitterto receiver.

Fading: Occurs while the vehicle is passingthrough freeway underpasses or in areas withmany tall buildings. It can also occur for severalseconds during ionospheric turbulence even inareas where no obstacles exist.

Static: Caused by thunderstorms, electricalpower lines, electric signs and even traffic lights.

SATELLITE RADIO RECEPTION (if soequipped)When the satellite radio is used for the first timeor the battery has been replaced, the satelliteradio may not work properly. This is not a mal-function. Wait more than 10 minutes with satelliteradio ON and the vehicle outside of any metal orlarge building for satellite radio to receive all ofthe necessary data.

The satellite radio mode will be skipped unless anoptional satellite receiver and antenna are in-stalled and an XM�* satellite radio service sub-scription is active. Satellite radio is not availablein Alaska, Hawaii and Guam.

Satellite radio performance may be affected ifcargo carried on the roof blocks the satellite radiosignal.

If possible, do not put cargo over the satelliteantenna.

A build up of ice on the satellite radio antenna canaffect satellite radio performance. Remove theice to restore satellite radio reception.

* XM� is a registered trademark of XM SatelliteRadio, Inc.

AUDIO OPERATION PRECAUTIONSLHA0099

4-48 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 209: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Compact disc (CD) player (modelswithout Navigation System)

CAUTION

● Do not force a compact disc into the CDinsert slot. This could damage the CDand/or CD changer/player.

● Trying to load a CD with the CD doorclosed could damage the CD and/or CDchanger.

● Only one CD can be loaded into the CDplayer at a time.

● Only use high quality 4.7 in (12 cm)round discs that have the “COMPACTdisc DIGITAL AUDIO” logo on the discor packaging.

● During cold weather or rainy days, theplayer may malfunction due to the hu-midity. If this occurs, remove the CDand dehumidify or ventilate the playercompletely.

● The player may skip while driving onrough roads.

● The CD player sometimes cannot func-tion when the compartment tempera-ture is extremely high or low.Decrease/increase the temperaturebefore use.

● Do not expose the CD to direct sun-light.

● CDs that are in poor condition or aredirty, scratched or covered with finger-prints may not work properly.

● The following CDs may not work prop-erly:

● Copy control compact discs (CCCD)

● Recordable compact discs (CD-R)

● Rewritable compact discs (CD-RW)

● Do not use the following CDs as theymay cause the CD player to malfunc-tion:

● 3.1 in (8 cm) discs with an adapter

● CDs that are not round

● CDs with a paper label

● CDs that are warped, scratched, orhave abnormal edges

● This audio system can only play pre-recorded CDs. It has no capability torecord or burn CDs.

● If the CD cannot be played, one of thefollowing messages will be displayed.

CHECK DISC:

● Confirm that the CD is inserted cor-rectly (the label side is facing up,etc.).

● Confirm that the CD is not bent orwarped and it is free of scratches.

PRESS EJECT:

This is an error due to excessive tem-perature inside the player. Remove theCD by pressing the EJECT button. Aftera short time, reinsert the CD. The CDcan be played when the temperature ofthe player returns to normal.

UNPLAYABLE:

The file is unplayable in this audio sys-tem (only MP3 or WMA (if so equipped)CD).

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-49

Page 210: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CD/DVD combination player (modelswith Navigation System)

● Do not force a disc into the CD/DVDinsert slot. This could damage theCD/DVD player.

● During cold weather or rainy days, theplayer may malfunction due to the hu-midity. If this occurs, remove theCD/DVD and dehumidify or ventilatethe player completely.

● The player may skip while driving onrough roads.

● The CD/DVD player sometimes cannotfunction when the passenger compart-ment temperature is extremely high.Decrease the temperature before use.

● Only use high quality 4.7 in (12 cm)round discs that have the “COMPACTdisc DIGITAL AUDIO” or “DVD Video”logo on the disc or packaging.

● Do not expose the CD/DVD to directsunlight.

● CDs/DVDs that are of poor quality,dirty, scratched, covered with finger-prints, or that have pinholes may notwork properly.

● The following CDs/DVDs are not guar-anteed to play:

● Copy control compact discs (CCCD)

● Recordable compact discs (CD-R)

● Rewritable compact discs (CD-RW)

● Recordable compact discs (DVD±R,DVD±R DL)

● Rewritable compact discs(DVD±RW, DVD±RW DL)

● Do not use the following CDs/DVDs asthey may cause the CD/DVD player tomalfunction.

● 3.1 in (8 cm) discs

● CDs/DVDs that are not round

● CDs/DVDs with a paper label

● CDs/DVDs that are warped,scratched, or have abnormal edges

● This audio system can only play pre-recorded CDs/DVDs. It has no capa-bilities to record or burn CDs/DVDs.

● If the CD/DVD cannot be played, one ofthe following messages will be dis-played.

Disc Read Error:

● Confirm that the CD/DVD is insertedcorrectly (the label side is facing up,etc.).

● Confirm that the CD/DVD is not bentor warped and it is free of scratches.

Please Eject Disc:

This error may be due to the tempera-ture inside the player getting too high.Remove the CD/DVD by pushing theEJECT button, and after a short timereinsert the CD/DVD. The CD/DVD canbe played when the temperature of theplayer returns to normal. If the errorpersists, consult your local dealership.

Unplayable File:

● The file may be copy protected.

● The file is not MP3, WMA, AAC, M4Aor DIVX type.

4-50 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 211: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Region Invalid

● The DVD is not for region 1 or allregions.

● Use DVDs with a region code “1”,“ALL” or “1 included” for your DVDentertainment system. (The regioncode �A is displayed as a small sym-bol printed on the top of the DVD�B .) This vehicle-installed DVDplayer cannot play DVDs with a re-gion code other than “1” or “ALL”.

Copyright and trademark

● The technology protected by the U.S.patent and other intellectual propertyrights owned by MacrovisionCorporation and other right holders isadopted for this system.

● This copyright protected technologycannot be used without a permit fromMacrovision Corporation. It is limitedto personal use, etc., as long as thepermit from Macrovision Corporationis not issued.

● Modifying or disassembling is prohib-ited.

● Dolby digital is manufactured under li-cense from Dolby Laboratories, Inc.

● Dolby and the double D mark “ ”are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories,Inc.

● DTS and DTS Digital Surround “ ”are registered trademarks of DigitalTheater Systems, Inc.

Universal Serial Bus (USB) memory (ifso equipped)This system supports various USB memorysticks, USB hard drives and iPod� players. Thereare some USB devices which may not be sup-ported with this system.

● Make sure that the USB device is connectedcorrectly into the USB connector.

● Do not force the memory stick or USB cableinto the USB connector.

LHA0484

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-51

Page 212: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● During cold weather or rainy days, the playermay malfunction due to the humidity. If thisoccurs, remove the USB memory stick anddehumidify or ventilate the player com-pletely.

● The player sometimes cannot function whenthe passenger compartment temperature isextremely high. Decrease the temperaturebefore use.

● Do not leave the USB memory in a placeprone to static electricity or where the airconditioner blows directly. The data in theUSB memory may be damaged.

● Prepare the USB device by yourself be-cause it is not equipped with the vehicle.

● The USB device cannot be formatted withthis system. If you want to format the USBmemory, use your personal computer.

● Partitioned USB devices may not be playedcorrectly.

● Some characters used in other languages(Chinese, Japanese, etc.) are not displayedproperly on the vehicle center screen.NISSAN recommends using English lan-guage characters with USB devices.

● Do not connect the USB device if the con-nector or cable is wet. Allow the cableand/or connectors to dry completely beforeconnecting the USB device.

● Large video podcast files cause slow re-sponses in the iPod�. The vehicle centerdisplay may momentarily black out, but it willsoon recover.

● If the iPod� automatically selects large videopodcast files while in the shuffle mode, thevehicle center display may momentarilyblack out, but it will soon recover.

● Audiobooks may not play in the same orderas they appear on the iPod�.

● The iPod� nano (1st Generation) may re-main in fast forward or rewind mode if it isconnected during a seek operation. In thiscase, please manually reset the iPod�.

● The iPod� nano (2nd Generation) will con-tinue to fast forward or rewind if it is discon-nected during a seek operation.

● An incorrect song title may appear when thePlay Mode is changed while using the iPod�nano (2nd generation).

● If you are using an iPod� (3rd Generationwith Dock connector), do not use very longnames for the song title, album name or artistname to avoid the iPod� resetting itself.

iPod� is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered inthe U.S. and other countries.

Bluetooth� streaming audio (if soequipped)

● Some Bluetooth� audio devices may not berecognized by the in-vehicle audio system.

● It is necessary to set up the wireless con-nection between a compatible Bluetooth�audio device and the in-vehicle Bluetooth�module before using the Bluetooth� audio.

● Operating procedure of the Bluetooth� au-dio will vary depending on the devices. Makesure how to operate your audio device be-fore using it with this system.

● The Bluetooth� audio may be stopped underthe following conditions:

● Receiving a call on the Hands-FreePhone System.

● Checking the connection to the hands-free phone.

4-52 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 213: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Do not place the Bluetooth� audio device inan area surrounded by metal or far away fromthe in-vehicle Bluetooth� module to preventtone quality degradation and wireless con-nection disruption.

● While an audio device is connected throughthe Bluetooth� wireless connection, the bat-tery power of the device may dischargequicker than usual.

● This system supports the Bluetooth� AudioDistribution Profile (A2DP, AVRCP).

BLUETOOTH� is atrademark owned byBluetooth SIG, Inc.and licensed toClarion.

CD or USB with Compressed AudioFiles (models without NavigationSystem)

The file types supported by this system are MP3and WMA.

Explanation of terms:

● MP3 — MP3 is short for Moving PicturesExperts Group Audio Layer 3. MP3 is themost well-known compressed digital audiofile format. This format allows for near “CDquality” sound, but at a fraction of the size ofnormal audio files. MP3 conversion of anaudio track from CD-ROM can reduce thefile size by approximately a 10:1 ratio withvirtually no perceptible loss in quality. MP3compression removes the redundant andirrelevant parts of a sound signal that thehuman ear doesn’t hear.

● WMA — Windows Media Audio (WMA)* is acompressed audio format created by Micro-soft as an alternative to MP3. The WMAcodec offers greater file compression thanthe MP3 codec, enabling storage of moredigital audio tracks in the same amount ofspace when compared to MP3s at the samelevel of quality.

● Bit rate — Bit rate denotes the number ofbits per second used by a digital music file.The size and quality of a compressed digitalaudio file is determined by the bit rate usedwhen encoding the file.

● Sampling frequency — Sampling frequencyis the rate at which the samples of a signalare converted from analog to digital (A/Dconversion) per second.

● Multisession — Multisession is one of themethods for writing data to media. Writingdata once to the media is called a singlesession, and writing more than once is calleda multisession.

● ID3/WMA Tag — The ID3/WMA tag is thepart of the encoded MP3 or WMA file thatcontains information about the digital musicfile such as song title, artist, encoding bitrate, track time duration, etc. ID3 tag infor-mation is displayed on the Artist/song titleline on the display.

* Windows�, Windows Media� and WindowsVista� are registered trademarks and trademarksin the United States of America and other coun-tries of Microsoft Corporation of the USA.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-53

Page 214: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Playback order:

Music playback order of a CD with MP3 or WMAfiles is as illustrated.

● The names of folders not containing MP3 orWMA files are not shown in the display.

● If there is a file in the top level of the disc,“Root Folder” is displayed.

● The playback order is the order in which thefiles were written by the writing software.Therefore, the files might not play in thedesired order.

Playback order chartWHA1078

4-54 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 215: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Specification chart:

Supported media CD, CD-R, CD-RW, USB 2.0

Supported file systems

CD, CD-R, CD-RW, ISO9660 LEVEL1, ISO9660 LEVEL2, Romeo, Joliet* ISO9660 Level 3 (packet writing) is not supported.* Files saved using the Live File System component (on a Windows Vista� operating system-basedcomputer) are not supported.UDF Bridge (UDF 1.02 + ISO9660), UDF 1.5, UDF 2.0VDF 1.5/VDF 2.0 (packet writing) is not supported.USB memory: FAT16, FAT32

Supportedversions

MP3Version MPEG1, MPEG2, MPEG2.5Sampling frequency 8 kHz - 48 kHzBit rate 8 kbps - 320 kbps, VBR*2

WMA*1 Version WMA7, WMA8Sampling frequency 8 kHz - 48 kHzBit rate 8 kbps - 320 kbps, VBR*2

Tag information (Song title and artist name)ID3 tag VER1.0, VER1.1, VER2.2, VER2.3, VER 2.4 (MP3 only)WMA tag (WMA only)

Folder levels Folder levels: 8, Folders: 255 (including root folder), Files: 512 (Max. 255 files for one folder)Text character number limitation 64 characters

Displayable character codes*301: ASCII, 02: ISO-8859-1, 03: UNICODE (UTF-16 LE), 04: UNICODE (UTF-16 BE),05: UNICODE (UTF-8)

*1 Protected WMA files (DRM) cannot be played.

*2 When VBR files are played, the playback time may not be displayed correctly.

*3 Available codes depend on what kind of media, versions and information are going to be displayed.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-55

Page 216: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Troubleshooting guide:

Symptom Cause and Countermeasure

Cannot play

Check if the CD/USB device was inserted correctly.Check if the CD is scratched or dirty.Check if there is condensation inside the player. If there is, wait until the condensation is gone (about 1 hour) before using the player.If there is a temperature increase error, the player will play correctly after it returns to the normal temperature.If there is a mixture of music CD files (CD-DA data) and compressed audio files on a CD, only the music CD files (CD-DA data) will be played.Files with extensions other than “.MP3” or “.WMA” cannot be played. In addition, the character codes and number of characters for folder names andfile names should be in compliance with the specifications.Check if the disc or file is generated in an irregular format. This may occur depending on the variation or the setting of the compressed audio file writ-ing application or other text editing applications.Check if the finalization process, such as session close and disc close, is done for the disc.Check if the CD/USB device is protected by copyright.

Poor sound quality Check if the CD is scratched or dirty.It takes a relatively long timebefore the music startsplaying.

If there are many folders or file levels on the CD/USB device, or if it is a multisession disc, some time may be required before the music starts playing.

Music cuts off or skipsThe writing software and hardware combination might not match, or the writing speed, writing depth, writing width, etc., might not match thespecifications. Try using the slowest writing speed.

Skipping with high bit ratefiles

Skipping may occur with large quantities of data, such as for high bit rate data.

Moves immediately to thenext song when playing

If an unsupported compressed audio file has been given a supported extension like “.MP3”, or when play is prohibited by copyright protection, theplayer will skip to the next song.

Songs do not play back inthe desired order

The playback order is the order in which the files were written by the writing software. Therefore, the files might not play in the desired order.Random/Shuffle may be active on the audio system or on the USB device.

4-56 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 217: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CD, DVD or USB with CompressedAudio Files (models with NavigationSystem)

The file types supported by this system are MP3,WMA, AAC/M4A and ATRAC3.

Explanation of terms:

● MP3 — MP3 is short for Moving PicturesExperts Group Audio Layer 3. MP3 is themost well known compressed digital audiofile format. This format allows for near “CDquality” sound, but at a fraction of the size ofnormal audio files. MP3 conversion of anaudio track can reduce the file size by ap-proximately 10:1 ratio (Sampling: 44.1 kHz,Bit rate: 128 kbps) with virtually no percep-tible loss in quality. The compression re-duces certain parts of sound that seem in-audible to most people.

● WMA — Windows Media Audio (WMA) is acompressed audio format created by Micro-soft as an alternative to MP3. The WMAcodec offers greater file compression thanthe MP3 codec, enabling storage of moredigital audio tracks in the same amount ofspace when compared to MP3s at the samelevel of quality.

● AAC/M4A — Advanced Audio Coding(AAC) is a lossy audio compression format.Audio files that have been encoded withAAC are generally smaller in size and delivera higher quality of sound than MP3.

● ATRAC3, ATRAC3 Plus — Adaptive Trans-form Acoustic Coding (ATRAC) is a lossyaudio compression format developed bySony.

● Bit rate — Bit rate denotes the number ofbits per second used by a digital music file.The size and quality of a compressed digitalaudio file is determined by the bit rate usedwhen encoding the file.

● Sampling frequency — Sampling frequencyis the rate at which the samples of a signalare converted from analog to digital (A/Dconversion) per second.

● Multisession — Multisession is one of themethods for writing data to media. Writingdata once to the media is called a singlesession, and writing more than once is calleda multisession.

● ID3/WMA Tag — The ID3/WMA tag is thepart of the encoded MP3 or WMA file thatcontains information about the digital musicfile such as song title, artist, album title,encoding bit rate, track time duration, etc.ID3 tag information is displayed on theAlbum/Artist/Track title line on the display.

* Windows�, Windows Media� and WindowsVista� are registered trademarks or trademarksof Microsoft Corporation in the United States ofAmerica and/or other countries.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-57

Page 218: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Playback order:

Music playback order of a CD, DVD or USBdevice with compressed audio files is as illus-trated.

● The folder names of folders not containingcompressed audio files are not shown in thedisplay.

● If there is a file in the top level of thedisc/USB, “Root Folder” is displayed.

● The playback order is the order in which thefiles were written by the writing software, sothe files might not play in the desired order.

Playback order chartWHA1374

4-58 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 219: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Specification chart:

Supported media CD, CD-R, CD-RW, DVD-ROM, DVD±R, DVD±RW, DVD±R DL, USB 2.0

Supported file systems

CD, CD-R, CD-RW, DVD-ROM, DVD±R, DVD±RW, DVD±R DL, ISO9660 LEVEL1, ISO9660 LEVEL2, Romeo, Joliet* ISO9660 Level 3 (packet writing) is not supported.* Files saved using the Live File System component (on a Windows Vista� operating system-based computer) are not supported.UDF Bridge (UDF 1.02 + ISO9660), UDF 1.5, UDF 2.0* VDF 1.5/VDF 2.0 (packet writing) is not supported.USB memory: FAT16, FAT32

Supportedversions*1

MP3Version MPEG1, MPEG2, MPEG2.5Sampling frequency 8 kHz - 48 kHzBit rate 8 kbps - 320 kbps, VBR*4

WMA*2 Version WMA7, WMA8, WMA9Sampling frequency 32 kHz - 48 kHzBit rate 32 kbps - 192 kbps, VBR*4

AAC Sampling frequency 8 kHz - 96 kHzBit rate 16 kbps - 320 kbps, VBR*4

ATRAC Version ATRAC3, ATRAC3 Plus

Tag information (Song title and artist name)ID3 tag VER1.0, VER1.1, VER2.2, VER2.3, VER 2.4 (MP3 only)WMA tag (WMA only)

Folder levels Folder levels: 8, Folders: 255 (including root folder), Files: 512 (Max. 255 files for one folder)Text character number limitation 128 characters

Displayable character codes*301: ASCII, 02: ISO-8859-1, 03: UNICODE (UTF-16 BOM Big Endian), 04: UNICODE (UTF-16 Non-BOM Big Endian),05: UNICODE (UTF-8), 06: UNICODE (Non-UTF 16 BOM Little Endian), 07: SHIFT-JIS

*1 Files created with a combination of 48 kHz sampling frequency and 64 kbps bit rate cannot be played.

*2 Protected WMA files (DRM) cannot be played.

*3 Available codes depend on what kind of media, versions and information are going to be displayed.

*4 When VBR files are played, the playback time may not be displayed correctly.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-59

Page 220: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Troubleshooting guide:

Symptom Cause and Countermeasure

Cannot play

Check if the CD/DVD/USB device was inserted correctly.Check if the CD/DVD is scratched or dirty.Check if there is condensation inside the player. If there is, wait until the condensation is gone (about 1 hour) before using the player.If there is a temperature increase error, the player will play correctly after it returns to the normal temperature.If there is a mixture of music CD files (CD-DA data) and compressed audio files on a CD, only the music CD files (CD-DA data) will be played.Files with extensions other than “.MP3”, “.WMA”, “.AAC”, “.M4A” or “.AA3” cannot be played. In addition, the character codes and number of charac-ters for folder names and file names should be in compliance with the specifications.Check if the disc or file is generated in an irregular format. This may occur depending on the variation or the setting of the compressed audio file writ-ing application or other text editing applications.Check if the finalization process, such as session close and disc close, is done for the disc.Check if the CD/DVD/USB device is protected by copyright.

Poor sound quality Check if the CD/DVD is scratched or dirty.It takes a relatively long timebefore the music startsplaying.

If there are many folders or file levels on the CD/DVD/USB device, or if it is a multisession disc, some time may be required before the music startsplaying.

Music cuts off or skipsThe writing software and hardware combination might not match, or the writing speed, writing depth, writing width, etc., might not match thespecifications. Try using the slowest writing speed.

Skipping with high bit ratefiles

Skipping may occur with large quantities of data, such as for high bit rate data.

Moves immediately to thenext song when playing

If an unsupported compressed audio file has been given a supported extension like “.MP3”, or when play is prohibited by copyright protection, theplayer will skip to the next song.

Songs do not play back inthe desired order

The playback order is the order in which the files were written by the writing software. Therefore, the files might not play in the desired order.Random/Shuffle may be active on the audio system or on the USB device.

4-60 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 221: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Compressed Video Files (models withNavigation System)Explanation of terms:

● DivX – DivX refers to the DivX� codecowned by Div, Inc. used for a lossy compres-sion of video based on MPEG-4.

● AVI – AVI stands for Audio Video Interleave.It is standard file format originated by Micro-soft Corporation. A .divx encoded file can besaved into the .avi file format for playback onthis system if it meets the requirementsstated in the table in this section. However,all .avi files are not playable on this systemsince different encodings can be used otherthan the DivX� codec.

● ASF – ASF stands for Advanced SystemsFormat. It is file format owned by MicrosoftCorporation. Note: Only .asf files that meetthe requirements stated in the table in thissection can be played.

● Bit rate — Bit rate denotes the number ofbits per second used by a digital video files.The size and quality of a compressed digitalaudio file is determined by the bit rate usedwhen encoding the file.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-61

Page 222: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Requirements for Supporting Video Playback:

Media CD, CD-R, CD-RW, DVD, DVD±R, DVD±RW, DVD±RW DL, USB 2.0 Memory

File Systems

CD, CD-R, CD-RW, DVD,DVD±R, DVD±RW,DVD±RW DL

ISO9660 LEVEL1, ISO9660 LEVEL2, Romeo, Joliet, UDF Bridge (UDF1.02+ISO9660), UDF1.5, UDF2.0* ISO9660 Level 3 (packet writing) is not supported.* Files saved using the Live File System component (on a Windows Vista-based computer) are not supported.* VDF1.5/VDF2.0 (packet writing) is not supported.

USB Memory FAT16, FAT32

File Types

.divx, .avi Video Codecs DivX3, DivX4, DivX5, DivX6Audio Codecs MP3, MPEG2.5 Audio Layer3, AC3, LPCM

.asf Video Codec ISO-MPEG4Audio Codec G.726

Bit Rates.divx, .avi Maximum Average 4 Mbps

Maximum Peak 8 Mbps

Resolution

.divx, .avi Minimum 32 x 32Maximum 720 x 480

.asf Minimum 32 x 32Maximum 720 x 576

4-62 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 223: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. CD eject button2. VOL/ON·OFF control knob3. Station and CD select (1 - 6) buttons4. LOAD CD button

5. TUNE/FOLDER and AUDIO controlknob (Bass, Treble, Fade, Balance, SSV(if so equipped), and Beep)

6. AUX IN jack7. AUX button8. TRACK button

9. SEEK/CAT button10. DISC button11. RPT/RDM button12. SCAN button13. AM·FM button14. DISP/CLOCK button

FM/AM RADIO WITH COMPACTDISC (CD) CHANGER (if soequipped)

For all operation precautions, see �Audio opera-tion precautions� in this section.

Audio main operation

VOL/ON·OFF control:

Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ONposition and push the VOL/ON·OFF control knobwhile the system is off to call up the mode (radioor CD) that was playing immediately before thesystem was turned off.

To turn the system off, press the VOL/ON·OFFcontrol knob.

Turn the VOL/ON·OFF control knob to adjust thevolume.

LHA2104

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-63

Page 224: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

AUDIO control knob (Bass, Treble, Fade,Balance and Beep):

Press the AUDIO control knob to change themode as follows:

Bass → Treble → Fade → Balance → BeepON/OFF → Bass

To adjust Bass, Treble, Fade and Balance, pressthe AUDIO control knob until the desired modeappears on the display. Turn the TUNE/FOLDERknob to adjust Bass and Treble to the desiredlevel. You can also use the TUNE/FOLDER knobto adjust Fade and Balance modes. Fade adjuststhe sound level between the front and rear speak-ers and Balance adjusts the sound between theright and left speakers.

To change the Beep to ON or OFF, turn theTUNE/FOLDER knob left or right. This will enableor disable the beep sound heard during menuselection.

Once you have adjusted the sound quality to thedesired level, press the AUDIO control knob re-peatedly until the radio or CD display reappears.Otherwise, the radio or CD display will automati-cally reappear after about five seconds.

Clock set

The clock displays the time when the ignitionswitch is placed in the ACC or ON position.

Adjusting the time

1. Push and hold the DISP/CLOCK button formore than 2 seconds until the display shows“Hour Adjust”.

2. Turn the TUNE/FOLDER knob to adjust thehour.

3. Press the DISP/CLOCK button again; thedisplay will show “Minute Adjust”.

4. Turn the TUNE/FOLDER knob to adjust theminutes.

5. Press the DISP/CLOCK button again to exitthe clock set mode.

Press the DISP/CLOCK button again to return tothe regular clock display. If no action is taken, thedisplay will return to the regular clock displayafter 10 seconds.

If the power supply is disconnected, the clock willnot indicate the correct time.

Readjust the time.

CD display mode

To change the text displayed while playing a CDwith text, press the DISP/CLOCK button. TheDISP/CLOCK button will allow you to scrollthrough CD text as follows: Track number andTrack time ←→ Album title ←→ Song title.

● Track number displays the track number se-lected on the disc.

● Track time displays the amount of time thetrack has played.

● Album title displays the title of the CD beingplayed.

● Song title displays the title of the selectedCD track.

MP3 display mode

To change the text displayed when listening to aCD with MP3s and ID3 tags, press theDISP/CLOCK button. The DISP/CLOCK buttonwill scroll through the CD text as follows: Discnumber, Track number and Folder number ←→Folder title ←→ Song title ←→ Artist name ←→Album title.

● Disc number displays the number of thecurrent disc playing.

● Track number displays the number of thetrack playing on the selected disc.

● Folder number displays the number of thecurrent folder on the MP3 CD.

● Folder title displays the title of the folder.

● Song title displays the title of the song play-ing.

4-64 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 225: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Artist name displays the name of the artist ofthe song playing.

● Album title displays the title of the album ofthe song playing.

FM/AM radio operation

FM/AM band select:

Pressing the AM·FM button will change the bandas follows:

AM → FM1 → FM2 → AM

When the AM·FM button is pressed while theignition switch is in the ACC or ON position, theradio will come on at the station last played.

The last station played will also come on whenthe VOL/ON·OFF control knob is pressed ON.

If a compact disc is playing when the AM·FMbutton is pressed, the compact disc will auto-matically be turned off and the last radio stationplayed will come on.

The FM stereo indicator ST will illuminate duringFM stereo reception. When the stereo broadcastsignal is weak, the radio will automatically changefrom stereo to monaural reception.

TUNE/FOLDER (Tuning) knob:

To manually tune the radio, turn theTUNE/FOLDER knob to the right or left.

SEEK/CAT and TRACK

tuning buttons:

Press the SEEK/CAT button or theTRACK button to tune from high to low orlow to high frequencies and stop at the nextbroadcasting station.

SCAN tuning:

Press the SCAN button to stop at each broad-casting station for 5 seconds. Pressing theSCAN button again during this 5-second periodwill stop scan tuning and the radio will remaintuned to that station. If the SCAN button is notpressed within 5 seconds, scan tuning moves tothe next station.

1 to 6 Station memory operations:

Twelve stations can be set for the FM band (6 forFM1, 6 for FM2) and six stations can be set forthe AM band.

1. Choose the radio band AM, FM1 or FM2using the AM·FM select button.

2. Tune to the desired station using manual,SEEK or SCAN tuning. Press and hold anyof the desired station memory buttons (1 –6) until a beep sound is heard.

3. The channel indicator will then come on andthe sound will resume. Programming is nowcomplete.

4. Other buttons can be set in the same man-ner.

If the battery cable is disconnected or if the fuseopens, the radio memory will be canceled. In thatcase, reset the desired stations.

Compact disc (CD) changer operation

Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ONposition and press the LOAD button, then pressone of the CD insert (1 – 6) slots. Insert thecompact disc into the slot with the label sidefacing up. The compact disc will be guided auto-matically into the slot and start playing.

If the radio is already operating, it will automati-cally turn off and the compact disc will play.

If the system has been turned off while a compactdisc was playing, pressing the VOL/ON·OFFcontrol knob will start the compact disc.

LOAD button:

To insert a CD in the CD changer, press theLOAD button for less than 1.5 seconds. Selectthe loading slot by pressing the CD insert selectbutton (1 – 6), then insert the CD.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-65

Page 226: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

To insert 6 CDs to the CD changer, press theLOAD button for more than 1.5 seconds.

The slot numbers (1 – 6) will illuminate on thedisplay when CDs are loaded into the changer.

DISC button:

When the DISC button is pressed with the sys-tem off and a compact disc loaded, the systemwill turn on and the compact disc will start to play.

When the DISC button is pressed with a com-pact disc loaded with the radio playing, the radiowill automatically be turned off and the compactdisc will start to play.

SEEK/CAT and TRACK

buttons:

When the SEEK/CAT button is pressedwhile a compact disc is playing, the track beingplayed returns to its beginning. Press severaltimes to skip back through tracks. The compactdisc will go back the number of times the buttonis pressed.

When the TRACK button is pressed whilethe compact disc is playing, the next track willstart to play from its beginning. Press severaltimes to skip through tracks. The compact discwill advance the number of times the button ispressed. (When the last track on the compactdisc is skipped through, the first track will beplayed.)

SEEK/CAT and TRACK

(Rewind·Fast Forward)

buttons:

Press and hold the SEEK/CAT (rewind)button or the TRACK (fast forward) buttonwhile a compact disc is playing, the compact discwill play while rewinding or fast forwarding. Whenthe button is released, the compact disc willreturn to normal play speed.

TUNE/FOLDER knob

While playing an MP3/WMA CD, turn theTUNE/FOLDER knob right or left to scan forwardor backward through available folders.

CD select buttons:

To play another CD that has been loaded, press aCD select button (1 – 6).

RPT/RDM button:

When the RPT/RDM button is pressed while thecompact disc is playing, the play pattern can bechanged as follows:

CD:

All Disc Repeat → 1 Disc Repeat → 1 TrackRepeat → All Disc Random → 1 Disc Random →All Disc Repeat

MP3/WMA CD:

All Disc Repeat → 1 Disc Repeat → 1 FolderRepeat → 1 Track Repeat → All Disc Random →1 Disc Random → 1 Folder Random → All DiscRepeat

All Disc Repeat: All discs loaded will be re-peated.1 Disc Repeat: The disc that is currently playingwill be repeated.1 Track Repeat: The track that is currently playingwill be repeated.1 Folder Repeat: The folder that is currently beingaccessed will be repeated.All Disc Random: All discs loaded will be playedin a mixed order.1 Disc Random: The tracks on the disc that iscurrently playing will be played in a mixed order.1 Folder Random: The tracks in the folder that iscurrently being accessed will be played in amixed order.

4-66 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 227: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

SCAN button:

While listening to a CD, press the SCAN buttonto preview the first 10 seconds of each track onthe CD playing. Pressing the SCAN button againduring this 10 second period stops the scan andthe CD remains on that track.

CD EJECT:

Current/Selected disc:

● Press the button, then press the slotnumber (1 – 6) for the desired disc. Thecompact disc will be ejected. If no slot num-ber (1 – 6) is pressed, the current loadeddisc will be ejected. If the ejected disc is notremoved within 15 seconds, the disc willreload.

All discs:

● Press and hold the button for morethan 1.5 seconds. The compact discs will beejected one by one. If a disc is not removedwithin 15 seconds or the button ispressed again during the eject sequence,the entire disc eject sequence will be can-celed.

When this button is pressed while a compactdisc is being played, the compact disc will ejectand the last source will be played.

CD IN indicator:

The slot numbers (1 – 6) will illuminate if CDshave been loaded into the changer in CD modeonly.

AUX IN jack

The AUX IN jack is located on the CD changer.The AUX IN audio input jack accepts any stan-dard analog audio input, such as from a portablecassette tape player, MP3 player or a laptopcomputer.

Press the AUX button to play a compatible devicewhen it is plugged into the AUX IN jack.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-67

Page 228: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. CD eject button2. VOL/ON·OFF control knob3. Station select (1 - 6) buttons4. TUNE/FOLDER and AUDIO control

knob (Bass, Treble, Fade and Balance)5. AUX button*

6. TRACK button7. SEEK/CAT button8. DISC button9. RPT/RDM button10. SCAN button11. FM·AM button

*No satellite radio reception is availablewhen the AUX button is pressed to ac-cess satellite radio stations unless op-tional satellite receiver and antenna areinstalled and an XM� satellite radio ser-vice subscription is active. Satellite ra-dio is not available in Alaska, Hawaiiand Guam.

FM/AM/SAT RADIO WITH COMPACTDISC (CD) PLAYER (if so equipped)

For all operation precautions, see �Audio opera-tion precautions� in this section.

Audio main operation

VOL/ON·OFF control:

Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ONposition and push the VOL/ON·OFF control knobwhile the system is off to call up the mode thatwas playing immediately before the system wasturned off.

To turn the system off, press the VOL/ON·OFFcontrol knob.

Turn the VOL/ON·OFF control knob to adjust thevolume.

WHA1364

4-68 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 229: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

This vehicle has Speed Sensitive Volume (SSV)for audio. The audio volume changes as the driv-ing speed changes.

AUDIO control knob (Bass, Treble, Bal-ance and Fade):

Press the AUDIO control knob to change themode as follows:

Bass → Treble → Balance → Fade

To adjust Bass, Treble, Balance and Fade, pressthe AUDIO control knob until the desired modeappears in the display. Turn the tuning knob toadjust Bass and Treble to the desired level. Youcan also use the tuning knob to adjust Fade andBalance modes. Fade adjusts the sound levelbetween the front and rear speakers and Balanceadjusts the sound between the right and leftspeakers.

Once you have adjusted the sound quality to thedesired level, press the AUDIO control knob re-peatedly until the radio or CD display reappears.If the control knob is not pressed for approxi-mately 10 seconds, the radio or CD display willautomatically reappear.

Speed Sensitive Volume (SSV):

To change the SSV mode from OFF to 5, pressthe SETTING button. Then select the “Audio” keyusing the NISSAN controller; the audio settingsscreen will be displayed. Select the “–”key or “+”key to change the SSV.

While in this screen you can also adjust the otheraudio settings by selecting the correspondingkey.

Once you have adjusted the sound quality to thedesired level, press the BACK button.

For information on how to use the NISSAN con-troller, see “How to use the NISSAN controller” inthis section.

Clock operation

For additional information on setting the clock,see “Adjusting the time” in this section.

LHA1304 LHA1314

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-69

Page 230: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CD/MP3 display mode

While listening to a CD or an MP3/WMA CD,certain text might be able to be displayed (whenCD encoded with text is being used).

Depending on how the CD or MP3/WMA CD isencoded, the following text might be able to bedisplayed by selecting the “Text” key:

● Folder displays the name of the currentfolder being accessed.

● File displays the name of the file currentlyplaying.

● Song displays the ID3 encoded tag of thesong name.

● Album displays the ID3 encoded tag of thealbum name.

● Artist displays the ID3 encoded tag of theartist’s name.

● Disc displays the disc name of the CD cur-rently playing.

● Track displays the name of the song on theCD currently playing.

Some of this text or modes might not displaywhile playing a regular CD. Select the “Menu”keywith the NISSAN controller, then select the “Text”key to display the text for the CD.

Press the BACK button to exit the CD text displayscreen.

FM/AM/SAT radio operation

FM/AM band select:

Pressing the FM·AM button will change the bandas follows:

AM → FM1 → FM2 → AM

When the FM·AM button is pressed while theignition switch is in the ACC or ON position, theradio will come on at the station last played.

The last station played will also come on whenthe VOL/ON·OFF control knob is pressed ON.

If a compact disc is playing when the FM·AMbutton is pressed, the compact disc will auto-matically be turned off and the last radio stationplayed will come on.

The FM stereo indicator ST will illuminate duringFM stereo reception. When the stereo broadcastsignal is weak, the radio will automatically changefrom stereo to monaural reception.

XM band select:

Pressing the AUX button will change the band asfollows:

USB → XM1* → XM2* → XM3* → AUX → USB(satellite, if so equipped)

WHA0949 WHA0950

4-70 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 231: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

When the AUX button is pressed while the igni-tion switch is in the ACC or ON position, theradio will come on at the station last played.

The last station played will also come on whenthe VOL/ON·OFF control knob is pressed ON.

*When the AUX button is pressed, the satelliteradio mode will be skipped unless an optionalsatellite receiver and antenna are installed and anXM� satellite radio service subscription is active.Satellite radio is not available in Alaska, Hawaiiand Guam.

If a compact disc is playing when the AUX buttonis pressed, the compact disc will automatically beturned off and the last radio station played willcome on.

TUNE/FOLDER (Tuning) knob:

To manually tune the radio, turn theTUNE/FOLDER knob to the right or left.

SEEK/CAT and TRACK

tuning buttons:

Press the SEEK/CAT button or theTRACK button to tune from high to low orlow to high frequencies and stop at the nextbroadcasting station.

SCAN tuning:

Press the SCAN button to stop at each broad-casting station for 5 seconds. Pressing theSCAN button again during this five second pe-riod will stop scan tuning and the radio will remaintuned to that station. If the SCAN button is notpressed within 5 seconds, scan tuning moves tothe next station.

1 to 6 Station memory operations:

Six stations can be set for the AM band. Twelvestations can be set for the FM band (6 for FM1, 6for FM2). Eighteen stations can be set for the XMband (6 for XM1, 6 for XM2, 6 for XM3).

1. Choose the radio band AM, FM1 or FM2using the FM·AM select button. Or choosethe satellite band SAT1 or SAT2 using theAUX button.

2. Tune to the desired station using manual,SEEK or SCAN tuning. Press and hold anyof the desired station memory buttons (1 –6) until a beep sound is heard.

3. The channel indicator will then come on andthe sound will resume. Programming is nowcomplete.

4. Other buttons can be set in the same man-ner.

If the battery cable is disconnected, or if the fuseopens, the radio memory will be canceled. In thatcase, reset the desired stations.

Radio data system (RDS):

RDS stands for Radio Data System, and is a datainformation service transmitted by some radiostations on the FM band (not AM band). Cur-rently, most RDS stations are in large cities, butmany stations are now considering broadcastingRDS data.

RDS can display:

● Station call sign, such as “WHFR 98.3”.

● Station name, such as “The Groove”.

● Music or programming type such as “Clas-sical”, “Country”, or “Rock”.

When the “Text” key is selected with the NISSANcontroller on the display while the radio is playing,additional information is displayed on the screen.

If the station broadcasts RDS information, theRDS icon is displayed.

Compact disc (CD) player operationPlace the ignition in the ACC or ON position andinsert the compact disc into the slot with the labelside facing up. The compact disc will be guidedautomatically into the slot and start playing.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-71

Page 232: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

If the radio is already operating, it will automati-cally turn off and the compact disc will play.

If the system has been turned off while the com-pact disc was playing, pressing theVOL/ON·OFF control knob will start the compactdisc.

DISC button:

When the DISC button is pressed with the sys-tem off and a compact disc loaded, the systemwill turn on and the compact disc will start to play.

When the DISC button is pressed with a com-pact disc loaded with the radio playing, the radiowill automatically be turned off and the compactdisc will start to play.

SEEK/CAT and TRACK

buttons:

When the SEEK/CAT button is pressedwhile a compact disc is playing, the track beingplayed returns to its beginning. Press severaltimes to skip back through tracks. The compactdisc will go back the number of times the buttonis pressed.

When the TRACK button is pressed whilea compact disc is playing, the next track will startto play from its beginning. Press several times toskip through tracks. The compact disc will ad-

vance the number of times the button is pressed.(When the last track on the compact disc isskipped through, the first track will be played.)

The NISSAN controller can also be used to se-lect tracks when a CD is playing.

SEEK/CAT and TRACK

(Rewind and Fast For-

ward) buttons:

Press and hold the SEEK/CAT (rewind)button or the TRACK (fast forward) buttonwhile a compact disc is playing; the compact discwill play while rewinding or fast forwarding. Whenthe button is released, the compact disc willreturn to normal play speed.

TUNE/FOLDER knob

While playing an MP3/WMA CD, turn theTUNE/FOLDER knob right or left to scan forwardor backward through available folders.

RPT/RDM button:

When the RPT/RDM button is pressed while thecompact disc is playing, the play pattern can bechanged as follows:

CD:

Repeat All → 1 Track Repeat → 1 Disc Random→ Repeat All

CD with compressed audio files:

Repeat All → 1 Folder Repeat → 1 Track Repeat→ 1 Disc Random → 1 Folder Random → Re-peat All

Repeat All: Normal play mode. All tracks willconstantly play in sequential order.1 Folder Repeat: The folder that is currently beingaccessed will be repeated.1 Track Repeat: The track that is currently playingwill be repeated.1 Disc Random: The tracks on the disc that iscurrently playing will be played in a mixed order.1 Folder Random: The tracks in the folder that iscurrently playing will be played in a mixed order.

CD EJECT button:

When the button is pressed with the com-pact disc loaded, the compact disc will beejected.

When the button is pressed while thecompact disc is being played, the compact discwill eject and the system will turn off.

4-72 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 233: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

AUX (auxiliary) input jacks

The auxiliary input jacks are located inside thecenter console �1 . NTSC compatible devicessuch as video games, camcorders and portablevideo players can be connected to the auxiliaryinput jacks. Audio devices, such as some MP3players, can also be connected to the systemthrough the auxiliary input jacks.

The auxiliary input jacks are color coded for iden-tification purposes:

● Red – right channel audio input

● White – left channel audio input

● Yellow – video input

Before connecting a device to the auxiliary inputjacks, turn off the power of the portable device.

With a compatible device connected to the aux-iliary input jacks, press the AUX button until theAUX mode appears in the display. The outputfrom the device will be played through the display(when the vehicle is in the (P) Park position andthe parking brake engaged) and audio system.

AUX settings

Select the “Settings” key using the NISSAN con-troller and press the ENTER button.

Choose one of the display modes by selecting

the “ ” key or the “ ” key:

● Normal

● Wide

● Cinema

LHA2031 LHA1367

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-73

Page 234: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Additional featuresFor more information about the iPod� playeravailable with this system, see “iPod� player op-eration without Navigation System” in this sec-tion.

For more information about the USB interfaceavailable with this system, see “USB interface(models without Navigation System)” in this sec-tion.

For more information about the Music Box� fea-ture available with this system, see “Music Box�without Navigation System” in this section.

1. CD eject button2. VOL/ON·OFF control knob3. Station select (1 - 6) buttons4. TUNE/FOLDER and AUDIO control

knob (Bass, Treble, Fade and Balance)5. DISC·AUX button

6. TRACK button7. SEEK/CAT button8. SAT* button9. RPT/RDM button10. SCAN button11. FM·AM button

WHA1365

4-74 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 235: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

*No satellite radio reception is availablewhen the SAT button is pressed to ac-cess satellite radio stations unless op-tional satellite receiver and antenna areinstalled and an XM� satellite radio ser-vice subscription is active. Satellite ra-dio is not available in Alaska, Hawaiiand Guam.

FM/AM/SAT RADIO WITH CD/DVDPLAYER (if so equipped)

For all operation precautions, see �Audio opera-tion precautions� in this section.

Audio main operation

VOL/ON·OFF control:

Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ONposition and push the VOL/ON·OFF control knobwhile the system is off to call up the mode thatwas playing immediately before the system wasturned off.

To turn the system off, press the VOL/ON·OFFcontrol knob.

Turn the VOL/ON·OFF control knob to adjust thevolume.

This vehicle has Speed Sensitive Volume (SSV)for audio. The audio volume changes as the driv-ing speed changes.

AUDIO control knob (Bass, Treble, Bal-ance and Fade):

Press the AUDIO control knob to change themode as follows:

Bass → Treble → Balance → Fade

To adjust Bass, Treble, Balance and Fade, pressthe AUDIO control knob until the desired modeappears in the display. Turn the tuning knob toadjust Bass and Treble to the desired level. Youcan also use the tuning knob to adjust Fade andBalance modes. Fade adjusts the sound levelbetween the front and rear speakers and Balanceadjusts the sound between the right and leftspeakers.

Once you have adjusted the sound quality to thedesired level, press the AUDIO control knob re-peatedly until the radio or CD display reappears.If the control knob is not pressed for approxi-mately 10 seconds, the radio or CD display willautomatically reappear.

Speed Sensitive Volume (SSV):

To change the SSV mode from OFF to 5, pressthe SETTING button. Then select the “Audio” keyusing the NISSAN controller, then press the EN-TER button; the audio settings screen will bedisplayed. Select the “–”key or “+”key to changethe SSV.

While in this screen you can also adjust the otheraudio settings by selecting the correspondingkey.

Once you have adjusted the sound quality to thedesired level, press the BACK button.

LHA1236

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-75

Page 236: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

For information on how to use the NISSAN con-troller, see “How to use the NISSAN controller” inthis section.

Display album cover art:

When an audio source encoded with albumcover art is played, the album cover art can bedisplayed on the screen. To toggle this feature onor off, touch the “Display Album Cover Art” key.When the feature is activated, the amber indica-tor next to the word ON will illuminate.

CD, DVD or USB with compressed audiofiles

While listening to a CD or compressed audiofiles, certain text might be able to be displayed(when CD encoded with text is being used).

Depending on how the CD or compressed audiofiles are encoded, the following text might bedisplayed:

● Folder displays the name of the currentfolder being accessed.

● File displays the name of the file currentlyplaying.

LHA1256 LHA1257 LHA1258

4-76 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 237: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Song displays the ID3 encoded tag of thesong name.

● Album displays the ID3 encoded tag of thealbum name.

● Artist displays the ID3 encoded tag of theartist’s name.

Some of this text might not display while playing aregular CD.

FM/AM/SAT radio operation

FM/AM band select:

Pressing the FM·AM button will change the bandas follows:

AM → FM1 → FM2 → AM

When the FM·AM button is pressed while theignition switch is in the ACC or ON position, theradio will come on at the station last played.

The last station played will also come on whenthe VOL/ON·OFF control knob is pressed ON.

If a compact disc is playing when the FM·AMbutton is pressed, the compact disc will auto-matically be turned off and the last radio stationplayed will come on.

The FM stereo indicator STEREO will illuminateduring FM stereo reception. When the stereo

broadcast signal is weak, the radio will automati-cally change from stereo to monaural reception.

SAT band select:

Pressing the SAT button will change the band asfollows:

XM1* → XM2* → XM3* → XM1 (satellite, if soequipped)

When the SAT button is pressed while the igni-tion switch is in the ACC or ON position, theradio will come on at the station last played.

The last station played will also come on whenthe VOL/ON·OFF control knob is pressed ON.

*When the SAT button is pressed, the satelliteradio reception will not be available unless anoptional satellite receiver and antenna are in-stalled and an XM� satellite radio service sub-scription is active. Satellite radio is not availablein Alaska, Hawaii and Guam.

If a compact disc is playing when the SAT buttonis pressed, the compact disc will automatically beturned off and the last radio station played willcome on.

TUNE/FOLDER (Tuning) knob:

To manually tune the radio, turn theTUNE/FOLDER knob to the right or left.

SEEK/CAT and TRACK

tuning buttons:

For AM or FM:Press the SEEK/CAT button or theTRACK button to tune from high to low orlow to high frequencies and stop at the nextbroadcasting station.

For XM:Press the SEEK/CAT button or theTRACK button to go to the first channel ofthe previous or next category.

SCAN tuning:

Press the SCAN button to stop at each broad-casting station for 5 seconds. Pressing theSCAN button again during this five second pe-riod will stop scan tuning and the radio will remaintuned to that station. If the SCAN button is notpressed within 5 seconds, scan tuning moves tothe next station.

1 to 6 Station memory operations:

Six stations can be set for the AM band. Twelvestations can be set for the FM band (6 for FM1, 6for FM2). Eighteen channels can be set for theSAT radio (6 for XM1, 6 for XM2, 6 for XM3 – if soequipped).

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-77

Page 238: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Choose the radio band AM, FM1 or FM2using the FM·AM select button, or choosethe satellite band XM1, XM2 or XM3 usingthe SAT button.

2. Tune to the desired station using manual,SEEK or SCAN tuning. Press and hold anyof the desired station memory buttons (1 –6) until the preset number is updated on thedisplay and the sound is briefly muted.

3. The channel indicator will then come on andthe sound will resume. Programming is nowcomplete.

4. Other buttons can be set in the same man-ner.

If the battery cable is disconnected, or if the fuseopens, the radio memory will be canceled. In thatcase, reset the desired stations.

List (AM and FM)

Select the “List” key using the NISSAN controlleror touchscreen to see a list of the presets in theAM, FM1 or FM2 preset banks.

Menu (XM, if so equipped)

Select the “Menu”key using the NISSAN control-ler or touchscreen to see a list of options:

● Preset List – Displays the list of presets.Press and hold the touchscreen or ENTERbutton on the NISSAN controller to save apreset.

● Customize Channel List – deselect chan-nels to skip while using the TUNE/FOLDERknob.

● Favorite Artist & Songs

– Tags the current artist or song playing onXM as a favorite.

– Turn the Alert ON to indicate whenever afavorite artist or song is playing on XM.The audio system must be playing XMradio for this feature to work.

– Delete a favorite artist or song.

● Categories – Displays a category list for XMradio. Select a category to select the firstchannel for that category.

● Direct Tune – Tune to a channel by enteringthe channel number.LHA1375

4-78 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 239: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Radio data system (RDS):

RDS stands for Radio Data System, and is a datainformation service transmitted by some radiostations on the FM band (not AM band). Cur-rently, most RDS stations are in large cities, butmany stations are now considering broadcastingRDS data.

RDS can display:

● Station call sign, such as “WHFR 98.3”.

● Station name, such as “The Groove”.

● Music or programming type such as “Clas-sical”, “Country”, or “Rock”.

● Station specific text.

If the station broadcasts RDS information, thetext information is automatically displayed.

Compact disc (CD) player operationPlace the ignition in the ACC or ON position andinsert the compact disc into the slot with the labelside facing up. The compact disc will be guidedautomatically into the slot and start playing.

If the radio is already operating, it will automati-cally turn off and the compact disc will play.

If the system has been turned off while the com-pact disc was playing, pressing theVOL/ON·OFF control knob will start the compactdisc.

DISC·AUX button:

When the DISC·AUX button is pressed with thesystem off and the compact disc loaded, thesystem will turn on and the compact disc will startto play.

When the DISC·AUX button is pressed with thecompact disc loaded but the radio playing, theradio will automatically be turned off and thecompact disc will start to play.

SEEK/CAT and TRACK

buttons:

When the SEEK/CAT button is pressedwhile a compact disc is playing, the track beingplayed returns to its beginning. Press severaltimes to skip back through tracks. The compactdisc will go back the number of times the buttonis pressed.

When the TRACK button is pressed whilethe compact disc is playing, the next track willstart to play from its beginning. Press severaltimes to skip through tracks. The compact discwill advance the number of times the button ispressed. (When the last track on the compactdisc is skipped through, the first track will beplayed.)

The NISSAN controller can also be used to se-lect tracks when a CD is being played.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-79

Page 240: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

SEEK/CAT and TRACK

(Rewind and Fast

Forward) buttons:

Press and hold the SEEK/CAT (rewind)button or the TRACK (fast forward) buttonwhile a compact disc is playing; the compact discwill play while rewinding or fast forwarding. Whenthe button is released, the compact disc willreturn to normal play speed.

TUNE/FOLDER knob

While playing a CD with compressed audio files,turn the TUNE/FOLDER knob right or left to playthe next or previous folder.

CD menu

Touch the “Menu” key on the display while a CDor CD with compressed audio files is playing tobring up a list of options. Depending on the typeof CD being played, the following options may beavailable:

● Play Mode

This option allows you to alter the play pattern ofthe CD. Touch the key of the mode you wish toapply. The modes change the play pattern asfollows:

1 Track Repeat - the current track is repeated.

1 Disc Random- tracks from the entire disc areplayed randomly.

1 Folder Repeat (compressed audio files CDonly) - the current folder is repeated.

1 Folder Random (compressed audio files CDonly) - tracks from the current folder are playedrandomly.

LHA1258 LHA1259

4-80 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 241: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Normal - Plays all tracks on the CD in sequentialorder until stopped.

● Folder List

The folders on the disc are displayed. Select thekey of a folder name to begin playing tracks fromthat folder.

● Track List

The tracks on the disc are displayed. Select thekey of a track name to begin playing that track.

LHA1262 LHA1260 LHA1261

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-81

Page 242: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Title Text Priority

● Record to Music Box, Automatic Recording,Recording Quality

For more information about these options, see“Music Box™ Hard-Drive Audio System withNavigation System” in this section.

CD EJECT button:

When the button is pressed with the com-pact disc loaded, the compact disc will beejected.

When the button is pressed while thecompact disc is being played, the compact discwill eject and the system will turn off.

AUX (auxiliary) input jacks

The auxiliary input jacks are located inside thecenter console �1 . NTSC compatible devicessuch as video games, camcorders and portablevideo players can be connected to the auxiliaryinput jacks. Audio devices, such as some MP3players, can also be connected to the systemthrough the auxiliary input jacks.

The auxiliary input jacks are color coded for iden-tification purposes:

● Red – right channel audio input

● White – left channel audio input

● Yellow – video input

LHA1267 LHA2031

4-82 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 243: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Before connecting a device to the auxiliary inputjacks, turn off the power of the portable device.

With a compatible device connected to the aux-iliary input jacks, press the DISC·AUX buttonrepeatedly until the AUX mode appears in thedisplay. The output from the device will be playedthrough the display (when the vehicle is in the (P)Park position and the parking brake engaged)and audio system.

AUX settings

Select the “Settings” key using the NISSAN con-troller.

The display mode can be set to Normal, Wide orCinema. The volume setting can be set to Low,Medium or High.

Additional featuresFor more information about the iPod� playeravailable with this system, see “iPod� player op-eration with Navigation System” in this section.

For more information about the USB interfaceavailable with this system, see “USB interface(models with Navigation System)” in this section.

For more information about the Music Box� fea-ture available with this system, see “Music Box�with Navigation System” in this section.

For more information about the Bluetooth�streaming audio feature available with this sys-tem, see “Bluetooth� streaming audio” in thissection.

WHA1393 LHA1394

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-83

Page 244: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

DIGITAL VERSATILE DISC (DVD)PLAYER OPERATION (models withNavigation System)

Precautions

Start the engine when using the DVD entertain-ment system.

Movies will not be shown on the front displaywhile the vehicle is in any drive position to reducedriver distraction. Audio is available when a movieis played. To view movies on the front display,stop the vehicle in a safe location, move the shiftselector to the P (Park) position and apply theparking brake.

WARNING

● The driver must not attempt to operatethe DVD system or wear the head-phones while the vehicle is in motion sothat full attention may be given to ve-hicle operation.

● Do not attempt to modify the system todisplay a movie on the front screenwhile the vehicle is being driven. Doingso may distract the driver and maycause a collision and serious personalinjury or death.

CAUTION

● Only operate the DVD while the vehicleengine is running. Operating the DVDfor extended periods of time with theengine OFF can discharge the vehiclebattery.

● Do not allow the system to get wet.Excessive moisture such as spilled liq-uids may cause the system tomalfunction.

● While playing VIDEO-CD media, thisDVD player does not guarantee com-plete functionality of all VIDEO-CDformats.

Playing a DVD

DISC-AUX button

Park the vehicle in a safe location for the frontseat occupants to operate the DVD drive whilewatching the images.

Press the DISC-AUX button until the DVD modeis active on the display.

When a DVD is loaded, it will be replayed auto-matically.

The operation screen will be turned on when theDISC-AUX button is pressed while a DVD isplaying. The operation screen will turn off auto-

LHA1376

4-84 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 245: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

matically after a period of time. To turn it on again,press the DISC-AUX button.

DVD operation keys

When the DVD is playing without the operationscreen being shown, you may use the touch-screen to select items from the displayed video.You may also use the NISSAN controller to selectan item from the displayed video. When the op-eration screen is being shown, use the NISSANcontroller or the touchscreen to select an itemfrom the displayed menus.

PAUSE:

Select the key to pause the DVD. To re-sume playing the DVD, use the key.

PLAY:

Select the key to start playing the DVD orresume playing the DVD after it has been paused.

STOP:

Select the key to stop playing the DVD.

NEXT/PREVIOUSCHAPTER:

Select the key to skip the chapter(s) of thedisc forward. Select the key to skip thechapter(s) of the disc backward. The chapterswill advance forward or backward the number oftimes the respective key is touched or selectedwith the NISSAN controller.

CM SKIP:

This function is only for DVD-VIDEO and DVD-

VR. Select the or key to fast forwardor rewind a set interval of time based on the CMsettings. For more information, see “DVD set-tings” in this section.

Top Menu:

When the “Top Menu” key is selected while theDVD is playing, the top menu specific to eachdisc will be displayed. For details, see the instruc-tions attached to the disc.

DVD settingsSelect the “Settings” key to adjust the followingsettings:

● Key (DVD-VIDEO)Displays the operation keys for the specificDVD menu.

– Select the directional keys to move thecursor on the DVD menu.

– Select the “Enter” key to fix the selectedmenu item.

– Select the “Move” key to move the loca-tion of the operation keys on the screen.

– Select the “Back” key to return to theprevious menu screen.

– Select the “Hide” key to hide the opera-tion keys.

● Title Menu (DVD-VIDEO)Some menus specific to each disc will beshown. For details, see the instructions at-tached to the disc.

● Title Search (DVD-VIDEO, DVD-VR)The scene with the specified title will bedisplayed the number of times the “+” or “-”side is selected.

● Group Search (VIDEO CD)The scene with the specified group will bedisplayed the number of times the “+” or “-”side is selected.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-85

Page 246: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● 10 Key Search (DVD-VIDEO, VIDEO CD,CD-DA, DVD-VR)Select the “10 Key Search” key to open thenumber entry screen. Input the number youwant to search for and select the “OK” key.The specified Title/Chapter or Group/Trackwill be played.

● Select No. (VIDEO CD)Select the “Select No.” key to open thenumber entry screen. Input the number youwant to search for and select the “OK” key.The specified scene will be played.

● Angle (DVD-VIDEO)If the DVD contains different angles (such asmoving images), the current image anglecan be switched to another one. Select the“Angle” key and use the “+” or “-” key tochange the angle.

● Angle Mark (DVD-VIDEO)When this item is turned on, an angle markwill be shown on the bottom of the screen ifthe scene can be seen from a different angle.

● Menu Skip (DVD-VIDEO)DVD menus are automatically configuredand the contents will be played directlywhen the “Menu Skip” key is turned on. Notethat some discs may not be played directlyeven if this item is turned on.

● CM Skip (DVD-VIDEO)Select the “CM Skip” key to choose thesetting time for CM backward and forwardoperations. Use the “+” or “-” key to choosea setting time of 15, 30 or 60 seconds.

● DRC (DVD-VIDEO, DVD-VR)DRC (Dynamic Range Compression) auto-matically adjusts the soundtrack volumelevel to maintain a more even sound to thespeakers.

● DVD Language (DVD-VIDEO, VIDEO CD)Select the “DVD Language” key to open thenumber entry screen. Input the number cor-responding to the preferred language andselect the “OK” key. The DVD top menulanguage will be changed to the one speci-fied.

● DisplayAdjust the image quality of the screen byselecting the preferred adjustment items.

● AudioChoose the preferred language for the au-dio.

● Subtitle (DVD-VIDEO, DVD-VR)Choose the preferred language for the sub-titles.

● Display Mode (DVD-VIDEO, VIDEO CD,DVD-VR)Choose from the “Full”, “Wide”, “Normal” or“Cinema” mode.

● Title List (DVD-VR)Choose the preferred title from the list.

● Play ModeChoose the preferred play mode.

● PG/PL Mode (DVD-VR)Choose from the “PG” or “PL” mode.

4-86 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 247: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

USB INTERFACE (models withoutNavigation System) (if so equipped)

Connecting a device to the USB inputjack

The USB input jack is located in the center con-sole. Insert the USB device into the jack �1 .

When a compatible storage device is pluggedinto the jack, compatible audio files on the stor-age device can be played through the vehicle’saudio system.

Audio file operation

AUX button:

Place the ignition switch in the ON or ACCposition and press the AUX button to switch tothe USB input mode. If another audio source isplaying and a USB memory device is inserted,press the AUX button repeatedly until the centerdisplay changes to the USB memory mode.

If the system has been turned off while the USBmemory was playing, push the ON-OFF/VOLcontrol knob to restart the USB memory.

SEEK/CAT and TRACK

(Reverse or Fast Forward)

buttons:

Press and hold the SEEK/CAT (rewind)button or TRACK (fast forward) button for1.5 seconds while an audio file on the USBdevice is playing to reverse or fast forward thetrack being played. The track plays at an in-creased speed while reversing or fast forwarding.When the button is released, the audio file re-turns to normal play speed.

SEEK/CAT and TRACK

buttons:

Press the SEEK/CAT button while an au-dio file on the USB device is playing to return tothe beginning of the current track. Press theSEEK/CAT button several times to skipbackward several tracks.

Press the TRACK button while an audiofile on the USB device is playing to advance onetrack. Press the TRACK button severaltimes to skip forward several tracks. If the lasttrack in a folder on the USB device is skipped, thefirst track of the next folder is played.

Folder selection:

To change to another folder in the USB memory,turn the TUNE/FOLDER knob or choose a folderdisplayed on the screen using the NISSAN con-troller.

RPT/RDM button:

When the RPT/RDM button is pressed while theUSB memory is playing, the play pattern can bechanged as follows:

Repeat All → 1 Folder Repeat → 1 Track Repeat→ All Random → 1 Folder Random → Repeat All

LHA2030

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-87

Page 248: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

USB INTERFACE (models withNavigation System)

Connecting a device to the USB inputjackThe USB input jack is located in the center con-sole. Insert the USB device into the jack �1 .

When a compatible storage device is pluggedinto the jack, compatible audio and video files onthe storage device can be played through thevehicle’s audio system and center display screen.

When there are both audio and movie files in theUSB memory, the mode select screen is dis-played. Use the touchscreen or the NISSAN con-troller to select the preferred type of file. Whenthere is only type of file in the USB memory, thataudio or movie operation screen is displayed andstarts to play.

When you play a file with limited playing time, theconfirmation screen will be displayed beforestarting to play the file. Confirm the playing timeand select “yes” to start playing.

Audio file operationDISC-AUX button:

Place the ignition switch in the ON or ACCposition and press the DISC-AUX button toswitch to the USB input mode. If another audiosource is playing and a USB memory device isinserted, press the DISC-AUX button repeatedlyuntil the center display changes to the USBmemory mode.

If the system has been turned off while the USBmemory was playing, push the ON-OFF/VOLcontrol knob to restart the USB memory.

LHA2030 LHA1378

4-88 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 249: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

SEEK/CAT and TRACK

(Reverse or Fast Forward)

buttons:

Press and hold the SEEK/CAT (rewind)button or TRACK (fast forward) button for1.5 seconds while an audio file on the USBdevice is playing to reverse or fast forward thetrack being played. The track plays at an in-creased speed while reversing or fast forwarding.When the button is released, the audio file re-turns to normal play speed.

SEEK/CAT and TRACK

buttons:

Press the SEEK/CAT button while an au-dio file on the USB device is playing to return tothe beginning of the current track. Press theSEEK/CAT button several times to skipbackward several tracks.

Press the TRACK button while an audiofile on the USB device is playing to advance onetrack. Press the TRACK button severaltimes to skip forward several tracks. If the lasttrack in a folder on the USB device is skipped, thefirst track of the next folder is played.

Folder selection:

To change to another folder in the USB memory,turn the TUNE/FOLDER knob or choose a folderdisplayed on the screen using the NISSAN con-troller.

RPT/RDM button:

When the RPT/RDM button is pressed while theUSB memory is playing, the play pattern can bechanged as follows:

Normal → 1 Folder Repeat → 1 Track Repeat →All Random → 1 Folder Random → Normal

Menu:

There are some options available during play-back. Select one of the following that are dis-played on the screen, if necessary. Refer to thefollowing information for each item.

● Movie PlaybackSwitch to the movie playback mode. Thisitem is displayed only when the USBmemory contains movie files.The shift selector must be in Park (P) withthe parking brake engaged to watch moviesfrom a USB device.

LHA1294

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-89

Page 250: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Folder List/Track ListDisplays the folder or track list. The “MoviePlayback” key is also displayed in this listscreen and enables you to switch to themovie playback mode.

● Play ModeChoose the preferred play mode using theNISSAN controller or the touchscreen.

Movie file operation

Park the vehicle in a safe location for thefront seat occupants to operate the USBmemory while watching the images.

DISC-AUX button:

When the DISC-AUX button is pushed with thesystem off and the USB memory inserted, thesystem will turn on. If another audio source isplaying and the USB memory is inserted, pressthe DISC-AUX button repeatedly until the centerdisplay changes to the USB memory mode.

Operation keys:

To operate the USB memory, select the desiredkey displayed on the display screen.

● Pause:

Select the key to pause the movie file.To resume playing the movie file, usethe key.

● Play:

Select the key to start playing themovie file or resume the movie file if it hasbeen paused.

● Stop:

Select the key to stop playing themovie file.

● Next Chapter/Fast Forward:

Select the key to skip the chapter(s)of the disc forward. The chapters will ad-vance the number of times the key is se-lected. Press and hold the key to fast for-ward the chapter.

LHA1379

4-90 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 251: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Previous Chapter/Rewind:

Select the key to skip the chapter(s)of the disc backward. The chapters will goback the number of times the key is selected.Press and hold the key to rewind the chap-ter.

List:

Select the “List” key on the movie file operationscreen to display the file list.

Settings:

Select the “Settings” key to adjust the followingsettings:

● Audio File PlaybackSwitch to the audio playback mode. Thisitem is displayed only when the USBmemory contains audio files.

● Play ModeChoose between the “Normal” or “1 TrackRepeat” play modes.

● 10 Key SearchSelect the “10 Key Search” key to open thenumber entry screen. Input the number youwant to search for and the specified file orfolder will be played.

● DisplayAdjust the image quality of the screen.

● DRCDRC (Dynamic Range Compression) auto-matically adjusts the soundtrack volumelevel to maintain a more even sound to thespeakers.

● AudioChoose the preferred language of the audio.

● SubtitleChoose the preferred language of the sub-titles.

● Display ModeChoose between the “Normal”, “Wide”,“Cinema” or “Full” display modes.

LHA1380

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-91

Page 252: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

iPod�* PLAYER OPERATIONWITHOUT NAVIGATION SYSTEM (ifso equipped)

Connecting iPod�

To connect an iPod� to the vehicle so that theiPod� can be controlled with the audio systemcontrols and display screen, use the USB jacklocated in the center console. Connect theiPod�-specific end of the cable to the iPod� andthe USB end of the cable to the USB jack on thevehicle �1 . If your iPod� supports charging via aUSB connection, its battery will be charged whileconnected to the vehicle with the ignition switchin the ACC or ON position.

While connected to the vehicle, the iPod� canonly be operated by the vehicle audio controls.

To disconnect the iPod� from the vehicle, removethe USB end of the cable from the USB jack onthe vehicle, then remove the cable from theiPod�.

* iPod� is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered inthe U.S. and other countries.

CompatibilityThe following models are compatible:

● iPod� 5th Generation - version 1.2.1

● iPod� Classic - version 1.1

● iPod� Touch - version 2.1.0

● iPod� Nano - 1st generation version 1.3.1

● iPod� Nano - 2nd generation version 1.1.3

● iPod� Nano - 3rd generation version 1.0.2

Make sure that your iPod� firmware is updated tothe version indicated above.

Audio main operationPlace the ignition switch in the ACC or ONposition. Press the AUX button repeatedly toswitch to the iPod� mode.

If the system has been turned off while the iPod�was playing, pressing the VOL/ON·OFF controlknob will start the iPod�.

AUX button:When the AUX button is pressed with the systemoff and the iPod� connected, the system will turnon. If another audio source is playing and theiPod� is connected, press the AUX button re-peatedly until the center display changes to theiPod� mode.

LHA2030 LHA1395

4-92 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 253: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Interface:

The interface for iPod� operation shown on thevehicle center display is similar to the iPod� in-terface. Use the NISSAN controller and theBACK button to play the iPod� with your favoritesettings.

The following items can be chosen from the menulist screen. For further information about eachitem, see the iPod� Owner’s Manual.

● Playlists

● Podcasts

● Songs

● Albums

● Artists

● Genres

● Composers

● Audiobooks

The following keys shown on the screen are alsoavailable:

● MENU: returns to the previous screen.

● : plays/pauses the music selected.

SEEK/CAT and TRACK buttons:

When the SEEK/CAT button orTRACK button is pressed for less than 1.5 sec-onds while the iPod� is playing, the next track orthe beginning of the current track on the iPod�will be played.

When the SEEK/CAT button orTRACK button is pressed for more than 1.5 sec-onds while the iPod� is playing, the iPod� willplay while fast forwarding or rewinding. When thebutton is released, the iPod� will return to thenormal play speed.

iPod�* PLAYER OPERATION WITHNAVIGATION SYSTEM (if soequipped)

Connecting iPod�

To connect an iPod� to the vehicle so that theiPod� can be controlled with the audio systemcontrols and display screen, use the USB jacklocated in the center console. Connect theiPod�-specific end of the cable to the iPod� andthe USB end of the cable to the USB jack on thevehicle �1 . If your iPod� supports charging via aUSB connection, its battery will be charged whileconnected to the vehicle with the ignition switchin the ACC or ON position.

LHA1396 LHA2030

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-93

Page 254: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

While connected to the vehicle, the iPod� canonly be operated by the vehicle audio controls.

To disconnect the iPod� from the vehicle, removethe USB end of the cable from the USB jack onthe vehicle, then remove the cable from theiPod�.

* iPod� is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered inthe U.S. and other countries.

CompatibilityThe following models are compatible:

● iPod� 5th Generation version 1.2.3

● iPod� Classic - version 1.1.1

● iPod� Touch - version 2.0.0*

● iPod� Nano - 1st generation version 1.3.1

● iPod� Nano - 2nd generation version 1.1.3

● iPod� Nano - 3rd generation version 1.1.3

● iPod� Nano - 4th generation version 1.0.4

● iPod� Nano - 5th generation version 1.0.1

* Some features of this iPod� may not be fullyfunctional.

Make sure that your iPod� firmware is updated tothe version indicated above.

Audio main operationPlace the ignition switch in the ACC or ONposition. Press the DISC·AUX button repeatedlyto switch to the iPod� mode.

If the system has been turned off while the iPod�was playing, pressing the VOL/ON·OFF controlknob will start the iPod�.

DISC·AUX button:

When the DISC·AUX button is pressed with thesystem off and the iPod� connected, the systemwill turn on. If another audio source is playing andthe iPod� is connected, press the DISC·AUXbutton repeatedly until the center displaychanges to the iPod� mode.

LHA1397

4-94 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 255: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Interface:

The interface for iPod� operation shown on thevehicle center display is similar to the iPod� in-terface. Use the NISSAN controller and theBACK button to play the iPod� with your favoritesettings. The touchscreen can also be used tocontrol your favorite settings.

The following items can be chosen from the menulist screen. For further information about eachitem, see the iPod� Owner’s Manual.

● Now Playing

● Playlists

● Artists

● Albums

● Songs

● Podcasts

● Genres

● Composers

● Audiobooks

● Shuffle Songs

The following keys shown on the screen are alsoavailable:

● MENU: returns to the previous screen.

● : plays/pauses the music selected.Play mode:

While the iPod� is playing, touch the “Menu” keyto display the iPod� menu. Touch the “PlayMode” key to display the Play Mode screen andadjust the settings for Shuffle, Repeat and Audio-books. For further information about each item,see the iPod� Owner’s Manual.

SEEK/CAT and TRACK buttons:

When the SEEK/CAT button orTRACK button is pressed for less than 1.5 sec-onds while the iPod� is playing, the next track orthe beginning of the current track on the iPod�will be played.

LHA1398 LHA1315

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-95

Page 256: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

When the SEEK/CAT button orTRACK button is pressed for more than 1.5 sec-onds while the iPod� is playing, the iPod� willplay while fast forwarding or rewinding. When thebutton is released, the iPod� will return to thenormal play speed.

The NISSAN controller can also be used to se-lect tracks when the iPod� is playing.

Scrolling menus:

While navigating long lists of artists, albums orsongs in the music menu, it is possible to scrollthe list by the first letter. To activate letter index-ing, perform one of the following:

● Turn the NISSAN controller quickly.

● Press and hold the up/down directional ar-rows on the NISSAN controller.

● Touch and hold the page up/down arrowson the touchscreen.

To exit the scrolling by letter mode, perform one ofthe following:

● Press the ENTER button on the NISSANcontroller.

● Push the ENTER switch on the steeringwheel.

● Do not touch the controls for 2 seconds.

MUSIC BOX� WITHOUTNAVIGATION SYSTEM (if soequipped)The Music Box system can store songs from CDsbeing played. The system has an 800 megabyte(MB) storage capacity.

The following CDs can be recorded in the MusicBox system:

● CDs without MP3/WMA files.

● Hybrid Compact Disc Digital Audio (HybridCD-DA) specification in Super Audio CDs.

● Compact Disc Digital Audio (CD-DA) speci-fication in CD-Extras.

● First session of multisession disc.

LHA1399

4-96 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 257: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Extreme temperature conditions [below �4°F(�20°C) and above 158°F (70°C)] could affectthe performance of the hard drive.

NOTE:

If the hard drive needs to be replaced dueto a malfunction, all stored music data willbe erased.

Recording CDs

1. Operate the audio system to play a CD.For information on playing CDs, see “Com-pact Disc (CD) player operation” in this sec-tion.

2. Select the “REC” key with the NISSAN con-troller. “REC Track” appears on the screen.

NOTE:

● The system starts playing and recording the1st track on the CD when the “REC” key isselected.

● The recording process can be stopped atany time. All tracks that were played beforethe CD was stopped are stored.

● Individual tracks can be deleted from theMusic Box after the CD is recorded.

If the title information of the track being recordedis stored either in the hard drive or in the CD, thetitle is automatically displayed on the screen. Fortitle acquisition from the hard-disk drive, musicrecognition technology and related data are pro-vided by Gracenote�.

If a track is not recorded successfully due toskipping sounds, the symbol is displayedbehind the track number.

WHA1368 WHA0956

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-97

Page 258: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

The Music Box audio system cannot performrecording under the following conditions:

● There is not enough space in the Music Box.

● The number of albums reaches the maximumof 99.

● The number of tracks reaches the maximumof 2,000.

Automatic recording:

If the “Automatic Recording” function is turned toON, recording starts when a CD is inserted andany previous CD “converting” is finished. Formore information, see “Music Box settings” in thissection.

Stopping recording:

To stop the recording, select the “Stop REC” keyon the screen. If the CD is ejected, the audiosystem is turned off or the ignition switch isplaced in the OFF position, the recording alsostops.

Playing recorded songsSelect the Music Box audio system by using oneof the following methods:

● Press the SOURCE select switch on thesteering wheel.For information, see “Steering wheel switchfor audio control” in this section.

● Press the DISC button repeatedly until thecenter display changes to the Music Boxmode.

Stopping playback:

The system stops playing when:

● Another mode (radio, CD, USB memory,iPod� or AUX) is selected.

● The audio system is turned off.

● The ignition switch is placed in the OFFposition.

SEEK/CAT and TRACK buttons:

Press the SEEK/CAT button while a trackis playing to return to the beginning of the currenttrack. Press the TRACK button while atrack is playing to skip to the beginning of the nexttrack.

If you press and hold the SEEK/CAT (re-wind) button or the TRACK (fast forward)button for more than approximately 1.5 seconds;the track will play while rewinding or fast forward-ing. When the SEEK/CAT (rewind) buttonor the TRACK (fast forward) button is re-leased, the track will return to the normal playingspeed.

The NISSAN controller can also be used to se-lect tracks.

WHA1369

4-98 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 259: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

For more information on how to use the NISSANcontroller, see “How to use the NISSAN control-ler” in this section.

Play mode selection:

To change to another album or artist, turn theTUNE/FOLDER knob.

RPT/RDM button:

Press the RPT/RDM button while a track is play-ing to change the play pattern as follows:

Repeat All → 1 Folder Repeat → 1 Track Repeat→ All Random→ 1 Folder Random → Repeat All

Music Box menu

There are some options available during play-back. Select the “Menu” key, then select one ofthe following that are displayed on the screen, ifnecessary. Refer to the following information foreach item:

● Music LibraryThere are some options available duringplayback. Select one of the following op-tions that are displayed on the screen, ifnecessary.

● AlbumsPlay tracks in each album. The albums arestored in alphabetical order.

● ArtistsPlay tracks by an artist whose music is cur-rently being played. The artists are stored inalphabetical order.

● GenresPlay tracks by genre by selecting from thedisplayed list.

● All SongsPlay tracks from all recorded tracks. Thetracks are stored in alphabetical order.

WHA1370 WHA1371

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-99

Page 260: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Transfer Titles from USBUpdate the in-vehicle Gracenote� Databaseusing a USB memory device. Search the titlefrom information acquired on the Internet.Visit www.nissanusa.com/gracenote/ fordetails.

● Transfer Missing Titles to USBTransfer the information of an album re-corded without titles to the USB memory.Visit www.nissanusa.com/gracenote/ fordetails.

● Update Missing TitlesSearch the title using the database in thehard-disk.

Music Box settings

To set up the Music Box system to your preferredsettings, select the “Menu” key with the NISSANcontroller during playback. Then select the “Mu-sic Box Settings” key with the NISSAN controller.

● Music Box Used/Free Space:Information about “Saved Album”, “SavedTrack” and “Remaining Time” is displayed.

● Delete Songs from the Music Box:Delete the current song, selected songs oralbums by choosing from the list, or allsongs/albums in the Music Box.

● Automatic Recording:When this item is turned to ON, the MusicBox system automatically starts recordingwhen a CD is inserted.

● Recording Quality:Set the recording quality of 105 kbps or 132kbps. The default is set to 105 kbps.

● Gracenote Database Version:The version of the built-in Gracenote� Data-base is displayed.

Gracenote�

NOTE:

● The information contained in theGracenote� Database is not fully guaran-teed.

● The service of the Gracenote� Database onthe Internet may be stopped without priornotice for maintenance.

WHA1372 WHA1373

4-100 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 261: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

End-User License Agreement

USE OF THIS PRODUCT IMPLIES ACCEP-TANCE OF THE TERMS BELOW.

Gracenote� MusicID™ Terms of Use

This device contains software from Gracenote,Inc. of Emeryville, California (“Gracenote”). Thesoftware from Gracenote (the “Gracenote Soft-ware”) enables this application to do online discidentification and obtain music-related informa-tion, including name, artist, track, and title infor-mation (“Gracenote Data”) from online servers(“Gracenote Servers”) and to perform other func-tions. You may use Gracenote Data only bymeans of the intended End-User functions of thisdevice.

You agree that you will use Gracenote Data, theGracenote Software, and Gracenote Servers foryour own personal non-commercial use only. Youagree not to assign, copy, transfer or transmit theGracenote Software or any Gracenote Data toany third party. YOU AGREE NOT TO USE OREXPLOIT GRACENOTE DATA, THEGRACENOTE SOFTWARE, OR GRACENOTESERVERS, EXCEPT AS EXPRESSLY PERMIT-TED HEREIN.

You agree that your non-exclusive license to usethe Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software,

and Gracenote Servers will terminate if you vio-late these restrictions. If your license terminates,you agree to cease any and all use of theGracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, andGracenote Servers. Gracenote reserves all rightsin Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, andthe Gracenote Servers, including all ownershiprights. Under no circumstances will Gracenotebecome liable for any payment to you for anyinformation that you provide. You agree thatGracenote, Inc. may enforce its rights under thisAgreement against you directly in its own name.

The Gracenote MusicID Service uses a uniqueidentifier to track queries for statistical purposes.The purpose of a randomly assigned numericidentifier is to allow the Gracenote MusicID ser-vice to count queries without knowing anythingabout who you are. For more information, see theweb page for the Gracenote Privacy Policy forthe Gracenote MusicID Service.

The Gracenote Software and each item ofGracenote Data are licensed to you “AS IS.”Gracenote makes no representations or warran-ties, express or implied, regarding the accuracyof any Gracenote Data from in the GracenoteServers. Gracenote reserves the right to deletedata from the Gracenote Servers or to changedata categories for any cause that Gracenotedeems sufficient. No warranty is made that theGracenote Software or Gracenote Servers are

error-free or that functioning of Gracenote Soft-ware or Gracenote Servers will be uninterrupted.Gracenote is not obligated to provide you withnew enhanced or additional data types or cat-egories that Gracenote may provide in the futureand is free to discontinue its online services atany time.

GRACENOTE DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIESEXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOTLIMITED TO, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MER-CHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULARPURPOSE, TITLE, AND NONINFRINGEMENT.GRACENOTE DOES NOT WARRANT THE RE-SULTS THAT WILL BE OBTAINED BY YOURUSE OF THE GRACENOTE SOFTWARE ORANY GRACENOTE SERVER. IN NO CASEWILL GRACENOTE BE LIABLE FOR ANYCONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAM-AGES OR FOR ANY LOST PROFITS OR LOSTREVENUES.

Copyright:

Music recognition technology and related dataare provided by Gracenote�. Gracenote is theindustry standard in music recognition technol-ogy and related content delivery. For more infor-mation visit www.gracenote.com.

CD and music-related data from Gracenote, Inc.,copyright © 2000-2007 Gracenote. GracenoteSoftware, copyright © 2000-2007 Gracenote.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-101

Page 262: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

This product and service may practice one ormore of the following U.S. Patents: #5,987,525;#6,061,680; #6,154,773, #6,161,132,#6,230,192, #6,230,207, #6,240,459,#6,330,593, and other patents issued or pend-ing. Some services supplied under license fromOpen Globe, Inc. for U.S. Patent: #6,304,523.Gracenote and CDDB are registered trademarksof Gracenote. The Gracenote logo and logotype,and the “Powered by Gracenote” logo are trade-marks of Gracenote.

MUSIC BOX� WITH NAVIGATIONSYSTEM (if so equipped)

The Music Box system can store songs from CDsbeing played. The system has a 9.3 gigabyte(GB) storage capacity.

The following CDs can be recorded in the MusicBox system:

● CDs without compressed audio files.

● Hybrid Compact Disc Digital Audio (HybridCD-DA) specification in Super Audio CDs.

● Compact Disc Digital Audio (CD-DA) speci-fication in CD-Extras.

● First session of multisession disc.

Extreme temperature conditions [below �4°F(�20°C) and above 158°F (70°C)] could affectthe performance of the hard drive.

NOTE:

If the hard drive needs to be replaced dueto a malfunction, all stored music data willbe erased.

Recording CDs

1. Operate the audio system to play a CD.For information on playing CDs, see “Com-pact Disc (CD) player operation” in this sec-tion.

2. Touch the “Start REC” key. REC CD ap-pears on the screen.

NOTE:

● The system starts playing and recording the1st track on the CD when the “Start REC”key is selected.

LHA1263

4-102 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 263: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Individual tracks from a CD cannot be se-lected to be recorded to the Music Box harddrive.

● The fast forward and rewind features aredisabled while the CD is recording.

● The recording process can be stopped atany time. All tracks that were played beforethe CD was stopped are stored.

● Individual tracks can be deleted from thehard drive after the CD is recorded.

● The system records faster than it plays.

If the title information of the track being recordedis stored either in the hard drive or in the CD, thetitle is automatically displayed on the screen. Fortitle acquisition from the hard drive, music recog-nition technology and related data are providedby Gracenote�.

To view the details of the track, touch the “Text”key on the screen or use the NISSAN controller.The track name and album title are displayed onthe screen.

If a track is not recorded successfully due toskipping sounds, the symbol is displayedbehind the track number.

The Music Box audio system cannot performrecording under the following conditions:

● There is not enough space in the hard drive.

● The number of albums reaches the maximumof 500.

● The number of tracks reaches the maximumof 3,000.

Automatic recording:

If the “Automatic Recording” function is turned toON, recording starts when a CD is inserted. Formore information, see “Music Box settings” in thissection.

Stopping recording:

To stop the recording, touch the “Stop REC” keyon the screen. If the CD is ejected, the audiosystem is turned off or the ignition switch isplaced in the OFF position, the recording alsostops.

LHA1282

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-103

Page 264: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Playing recorded songsSelect the Music Box audio system by using oneof the following methods:

● Press the SOURCE select switch on thesteering wheel.For information, see “Steering wheel switchfor audio control” in this section.

● Press the DISC·AUX button repeatedly untilthe center display changes to the Music Boxmode.

● Give voice commands.For information, see “NISSAN Voice Recog-nition system” in this section.

Stopping playback:

The system stops playing when:

● Another mode (radio, CD, USB, Bluetooth�Audio or AUX) is selected.

● The audio system is turned off.

● The ignition switch is placed in the OFFposition.

SEEK/CAT and TRACK buttons:

Press the SEEK/CAT button while a trackis playing to return to the beginning of the currenttrack. Press the TRACK button while atrack is playing to skip to the beginning of the nexttrack.

If you press and hold the SEEK/CAT (re-wind) button or the TRACK (fast forward)button for more than approximately 1.5 seconds;the track will play while rewinding or fast forward-ing. When the SEEK/CAT (rewind) buttonor the TRACK (fast forward) button is re-leased, the track will return to the normal playingspeed.

The NISSAN controller can also be used to se-lect tracks.

For more information on how to use the NISSANcontroller, see “How to use the NISSAN control-ler” in this section.

TUNE/FOLDER knob:

The TUNE/FOLDER knob skips from album toalbum unless it is playing “All Songs” from theMusic Library menu. When playing “All Songs”,the TUNE/FOLDER knob changes the track in-stead of the album. The upper right corner of thescreen indicates if the TUNE/FOLDER knob ischanging by track or album.

LHA1283

4-104 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 265: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Music Box menu

There are some options available during play-back. Select the “Menu” key, then select one ofthe following that are displayed on the screen, ifnecessary. Refer to the following information foreach item:

● Now PlayingLists the tracks stored in the Music Boxsystem. Touch the name of the track to beginplaying that track.

● Music LibraryLists the songs in the Music Library. Trackscan be searched by Album, Artist or Genre.

LHA1284 LHA1285 LHA1286

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-105

Page 266: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● My PlaylistsDisplays the playlists stored in the system.Touch the “Edit” key next to a playlist toperform the following operations for thatplaylist:

– Add Current Song - adds the song cur-rently playing to the playlist.

– Add Songs by Album - adds songs to theplaylist by album.

– Add Songs by Artist - adds songs to theplaylist by artist.

– Edit Song Order - edits the order of thesongs in the playlist.

– Edit Name - changes the name of theplaylist.

– Delete Songs - deletes songs from theplaylist.

● Play ModeAlters the play mode of the playlist. Touchthe key of the mode you wish to apply. Themodes change the play pattern as follows:

– Normal - no play pattern is applied.

– 1 Album Repeat - the songs in the currentalbum are repeated.

– 1 Track Repeat - the current track is re-peated.

– 1 Album Random - the songs in the cur-rent album are played randomly.

– All Random - all songs are played ran-domly.

LHA1287 LHA1288

4-106 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 267: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Edit Music InformationEdits the information of the songs in theMusic Library.

– Edit Information of Current Song

– Edit Information by Album

– Update Gracenote from USB Device

– Transfer Missing Titles to USB

– Update Gracenote from HDD

The “Transfer Missing Titles to USB” and “Up-date Gracenote from HDD” options can be usedto update the titles of songs in the Music Library.Visit www.nissanusa.com/gracenote for detailedinstructions on how to update the Gracenotedatabase.

Music Box settingsTo set up the Music Box system to your preferredsettings, touch the “Menu” key during playback,then touch the “Music Box Settings” key.

● Music Box Used/Free Space:Displays the number of tracks and albumsstored on the hard drive. The percentage ofhard drive space taken up and the amount ofremaining recording time left are also shown.

● Automatic Recording:When this item is turned to ON, the MusicBox system automatically starts recordingwhen a CD is inserted.

LHA1289 LHA1290

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-107

Page 268: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Delete Songs from Music Box:Delete music data stored on the hard drive.

● Recording Quality:Set the recording quality of 105 kbps or 132kbps. The default is set to 132 kbps.

● CDDB Version:Shows the version of CDDB (Compact DiscData Base).

Gracenote�

NOTE:

● The information contained in theGracenote� Database is not fully guaran-teed.

● The service of the Gracenote� Database onthe Internet may be stopped without priornotice for maintenance.

End-User License Agreement

USE OF THIS PRODUCT IMPLIES ACCEP-TANCE OF THE TERMS BELOW.

Gracenote� MusicID™ Terms of Use

This device contains software from Gracenote,Inc. of Emeryville, California (“Gracenote”). Thesoftware from Gracenote (the “Gracenote Soft-ware”) enables this application to do online discidentification and obtain music-related informa-tion, including name, artist, track, and title infor-mation (“Gracenote Data”) from online servers(“Gracenote Servers”) and to perform other func-tions. You may use Gracenote Data only bymeans of the intended End-User functions of thisdevice.

You agree that you will use Gracenote Data, theGracenote Software, and Gracenote Servers foryour own personal non-commercial use only. Youagree not to assign, copy, transfer or transmit theGracenote Software or any Gracenote Data toany third party. YOU AGREE NOT TO USE OREXPLOIT GRACENOTE DATA, THEGRACENOTE SOFTWARE, OR GRACENOTESERVERS, EXCEPT AS EXPRESSLY PERMIT-TED HEREIN.

LHA1291 LHA1292

4-108 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 269: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

You agree that your non-exclusive license to usethe Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software,and Gracenote Servers will terminate if you vio-late these restrictions. If your license terminates,you agree to cease any and all use of theGracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, andGracenote Servers. Gracenote reserves all rightsin Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, andthe Gracenote Servers, including all ownershiprights. Under no circumstances will Gracenotebecome liable for any payment to you for anyinformation that you provide. You agree thatGracenote, Inc. may enforce its rights under thisAgreement against you directly in its own name.

The Gracenote MusicID Service uses a uniqueidentifier to track queries for statistical purposes.The purpose of a randomly assigned numericidentifier is to allow the Gracenote MusicID ser-vice to count queries without knowing anythingabout who you are. For more information, see theweb page for the Gracenote Privacy Policy forthe Gracenote MusicID Service.

The Gracenote Software and each item ofGracenote Data are licensed to you “AS IS.”Gracenote makes no representations or warran-ties, express or implied, regarding the accuracyof any Gracenote Data from in the GracenoteServers. Gracenote reserves the right to deletedata from the Gracenote Servers or to changedata categories for any cause that Gracenote

deems sufficient. No warranty is made that theGracenote Software or Gracenote Servers areerror-free or that functioning of Gracenote Soft-ware or Gracenote Servers will be uninterrupted.Gracenote is not obligated to provide you withnew enhanced or additional data types or cat-egories that Gracenote may provide in the futureand is free to discontinue its online services atany time.

GRACENOTE DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIESEXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOTLIMITED TO, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MER-CHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULARPURPOSE, TITLE, AND NONINFRINGEMENT.GRACENOTE DOES NOT WARRANT THE RE-SULTS THAT WILL BE OBTAINED BY YOURUSE OF THE GRACENOTE SOFTWARE ORANY GRACENOTE SERVER. IN NO CASEWILL GRACENOTE BE LIABLE FOR ANYCONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAM-AGES OR FOR ANY LOST PROFITS OR LOSTREVENUES.

Copyright:

Music recognition technology and related dataare provided by Gracenote�. Gracenote is theindustry standard in music recognition technol-ogy and related content delivery. For more infor-mation visit www.gracenote.com.

CD and music-related data from Gracenote, Inc.,copyright © 2000-2007 Gracenote. GracenoteSoftware, copyright © 2000-2007 Gracenote.This product and service may practice one ormore of the following U.S. Patents: #5,987,525;#6,061,680; #6,154,773, #6,161,132,#6,230,192, #6,230,207, #6,240,459,#6,330,593, and other patents issued or pend-ing. Some services supplied under license fromOpen Globe, Inc. for U.S. Patent: #6,304,523.Gracenote and CDDB are registered trademarksof Gracenote. The Gracenote logo and logotype,and the “Powered by Gracenote” logo are trade-marks of Gracenote.

BLUETOOTH� STREAMING AUDIO(if so equipped)If you have a compatible Bluetooth� audio devicethat is capable of playing audio files, the devicecan be connected to the vehicle’s audio systemso that the audio files on the device play throughthe vehicle’s speakers.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-109

Page 270: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Connecting Bluetooth� audioTo connect your Bluetooth� audio device to thevehicle, follow the procedure below:

1. Press the SETTING button on the instru-ment panel.

2. Select the “Bluetooth” key.

3. Select the “Connect Bluetooth” key.

4. A screen will appear asking if you are con-necting the device to use with the hands-free phone system. Select the “No” key.

5. Enter a PIN of your choice. It will be neededby your Bluetooth� audio device to com-plete the connection process. See theBluetooth� audio device’s owner’s manualfor more information.

LHA1316 LHA1317 LHA1351

4-110 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 271: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Audio main operationTo switch to the Bluetooth� audio mode, pressthe DISC-AUX button repeatedly until theBluetooth� audio mode is displayed on thescreen.

The controls for the Bluetooth� audio are dis-played on the screen.

Bluetooth� audio settingsTo adjust the Bluetooth� audio settings, followthe procedure below:

1. Press the SETTING button on the instru-ment panel.

2. Select the “Bluetooth” key.

3. Select the “Connected Devices” key.

4. Select the “Audio Player” key.LHA1299 LHA1316 LHA1296

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-111

Page 272: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

5. A list of the connected Bluetooth� audioplayers is displayed. Select the name of thedevice you wish to edit.

6. The Device Name and Device Address aredisplayed on the screen. Select the “Select”key to make this device the activeBluetooth� audio player. Select the “Edit”key to edit the details of the player, such asDevice Name. Select the “Delete” key todelete the device.

CD CARE AND CLEANING

● Handle a CD by its edges. Do not bend thedisc. Never touch the surface of the disc.

● Always place the discs in the storage casewhen they are not being used.

● To clean a disc, wipe the surface from thecenter to the outer edge using a clean, softcloth. Do not wipe the disc using a circularmotion.

● Do not use a conventional record cleaner oralcohol intended for industrial use.

LHA1297 LHA1298 LHA0049

4-112 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 273: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● A new disc may be rough on the inner andouter edges. Remove the rough edges byrubbing the inner and outer edges with theside of a pen or pencil as illustrated.

1. Power on and SOURCE select switch2. Tuning switch3. Volume control switch

1. Power on and SOURCE select switch2. Menu control switch/ENTER button3. Volume control switch

STEERING WHEEL SWITCH FORAUDIO CONTROL

The audio system can be operated using thecontrols on the steering wheel.

POWER on switch

With the ignition switch in the ACC or ON posi-tion, push the SOURCE switch to turn the audiosystem on.

Type ALHA1144

Type BLHA2094

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-113

Page 274: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

SOURCE select switch

Push the source select switch to change themode in the following sequence:

Models without Navigation System:AM → FM1 → FM2 → XM1 → XM2 → XM3(satellite radio, if so equipped) → USB* (if soequipped) → CD/DVD* → Music Box** (if soequipped) → AUX* → AM.

Models with Navigation System:AM → FM1 → FM2 → XM1 → XM2 → XM3(satellite radio, if so equipped) → CD/DVD*→Music Box** → USB/iPod�* → Bluetooth� Au-dio* → AUX* → AM.

* These modes are only available when compat-ible media storage is inserted into the device.

** This mode is only available when music hasbeen downloaded into the Music Box system.

Volume control switchPush the volume control switch to increase ordecrease the volume.

Menu controlswitch/ENTER button

While the display is showing a MAP, STATUS orAudio screen, tilt the Menu Control switch up-ward or downward to select a station, track, CD

or folder. For most audio sources, tilting theswitch up/down for more than 1.5 seconds pro-vides a different function than a tilting up/downfor less than 1.5 seconds.

AM and FM:

● Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds toincrease or decrease the preset station.

● Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds toseek up or down to the next station.

● Press the ENTER button to show the list ofpreset stations.

XM (if so equipped):

● Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds toincrease or decrease the preset station.

● Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds togo to the next or previous category.

● Press the ENTER button to show the XMMenu.

iPod� (if so equipped):

● Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds toincrease or decrease the track number.

● Press the ENTER button to show the iPodMenu.

CD:

● Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds toincrease or decrease the track number.

● Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds toincrease or decrease the folder number (ifplaying compressed audio files).

● Press the ENTER button to show the CDMenu.

DVD (if so equipped):

● Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds toincrease or decrease the track number.

● Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds toincrease or decrease the title number.

● Press the ENTER button to select an itemfrom the DVD display.

● When the transparent operation menu ap-pears, the switch will control the menu.

USB (if so equipped):

● Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds toincrease or decrease the track number.

● Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds toincrease or decrease the folder number.

● Press the ENTER button to show the USBMenu.

4-114 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 275: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Music Box (if so equipped):

● Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds toincrease or decrease the track number.

● Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds toincrease or decrease the album (folder)number (if playing compressed audio files).

● Press the ENTER button to show the MusicBox Menu.

Bluetooth� Audio (if so equipped):

● Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds toincrease or decrease the track number.

AUX:

● Press the ENTER button to show the AUXMenu.

ANTENNA

Window antennaThe antenna pattern is printed inside the rearwindow.

CAUTION

● Do not place metalized film near therear window glass or attach any metalparts to it. This may cause poor recep-tion or noise.

● When cleaning the inside of the rearwindow, be careful not to scratch ordamage the rear window antenna.Lightly wipe along the antenna with adampened soft cloth.

When installing a CB, ham radio or car phone inyour NISSAN, be sure to observe the followingprecautions; otherwise, the new equipment mayadversely affect the engine control system andother electronic parts.

WARNING

● A cellular telephone should not be usedfor any purpose while driving so fullattention may be given to vehicle op-eration. Some jurisdictions prohibit theuse of cellular telephones while driving.

● If you must make a call while your ve-hicle is in motion, the hands free cellu-lar phone operational mode (if soequipped) is highly recommended. Ex-ercise extreme caution at all times sofull attention may be given to vehicleoperation.

● If you are unable to devote full attentionto vehicle operation while talking onthe phone, pull off the road to a safelocation and stop your vehicle.

CAR PHONE OR CB RADIO

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-115

Page 276: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CAUTION

● Keep the antenna as far away as pos-sible from the electronic controlmodules.

● Keep the antenna wire more than 8 in(20 cm) away from the electronic con-trol system harnesses. Do not route theantenna wire next to any harness.

● Adjust the antenna standing-wave ratioas recommended by the manufacturer.

● Connect the ground wire from the CBradio chassis to the body.

● For details, consult a NISSAN dealer.

WARNING

● Use a phone after stopping your vehiclein a safe location. If you have to use aphone while driving, exercise extremecaution at all times so full attention maybe given to vehicle operation.

● If you are unable to devote full attentionto vehicle operation while talking onthe phone, pull off the road to a safelocation and stop your vehicle.

CAUTION

To avoid discharging the vehicle battery,use a phone after starting the engine.

BLUETOOTH� HANDS-FREE PHONESYSTEM WITHOUT NAVIGATIONSYSTEM (if so equipped)

4-116 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 277: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Your NISSAN is equipped with the Bluetooth�Hands-Free Phone System. If you have a com-patible Bluetooth� enabled cellular phone, youcan set up the wireless connection between yourcellular phone and the in-vehicle phone module.With Bluetooth� wireless technology, you can

make or receive a hands-free telephone call withyour cellular phone in the vehicle.

Once your cellular phone is connected to the in-vehicle phone module, no other phone connectingprocedure is required. Your phone is automaticallyconnected with the in-vehicle phone module when

the ignition switch is placed in the ON position withthe previously connected cellular phone turned onand carried in the vehicle.

You can connect up to 5 different Bluetooth�cellular phones to the in-vehicle phone module.However, you can talk on only one cellular phoneat a time.

Before using the Bluetooth� Hands-Free PhoneSystem, refer to the following notes.

● Set up the wireless connection between acompatible cellular phone and the in-vehiclephone module before using the hands-freephone system.

● Some Bluetooth� enabled cellular phones maynot be recognized by the in-vehicle phone mod-ule. Please visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetoothfor a recommended phone list and connectinginstructions.

● You will not be able to use a hands-freephone under the following conditions:

– Your vehicle is outside of the cellular ser-vice area.

– Your vehicle is in an area where it isdifficult to receive a cellular signal; suchas in a tunnel, in an underground parkinggarage, near a tall building or in a moun-tainous area.

LHA1158

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-117

Page 278: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

– Your cellular phone is locked to prevent itfrom being dialed.

● When the radio wave condition is not idealor ambient sound is too loud, it may bedifficult to hear the other person’s voice dur-ing a call.

● Do not place the cellular phone in an areasurrounded by metal or far away from thein-vehicle phone module to prevent tonequality degradation and wireless connectiondisruption.

● While a cellular phone is connected throughthe Bluetooth� wireless connection, the bat-tery power of the cellular phone may dis-charge quicker than usual. The Bluetooth�Hands-Free Phone System cannot chargecellular phones.

● If the hands-free phone system seems to bemalfunctioning, see “Troubleshooting guide”in this section. You can also visitwww.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for trouble-shooting help.

● Some cellular phones or other devices maycause interference or a buzzing noise tocome from the audio system speakers. Stor-ing the device in a different location mayreduce or eliminate the noise.

● Refer to the cellular phone Owner’s Manualregarding the telephone charges, cellularphone antenna and body, etc.

REGULATORY INFORMATION

FCC Regulatory information

– CAUTION: To maintain compliance withFCC’s RF exposure guidelines, use only thesupplied antenna. Unauthorized antenna,modification, or attachments could damagethe transmitter and may violate FCC regula-tions.

– Operation is subject to the following two con-ditions:

1. This device may not cause interference and

2. this device must accept any interference,including interference that may cause unde-sired operation of the device.

IC Regulatory information

– Operation is subject to the following two con-ditions: (1) this device may not cause interfer-ence, and (2) this device must accept anyinterference, including interference that maycause undesired operation of the device.

– This Class B digital apparatus meets all re-quirements of the Canadian Interference-Causing Equipment Regulations.

BLUETOOTH� is atrademark owned byBluetooth SIG, Inc.and licensed to Vis-teon.

USING THE SYSTEMThe NISSAN Voice Recognition system allowshands-free operation of the Bluetooth� PhoneSystem.

If the vehicle is in motion, some commands maynot be available so full attention may be given tovehicle operation.

InitializationWhen the ignition switch is placed in the ONposition, NISSAN Voice Recognition is initialized,which takes a few seconds. If the button ispressed before the initialization completes, thesystem will announce “Hands-free phone systemnot ready” and will not react to voice commands.

4-118 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 279: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Operating tips

To get the best performance out of the NISSANVoice Recognition system, observe the following:

● Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet aspossible. Close the windows to eliminatesurrounding noises (traffic noises, vibrationsounds, etc.), which may prevent the systemfrom recognizing voice commands correctly.

● Wait until the tone sounds before speaking acommand. Otherwise, the command will notbe received properly.

● Start speaking a command within 5 secondsafter the tone sounds.

● Speak in a natural voice without pausingbetween words.

Giving voice commandsTo operate NISSAN Voice Recognition, pressand release the button located on thesteering wheel. After the tone sounds, speak acommand.

The command given is picked up by the micro-phone, and voice feedback is given when thecommand is accepted.

● If you need to hear the available commandsfor the current menu again, say “Help” andthe system will repeat them.

● If a command is not recognized, the systemannounces, “Command not recognized.Please try again.” Repeat the command in aclear voice.

● If you want to go back to the previous com-mand, you can say “Go back” or “Correc-tion” any time the system is waiting for aresponse.

● You can cancel a command when the sys-tem is waiting for a response by saying,“Cancel” or “Quit.” The system announces“Cancel” and ends the VR session. You canalso press and hold the button on thesteering wheel for 5 seconds at any time toend the VR session. Whenever the VR ses-sion is cancelled, a double beep is played toindicate you have exited the system.

● If you want to adjust the volume of the voicefeedback, press the volume control switches(+ or -) on the steering wheel while beingprovided with feedback. You can also usethe radio volume control knob.

● In most cases you can interrupt the voicefeedback to speak the next command bypressing the button on the steeringwheel.

● To use the system faster, you may speak thesecond level commands with the main menucommand on the main menu. For example,press the button and after the tonesay, “Call Redial.”

NOTE:

The combined command of Call and (aName) cannot be used.

How to say numbers

NISSAN Voice Recognition requires a certainway to speak numbers in voice commands. Referto the following rules and examples.

● Either “zero” or “oh” can be used for “0”.

Example: 1-800-662-6200

– “One eight oh oh six six two six two ohoh”, or

– “One eight zero zero six six two six two ohoh”

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-119

Page 280: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Words can be used for the first 4 digitsplaces only.

Example: 1-800-662-6200

– “One eight hundred six six two six two ohoh”,

– NOT “One eight hundred six six two sixtytwo hundred,” and

– NOT “One eight oh oh six six two sixty twohundred”

● Numbers can be spoken in small groups.The system will prompt you to continue en-tering digits, if desired.

Example: 1-800-662-6200

– “One eight zero zero”

The system repeats the numbers andprompts you to enter more.

– “six six two”

The system repeats the numbers andprompts you to enter more.

– “six two zero zero”

● Say “pound” for “#”. Say “star” for “*” (avail-able when using the “Special Number” com-mand and the “Send” command during acall).

See “List of voice commands” and “Specialnumber” in this section for more information.

Example: 1-555-1212 *123

– “One five five five one two one two starone two three”

● Say “plus” for “+” (available only when usingthe “Special Number” command).

● Say “pause” for a 2-second pause (availableonly when storing a phone book number).

NOTE:

For best results, say phone numbers assingle digits.

The voice command “Help” is available at anytime. Please use the “Help” command to getinformation on how to use the system.

CONTROL BUTTONS

The control buttons for the Bluetooth� Hands-Free Phone System are located on the steeringwheel.

PHONE/SEND

Press the button to initiate aVR session or answer an incomingcall.

LHA1160

4-120 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 281: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

You can also use the buttonto interrupt the system feedbackand give a command at once. See“List of voice commands” and“During a call” in this section formore information.

PHONE/ENDWhile the voice recognition sys-tem is active, press and holdthe button for 5 seconds toquit the voice recognition systemat any time.

TUNING SWITCHWhile using the voice recognitionsystem, tilt the tuning switch up ordown to manually control thephone system (if so equipped).

GETTING STARTED

The following procedures will help you getstarted using the Bluetooth� Hands-Free PhoneSystem with NISSAN Voice Recognition. For ad-ditional command options, refer to “List of voicecommands” in this section.

Choosing a language

You can interact with the Bluetooth� Hands-FreePhone System using English, Spanish or French.

To change the language, perform the following.

1. Press and hold the button for morethan 5 seconds.

2. The system announces: “Press thePHONE/SEND ( ) button for thehands-free phone system to enter the voiceadaptation mode or press the PHONE/END( ) button to select a different lan-guage.”

3. Press the button.

For information on voice adaptation, see“Voice adaptation (VA) mode” in this section.

4. The system announces the current languageand gives you the option to change the lan-guage to Spanish (in Spanish) or French (inFrench). To select the current language,press the PHONE/SEND ( ) button. Toselect a different language, tilt the tuning

switch ( or ) up or down.

NOTE:

You must press the button within 5seconds to change the language.

5. If you decide not to change the language, donot press either button. After 5 seconds, theVR session will end, and the language willnot be changed.

Connecting procedure

NOTE:

The connecting procedure must be per-formed when the vehicle is stationary. If thevehicle starts moving during the procedure,the procedure will be cancelled.

Main Menu

“Connect phone” �A

“Add phone” �B

Initiate from handset �C

Name phone �D

1. Press the button on the steeringwheel. The system announces the availablecommands.

2. Say: “Connect phone” �A . The system ac-knowledges the command and announcesthe next set of available commands.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-121

Page 282: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

3. Say: “Add phone” �B . The system acknowl-edges the command and asks you to initiateconnecting from the phone handset �C .

The connecting procedure of the cellularphone varies according to each cellularphone model. See the cellular phone Own-er’s Manual for details. You can also visitwww.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for instruc-tions on connecting NISSAN recommendedcellular phones.

When prompted for a Passkey code, enter“1234” from the handset. The Passkey code“1234” has been assigned by NISSAN andcannot be changed.

4. The system asks you to say a name for thephone �D .

If the name is too long or too short, thesystem tells you, then prompts you for aname again.

Also, if more than one phone is connectedand the name sounds too much like a namealready used, the system tells you, thenprompts you for a name again.

Making a call by entering a phonenumber

Main Menu

“Call” �A

“Phone Number” �B

Speak the digits �C

“Dial” �D

1. Press the button on the steeringwheel. A tone will sound.

2. Say: “Call” �A . The system acknowledgesthe command and announces the next set ofavailable commands.

3. Say “Phone Number” �B . The system ac-knowledges the command and announcesthe next set of available commands.

Say: “Special Number” to dial more than 10digits or any special characters.

4. Say the number you wish to call starting withthe area code in single digit format �C . If thesystem has trouble recognizing the correctphone number, try entering the number inthe following groups: 3-digit area code,3-digit prefix and the last 4-digits. For ex-ample, 555-121-3354 can be said as “fivefive five” as the 1st group, then “one twoone” as the 2nd group, and “three three five

four” as the 3rd group. For dialing more than10 digits or any special characters, say“Special Number”. See “How to say num-bers” in this section for more information.

5. When you have finished speaking the phonenumber, the system repeats it back and an-nounces the available commands.

6. Say: “Dial” �D . The system acknowledgesthe command and makes the call.

For additional command options, see “List ofvoice commands” in this section.

Receiving a call

When you hear the ring tone, press thebutton on the steering wheel.

Once the call has ended, press the buttonon the steering wheel.

NOTE:

If you do not wish to take the call when youhear the ring tone, press the buttonon the steering wheel.

For additional command options, see “List ofvoice commands” later in this section.

4-122 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 283: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

LIST OF VOICE COMMANDS

Main Menu

“Call”

“Phonebook”

“Recent Calls”

“Connect Phone”

When you press and release the button onthe steering wheel, you can choose from thecommands on the Main Menu. The followingpages describe these commands and the com-mands in each sub-menu.

Remember to wait for the tone beforespeaking.

After the main menu, you can say “Help” to hearthe list of commands currently available any timethe system is waiting for a response.

If you want to end an action without completing it,you can say “Cancel” or “Quit” at any time thesystem is waiting for a response. The system willend the VR session. Whenever the VR session iscancelled, a double beep is played to indicateyou have exited the system.

If you want to go back to the previous command,you can say “Go back” or “Correction” any timethe system is waiting for a response.

“Call”

Main Menu

“Call”

(Speak name) �A

“Phone Number”

(Speak Digits) �B

“Special Number” �C

“Redial” �D

“Call Back” �E

(Speak name) �A

If you have stored entries in the phonebook, youcan dial a number associated with a name andlocation.

See “Phonebook” in this section to learn how tostore entries.

When prompted by the system, say the name ofthe phone book entry you wish to call. The systemacknowledges the name.

If there are multiple locations associated with thename, the system asks you to choose the loca-tion.

Once you have confirmed the name and location,the system begins the call.

(Speak Digits) �B

When prompted by the system, say the numberyou wish to call. Refer to “How to say numbers”and “Making a call by entering a phone number”in this section for more details.

“Special Number” �C

For dialing more than 10 digits or any specialcharacters, say “Special Number”. When thesystem acknowledges the command, the systemwill prompt you to speak the number.

“Redial” �D

Use the Redial command to call the last numberthat was dialed.

The system acknowledges the command, re-peats the number and begins dialing.

If a redial number does not exist, the systemannounces, “There is no number to redial” andends the VR session.

“Call Back” �E

Use the Call Back command to dial the number ofthe last incoming call within the vehicle.

The system acknowledges the command, re-peats the number and begins dialing.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-123

Page 284: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

If a call back number does not exist, the systemannounces, “There is no number to call back”andends the VR session.

During a call

During a call there are several command optionsavailable. Press the button on the steeringwheel to mute the receiving voice and enter com-mands.

● “Help” — The system announces the avail-able commands.

● “Go back/Correction” — The system an-nounces “Go back,” ends the VR sessionand returns to the call.

● “Cancel/Quit” — The system announces“Cancel,” ends the VR session and returnsto the call.

● “Send/Enter/Call/Dial” — Use the Sendcommand to enter numbers, “*” or “#” duringa call. For example, if you were directed todial an extension by an automated system:

Say: “Send one two three four.”

The system acknowledges the commandand sends the tones associated with thenumbers. The system then ends the VR ses-sion and returns to the call. Say “star” for “*”,Say “pound” for “#”.

● “Transfer call” — Use the Transfer Call com-mand to transfer the call from the Bluetooth�Hands-Free Phone System to the cellularphone when privacy is desired.

The system announces, “Transfer call. Calltransferred to privacy mode.” The systemthen ends the VR session.

To reconnect the call from the cellular phoneto the Bluetooth� Hands-Free System,press the button.

● “Mute” — Use the Mute command to muteyour voice so the other party cannot hear it.Use the mute command again to unmuteyour voice.

NOTE:

If a call is ended or the cellular phonenetwork connection is lost while the Mutefeature is on, the Mute feature will be resetto “off” for the next call so the other partycan hear your voice.

“Phonebook” (phones withoutautomatic phonebook downloadfunction)

NOTE:

The “Transfer Entry” command is not avail-able when the vehicle is moving.

Main Menu

“Phonebook”

“Transfer Entry” �A

“Delete Entry” �B

“List Names” �C

For phones that do not support automatic down-load of the phonebook (PBAP Bluetooth� pro-file), the “Phonebook”command is used to manu-ally add entries to the vehicle phonebook.

The phonebook stores up to 40 names for eachphone connected to the system.

NOTE:

Each phone has its own separate phone-book. You cannot access Phone A’s phone-book if you are currently connected withPhone B.

4-124 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 285: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

“Transfer Entry” �A

Use the Transfer Entry command to store a newname in the system.

When prompted by the system, say the name youwould like to give the new entry.

For example, say: “Mary.”If the name is too long or too short, the systemtells you, then prompts you for a name again.

Also, if the name sounds too much like a namealready stored, the system tells you, then promptsyou for a name again.

The system will ask you to transfer a phonenumber stored in the cellular phone’s memory.

Enter a phone number by voice command:

For example, say: “five five five one two one two.”See “How to say numbers” in this section formore information.

To transfer a phone number stored in the cellularphone’s memory:

Say “Transfer entry.” The system acknowledgesthe command and asks you to initiate the transferfrom the phone handset. The new contact phonenumber will be transferred from the cellularphone via the Bluetooth� communication link.

The transfer procedure varies according to eachcellular phone. See the cellular phone Owner’s

Manual for details. You can also visitwww.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for instructionson transferring phone numbers from NISSANrecommended cellular phones.

The system repeats the number and prompts youfor the next command. When you have finishedentering numbers or transferring an entry, choose“Store.”

The system confirms the name, location andnumber.

“Delete Entry” �B

Use the Delete Entry command to erase oneentry from the phonebook. After the system rec-ognizes the command, speak the name to deleteor say “List Names” to choose an entry.

“List Names” �C

Use the List Names command to hear all thenames in the phonebook.

The system recites the phonebook entries butdoes not include the actual phone numbers.When the playback of the list is complete, thesystem goes back to the main menu.

You can stop the playback of the list at any timeby pressing the button on the steeringwheel. The system ends the VR session.

“Phonebook” (phones with automaticphonebook download function)

NOTE:The “Transfer Entry” command is not avail-able when the vehicle is moving.

Main Menu

“Phonebook”

Speak a Name

“List Names” �A

“Record Name” �B

For phones that support automatic download ofthe phonebook (PBAP Bluetooth� profile), the“Phonebook” command is used to manage en-tries in the vehicle phonebook. You can say thename of an entry at this menu to initiate dialing ofthat entry.

The phonebook stores up to 1000 names foreach phone connected to the system.

When a phone is connected to the system, thephonebook is automatically downloaded to thevehicle. This feature allows you to access yourphonebook from the Bluetooth� system and callcontacts by name. You can record a customvoice tag for contact names that the system hasdifficulty recognizing. For more information see“Record name” in this section.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-125

Page 286: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

NOTE:

Each phone has its own separate phone-book. You cannot access Phone A’s phone-book if you are currently connected withPhone B.

“List Names” �A

Use the List Names command to hear all thenames and locations in the phone book.

The system recites the phone book entries butdoes not include the actual phone numbers.When the playback of the list is complete, thesystem goes back to the main menu.

You can stop the playback of the list at any timeby pressing the button on the steeringwheel. The system ends the VR session. See the“Record name” command in this section for infor-mation about recording custom voice tags for listentries that the system has difficulty pronounc-ing.

“Record Name” �B

The system allows you to record custom voicetags for contact names in the phonebook that thevehicle has difficulty recognizing. This feature canalso be used to record voice tags to directly dialan entry with multiple numbers. Up to 40 voicetags can be recorded to the system.

“Recent Calls”

Main Menu

“Recent Calls”

“Outgoing” �A

“Incoming” �B

“Missed” �C

Use the Recent Calls command to access out-going, incoming or missed calls.

“Outgoing” �A

Use the Outgoing command to list the outgoingcalls made from the vehicle.

“Incoming” �B

Use the Incoming command to list the incomingcalls made to the vehicle.

“Missed” �C

Use the Missed command to list the calls made tothe vehicle that were not answered.

“Connect Phone”

NOTE:

The Add Phone command is not availablewhen the vehicle is moving.

Main Menu

“Connect Phone”

“Add Phone” �A

“Select Phone” �B

“Delete Phone” �C

“Turn Bluetooth OFF” �D

Use the Connect Phone commands to managethe phones connecting to the vehicle or to enablethe Bluetooth� function on the vehicle.

“Add Phone” �A

Use the Add Phone command to add a phone tothe vehicle. See “Connecting procedure” in thissection for more information.

“Select Phone” �B

Use the Select Phone command to select from alist of phones connected to the vehicle. The sys-tem will list the names assigned to each phoneand then prompt you for the phone you wish toselect. Only one phone can be active at a time.

4-126 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 287: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

“Delete Phone” �C

Use the Delete Phone command to delete aphone that is connected to the vehicle. The sys-tem will list the names assigned to each phoneand then prompt you for the phone you wish todelete. Deleting a phone from the vehicle will alsodelete that phonebook for that phone.

“Turn Bluetooth OFF” �D

Use the Turn Bluetooth OFF command to preventa wireless connection to your phone.

VOICE ADAPTATION (VA) MODE

Voice Adaptation allows up to two out-of-dialectusers to train the system to improve recognitionaccuracy. By repeating a number of commands,the users can create a voice model of their ownvoice that is stored in the system. The system iscapable of storing a different voice adaptationmodel for each connected phone.

Training procedure

The procedure for training a voice is as follows.

1. Position the vehicle in a reasonably quietoutdoor location.

2. Sit in the driver’s seat with the engine run-ning, the parking brake on, and the transmis-sion in P (Park).

3. Press and hold the button for morethan 5 seconds.

4. The system announces: “Press thePHONE/SEND ( ) button for thehands-free phone system to enter the voiceadaptation mode or press the PHONE/END( ) button to select a different lan-guage.”

5. Press the button.

For information on selecting a different lan-guage, see “Choosing a language” in thissection.

6. Voice memory A or memory B is selectedautomatically. If both memory locations arealready in use, the system will prompt you tooverwrite one. Follow the instructions pro-vided by the system.

7. When preparation is complete and you areready to begin, press the button.

8. The VA mode will be explained. Follow theinstructions provided by the system.

9. When training is finished, the system will tellyou an adequate number of phrases havebeen recorded.

10. The system will announce that voice adap-tation has been completed and the system isready.

The VA mode will stop if:

● The button is pressed for more than 5seconds in VA mode.

● The vehicle begins moving during VA mode.

● The ignition switch is placed in the OFF orLOCK position.

Training phrases

During the VA mode, the system instructs thetrainer to say the following phrases. (The systemwill prompt you for each phrase.)

● phonebook transfer entry

● dial three oh four two nine

● delete call back number

● incoming

● transfer entry

● eight pause nine three two pause seven

● delete all entries

● call seven two four zero nine

● phonebook delete entry

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-127

Page 288: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● next entry

● dial star two one seven oh

● yes

● no

● select

● missed

● dial eight five six nine two

● Bluetooth on

● outgoing

● call three one nine oh two

● nine seven pause pause three oh eight

● cancel

● call back number

● call star two zero nine five

● delete phone

● dial eight three zero five one

● record name

● four three pause two nine pause zero

● delete redial number

● phonebook list names

● call eight oh five four one

● correction

● connect phone

● dial seven four oh one eight

● previous entry

● delete

● dial nine seven two six six

● call seven six three oh one

● go back

● call five six two eight zero

● dial six six four three seven

MANUAL CONTROL

While using the voice recognition system, it ispossible to select menu options by using thesteering wheel controls instead of speaking voicecommands. The manual control mode does notallow dialing a phone number by digits. The usermay select an entry from the Phonebook or Re-cent Calls lists. To re-activate voice recognition,exit the manual control mode by pressing andholding the PHONE/END ( ) button. At thattime, pressing the PHONE/SEND ( ) buttonwill start the Hands Free Phone System.

Operating tips● To enter manual control mode, start the

voice recognition system and tilt the tuning( ) switch up or down. The system willspeak �Showing Manual Options� whenmanual controls are initially activated.

● To browse the menu options, tilt the tuning( ) switch up or down. The system willalways speak the current menu option. De-pending on the audio display, it will alsoshow the current menu option.

● To select the current menu option, press thePHONE/SEND ( ) button.

● To go back to the previous menu, press thePHONE/END ( ) button. If the currentmenu is the Main Menu, pressing thePHONE/END ( ) button will exit thePhone system.

● To exit the manual control mode, press andhold the PHONE/END ( ) button for 5seconds.

4-128 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 289: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDEThe system should respond correctly to all voicecommands without difficulty. If problems are en-countered, try the following solutions.

Where the solutions are listed by number, tryeach solution in turn, starting with number 1, untilthe problem is resolved.

Symptom Solution

System fails to interpret the command correctly.

1. Ensure that the command is valid. See “List of voice commands” in this section.2. Ensure that the command is spoken after the tone.3. Speak clearly without pausing between words and at a level appropriate to the ambient noise level in the vehicle.4. Ensure that the ambient noise level is not excessive (for example, windows open or defroster on). NOTE: If it is toonoisy to use the phone, it is likely that the voice commands will not be recognized.5. If more than one command was said at a time, try saying the commands separately.6. If the system consistently fails to recognize commands, the voice training procedure should be carried out to im-prove the recognition response for the speaker. See “Voice Adaptation (VA) mode” in this section.

The system consistently selects the wrong entry from thephone book.

1. Ensure that the phone book entry name requested matches what was originally stored. This can be confirmed byusing the “List Names” command. See “Phonebook” in this section.2. Replace one of the names being confused with a new name.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-129

Page 290: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● Use a phone after stopping your vehiclein a safe location. If you have to use aphone while driving, exercise extremecaution at all times so full attention maybe given to vehicle operation.

● If you are unable to devote full attentionto vehicle operation while talking onthe phone, pull off the road to a safelocation and stop your vehicle.

CAUTION

To avoid discharging the vehicle battery,use a phone after starting the engine.

Your NISSAN is equipped with the Bluetooth�Hands-Free Phone System. If you have a com-patible Bluetooth� enabled cellular phone, youcan set up the wireless connection between yourcellular phone and the in-vehicle phone module.With Bluetooth� wireless technology, you can

make or receive a hands-free telephone call withyour cellular phone in the vehicle.

Once your cellular phone is connected to thein-vehicle phone module, no other phone con-necting procedure is required. Your phone isautomatically connected with the in-vehicle

WHA1350

BLUETOOTH� HANDS-FREE PHONESYSTEM WITH NAVIGATION SYSTEM(if so equipped)

4-130 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 291: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

phone module when the ignition switch is placedin the ON position with the connected cellularphone turned on and carried in the vehicle.

You can register up to 5 different Bluetooth�cellular phones to the in-vehicle phone module.However, you can talk on only one cellular phoneat a time.

NISSAN Voice Recognition system supports thephone commands, so dialing a phone numberusing your voice is possible. For more details, see“NISSAN Voice Recognition System” in this sec-tion.

Before using the Bluetooth� Hands-Free PhoneSystem, refer to the following notes.

● Set up the wireless connection between acellular phone and the in-vehicle phonemodule before using the hands-free phonesystem.

● Some Bluetooth� enabled cellular phonesmay not be recognized by the in-vehiclephone module. Please visitwww.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for a recom-mended phone list and connecting.

● You will not be able to use a hands-freephone under the following conditions:

– Your vehicle is outside of the cellular ser-vice area.

– Your vehicle is in an area where it isdifficult to receive cellular signal; such asin a tunnel, in an underground parkinggarage, near a tall building or in a moun-tainous area.

– Your cellular phone is locked to prevent itfrom being dialed.

● When the radio wave condition is not idealor ambient sound is too loud, it may bedifficult to hear the other person’s voice dur-ing a call.

● Immediately after the ignition switch isplaced in the ON position, it may be impos-sible to receive a call for a short period oftime.

● Do not place the cellular phone in an areasurrounded by metal or far away from thein-vehicle phone module to prevent tonequality degradation and wireless connectiondisruption.

● While a cellular phone is connected throughthe Bluetooth� wireless connection, the bat-tery power of the cellular phone may dis-charge quicker than usual. The Bluetooth�Hands-Free Phone System cannot chargecellular phones.

● If the hands-free phone system seems to bemalfunctioning, see “Troubleshooting guide”in this section. You can also visitwww.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for trouble-shooting help.

● Some cellular phones or other devices maycause interference or a buzzing noise tocome from the audio system speakers. Stor-ing the device in a different location mayreduce or eliminate the noise.

● Refer to the cellular phone owner’s manualregarding the telephone charges, cellularphone antenna and body, etc.

● The signal strength display on the monitorwill not coincide with the signal strengthdisplay of some cellular phones.

● If reception between callers is unclear, ad-justing the incoming or outgoing call volumemay improve the clarity. See “Call volume” inthis section.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-131

Page 292: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

REGULATORY INFORMATION

FCC Regulatory information

– CAUTION: To maintain compliance withFCC’s RF exposure guidelines, use only thesupplied antenna. Unauthorized antenna,modification, or attachments could damagethe transmitter and may violate FCC regula-tions.

– Operation is subject to the following two con-ditions:

1. This device may not cause interference and

2. this device must accept any interference,including interference that may cause unde-sired operation of the device.

IC Regulatory information

– Operation is subject to the following two con-ditions: (1) this device may not cause interfer-ence, and (2) this device must accept anyinterference, including interference that maycause undesired operation of the device.

– This Class B digital apparatus meets all re-quirements of the Canadian Interference-Causing Equipment Regulations.

BLUETOOTH� is atrademark owned byBluetooth SIG, Inc.and licensed toClarion.

VOICE COMMANDSYou can use voice commands to operate variousBluetooth� Hands-Free Phone System featuresusing the NISSAN Voice Recognition system. Formore details, see “NISSAN Voice RecognitionSystem” in this section.

CONNECTING PROCEDURE1. Press the SETTING button on the instru-

ment panel and select the “Bluetooth” keyon the display.

LHA1236

4-132 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 293: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

2. Select the “Connect Bluetooth” key. 3. A popup box will appear on the screen,prompting you to confirm that the connec-tion is for the phone system. Select the “Yes”key.

4. When a PIN code appears on the screen,operate the Bluetooth� cellular phone toenter the PIN code.

The connecting procedure of the cellularphone varies according to each cellularphone. See the cellular phone Owner’sManual for details. You can also visitwww.nissanusa.com/bluetooth or call theNISSAN Consumer Affairs Department forinstructions on connecting recommendedcellular phones.

When the connecting is complete, thescreen will return to the Bluetooth� settingsscreen.

LHA1316 LHA1317 LHA1318

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-133

Page 294: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

VEHICLE PHONEBOOK

This vehicle has two phonebooks available foryour use. Depending on your phone, the systemmay automatically download your entire cellphone’s phonebook into the “Handset Phone-book”. For the details on downloading yourphonebook, see “Handset phonebook” in thissection. If your phonebook does not automati-cally download, you may set up the vehiclephonebook for up to 40 entries. This phonebookallows you to record a name to speak while usingvoice recognition.

1. Push the PHONE button and select the “Ve-hicle Phonebook” key.

2. Select the “Add New” key at the top of thescreen.

3. Choose the method for entering the phone-book entry. For this example, select “EnterNumber by Keypad”.

4. Enter the digits and select the “OK” key. Formore information, see “How to use thetouchscreen” in this section.

5. Select the “Voicetag” key to record a nameto speak when using the Voice Recognitionsystem.

6. Select the “Store” key and prepare to speakthe name after the tone.

7. When the voicetag is successfully saved( ), select the “OK” key to save thephonebook entry.

8. After the phonebook entry is saved, it willshow a screen that is ready to call the num-ber. Press the BACK button to return to theVehicle Phonebook.

LHA1320 LHA1321 LHA1381

4-134 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 295: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Copy from Call HistoryThe system will show a list of your incoming,outgoing or missed calls that were down-loaded from your cell phone (depending onyour phone’s compatibility). You may selectone of these entries to save in the vehiclephonebook.

● Copy from the HandsetThe system will show your cell phone’sphonebook that was downloaded (depend-ing on your phone’s compatibility). You mayselect one of these entries to save in thevehicle phonebook.

● Editing the Vehicle Phonebook

1. Push the PHONE button and select the “Ve-hicle Phonebook” key.

2. Select the desired entry from the displayedlist.

3. Select the “Edit” key.

4. Select the desired item to change.

The following editing items are available:

● Entry #Changes the displayed number of the se-lected entry.

● NameEdit the name of the entry using the keypaddisplayed on the screen.

● NumberEdit the phone number using the keypaddisplayed on the screen.

● TypeSelect the icon from the icon list.

LHA1382 LHA1383

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-135

Page 296: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● VoicetagConfirm and store the voicetag. Voicetagsallow easy dialing using the NISSAN VoiceRecognition system. For more information,see “NISSAN Voice Recognition System” inthis section.

To delete an entry, select the “Delete” key at step3.

HANDSET PHONEBOOKMany phones will support an automatic down-load of the cellular phone’s phonebook. Sincethis method allows for up to 1000 numbers to bestored and entries are automatically assignedvoice tags by the system, this is a useful functionfor easy dialing supported by the Voice Recogni-tion system.

Transferring the handset phonebookIf your cellular phone supports automatic down-loading, the system transfers the handset phone-book automatically by default. To ensure that thisfeature is activated, press the SETTING buttonon the instrument panel and select the “Phone”key. The “Auto Downloaded” selection shouldhave the amber indicator next to the word ONactivated. Select the “Auto Downloaded” key totoggle this feature on or off.

To transfer the handset phonebook to the vehiclemanually, follow these steps:

1. Press the SETTING button on the instru-ment panel.

2. Select the “Phone” key.

3. Select the “Download Handset Phonebook”key.

Once the handset phonebook is transferred tothe vehicle, it can be accessed by pressing thePHONE key on the instrument panel or thebutton on the steering wheel, then selecting the“Handset Phonebook” key.

Whether the handset phonebook is transferredmanually or automatically, the process can takeup to five minutes to complete, depending on thesize of the handset phonebook. See the cellularphone’s owner’s manual for more details.

LHA1319

4-136 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 297: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

MAKING A CALL

To make a call, follow the procedure below:

1. Press the PHONE button on the instrumentpanel or the switch on the steeringwheel. The “Phone” screen will appear onthe display.

2. Select one of the following options to make acall:

● Vehicle Phonebook: Select the name froman entry stored in the vehicle phonebook.

● Handset Phonebook: Select the name froman entry stored in the handset phonebook.

● Call History: Select the name from the in-coming or outgoing call history.

● Dial Number: Input the phone number manu-ally using a keypad displayed on the screen.For information on how to use the touch-screen, see “How to use the touchscreen” inthis section.

3. For all of the methods listed in Step 2 except“Dial Number”, dialing commences when thelisted name is selected. Dialing commenceswhen “OK” is selected if the number is input-ted manually. The screen changes to the“Call in Progress” screen.

4. After the call is over, perform one of thefollowing to finish the call:

a. Select the “Hang up” key on the Call inProgress screen.

b. Press the switch on the steeringwheel.

c. When the “Call in Progress” screen isdisplayed, press the PHONE button on theinstrument panel to hang up. If any otherscreen is currently displayed, press thePHONE button to display the “Call inProgress” screen first, then press thePHONE button again to hang up.

RECEIVING A CALL

When you hear a phone ring, the display willchange to phone mode. To receive a call, followone of the procedures listed below.

a. Select the “Answer” key on the display.

b. Press the PHONE button on the instrumentpanel.

c. Press the phone button on the steeringwheel switches.

There are some options available when receivinga call. Select one of the following displayed onthe screen.

LHA1322 LHA1323

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-137

Page 298: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Answer:Accept an incoming call to talk.

Hold Call:Put an incoming call on hold.

Reject Call:Reject an incoming call.

To finish the call, follow one of the procedureslisted below:

a. Select the “Reject Call” key on the display.

b. Press the PHONE button on the instrumentpanel.

c. Press and hold the phone button on thesteering wheel switches. DURING A CALL

There are some options available during a call.Select one of the following displayed on thescreen, if necessary:

Hang up:Finish the call.

Use Handset:Transfer the call to the cellular phone.

Mute:Mute your voice to the person.

Keypad:Brings up a keypad; enter digits when needed.For example, entering your PIN number for voice-mail.

NOTE:

Pushing the TALK switch on thesteering wheel during a call allows num-bers and digits to be sent using Voice Rec-ognition.

Cancel Mute:This will appear after the “Mute” key is selected.Mute will be cancelled.

Switch Call:Select “Switch Call” to answer another incomingcall. By selecting “Hang Up,” you can end a calland can speak to a caller who is on hold again.

● This function may not be useable, depend-ing on the model of phone.

To adjust the person’s voice to be louder orquieter, press the volume control switch locatedon the steering wheel switches or turn the volumecontrol knob on the instrument panel while talkingon the phone. This adjustment is also available inthe SETTING mode.

LHA2074

4-138 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 299: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

ENDING A CALLTo finish the call, perform one of the followingprocedures:

● Select the “Hang up” key on the “Call inProgress” display.

● Push the switch on the steeringwheel.

● When the “Call in Progress” screen is dis-played, press the PHONE button on theinstrument panel to hang up. If any otherscreen is currently displayed, press thePHONE button to display the “Call in Prog-ress” screen first, then press the PHONEbutton again to hang up.

PHONE SETTINGSTo set up the Bluetooth� Hands-Free PhoneSystem to your preferred settings, press the SET-TING button on the instrument panel and selectthe “Phone” key on the display.

Edit Vehicle Phonebook:See “Vehicle Phonebook” in this section for add-ing, editing and deleting contacts in the vehiclephonebook.

Delete Phonebook:Delete a phonebook stored on the system.

Download Handset Phonebook:See “Handset Phonebook” in this section foradding, editing and deleting contacts in thehandset phonebook.

LHA1324 LHA1319

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-139

Page 300: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Volume & Ringtone:Adjust the volume level of the ringtone, incomingcall sound and outgoing call sound. When the“Automatic Hold” option is turned on, an incom-ing call will be placed on hold automatically afterseveral rings. When the “Vehicle Ringtone” op-tion is turned on, a specific ringtone that is differ-ent from the cellular phone’s will sound whenreceiving a call.

Auto Downloaded:See “Handset Phonebook” in this section forinformation about automatically downloading thehandset phonebook.

BLUETOOTH SETTINGSTo set up the Bluetooth� Hands-Free PhoneSystem to your preferred settings, press the SET-TING button on the instrument panel and selectthe “Bluetooth” key on the display.

Bluetooth:Turn the Bluetooth� system on or off.

Connect Bluetooth:See “Connecting procedure” in this section formore information about connecting a phone.

Connected Devices:Display a list of the Bluetooth� devices con-nected to the system.

Edit Bluetooth Info:Check information about the device name, deviceaddress and device PIN.

Replace Connected Phone:Replace the phone currently connected to thesystem. This option allows you to keep any voic-etags that were recorded using the previousphone.

LHA1325 LHA1316

4-140 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 301: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CALL VOLUMEAdjusting the incoming or outgoing call volumemay improve clarity if reception between callers isunclear.

● Incoming call — adjusting this setting allowsyou to hear a difference in volume.

● Outgoing call — adjusting this setting allowsthe person you are talking with to hear adifference in volume.

To access the settings, press the SETTING but-ton, then select “Volume & Beeps”.

You can also adjust the volume of an incomingvoice during a call by pushing the volume controlswitch on the steering wheel or by turning thevolume control knob on the instrument panel.

NISSAN Voice Recognition allows hands-freeoperation of the systems equipped on this ve-hicle, such as phone and vehicle information.

There are two voice recognition modes of opera-tion available. They are:

● Standard Mode

● Alternate Command Mode

In Standard Mode (the factory default setting),commands that are available are always shownon the display and announced by the system. Youcan complete your desired operation by simplyfollowing the prompts given by the system. Not allNISSAN Voice Recognition options are availablewhile in Standard Mode.

For advanced operation, you can change to anAlternate Command Mode that enables the op-eration of the display, audio, and climate controlthrough NISSAN Voice Recognition. When thismode is active, an expanded list of commandscan be spoken after pushing the TALKswitch on the steering wheel, and the voice com-mand menu prompts are turned off.

In Alternate Command Mode the recognitionsuccess rate may be affected because the num-ber of available commands and the ways ofspeaking each command are increased. See“NISSAN Voice Recognition Alternate Com-mand Mode” in this section.

LHA1253

NISSAN VOICE RECOGNITIONSYSTEM (if so equipped)

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-141

Page 302: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

To improve the recognition success rate whenAlternate Command Mode is active, try using theSpeaker Adaptation Function available in thatmode. See “Speaker Adaptation Function” in thissection. Otherwise, it is recommended that Alter-nate Command Mode be turned off and StandardMode be used for the best recognition perfor-mance.

While using the NISSAN Voice Recognition sys-tem for certain Phone and Navigation features,you can switch to using manual controls (touch-screen, NISSAN controller, steering wheel con-trols) and the information you have already en-tered by voice control will be retained. To switchto manual controls, select the “Manual Controls”key on the display when it appears. The systemwill respond by speaking “Changing to manualoperation. Please use manual controls to con-tinue.”

For the voice commands for the navigation sys-tem, refer to the Navigation System Owner’sManual of your vehicle.

For vehicles in the U.S., the factory default settingis the Standard Mode. See “Standard Mode” inthis section. For vehicles in Canada, the factorydefault setting is the Alternate Command Mode.See “Alternate Command Mode” in this section.

NISSAN VOICE RECOGNITIONSTANDARD MODEThe Standard Mode enables control of naviga-tion, phone and vehicle information. With thissetting active, commands that are available arealways shown on the display and announced bythe system.

Displaying user guideIf you use the NISSAN Voice Recognition systemfor the first time or you do not know how tooperate it, you can display the User Guide forconfirmation.

You can confirm how to use voice commands byaccessing a simplified User Guide, which con-tains basic instructions and tutorials for severalvoice commands.

1. Press the INFO button on the instrumentpanel.

2. Select the “Others” key.

3. Select the “Voice Recognition” key.

NOTE:

You can skip steps 1 to 3 by pressingthe switch and saying “Help”.

4. Select the “User Guide” key.

5. Select an item.

LHA1326

4-142 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 303: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Available items:

● Getting Started

Describes the basics of how to operate theVoice Recognition system.

● Let’s Practice

Initiates a practice session that demon-strates how to improve voice recognition bythe system.

● Using the Address Book

Tutorial for using the Address Book

● Finding a Street Address

Tutorial for entering a destination by streetaddress.

● Placing Calls

Tutorial for making a phone call by voicecommand operation.

● Help on Speaking

Displays useful tips of speaking for correctcommand recognition by the system.

Getting startedBefore using the Voice Recognition system forthe first time, you can confirm how to use com-mands by viewing the Getting Started section ofthe User Guide.

1. Select the “Getting Started” key.

2. You can confirm the page by scrolling thescreen using the NISSAN controller ortouching the page down key.

Tutorials on the operation of the Voice Rec-ognition system

If you choose “Finding a Street Address”, “Usingthe Address Book” or “Placing Calls”, you canview tutorials on how to perform these operationsusing Voice Recognition.

LHA1329

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-143

Page 304: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Let’s PracticeThe system is equipped with a tutorial that allowsyou to practice saying commands and receivefeedback on the volume, speed and timing of yourspeech.

To initiate a practice session, access the UserGuide and select the “Let’s Practice” key. Followthe on-screen prompts until the session is com-plete. After the session is completed, a screenwill be displayed that shows an analysis of differ-ent elements of your speech. Select the “TryAgain” to repeat the session if improvement isneeded. Select the “Done” key to return to theUser Guide screen.

Useful tips for correct operationYou can display useful speaking tips to help thesystem recognize your voice commands cor-rectly.

1. Select “Help on Speaking”.

2. You can confirm the page by scrolling thescreen using the NISSAN controller ortouching the page down key.

LHA1327 LHA1328 LHA1330

4-144 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 305: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Voice recognition settingsThe available settings of the NISSAN Voice Rec-ognition system are described.

1. Select “Voice Recognition”.

2. You can confirm the page by scrolling thescreen using the NISSAN controller.

USING THE SYSTEMInitializationWhen the ignition switch is placed in the ONposition, NISSAN Voice Recognition is initialized,which takes a few seconds. When completed,the system is ready to accept voice commands. Ifthe switch is pressed before the initializa-tion completes, voice commands will not be ac-cepted. Please wait until the NISSAN Voice Rec-ognition initialization is completed.

BEFORE STARTINGTo get the best recognition performance fromVoice Recognition, observe the following:

● The interior of the vehicle should be as quietas possible. Close the windows to eliminatethe surrounding noises (traffic noise and vi-bration sounds, etc.), which may prevent thesystem from correctly recognizing the voicecommands.

● Wait until the tone sounds before speaking acommand.

● Speak in a natural conversational voice with-out pausing between words.

● If the air conditioner is set to “Auto”, the fanspeed is automatically lowered so that yourcommands can be recognized more easily.

GIVING VOICE COMMANDS

1. Press the switch located on the steer-ing wheel.

LHA1331 WHA1332

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-145

Page 306: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

2. A list of commands appears on the screen,and the system announces, “Would you liketo access Phone, Navigation, Information,Audio or Help?”

3. After the tone sounds and the icon on thescreen changes from to , speaka command.

4. Continue to follow the voice menu promptsand speak after the tone sounds until yourdesired operation is completed.

Operating tips● Say a command after the tone. Voice com-

mands cannot be accepted when the iconis .

● Commands that are available are alwaysshown on the display and spoken throughvoice menu prompts. Commands other thanthose that are displayed are not accepted.Please follow the prompts given by the sys-tem.

● If the command is not recognized, the sys-tem repeats the announcement. Repeat thecommand in a clear voice.

● Press the switch on the steeringwheel to return to the previous screen.

● If you want to cancel the command, pressand hold the switch. The message,“Voice cancelled” will be announced.

● If you want to adjust the volume of the sys-tem feedback, push the volume controlswitch on the steering wheel or use theaudio system volume knob while the systemis making an announcement.

How to speak numbersVoice Recognition requires a certain way tospeak numbers when giving voice commands.Refer to the following examples.

General rule:

● Only single digits 0 (zero) to 9 can be used.

● When saying the phone number 800-662-6200, the system will accept “eight-hundred”in addition to “eight zero zero”or “eight oh oh”.500, 700, and 900 are also supported.

Examples:

● 1-800-662-6200

– “One eight zero zero six six two six twozero zero”

– “One eight hundred six six two six twozero zero”

Improving Recognition of Phone numbers:

You can improve the recognition of phone numbersby saying the phone number in three groups ofnumbers. For example, when you try to call 800-662-6200, say “eight zero zero” first, and the sys-tem will then ask you for the next three digits. Then,say “six six two”. After recognition, the system willthen ask for the last four digits. Say, “six two zerozero”. Using this method of phone digit entry canimprove recognition performance.

NOTE:

When speaking a house number, speak thenumber “0” as “zero” or “oh”. If the letter“O” is included in the house number, it willnot be recognized as “0” even if you speak“oh” instead of “zero”.

LHA1333

4-146 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 307: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Standard Mode command listCategory Command:

COMMAND ACTIONPhone Displays Phone function commands.Navigation Displays Navigation function commands.Information Displays Vehicle Information.Audio Displays Audio commands.Help Displays User Guide.

Phone Command:

COMMAND ACTIONDial Number Makes a call to a spoken phone number up to 10 digits.Change Number Corrects the phone number when it is not recognized (available during phone number entry).Vehicle Phonebook Makes a call to a contact that is stored in the vehicle phonebook.Handset Phonebook Makes a call to a contact that is stored in the handset phonebook.Call History Makes a call to a number in the incoming or outgoing call logs.International Call Makes an international call by allowing more than 10 digits to be spoken, as well as star (*), pound (#), and plus (+).

Navigation Command:

COMMAND ACTIONHome Sets a route to your home that is stored in the Address Book.Address Searches for a location by the street address specified, and sets a route (for continental US and Canada only).Places Sets a route to a facility near the current vehicle location.Address Book Searches for a location stored in the Address Book.Previous Destinations Sets a route to a previous destination.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-147

Page 308: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Vehicle Information Command:

COMMAND ACTIONFuel Economy Displays Fuel Economy information.Maintenance Displays Maintenance information.Traffic Info. Turns the traffic information system on and off.Where am I? Displays current vehicle location.

Audio Command:

COMMAND ACTIONAM Changes the audio system mode to AM radio.FM Changes the audio system mode to FM radio.XM Changes the audio system mode to satellite radio.Music Box Changes the audio system mode to Music Box.CD Changes the audio system mode to CD.

4-148 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 309: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Voice command examplesSome basic voice command examples are de-scribed here.

For navigation system commands, see the sepa-rate Navigation System Owner’s Manual.

Example 1 — Placing a call to the phonenumber 800-662-6200:

1. Press the switch located on the steer-ing wheel.

2. The system announces, “Would you like toaccess Phone, Navigation, Information, Au-dio or Help?”

3. Say “Phone”.

WHA1332 LHA1333

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-149

Page 310: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

4. Say “Dial Number”. 5. Say “800”. 6. The system announces, “Please say the nextthree digits or dial, or say change number.”

7. Say “662”.

LHA1334 LHA1335 LHA1336

4-150 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 311: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

8. The system announces, “Please say the lastfour digits or say change number.”

9. Say “6200”.

10. The system announces, “Dial or ChangeNumber?”

11. Say “Dial”.

12. The system makes a call to 800-662- 6200.

NOTE:

● You can also speak “800-662-6200” (10continuous digits) or “662-6200” (7 con-tinuous digits), if the area code is not nec-essary. However, the 3-3-4 digit grouping isrecommended for improved recognition.See “How to speak numbers” in this section.

● You can only say a phone number using the3-3-4 grouping, 7 digits, and 10 digits usingthis command. Please use the “InternationalCall” command for all other formats, andwhen special characters such as star (*),pound (#), and plus (+) need to be entered.

● If you say “Change Number” during phonenumber entry, the system will automaticallyrequest that you repeat the number usingthe 3-3-4 format. In this case please say thearea code first and then follow the prompts.

● Do not add a “1” in front of the area codewhen speaking phone numbers.

● If the system does not recognize your com-mand, please try repeating the commandusing a natural voice. Speaking too slowly ortoo loudly may further decrease recognitionperformance.

LHA1337 LHA1338

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-151

Page 312: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Example 2 — Placing an international callto the phone number 011-81-111-222-3333:

1. Press the switch located on the steer-ing wheel.

2. The system announces, “Would you like toaccess Phone, Navigation, Information, Au-dio or Help?”

3. Say “Phone”.

4. Say “International Call”.WHA1332 LHA1333 LHA1334

4-152 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 313: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

5. Say “011811112223333”. 6. Say “Dial”.

7. The system makes a call to 011-81-111-222-3333.

NOTE:

Any digit input format is available in theInternational Number input process, aswell as the special characters such as star(*), pound (#), and plus (+).

NISSAN VOICE RECOGNITIONALTERNATE COMMAND MODEThe Alternate Command Mode enables controlof the Audio, Climate Control and Display sys-tems as well as additional commands for theVehicle Information, Phone and Navigation sys-tems. With this setting active, the system doesnot announce or display the available commandsat each step.

When Alternate Command Mode is activated, anexpanded list of commands can be used afterpushing the TALK switch. Under thismode, the screen for Standard Mode commandsis not available on the display. Please review theexpanded command list, available when thismode is active, as some Standard Mode com-mands are replaced. Please see examples ofAlternate Command Mode screens.

Please note that in this mode the recognitionsuccess rate may be affected as the number ofavailable commands and ways of speaking eachcommand are increased. You can turn this modeON or OFF. When this mode is activated, theVoice Recognition Settings will change to showmore options.

LHA1339 LHA1340

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-153

Page 314: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Activating Alternate Command Mode1. Press the SETTING button on the instru-

ment panel.

2. Select the “Others” key on the display.

3. Select the “Voice Recognition” key.

4. Select the “Alternate Command Mode” key.

5. The confirmation message is displayed onthe screen. Select the “OK” key to activatethe Alternate Command Mode.

6. Alternate Command Mode is activated andthe setting menu is expanded to include theAlternate Command Mode options. See“Settings menu” in this section for an expla-nation of the options.

Displaying the command listIf you are controlling the system by voice com-mands for the first time or do not know theappropriate voice command, perform the follow-ing procedure for displaying the voice commandlist (available only in Alternate Command Mode).

Press the switch, listen for the tone andsay, “Help”. The system will respond by display-ing the command list main menu.

LHA1248 LHA1331 LHA1341

4-154 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 315: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Only manual controls such as the touchscreencan navigate the command list menu.

As an alternative to the voice command “Help”,you may access the command list using the fol-lowing steps:

1. Press the INFO button on the instrumentpanel.

2. Select the “Others” key using the NISSANcontroller.

3. Select the “Voice Recognition” key using theNISSAN controller.

NOTE:

You can skip steps 1 to 3 if you say “Help”.

4. Select the “Command List” key using theNISSAN controller.

5. Select a category using the NISSAN con-troller. The command list for the categoryselected is shown.

6. If necessary, scroll the screen using theNISSAN controller to view the entire list.

7. Press the BACK button to return to theprevious screen.

LHA1342 LHA1231 LHA1342

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-155

Page 316: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Alternate Command Mode command list

Phone Command:

COMMAND ACTIONDial Number Makes a call to a spoken phone number up to 10 digits.Vehicle Phonebook Makes a call to a contact in the vehicle phonebook.Handset Phonebook Makes a call to a contact in the handset phonebook.International Call Makes an international call by allowing more than 10 digits to be spoken, as well as star (*), pound (#), and plus (+).Call <name> Makes a call to a contact that is stored in either the Vehicle Phonebook or Handset Phonebook. Please say “Call” followed by a stored

name.Incoming Calls Shows the last 5 incoming phone calls.Outgoing Calls Shows the last 5 outgoing phone calls.Missed Calls Shows the last 5 missed phone calls.

Navigation Command:

COMMAND ACTIONHome Sets a route to your home that is stored in the Address Book.Address Searches for a location by the street address specified, and sets a route (for continental US and Canada only).Places Sets a route to a facility near the current vehicle location.Address Book Displays the first 5 entries of the Address Book.Previous Destinations Sets a route to a previous destination.Previous Start Point Calculates a route to your previous starting point of the last route.Minimize Freeway Route Recalculates a route to the current destination while minimizing freeway usage.Fastest Route Recalculates a route to the current destination using the fastest estimated time.Shortest Route Recalculates a route to the current destination using the shortest distance.Cancel Route Cancels the current route.Delete Destination Deletes the current destination.Birdview Map Changes the Map display to Birdview.

4-156 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 317: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

COMMAND ACTIONPlanview Map Changes the Map display to a 2-dimensional view.North Up Changes the Map display to keep north pointing up on the screen.Heading Up Changes the Map display to keep the direction of the vehicle pointing up on the screen.Zoom In <1 to 13> Changes the map scale to a smaller number.Zoom Out <1 to 13> Changes the map scale to a larger number.Guidance Voice ON/OFF Turns the navigation voice guidance on or off.Guide Voice Repeat Repeats the last navigation voice guidance.

Information Command:

COMMAND ACTIONFuel Economy Displays Fuel Economy information.Maintenance Display Maintenance information.Traffic Information Turns the traffic information system on and off.Where am I? Displays the current vehicle location.Weather Information Displays weather information.Weather Map Displays the current weather map.

Audio Command:

COMMAND ACTIONAM Turns to the AM band, selecting the station last played.FM Turns to the FM band, selecting the station last played.XM Turns to the SAT band, selecting the station last played.Music Box Turns to the Music Box hard-disk drive audio system.CD Starts to play a CD.USB Turns to the USB audio input.Bluetooth Audio Turns to the Bluetooth� audio system.AUX Turns to the AUX input.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-157

Page 318: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Displaying user guideYou can confirm how to use voice commands byaccessing a simplified User Guide, which con-tains basic instructions and tutorials for severalvoice commands.

1. Press the INFO button on the instrumentpanel.

2. Select the “Others” key.

3. Select the “Voice Recognition” key.

4. Select the “User Guide” key.

5. Select an item.

Available items:

● Getting Started

Describes the basics of how to operate theVoice Recognition system.

● Let’s Practice

Initiates a practice session that demon-strates how to improve recognition by thesystem.

● Using the Address Book

Tutorial for using the Address Book.

● Finding a Street Address

Tutorial for Finding a Street Address.

● Placing Calls

Tutorial for making a phone call by voicecommand operation.

● Help on Speaking

Displays useful tips for how to correctlyspeak commands in order for them to beproperly recognized by the system.

● Voice Recognition Settings

Describes the available Voice Recognitionsettings.

● Adapting the System to Your Voice

Tutorial for adapting the system to yourvoice.

USING THE SYSTEM

InitializationWhen the ignition switch is placed in the ONposition, NISSAN Voice Recognition is initialized,which takes a few seconds. When completed,the system is ready to accept voice commands. Ifthe switch is pressed before the initializa-tion completes, the display will show the mes-sage: “System not ready.” or a beep sounds.

LHA1343 LHA1344

4-158 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 319: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Before startingTo get the best performance from NISSAN VoiceRecognition, observe the following:

● Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet aspossible. Close the windows to eliminate thesurrounding noises (traffic noises, vibrationsounds, etc.), which may prevent the systemfrom recognizing the voice commands cor-rectly.

● When the climate control is in the AUTOmode, the fan speed decreases automati-cally for easy recognition.

● Wait until a tone sounds before speaking acommand.

● Speak in a natural voice without pausingbetween words.

Giving voice commands

1. Press and release the switch locatedon the steering wheel.

2. A list of commands appears on the screen,and the system announces, “Please say acommand from the displayed list or say Helpto show all commands.”

3. After the tone sounds and the icon on the

screen changes from to , speaka command.

4. Once a command is recognized, the systemwill announce the recognized command andperform the requested action.

If the command is not recognized, the sys-tem repeats the announcement. Repeat thecommand in a clear voice after the tone.

WHA1332 LHA1345

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-159

Page 320: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Operating tips● Say a command after the tone. Voice com-

mands cannot be accepted when the iconis .

● If the command is not recognized, the sys-tem repeats the announcement. Repeat thecommand in a clear voice.

● Press the switch on the steeringwheel to return to the previous screen.

● If you want to cancel the command, pressand hold the switch. The message,“Voice cancelled” will be announced.

● If you want to adjust the volume of the sys-tem feedback, push the volume controlswitch on the steering wheel or use theaudio system volume knob while the systemis making an announcement.

● To minimize the amount of prompts spokenby the system in Alternate Command Mode,use the Minimize Voice Feedback function.To access the Minimize Voice Feedbackfunction press the SETTING button, thenselect the “Others” key. Then select the“Voice Recognition” key.

How to speak numbersVoice Recognition requires a certain way tospeak numbers when giving voice commands.Refer to the following examples.

General rule:

● Only single digits 0 (zero) to 9 can be used.

● When saying the phone number 800-662-6200, the system will accept “eight-hundred” in addition to “eight zero zero” or“eight oh oh”. 500, 700, and 900 are alsosupported.

Examples:

● 1-800-662-6200

– “One eight zero zero six six two six twozero zero”

– “One eight hundred six six two six twozero zero”

Improving Recognition of Phone numbers:

You can improve the recognition of phone num-bers by saying the phone number in three groupsof numbers. For example, when you try to call800-662-6200, say “eight zero zero” first, andthe system will then ask you for the next threedigits. Then, say “six six two”. After recognition,the system will then ask for the last four digits.Say, “six two zero zero”. Using this method ofphone digit entry can improve recognition perfor-mance.

NOTE:

When speaking a house number, speak thenumber “0” as “zero” or “oh”. If the letter“O” is included in the house number, it willnot be recognized as “0” even if you speak“oh” instead of “zero”.

Settings menuThe content of the Settings Menu differs whenthe system is in the Alternate Command Mode.

Command List:

Displays the command list for Alternate Com-mand Mode.

4-160 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 321: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

User Guide:

The user guide provides basic instructions forusing Voice Recognition and accessing somevoice commands.

NOTE:

The user guide can also be accessed fromwithin the INFO menu after pressing theINFO button.

Speaker Adaptation:

Starts a system training procedure to learn thespecific sounds of your voice. See “Speaker ad-aptation function” in this section.

Alternate Command Mode:

For advanced operation, an Alternate CommandMode is provided. This setting enables control ofthe Audio and Climate Control systems in addi-tion to additional commands for the Phone andNavigation systems. With this setting active, thesystem does not announce or display the avail-able commands at each step. When this mode isactivated, the Voice Recognition Settings willchange to show more options.

Minimize Voice Feedback:

Reduces the amount of the information spokenfor each voice instruction.

SPEAKER ADAPTATION FUNCTIONThe Voice Recognition system has a function tolearn the user’s voice for better voice recognitionperformance. The system can memorize thevoices of up to three persons.

Having the system learn the user’svoice

1. Press the SETTING button on the instru-ment panel, select the “Others” key on thedisplay.

2. Select the “Voice Recognition” key.

3. Select the “Speaker Adaptation” key.

4. Select the user whose voice is to be memo-rized by the system.

LHA1341 LHA1346

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-161

Page 322: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

5. Select a category to be learned by the sys-tem from the following list:

● Phone

● Navigation

● Information

● Audio

● Help

The voice commands in the category aredisplayed.

6. Select a voice command to train.

The Voice Recognition system starts.

7. The system requests that you repeat a com-mand after a tone. This command is alsodisplayed on the screen.

8. After the tone sounds and the icon on the

screen changes from to , speakthe command that the system requested.

9. When the system has recognized the voicecommand, the voice of the user is learned.

Press the switch or the BACK button toreturn to the previous screen.

If the system has learned the command correctly,the voice command indicator on the screen turnson.

Speaker Adaptation function settingsEdit Name:

Edit the user name using the keypad displayed onthe screen.

Reset Result:

Resets the user’s voice that the Voice Recogni-tion system has learned.

Continuous Learning:

When this item is turned to ON, you can have thesystem learn the voice commands in succession,without selecting commands one by one.

LHA1347 LHA1348 LHA1349

4-162 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 323: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDEThe system should respond correctly to all voicecommands without difficulty. If problems are en-countered, follow the solutions given in this guidefor the appropriate error.

Where the solutions are listed by number, tryeach solution in turn, starting with number one,until the problem is resolved.

Symptom/error message SolutionDisplays “COMMAND NOT RECOG-NIZED” or the system fails to interpretthe command correctly.

1. Ensure that the command format is valid, see “Standard Mode command list” or “Alternate Command Mode command list” in thissection.

2. Speak clearly using your normal speech pattern and at a level appropriate to the ambient noise level.3. Ensure that the ambient noise level is not excessive, for example, windows open or defrost on.

NOTE:

If it is too noisy to use the phone, it is likely that voice commands will not be recognized.The system consistently selects thewrong voicetag in the phonebook.

1. Ensure that the voicetag requested matches what was originally stored. See “Bluetooth� Hands-Free Phone System with NavigationSystem” in this section.

2. Replace one of the voicetags being confused with a different voicetag.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-163

Page 324: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

MEMO

4-164 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Page 325: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

5 Starting and driving

Precautions when starting and driving. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2Exhaust gas (carbon monoxide) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2Three-way catalyst. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). . . . . . . . . . 5-3Avoiding collision and rollover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5Off-road recovery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6Rapid air pressure loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6Drinking alcohol/drugs and driving. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7

Push-Button Ignition Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7Push-button ignition switch positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8Emergency engine shut off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9NISSAN Intelligent Key™ battery discharge . . . . . . . . 5-9NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10

Before starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11Driving the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11

Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT). . . . . . . . 5-11Parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17Cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18

Precautions on cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18Cruise control operations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18

Break-in schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19Increasing fuel economy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20Parking/parking on hills. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21Power steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22Brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22

Brake precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22Anti-lock Braking System (ABS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23

Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24Cold weather driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26

Freeing a frozen door lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26Anti-freeze. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26Draining of coolant water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26Tire equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26Special winter equipment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26Driving on snow or ice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26Engine block heater (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-27

Page 326: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● Do not leave children or adults whowould normally require the assistanceof others alone in your vehicle. Petsshould also not be left alone. Theycould accidentally injure themselves orothers through inadvertent operation ofthe vehicle. Also, on hot, sunny days,temperatures in a closed vehicle couldquickly become high enough to causesevere or possibly fatal injuries topeople or animals.

● Closely supervise children when theyare around cars to prevent them fromplaying and becoming locked in thetrunk where they could be seriously in-jured. Keep the car locked, with the rearseatback and trunk lid securely latchedwhen not in use, and prevent children’saccess to car keys.

EXHAUST GAS (carbon monoxide)

WARNING

● Do not breathe exhaust gases; theycontain colorless and odorless carbonmonoxide. Carbon monoxide is danger-ous. It can cause unconsciousness ordeath.

● If you suspect that exhaust fumes areentering the vehicle, drive with all win-dows fully open, and have the vehicleinspected immediately.

● Do not run the engine in closed spacessuch as a garage.

● Do not park the vehicle with the enginerunning for any extended length of time.

● Keep the rear vent windows, lift gates,doors and trunk lids (if so equipped)closed while driving, otherwise exhaustgases could be drawn into the passen-ger compartment. If you must drive withone of these open, follow theseprecautions:

1. Open all the windows.

2. Set the air recirculation but-ton to off and the fan control dial tohigh to circulate the air.

● If electrical wiring or other cable con-nections must pass to a trailer throughthe seal on the trunk lid or the body,follow the manufacturer’s recommen-dation to prevent carbon monoxide en-try into the vehicle.

● The exhaust system and body should beinspected by a qualified mechanicwhenever:a. The vehicle is raised for service.b. You suspect that exhaust fumes are

entering into the passengercompartment.

c. You notice a change in the sound ofthe exhaust system.

d. You have had an accident involvingdamage to the exhaust system, un-derbody, or rear of the vehicle.

THREE-WAY CATALYST

The three-way catalyst is an emission controldevice installed in the exhaust system. Exhaustgases in the three-way catalyst are burned athigh temperatures to help reduce pollutants.

WARNING

● The exhaust gas and the exhaust sys-tem are very hot. Keep people, animalsor flammable materials away from theexhaust system components.

● Do not stop or park the vehicle overflammable materials such as dry grass,waste paper or rags. They may igniteand cause a fire.

PRECAUTIONS WHEN STARTINGAND DRIVING

5-2 Starting and driving

Page 327: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CAUTION

● Do not use leaded gasoline. Depositsfrom leaded gasoline will seriously re-duce the three-way catalyst’s ability tohelp reduce exhaust pollutants.

● Keep your engine tuned up. Malfunc-tions in the ignition, fuel injection, orelectrical systems can cause overrichfuel flow into the three-way catalyst,causing it to overheat. Do not keep driv-ing if the engine misfires, or if notice-able loss of performance or other un-usual operating conditions aredetected. Have the vehicle inspectedpromptly by a NISSAN dealer.

● Avoid driving with an extremely low fuellevel. Running out of fuel could causethe engine to misfire, damaging thethree-way catalyst.

● Do not race the engine while warming itup.

● Do not push or tow your vehicle to startthe engine.

TIRE PRESSURE MONITORINGSYSTEM (TPMS)Each tire, including the spare (if provided),should be checked monthly when cold and in-flated to the inflation pressure recommended bythe vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placardor tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle hastires of a different size than the size indicated onthe vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label,you should determine the proper tire inflationpressure for those tires.)

As an added safety feature, your vehicle has beenequipped with a tire pressure monitoring system(TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltalewhen one or more of your tires is significantlyunder-inflated. Accordingly, when the low tirepressure telltale illuminates, you should stop andcheck your tires as soon as possible, and inflatethem to the proper pressure. Driving on a signifi-cantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to over-heat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflationalso reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, andmay affect the vehicle’s handling and stoppingability.

Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute forproper tire maintenance, and it is the driver’sresponsibility to maintain correct tire pressure,even if under-inflation has not reached the level totrigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressuretelltale.

Your vehicle has also been equipped with aTPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when thesystem is not operating properly. The TPMS mal-function indicator is combined with the low tirepressure telltale. When the system detects amalfunction, the telltale will flash for approxi-mately one minute and then remain continuouslyilluminated. This sequence will continue uponsubsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the mal-function exists. When the malfunction indicator isilluminated, the system may not be able to detector signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMSmalfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons,including the installation of replacement or alter-nate tires or wheels on the vehicle that preventthe TPMS from functioning properly. Alwayscheck the TPMS malfunction telltale after replac-ing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle toensure that the replacement or alternate tires andwheels allow the TPMS to continue to functionproperly.

Starting and driving 5-3

Page 328: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Additional information:

● The TPMS does not monitor the tirepressure of the spare tire.

● The TPMS will activate only when the vehicleis driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25km/h). Also, this system may not detect asudden drop in tire pressure (for example aflat tire while driving).

● The low tire pressure warning light does notautomatically turn off when the tire pressureis adjusted. After all 4 tires are inflated to therecommended pressure, the vehicle must bedriven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h)to activate the TPMS and turn off the low tirepressure warning light. Use a tire pressuregauge to check the tire pressure.

● The CHECK TIRE PRESSURE warning ap-pears in the vehicle information display whenthe low tire pressure warning light is illumi-nated and low tire pressure is detected. TheCHECK TIRE PRESSURE warning turns offwhen the low tire pressure warning lightturns off.

● The CHECK TIRE PRESSURE warningdoes not appear if the low tire pressurewarning light illuminates to indicate a TPMSmalfunction.

● Tire pressure rises and falls depending onthe heat caused by the vehicle’s operationand the outside temperature. Low outsidetemperature can lower the temperature ofthe air inside the tire which can cause alower tire inflation pressure. This may causethe low tire pressure warning light to illumi-nate. If the warning light illuminates in lowambient temperature, check the tire pres-sure for all four tires.

● The Tire and Loading Information label (alsoreferred to as the vehicle placard or tireinflation pressure label) is located in thedriver’s door opening.

For additional information, see “Low tire pressurewarning light” in the “Instruments and controls”section and “Tire Pressure Monitoring System(TPMS)” in the “In case of emergency” section.

WARNING

● If the low tire pressure warning lightilluminates while driving, avoid suddensteering maneuvers or abrupt braking,reduce vehicle speed, pull off the roadto a safe location and stop the vehicleas soon as possible. Driving with under-inflated tires may permanently damagethe tires and increase the likelihood oftire failure. Serious vehicle damagecould occur and may lead to an acci-dent and could result in serious per-sonal injury. Check the tire pressure forall four tires. Adjust the tire pressure tothe recommended COLD tire pressureshown on the Tire and Loading Informa-tion label to turn the low tire pressurewarning light OFF. If you have a flat tire,replace it with a spare tire as soon aspossible. (See “Flat tire” in the “In caseof emergency” section for changing aflat tire.)

5-4 Starting and driving

Page 329: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● When a spare tire is mounted or a wheelis replaced, tire pressure will not beindicated, the TPMS will not functionand the low tire pressure warning lightwill flash for approximately 1 minute.The light will remain on after 1 minute.Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon aspossible for tire replacement and/orsystem resetting.

● Replacing tires with those not originallyspecified by NISSAN could affect theproper operation of the TPMS.

● Do not inject any tire liquid or aerosoltire sealant into the tires, as this maycause a malfunction of the tire pressuresensors.

CAUTION

Do not place metalized film or any metalparts (antenna, etc.) on the windows. Thismay cause poor reception of the signalsfrom the tire pressure sensors, and theTPMS will not function properly.

Some devices and transmitters may temporarilyinterfere with the operation of the TPMS andcause the low tire pressure warning light to illu-minate.

Some examples are:

– Facilities or electric devices using similar radiofrequencies are near the vehicle.

– If a transmitter set to similar frequencies isbeing used in or near the vehicle.

– If a computer (or similar equipment) or aDC/AC converter is being used in or near thevehicle.

FCC Notice:

For USA:

This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC Rules. Operation is subject to the fol-lowing two conditions:

1. This device may not cause harmful in-terference, and

2. This device must accept any interfer-ence received, including interferencethat may cause undesired operation.Note: Changes or modification not ex-pressly approved by the party respon-sible for compliance could void the us-er’s authority to operate theequipment.

For Canada:

This device complies with RSS-210 of In-dustry Canada. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions:

1. This device may not cause interfer-ence, and

2. This device must accept any interfer-ence, include interference that maycause undesired operation of the de-vice.

AVOIDING COLLISION ANDROLLOVER

WARNING

Failure to operate this vehicle in a safeand prudent manner may result in loss ofcontrol or an accident.

Be alert and drive defensively at all times. Obeyall traffic regulations. Avoid excessive speed,high speed cornering, or sudden steering ma-neuvers, because these driving practices couldcause you to lose control of your vehicle. As withany vehicle, loss of control could result in acollision with other vehicles or objects orcause the vehicle to roll over, particularly ifthe loss of control causes the vehicle toslide sideways. Be attentive at all times, and

Starting and driving 5-5

Page 330: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

avoid driving when tired. Never drive when underthe influence of alcohol or drugs (including pre-scription or over-the-counter drugs which maycause drowsiness). Always wear your seat beltas outlined in the “Safety – Seats, seat belts andsupplemental restraint system” section of thismanual, and also instruct your passengers to doso.

Seat belts help reduce the risk of injury in colli-sions and rollovers. In a rollover crash, anunbelted or improperly belted person issignificantly more likely to be injured orkilled than a person properly wearing aseat belt.

OFF-ROAD RECOVERY

If the right side or left side wheels unintentionallyleave the road surface, maintain control of thevehicle by following the procedure below. Pleasenote that this procedure is only a general guide.The vehicle must be driven as appropriate basedon the conditions of the vehicle, road and traffic.

1. Remain calm and do not overreact.

2. Do not apply the brakes.

3. Maintain a firm grip on the steering wheelwith both hands and try to hold a straightcourse.

4. When appropriate , slowly release the accel-erator pedal to gradually slow the vehicle.

5. If there is nothing in the way, steer the ve-hicle to follow the road while vehicle speedis reduced. Do not attempt to drive the ve-hicle back onto the road surface until vehiclespeed is reduced.

6. When it is safe to do so, gradually turn thesteering wheel until both tires return to theroad surface. When all tires are on the roadsurface, steer the vehicle to stay in the ap-propriate driving lane.

● If you decide that it is not safe to return thevehicle to the road surface based on vehicle,road or traffic conditions, gradually slow thevehicle to a stop in a safe place off the road.

RAPID AIR PRESSURE LOSSRapid air pressure loss or a “blow-out” can occurif the tire is punctured or is damaged due tohitting a curb or pothole. Rapid air pressure losscan also be caused by driving on under-inflatedtires.

Rapid air pressure loss can affect the handlingand stability of the vehicle, especially at highwayspeeds.

Help prevent rapid air pressure loss by maintain-ing the correct air pressure and visually inspectthe tires for wear and damage. See “Wheels andtires” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself”section of this manual. If a tire rapidly loses airpressure or “blows-out” while driving, maintaincontrol of the vehicle by following the procedurebelow. Please note that this procedure is only ageneral guide. The vehicle must be driven asappropriate based on the conditions of the ve-hicle, road and traffic.

WARNING

The following actions can increase thechance of losing control of the vehicle ifthere is a sudden loss of tire air pressure.Losing control of the vehicle may cause acollision and result in personal injury.

● The vehicle generally moves or pulls inthe direction of the flat tire.

● Do not rapidly apply the brakes.

● Do not rapidly release the acceleratorpedal.

● Do not rapidly turn the steering wheel.

1. Remain calm and do not over react.

5-6 Starting and driving

Page 331: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

2. Maintain a firm grip on the steering wheelwith both hands and try to hold a straightcourse.

3. When appropriate, slowly release the accel-erator pedal to gradually slow the vehicle.

4. Gradually steer the vehicle to a safe locationoff the road and away from traffic if possible.

5. Lightly apply the brake pedal to graduallystop the vehicle.

6. Turn on the hazard warning flashers andeither contact a roadside emergency serviceto change the tire or see “Changing a flattire” in the “In case of emergency” section ofthis manual.

DRINKING ALCOHOL/DRUGS ANDDRIVING

WARNING

Never drive under the influence of alcoholor drugs. Alcohol in the bloodstream re-duces coordination, delays reaction timeand impairs judgement. Driving afterdrinking alcohol increases the likelihoodof being involved in an accident injuringyourself and others. Additionally, if youare injured in an accident, alcohol canincrease the severity of the injury.

NISSAN is committed to safe driving. However,you must choose not to drive under the influenceof alcohol. Every year thousands of people areinjured or killed in alcohol-related accidents. Al-though the local laws vary on what is consideredto be legally intoxicated, the fact is that alcoholaffects all people differently and most peopleunderestimate the effects of alcohol.

Remember, drinking and driving don’t mix! Andthat is true for drugs, too (over-the-counter, pre-scription, and illegal drugs). Don’t drive if yourability to operate your vehicle is impaired by alco-hol, drugs, or some other physical condition.

WARNING

Do not operate the push-button ignitionswitch while driving the vehicle except inan emergency. (The engine will stop whenthe ignition switch is pushed 3 consecu-tive times in quick succession or the igni-tion switch is pushed and held for morethan 2 seconds.) If the engine stops whilethe vehicle is being driven, this could leadto a crash and serious injury.

PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH

Starting and driving 5-7

Page 332: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

When the ignition switch is pushed without de-pressing the brake pedal, the ignition switch po-sition will illuminate as follows:

Push the ignition switch center:

● once to change to ACC.

● two times to change to ON.

● three times to return to OFF.

The ignition switch will automatically return to theLOCK position when any door is either opened orclosed with the switch in the OFF position.

The ignition lock is designed so that the ignitionswitch position cannot be switched to OFF untilthe shift selector is moved to the P (Park) posi-tion.

When the ignition switch cannot be pushed to-ward the OFF position, proceed as follows:

1. Move the shift selector into the P (Park)position.

2. Push the ignition switch. The ignition switchposition will change to the ON position.

3. Push the ignition switch again to the OFFposition.

The shift selector can be moved from the P(Park) position if the ignition switch is inthe ON position and the brake pedal isdepressed.

If the battery of the vehicle is discharged,the push-button ignition switch cannot bemoved from the LOCK position.

Some indicators and warnings for operation aredisplayed on the vehicle information display. See“Vehicle information display” in the “Instrumentsand controls” section of this manual.

PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCHPOSITIONS

LOCK (Normal parking position):

The ignition switch can only be locked in thisposition.

The ignition switch will be unlocked when it ispushed to the ACC position while carrying theIntelligent Key or with the Intelligent Key insertedin the port.

The ignition switch will lock when any door isopened or closed with the ignition switched off.

OFF:

The ignition switch is in the OFF position whenthe engine is turned off using the ignition switch.No lights will illuminate on the ignition switch.

ACC (Accessories):

This position activates electrical accessories,such as the radio, when the engine is not running.

ACC has a battery saver feature that will turn theignition switch to the OFF position after 30 min-utes under the following conditions:

● all doors are closed.

● shift selector is in P (Park).

LSD2000

5-8 Starting and driving

Page 333: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

The battery saver feature will be cancelled if anyof the following occur:

● any door is opened.

● shift selector is moved out of the P (Park).

● ignition switch changes position.

ON (Normal operating position):

This position turns on the ignition system andelectrical accessories.

CAUTION

Do not leave the vehicle with the ignitionswitch in ACC or ON positions when theengine is not running for an extended pe-riod. This can discharge the battery.

EMERGENCY ENGINE SHUT OFFTo shut off the engine in an emergency situationwhile driving perform the following procedure:

– Rapidly push the push-button ignition switch 3consecutive times, or

– Push and hold the push-button ignition switchfor more than 2 seconds.

NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY™BATTERY DISCHARGEIf the battery of the Intelligent Key is almost dis-charged, the guide light �A of the Intelligent Keyport blinks and the indicator appears on the ve-hicle information display. See “Vehicle informa-tion display” in the “Instruments and controls”section.

In this case, inserting the Intelligent Key into theport �B allows you to start the engine. Make surethe Intelligent Key is placed in the correct direc-tion: The front side faces upward and the key ringside faces downward as illustrated.

To remove the Intelligent Key from the port, pushthe ignition switch to the LOCK position and pullthe Intelligent Key out of the port �C .

NOTE:

The Intelligent Key port does not chargethe Intelligent Key battery. If you see thelow battery indicator, replace the battery assoon as possible. See “Battery replace-ment” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section.

WSD0232 WSD0233

Starting and driving 5-9

Page 334: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CAUTION

● Never place anything except the Intelli-gent Key in the Intelligent Key port. Do-ing so may cause damage to theequipment.

● Make sure the Intelligent Key is in thecorrect direction when inserting it tothe Intelligent Key port. The engine maynot start if it is in the wrong direction.

● Remove the Intelligent Key from theIntelligent Key port after the ignitionswitch is pushed to the LOCK position.

NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZERSYSTEMThe NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer system will notallow the engine to start without the use of theregistered key.

If the engine fails to start using a registered key(for example, when interference is caused byanother registered key, an automated toll roaddevice or automatic payment device on the keyring), restart the engine using the following pro-cedure:

1. Leave the ignition switch in the ON positionfor approximately 5 seconds.

2. Place the ignition switch in the OFF orLOCK position, and wait approximately 10seconds.

3. Repeat steps 1 and 2.

4. Restart the engine while holding the device(which may have caused the interference)separate from the registered key.

If the no start condition re-occurs, NISSAN rec-ommends placing the registered key on a sepa-rate key ring to avoid interference from otherdevices.

● Make sure the area around the vehicle isclear.

● Check fluid levels such as engine oil, cool-ant, brake fluid, and window washer fluid asfrequently as possible, or at least wheneveryou refuel.

● Check that all windows and lights are clean.

● Visually inspect tires for their appearanceand condition. Also check tires for properinflation.

● Lock all doors.

● Position seat and adjust head restraints.

● Adjust inside and outside mirrors.

● Fasten seat belts and ask all passengers todo likewise.

● Check the operation of warning lights whenthe ignition switch is pushed to the ONposition. See “Warning/indicator lights andaudible reminders” in the “Instruments andcontrols” section of this manual.

BEFORE STARTING THE ENGINE

5-10 Starting and driving

Page 335: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Apply the parking brake.

2. Move the shift selector to P (Park) or N(Neutral). P (Park) is recommended.

The starter is designed not to operate ifthe shift selector is in any of the drivingpositions.

3. Push the ignition switch to the ON position.Depress the brake pedal and push the igni-tion switch to start the engine.

To start the engine immediately, push andrelease the ignition switch while depressingthe brake pedal with the ignition switch inany position.

● If the engine is very hard to start in ex-tremely cold weather or when restarting,depress the accelerator pedal a little (ap-proximately 1/3 to the floor) and whileholding, crank the engine. Release theaccelerator pedal when the engine starts.

● If the engine is very hard to start becauseit is flooded, depress the acceleratorpedal all the way to the floor and hold it.Push the ignition switch to the ON posi-tion to start cranking the engine. After 5 or6 seconds, stop cranking by pushing theignition switch to LOCK. After crankingthe engine, release the accelerator pedal.Crank the engine with your foot off the

accelerator pedal by depressing thebrake pedal and pushing the push-buttonignition switch to start the engine. If theengine starts, but fails to run, repeat theabove procedure.

CAUTION

Do not operate the starter for more than15 seconds at a time. If the engine doesnot start, push the ignition switch to theOFF position and wait 10 seconds beforecranking again, otherwise the startercould be damaged.

4. Warm-up

Allow the engine to idle for at least 30 sec-onds after starting. Do not race the enginewhile warming it up. Drive at moderatespeed for a short distance first, especially incold weather. In cold weather, keep the en-gine running for a minimum of 2 - 3 minutesbefore shutting it off. Starting and stoppingthe engine over a short period of time maymake the vehicle more difficult to start.

5. To stop the engine, shift the shift selector tothe P (Park) position and push the ignitionswitch to the OFF position.

CONTINUOUSLY VARIABLETRANSMISSION (CVT)

LSD0238

STARTING THE ENGINE DRIVING THE VEHICLE

Starting and driving 5-11

Page 336: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● Do not depress the accelerator pedalwhile shifting from P (Park) or N (Neu-tral) to R (Reverse), D (Drive), Ds (DriveSport) or (M) Manual shift mode. Al-ways depress the brake pedal untilshifting is completed. Failure to do socould cause you to lose control andhave an accident.

● Cold engine idle speed is high, so usecaution when shifting into a forward orreverse gear before the engine haswarmed up.

● Do not downshift abruptly on slipperyroads. This may cause a loss of control.

● Never shift to P (Park) or R (Reverse)while the vehicle is moving. This couldcause an accident.

● Except in an emergency, do not shift tothe N (Neutral) position while driving.Doing so can cause a loss of enginebraking which may result in a collision,serious personal injury or death. In ad-dition, coasting with the transmissionin the N (Neutral) position may causeserious damage to the transmission.

CAUTION

When stopping the vehicle on an uphillgrade, do not hold the vehicle by depress-ing the accelerator pedal. The foot brakeshould be used for this purpose.

The CVT in your vehicle is electronically con-trolled to produce maximum power and smoothoperation.

The CVT can operate in two different automaticdrive modes:

● D (Drive) mode - Move the shift selector to D(Drive), the transmission is in the normalforward automatic driving mode. The posi-tion indicator in the meter shows a “D”. TheD (Drive) mode does not produce a gearchange sensation like a traditional automatictransmission.

● Ds (Drive Sport) mode - Move the shift se-lector over from D (Drive) to the left into themanual shift gate. The position indicator inthe meter shows a “Ds”. In Ds (Drive Sport)mode, transmission operation changes to�Sporty” driving shift operation, creating amore aggressive acceleration feeling thanthe D (Drive) mode and a gear change sen-sation when the driver accelerates quickly.When the driver selects M (Manual) moderatio with shift selector or shift paddles (if soequipped) during Ds (Drive Sport) modeoperation, the driver must move the shiftselector from Ds mode to D mode and backagain to re-select Ds (Drive Sport) mode.

● To cancel the Ds mode, return the shift se-lector to the D (Drive) position. The trans-mission returns to the automatic drive mode.

The CVT can operate in two manual drive modes:

● M (Manual) mode - With the shift selector inthe manual shift gate Ds (Drive Sport) mode,M (Manual) mode can be selected by mov-ing the shift selector up (+) or down (–) orusing the shift paddles (if so equipped) up(+) or down (–). In M mode, the transmissionwill produce noticeable upshifts and down-shifts. The position indicator in the metershows a “M”.

5-12 Starting and driving

Page 337: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Temporary M (Manual) shift mode - With theshift selector in the D (Drive) mode and if theshift paddle is moved + (up) or - (down), thetransmission will temporarily switch to the M(Manual) mode. If the shift paddles are notused after 5 - 10 seconds, the transmissionwill return to the D (Drive) mode.

● To cancel the M (Manual) mode and return tothe D (Drive) mode, press and hold eithershift paddle for 3 - 5 seconds.

Follow these procedures for maximum vehicleperformance and driving enjoyment.

NOTE:

Engine power may be automatically re-duced to protect the CVT if the enginespeed increases quickly when driving onslippery roads or while being tested onsome dynamometers.

Starting the vehicle1. After starting the engine, fully depress the

foot brake pedal before moving the shiftselector out of the P (Park) position.

2. Keep the foot brake pedal depressed andmove the shift selector into a driving gear.

3. Release the foot brake, then gradually startthe vehicle in motion.

4. Stop the vehicle completely before shiftingthe shift selector to the P (Park) position.

The CVT is designed so the foot brakepedal MUST be depressed before shiftingfrom P (Park) to any drive position whilethe ignition switch is in the ON position.

The shift selector cannot be moved out of P(Park) and into any of the other gear posi-tions if the ignition switch is pushed to theLOCK position.

To move the shift selector:

Press the button while depressing thebrake pedal

Press the button to shift

Shift without pressing button

Shifting

After starting the engine, fully depress the brakepedal and move the shift selector from P (Park) toany of the desired shift positions.

WSD0242

Starting and driving 5-13

Page 338: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

Apply the parking brake if the shift selec-tor is in any position while the engine isnot running. Failure to do so could causethe vehicle to move unexpectedly or rollaway and result in serious personal injuryor property damage.

P (Park):

CAUTION

To prevent transmission damage, use theP (Park) or R (Reverse) position only whenthe vehicle is completely stopped.

Use the P (Park) shift selector position when thevehicle is parked or when starting the engine.Make sure the vehicle is completely stopped.The brake pedal should be depressed tomove the shift selector from N (Neutral) orany drive position to P (Park). Apply theparking brake. When parking on a hill, apply theparking brake first, then move the shift selectorinto the P (Park) position.

R (Reverse):

CAUTION

To prevent transmission damage, use theP (Park) or R (Reverse) position only whenthe vehicle is completely stopped.

Use the R (Reverse) position to back up. Makesure the vehicle is completely stopped beforeselecting the R (Reverse) position. The brakepedal must be depressed to move the shiftselector from P (Park), N (Neutral) or anydrive position to R (Reverse).

N (Neutral):

Neither forward nor reverse gear is engaged. Theengine can be started in this position. You mayshift to N (Neutral) and restart a stalled enginewhile the vehicle is moving.

D (Drive):

Use this position for all normal forward driving.

DS (Drive Sport):

When the shift selector is shifted from the D(Drive) position to the manual shift gate, thetransmission enters the DS (Drive Sport) mode.Moving the shift selector to the DS (Drive Sport)position allows you to enjoy “sporty” driving shiftoperation on a winding road and feel smoothacceleration or deceleration on a hilly road bymoving in a lower gear automatically. When can-celing the DS mode, return the shift selector tothe D (Drive) position. The transmission returns tothe normal driving mode.

5-14 Starting and driving

Page 339: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Manual shift mode

When the shift selector is in the Ds (Drive Sport)position, the transmission is ready for the manualshift mode. Shift ranges can be selected manu-ally by moving the shift selector up or down, orpulling the right-side or left-side paddle shifter.To cancel the Ds mode, return shift selector to theD (Drive) position. The transmission returns toautomatic driving mode.

When the shift selector is shifted from D (Drive)to the manual shift gate �A with the vehiclestopped or while driving, the transmission entersthe manual shift mode. Shift ranges can be se-lected manually. Shift ranges can also be se-

lected using the shift paddles (if so equipped) onthe steering wheel �B and �C . In the manual shiftmode, the shift range is displayed on the positionindicator in the meter. When shifting the shiftselector to the manual shift gate, the positionindicator displays 1 (first) up to 6 (sixth) depend-ing on vehicle speed.

Shift ranges up or down one by one as follows:

1⇔ 2 ⇔ 3 ⇔ 4 ⇔ 5 ⇔ 6

M6 (6th):

Use this position for all normal forward driving athighway speeds.

M5 (5th):

Use this position when driving up long slopes, orfor engine braking when driving down longslopes.

M4 (4th), M3 (3rd) and M2 (2nd):

Use for hill climbing or engine braking on downhillgrades.

M1 (First):

Use this position when climbing steep hills slowlyor driving slowly through deep snow, sand ormud, or for maximum engine braking on steepdownhill grades.

● Remember not to drive at high speeds forextended periods of time in lower than 6range. This reduces fuel economy.

When shifting up:

Move the shift selector to the + (up) side. (Shiftsto higher range.)

When shifting down:

Move the shift selector to the � (down) side.(Shifts to lower range.)

● Moving the shift selector rapidly to the sameside twice will shift the ranges in succession.

WSD0243 LSD0193

Starting and driving 5-15

Page 340: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

When canceling the manual shift mode:

Return the shift selector to the D (Drive) positionto return the transmission to the normal drivingmode.

● In the manual shift mode, the transmis-sion may not shift to the selected gear.This helps maintain driving perfor-mance and reduces the chance of ve-hicle damage or loss of control.

● In the manual shift mode, the transmis-sion may shift up automatically to ahigher range than selected if the en-gine speed is too high. When the ve-hicle speed decreases, the transmis-sion automatically shifts down andshifts to 1st gear before the vehiclecomes to a stop.

● CVT operation is limited to automatic drivemode when CVT fluid temperature is ex-tremely low even if manual shift mode isselected. This is not a malfunction. WhenCVT fluid warms up, manual mode can beselected.

● When the CVT fluid temperature is high, theshift range may upshift in lower rpm thanusual. This is not a malfunction.

Shift lock release

If the battery charge is low or discharged, theshift selector may not be moved from the P (Park)position even with the brake pedal depressedand the shift selector button pressed.

It will be necessary to jump start or have yourbattery charged, see “Jump starting” in the “Incase of emergency” section. Contact yourNISSAN dealer or a professional towing service.

To move the shift selector, complete the followingprocedure:

1. Press the ignition switch to the LOCK posi-tion.

2. Apply the parking brake.

3. Using a protective cloth on the tip of a 3 mmscrewdriver, remove the shift lock releasecover.

● If available, a plastic trim tool can also beused.

4. Insert the small screwdriver in the shift lockrelease slot and push down.

5. Move the shift selector to the N (Neutral)position while holding down the shift lockrelease.

6. Push the ignition switch to the ON positionto unlock the steering wheel. Now the ve-hicle may be moved to the desired location.

If the shift selector cannot be moved out of P(Park), have a NISSAN dealer check the trans-mission as soon as possible.

WARNING

If the shift selector cannot be moved fromthe P (Park) position while the engine isrunning and the brake pedal is depressed,the stop lights may not work. Malfunction-ing stop lights could cause an accidentinjuring yourself and others.

WSD0236

5-16 Starting and driving

Page 341: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Accelerator downshift— in D (Drive) position and manualshift mode

For passing or hill climbing, depress the accel-erator pedal to the floor. This shifts the transmis-sion down into lower range, depending on thevehicle speed.

High fluid temperature protectionmode

This transmission has a high fluid temperatureprotection mode. If the fluid temperature be-comes too high (for example, when climbingsteep grades in high temperature with heavyloads, such as when towing a trailer), enginepower and, under some conditions, vehiclespeed will be decreased automatically to reducethe chance of transmission damage. Vehiclespeed can be controlled with the acceleratorpedal, but the engine and vehicle speed may belimited.

Fail-safeIf the vehicle is driven under extreme con-ditions, such as excessive wheel spinningand subsequent hard braking, the fail-safesystem may be activated. The MIL maycome on to indicate the fail-safe mode isactivated, see “Malfunction Indicator Light

(MIL)” in the “Instrument and controls”sec-tion. This will occur even if all electricalcircuits are functioning properly. In thiscase, place the ignition switch in the OFFposition and wait for 10 seconds. Thenpush the switch back to the ON position.The vehicle should return to its normal op-erating condition. If it does not return to itsnormal operating condition, have aNISSAN dealer check the transmission andrepair if necessary.

WARNING

When the high fluid temperature protec-tion mode or fail-safe operation occurs,vehicle speed may be gradually reduced.The reduced speed may be lower thanother traffic, which could increase thechance of a collision. Be especially care-ful when driving. If necessary, pull to theside of the road at a safe place and allowthe transmission to return to normal op-eration, or have it repaired if necessary.

WARNING

● Be sure the parking brake is fully re-leased before driving. Failure to do socan cause brake failure and lead to anaccident.

● Do not release the parking brake fromoutside the vehicle.

● Do not use the shift selector in place ofthe parking brake. When parking, besure the parking brake is fully engaged.

● Do not leave children unattended in avehicle. They could release the parkingbrake and cause an accident.

PARKING BRAKE

Starting and driving 5-17

Page 342: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

To engage: Firmly depress the parking brake.

To release:

1. Firmly apply the foot brake.

2. Move the shift selector to the P (Park) posi-tion.

3. Firmly depress the parking brake pedal and itwill release.

4. Before driving, be sure the brake warninglight goes out.

1. CANCEL switch2. ACCEL/RES switch3. COAST/SET switch4. ON/OFF switch

PRECAUTIONS ON CRUISECONTROL

● If the cruise control system malfunctions, itcancels automatically.

WARNING

Do not use the cruise control when drivingunder the following conditions:

● When it is not possible to keep thevehicle at a set speed.

● In heavy traffic or in traffic that varies inspeed.

● On winding or hilly roads.

● On slippery roads (rain, snow, ice, etc.).

● In very windy areas.

Doing so could cause a loss of vehiclecontrol and result in an accident.

CRUISE CONTROL OPERATIONSThe cruise control allows driving at a speed be-tween 25 - 89 MPH (40 - 144 km/h) withoutkeeping your foot on the accelerator pedal.

To turn on the cruise control, push theON·OFF switch on. The CRUISE indicator light inthe instrument panel will illuminate.

LSD0158 WSD0231

CRUISE CONTROL

5-18 Starting and driving

Page 343: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

To set cruising speed, accelerate the vehicle tothe desired speed, push the COAST/SET switchand release it. Take your foot off the acceleratorpedal. Your vehicle maintains the set speed.

● To pass another vehicle, depress the ac-celerator pedal. When you release thepedal, the vehicle returns to the previouslyset speed.

● The vehicle may not maintain the set speedwhen going up or down steep hills. If thishappens, drive without the cruise control.

To cancel the preset speed, use one of thefollowing three methods.

● Push the CANCEL button.

● Tap the brake pedal.

● Push the ON·OFF switch off. The CRUISEindicator light in the instrument panel goesout.

The cruise control is automatically canceled if:

● you depress the brake pedal while pushingthe ACCEL/RES or SET/COAST switch.The preset speed is deleted from memory.

● the vehicle slows down more than 8 MPH(13 km/h) below the set speed.

● you move the shift selector to N (Neutral).

To reset at a faster cruising speed, use oneof the following three methods.

● Depress the accelerator pedal. When thevehicle attains the desired speed, push andrelease the COAST/SET switch.

● Push and hold the ACCEL/RES switch.When the vehicle attains the speed you de-sire, release the switch.

● Push and release the ACCEL/RES switch.Each time you do this, the set speed in-creases by about 1 MPH (1.6 km/h).

To reset at a slower cruising speed, use oneof the following three methods.

● Lightly tap the brake pedal. When the ve-hicle attains the desired speed, push theCOAST/SET switch and release it.

● Push and hold the COAST/SET switch. Re-lease the switch when the vehicle slows tothe desired speed.

● Push and release the COAST/SET switch.Each time you do this, the set speed de-creases by about 1 MPH (1.6 km/h).

To resume the preset speed, push and re-lease the ACCEL/RES switch. The vehicle re-turns to the last set cruising speed when thevehicle speed is over 25 MPH (40 km/h).

CAUTION

During the first 1,200 miles (2,000 km),follow these recommendations to obtainmaximum engine performance and en-sure the future reliability and economy ofyour new vehicle. Failure to follow theserecommendations may result in short-ened engine life and reduced engineperformance.

● Avoid driving for long periods at constantspeed, either fast or slow, and do not run theengine over 4,000 rpm.

● Do not accelerate at full throttle in any gear.

● Avoid quick starts.

● Avoid hard braking as much as possible.

● Do not tow a trailer for the first 500 miles(800 km). Your engine, axle or other partscould be damaged.

BREAK-IN SCHEDULE

Starting and driving 5-19

Page 344: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Accelerate slowly and smoothly. Maintaincruising speeds with a constant acceleratorposition.

● Drive at moderate speeds on the highway.Driving at high speed lowers fuel economy.

● Avoid unnecessary stopping and braking.Maintain a safe distance behind other ve-hicles.

● Use a proper gear range which suits roadconditions. On level roads, shift into highgear as soon as possible.

● Avoid unnecessary engine idling.

● Keep your engine tuned up.

● Follow the recommended periodic mainte-nance schedule.

● Keep the tires inflated to the correct pres-sure. Low tire pressure increases tire wearand lowers fuel economy.

● Keep the wheels in correct alignment. Im-proper alignment increases tire wear andlowers fuel economy.

● Air conditioner operation lowers fueleconomy. Use the air conditioner only whennecessary.

● When cruising at highway speeds, it is moreeconomical to use the air conditioner andleave the windows closed to reduce drag.

● Use the recommended viscosity engine oil.See “Capacities and recommendedfuel/lubricants” in the “Technical and con-sumer information” section of this manual.

INCREASING FUEL ECONOMY

5-20 Starting and driving

Page 345: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● Do not stop or park the vehicle overflammable materials such as dry grass,waste paper or rags. They may igniteand cause a fire.

● Safe parking procedures require thatboth the parking brake be set and thetransmission placed into P (Park). Fail-ure to do so could cause the vehicle tomove unexpectedly or roll away and re-sult in an accident. Make sure the shiftselector has been pushed as far forwardas it can go and cannot be moved withoutdepressing the foot brake pedal.

● Never leave the engine running whilethe vehicle is unattended.

● Do not leave children unattended insidethe vehicle. They could unknowingly ac-tivate switches or controls. Unattendedchildren could become involved in seri-ous accidents.

1. Firmly apply the parking brake.

2. Move the shift selector to the P (Park) posi-tion.

3. To help prevent the vehicle from rolling intotraffic when parked on an incline, it is a goodpractice to turn the wheels as illustrated.

● HEADED DOWNHILL WITH CURB: �A

Turn the wheels into the curb and move thevehicle forward until the curb side wheelgently touches the curb.

● HEADED UPHILL WITH CURB: �B

Turn the wheels away from the curb andmove the vehicle back until the curb sidewheel gently touches the curb.

● HEADED UPHILL OR DOWNHILL, NOCURB: �C

Turn the wheels toward the side of the roadso the vehicle will move away from the cen-ter of the road if it moves.

4. Place the ignition switch to the LOCK posi-tion.

WSD0050

PARKING/PARKING ON HILLS

Starting and driving 5-21

Page 346: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

The power assisted steering uses a hydraulicpump, driven by the engine, to assist steering.

If the engine stops or the drive belt breaks, youwill still have control of the vehicle. However,much greater steering effort is needed, especiallyin sharp turns and at low speeds.

WARNING

If the engine is not running or is turned offwhile driving, the power assist for thesteering will not work. Steering will beharder to operate.

The brake system has two separate hydrauliccircuits. If one circuit malfunctions, you will stillhave braking at 2 wheels.

BRAKE PRECAUTIONS

Vacuum assisted brakes

The brake booster aids braking by using enginevacuum. If the engine stops, you can stop thevehicle by depressing the brake pedal. However,greater foot pressure on the brake pedal will berequired to stop the vehicle and stopping dis-tance will be longer.

Using the brakes

Avoid resting your foot on the brake pedal whiledriving. This will overheat the brakes, wear out thebrake pads faster, and reduce gas mileage.

To help reduce brake wear and to prevent thebrakes from overheating, reduce speed anddownshift to a lower gear before going down aslope or long grade. Overheated brakes mayreduce braking performance and could result inloss of vehicle control.

WARNING

● While driving on a slippery surface, becareful when braking, accelerating ordownshifting. Abrupt braking or accel-erating could cause the wheels to skidand result in an accident.

● If the engine is not running or is turnedoff while driving, the power assist forthe brakes will not work. Braking will beharder.

Wet brakes

When the vehicle is washed or driven throughwater, the brakes may get wet. As a result, yourbraking distance will be longer and the vehiclemay pull to one side during braking.

To dry the brakes, drive the vehicle at a safespeed while lightly pressing the brake pedal toheat up the brakes. Do this until the brakes returnto normal. Avoid driving the vehicle at highspeeds until the brakes function correctly.

Parking brake break-in

Break-in the parking brake shoes whenever thestopping effect of the parking brake is weakenedor whenever the parking brake shoes and/ordrum/rotors are replaced, in order to assure thebest brake performance.

POWER STEERING BRAKE SYSTEM

5-22 Starting and driving

Page 347: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

This procedure is described in the vehicle servicemanual and can be performed by a NISSANdealer.

ANTI-LOCK BRAKING SYSTEM(ABS)

WARNING

● The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) is asophisticated device, but it cannot pre-vent accidents resulting from carelessor dangerous driving techniques. It canhelp maintain vehicle control duringbraking on slippery surfaces. Remem-ber that stopping distances on slipperysurfaces will be longer than on normalsurfaces even with ABS. Stopping dis-tances may also be longer on rough,gravel or snow covered roads, or if youare using tire chains. Always maintain asafe distance from the vehicle in frontof you. Ultimately, the driver is respon-sible for safety.

● Tire type and condition may also affectbraking effectiveness.

– When replacing tires, install thespecified size of tires on all fourwheels.

– When installing a spare tire, makesure that it is the proper size and typeas specified on the Tire and LoadingInformation label. See “Tire andLoading Information label” in the“Technical and consumer informa-tion” section of this manual.

– For detailed information, see“Wheels and tires” in the “Mainte-nance and do-it-yourself” section ofthis manual.

The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) controls thebrakes so the wheels do not lock during hardbraking or when braking on slippery surfaces.The system detects the rotation speed at eachwheel and varies the brake fluid pressure to pre-vent each wheel from locking and sliding. Bypreventing each wheel from locking, the systemhelps the driver maintain steering control andhelps to minimize swerving and spinning on slip-pery surfaces.

Using the system

Depress the brake pedal and hold it down. De-press the brake pedal with firm steady pressure,but do not pump the brakes. The ABS will oper-ate to prevent the wheels from locking up. Steerthe vehicle to avoid obstacles.

WARNING

Do not pump the brake pedal. Doing somay result in increased stoppingdistances.

Self-test featureThe ABS includes electronic sensors, electricpumps, hydraulic solenoids and a computer. Thecomputer has a built-in diagnostic feature thattests the system each time you start the engineand move the vehicle at a low speed in forward orreverse. When the self-test occurs, you may heara “clunk”noise and/or feel a pulsation in the brakepedal. This is normal and does not indicate amalfunction. If the computer senses a malfunc-tion, it switches the ABS off and illuminates theABS warning light on the instrument panel. Thebrake system then operates normally, but withoutanti-lock assistance.

If the ABS warning light illuminates during theself-test or while driving, have the vehiclechecked by a NISSAN dealer.

Starting and driving 5-23

Page 348: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Normal operationThe ABS operates at speeds above 3 - 6 MPH (5- 10 km/h). The speed varies according to roadconditions.

When the ABS senses that 1 or more wheels areclose to locking up, the actuator rapidly appliesand releases hydraulic pressure. This action issimilar to pumping the brakes very quickly. Youmay feel a pulsation in the brake pedal and hear anoise from under the hood or feel a vibration fromthe actuator when it is operating. This is normaland indicates that the ABS is operating properly.However, the pulsation may indicate that roadconditions are hazardous and extra care is re-quired while driving.

The Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system usesvarious sensors to monitor driver inputs and ve-hicle motion. Under certain driving conditions,the VDC System helps to perform the followingfunctions:

● Controls brake pressure to reduce wheelslip on one slipping drive wheel so power istransferred to a non slipping drive wheel onthe same axle.

● Controls brake pressure and engine outputto reduce drive wheel slip based on vehiclespeed (traction control function).

● Controls brake pressure at individual wheelsand engine output to help the driver maintaincontrol of the vehicle in the following condi-tions:

– understeer (vehicle tends to not followthe steered path despite increased steer-ing input)

– oversteer (vehicle tends to spin due tocertain road or driving conditions)

The VDC system can help the driver to maintaincontrol of the vehicle, but it cannot prevent loss ofvehicle control in all driving situations.

When the VDC system operates, the indi-cator in the instrument panel flashes so note thefollowing:

● The road may be slippery or the system maydetermine some action is required to helpkeep the vehicle on the steered path.

● You may feel a pulsation in the brake pedaland hear a noise or vibration from under thehood. This is normal and indicates that theVDC system is working properly.

● Adjust your speed and driving to the roadconditions.

See “Slip indicator light” and ”Vehicle DynamicControl (VDC) off indicator light” in the ”Instru-ments and controls” section.

If a malfunction occurs in the system, theand indicator lights come on in the instru-ment panel. The VDC system automatically turnsoff when these indicator lights are on.

The VDC OFF switch is used to turn off the VDCsystem. The indicator illuminates to indi-cate the VDC system is off.

When the VDC switch is used to turn off thesystem, the VDC system still operates to preventone drive wheel from slipping by transferringpower to a non slipping drive wheel. Theindicator flashes if this occurs. All other VDCfunctions are off and the indicator will notflash.

VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL (VDC)SYSTEM

5-24 Starting and driving

Page 349: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

The VDC system is automatically reset to onwhen the ignition switch is placed in the offposition then back to the on position.

The computer has a built in diagnostic featurethat tests the system each time you start theengine and move the vehicle forward or in reverseat a slow speed. When the self-test occurs, youmay hear a clunk noise and/or feel a pulsation inthe brake pedal. This is normal and is not anindication of a malfunction.

WARNING

● The VDC system is designed to help thedriver maintain stability but does notprevent accidents due to abrupt steer-ing operation at high speeds or by care-less or dangerous driving techniques.Reduce vehicle speed and be especiallycareful when driving and cornering onslippery surfaces and always drivecarefully.

● Do not modify the vehicle’s suspension.If suspension parts such as shock ab-sorbers, struts, springs, stabilizer bars,bushings and wheels are not NISSANrecommended for your vehicle or areextremely deteriorated, the VDC systemmay not operate properly. This couldadversely affect vehicle handling per-formance, and the indicator may

flash or both the and indi-cator lights may illuminate.

● If brake related parts such as brakepads, rotors and calipers are notNISSAN recommended or are extremelydeteriorated, the VDC system may notoperate properly and both theand the indicator lights mayilluminate.

● If engine control related parts are notNISSAN recommended or are extremely

deteriorated, both the andindicator lights may illuminate.

● When driving on extremely inclined sur-faces such as higher banked corners,the VDC system may not operate prop-erly and the indicator may flash or

both the and indicatorlights may illuminate. Do not drive onthese types of roads.

● When driving on an unstable surfacesuch as a turntable, ferry, elevator orramp, the indicator may flash or

both the and indicatorlights may illuminate. This is not a mal-function. Restart the engine after driv-ing onto a stable surface.

● If wheels or tires other than the NISSANrecommended ones are used, the VDCsystem may not operate properly andthe indicator may flash or both

the and indicator lights mayilluminate.

● The VDC system is not a substitute forwinter tires or tire chains on a snowcovered road.

Starting and driving 5-25

Page 350: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

FREEING A FROZEN DOOR LOCKTo prevent a door lock from freezing, apply de-icer through the key hole. If the lock becomesfrozen, heat the key before inserting it into the keyhole or use the remote keyless entry function onthe Intelligent Key.

ANTI-FREEZEIn the winter when it is anticipated that the tem-perature will drop below 32°F (0°C), check theanti-freeze to assure proper winter protection.For details, see “Engine cooling system” in the“Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of thismanual.

BATTERYIf the battery is not fully charged during extremelycold weather conditions, the battery fluid mayfreeze and damage the battery. To maintain maxi-mum efficiency, the battery should be checkedregularly. For details, see “Battery” in the “Main-tenance and do-it-yourself” section of thismanual.

DRAINING OF COOLANT WATER

If the vehicle is to be left outside without anti-freeze, drain the cooling system, including theengine block. Refill before operating the vehicle.For details, see “Changing engine coolant” in the“Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of thismanual.

TIRE EQUIPMENT

1. SUMMER tires have a tread designed toprovide superior performance on dry pave-ment. However, the performance of thesetires will be substantially reduced in snowyand icy conditions. If you operate your ve-hicle on snowy or icy roads, NISSAN recom-mends the use of MUD & SNOW or ALLSEASON TIRES on all four wheels. Pleaseconsult a NISSAN dealer for the tire type,size, speed rating and availability informa-tion.

2. For additional traction on icy roads, studdedtires may be used. However, some U.S.states and Canadian provinces prohibit theiruse. Check local, state and provincial lawsbefore installing studded tires.

Skid and traction capabilities of studdedsnow tires on wet or dry surfaces may bepoorer than that of non-studded snow tires.

3. Tire chains may be used. For details, see“Tire chains” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual.

SPECIAL WINTER EQUIPMENT

It is recommended that the following items becarried in the vehicle during winter:

● A scraper and stiff-bristled brush to removeice and snow from the windows and wiperblades.

● A sturdy, flat board to be placed under thejack to give it firm support.

● A shovel to dig the vehicle out of snowdrifts.

● Extra washer fluid to refill the windshield-washer fluid reservoir.

DRIVING ON SNOW OR ICE

WARNING

● Wet ice (32°F, 0°C and freezing rain),very cold snow or ice can be slick andvery hard to drive on. The vehicle willhave much less traction or “grip” underthese conditions. Try to avoid driving onwet ice until the road is salted orsanded.

COLD WEATHER DRIVING

5-26 Starting and driving

Page 351: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Whatever the condition, drive with cau-tion. Accelerate and slow down withcare. If accelerating or downshifting toofast, the drive wheels will lose evenmore traction.

● Allow more stopping distance underthese conditions. Braking should bestarted sooner than on dry pavement.

● Allow greater following distances onslippery roads.

● Watch for slippery spots (glare ice).These may appear on an otherwiseclear road in shaded areas. If a patch ofice is seen ahead, brake before reach-ing it. Try not to brake while on the ice,and avoid any sudden steeringmaneuvers.

● Do not use the cruise control on slip-pery roads.

● Snow can trap dangerous exhaustgases under your vehicle. Keep snowclear of the exhaust pipe and fromaround your vehicle.

ENGINE BLOCK HEATER (if soequipped)

WARNING

● Do not use your engine block heaterwith an ungrounded electrical systemor a 2-pronged adapter. You can be se-riously injured by an electrical shock ifyou use an ungrounded connection.

● Disconnect and properly store the en-gine block heater cord before startingthe engine. Damage to the cord couldresult in an electrical shock and cancause serious injury.

● Use a heavy-duty 3-wire, 3-pronged ex-tension cord rated for at least 10 A. Plugthe extension cord into a Ground FaultInterrupt (GFI) protected, grounded110-VAC outlet. Failure to use theproper extension cord or a groundedoutlet can result in a fire or electricalshock and cause serious personalinjury.

Engine block heaters are available throughNISSAN dealers to assist in cold temperaturestarting. The engine block heater should be usedwhen the outside temperature is 20° F (-7° C) orlower.

To use the engine block heater:

1. Turn the engine off.

2. Open the hood and unwrap the engine blockheater cord.

3. Plug the engine block heater cord into agrounded 3 wire, 3 pronged extension cord.

4. Plug the extension cord into a Ground FaultInterrupt (GFI) protected, grounded 110-volt AC (VAC) outlet.

5. The engine block heater must be plugged infor at least 2 - 4 hours, depending on outsidetemperatures, to properly warm the enginecoolant. Use an appropriate timer to turn theengine block heater on.

6. Before starting the engine, unplug and prop-erly store the cord to keep it away frommoving parts.

Starting and driving 5-27

Page 352: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

MEMO

5-28 Starting and driving

Page 353: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

6 In case of emergency

Emergency engine shut off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2Flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). . . . . . . . . . 6-2Changing a flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3

Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7

Push starting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9If your vehicle overheats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9Towing your vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10

Towing recommended by NISSAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11Vehicle recovery (freeing a stuck vehicle) . . . . . . . . . 6-12

Page 354: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

To shut off the engine in an emergency situationwhile driving perform the following procedure:

– Rapidly push the push-button ignition switch 3consecutive times, or

– Push and hold the push-button ignition switchfor more than 2 seconds.

TIRE PRESSURE MONITORINGSYSTEM (TPMS)

This vehicle is equipped with the Tire PressureMonitoring System (TPMS). It monitors tire pres-sure of all tires except the spare. When the lowtire pressure warning light is lit, and the CHECKTIRE PRESSURE warning appears in the vehicleinformation display, one or more of your tires issignificantly under-inflated. If the vehicle is beingdriven with low tire pressure, the TPMS will acti-vate and warn you of it by the low tire pressurewarning light. This system will activate only whenthe vehicle is driven at speeds above 16 MPH(25 km/h). For more details, refer to“Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders”in the “Instruments and controls” section and“Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)” in the“Starting and driving” section.

WARNING

● If the low tire pressure warning lightilluminates while driving, avoid suddensteering maneuvers or abrupt braking,reduce vehicle speed, pull off the roadto a safe location and stop the vehicleas soon as possible. Driving with under-inflated tires may permanently damagethe tires and increase the likelihood oftire failure. Serious vehicle damagecould occur and may lead to an acci-dent and could result in serious per-sonal injury. Check the tire pressure forall four tires. Adjust the tire pressure tothe recommended COLD tire pressureshown on the Tire and Loading Informa-tion label to turn the low tire pressurewarning light OFF. If you have a flat tire,replace it with a spare tire as soon aspossible.

● When a spare tire is mounted or a wheelis replaced, tire pressure will not beindicated, the TPMS will not functionand the low tire pressure warning lightwill flash for approximately 1 minute.The light will remain on after 1 minute.Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon aspossible for tire replacement and/orsystem resetting.

EMERGENCY ENGINE SHUT OFF FLAT TIRE

6-2 In case of emergency

Page 355: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Replacing tires with those not originallyspecified by NISSAN could affect theproper operation of the TPMS.

● Do not inject any tire liquid or aerosoltire sealant into the tires, as this maycause a malfunction of the tire pressuresensors.

CHANGING A FLAT TIRE

If you have a flat tire, follow the instructions be-low:

Stopping the vehicle

1. Safely move the vehicle off the road andaway from traffic.

2. Turn on the hazard warning flashers.

3. Park on a level surface and apply the parkingbrake. Move the shift selector to P (Park).

4. Turn off the engine.

5. Raise the hood to warn other traffic and tosignal professional road assistance person-nel that you need assistance.

6. Have all passengers get out of the vehicleand stand in a safe place, away from trafficand clear of the vehicle.

WARNING

● Make sure the parking brake is securelyapplied and the CVT is shifted into P(Park).

● Never change tires when the vehicle ison a slope, ice or slippery areas. This ishazardous.

● Never change tires if oncoming traffic isclose to your vehicle. Wait for profes-sional road assistance.

Blocking wheelsPlace suitable blocks �1 at both the front andback of the wheel diagonally opposite the flat tire�2 to prevent the vehicle from moving when it isjacked up.

WARNING

Be sure to block the wheel as the vehiclemay move and result in personal injury.

WCE0044

In case of emergency 6-3

Page 356: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Getting the spare tire and toolsOpen the trunk. Remove the floor carpeting andspare tire cover.

Remove the jack �1 and wheel nut wrench �2from the tool box on the right side of the trunkcompartment.

Remove the spare tire.LCE0199 WCE0189 WCE0188

6-4 In case of emergency

Page 357: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Jacking up vehicle and removing thedamaged tire

WARNING

● Never get under the vehicle while it issupported only by the jack. If it is nec-essary to work under the vehicle, sup-port it with safety stands.

● Use only the jack provided with yourvehicle to lift the vehicle. Do not use thejack provided with your vehicle on othervehicles. The jack is designed for liftingonly your vehicle during a tire change.

● Use the correct jack-up points. Neveruse any other part of the vehicle for jacksupport.

● Never jack up the vehicle more thannecessary.

● Never use blocks on or under the jack.

● Do not start or run the engine whilevehicle is on the jack. It may cause thevehicle to move. This is especially truefor vehicles with limited slipdifferentials.

● Do not allow passengers to stay in thevehicle while it is on the jack.

● Never run the engine with a wheel(s) offthe ground. It may cause the vehicle tomove.

CE1089

In case of emergency 6-5

Page 358: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Always refer to the proper illustrations for thecorrect placement and jack-up points for yourspecific vehicle model and jack type.

Carefully read the caution label attached tothe jack body and the following instruc-tions.

1. Loosen each wheel nut one or two turns byturning counterclockwise with the wheel nutwrench. Do not remove the wheel nutsuntil the tire is off the ground.

2. Place the jack directly under the jack-uppoint as illustrated so the top of the jackcontacts the vehicle at the jack-up point.Align the jack head between the two

notches in the front or the rear as shown.Also fit the groove of the jack head betweenthe notches as shown.

The jack should be used on firm andlevel ground.

3. To lift the vehicle, securely hold the jack leverand rod with both hands. Carefully raise thevehicle until the tire clears the ground. Re-move the wheel nuts, and then remove thetire.

Installing the spare tire

The spare tire is designed for emergencyuse. See specific instructions under theheading “Wheels and tires” in the “Mainte-nance and do-it-yourself” section of thismanual.

1. Clean any mud or dirt from the surface be-tween the wheel and hub.

2. Carefully put the spare tire on and tightenthe wheel nuts finger tight.

3. With the wheel nut wrench, tighten wheelnuts alternately and evenly as illustrated untilthey are tight.

LCE0020 SCE0661

6-6 In case of emergency

Page 359: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

4. Lower the vehicle slowly until the tiretouches the ground. Then, with the wheelnut wrench, tighten the wheel nuts securelyin the sequence illustrated (�1 , �2 , �3 , �4 ,�5 ). Lower the vehicle completely.

WARNING

● Incorrect wheel nuts or improperlytightened wheel nuts can cause thewheel to become loose or come off.This could cause an accident.

● Do not use oil or grease on the wheelstuds or nuts. This could cause the nutsto become loose.

● Retighten the wheel nuts when the ve-hicle has been driven for 600 miles(1,000 km) (also in cases of a flat tire,etc.).

As soon as possible, tighten the wheel nutsto the specified torque with a torquewrench.

Wheel nut tightening torque:

83 ft-lb (112 N·m)

The wheel nuts must be kept tightened tospecification at all times. It is recom-mended that wheel nuts be tightened tospecifications at each lubrication interval.

Adjust tire pressure to the COLD pressure.

COLD pressure: After vehicle has beenparked for three hours or more or drivenless than 1 mile (1.6 km).

COLD tire pressures are shown on the Tireand Loading Information label affixed tothe driver’s door opening.

5. Securely store the flat tire and jacking equip-ment in the vehicle.

6. Place the spare tire cover and the trunk floorcarpeting over the damaged tire.

7. Close the trunk.

WARNING

● Always make sure that the spare tireand jacking equipment are properly se-cured after use. Such items can becomedangerous projectiles in an accident orsudden stop.

● The spare tire is designed for emer-gency use. See specific instructions un-der the heading “Wheels and tires” inthe “Maintenance and do-it-yourself”section of this manual.

To start your engine with a booster battery, theinstructions and precautions below must be fol-lowed.

WARNING

● If done incorrectly, jump starting canlead to a battery explosion, resulting insevere injury or death. It could alsodamage your vehicle.

● Explosive hydrogen gas is always pres-ent in the vicinity of the battery. Keep allsparks and flames away from thebattery.

● Do not allow battery fluid to come intocontact with eyes, skin, clothing orpainted surfaces. Battery fluid is a cor-rosive sulfuric acid solution which cancause severe burns. If the fluid shouldcome into contact with anything, imme-diately flush the contacted area withwater.

● Keep battery out of the reach ofchildren.

● The booster battery must be rated at 12volts. Use of an improperly rated batterycan damage your vehicle.

JUMP STARTING

In case of emergency 6-7

Page 360: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Whenever working on or near a battery,always wear suitable eye protectors (forexample, goggles or industrial safetyspectacles) and remove rings, metalbands, or any other jewelry. Do not leanover the battery when jump starting.

● Do not attempt to jump start a frozenbattery. It could explode and cause se-rious injury.

● Your vehicle has an automatic enginecooling fan. It could come on at anytime. Keep hands and other objectsaway from it.

WARNING

Always follow the instructions below.Failure to do so could result in damage tothe charging system and cause personalinjury.

1. If the booster battery is in another vehicle,position the two vehicles to bring their bat-teries near each other.

Do not allow the two vehicles to touch.

2. Apply the parking brake. Move the shift se-lector to P (Park). Switch off all unnecessaryelectrical systems (lights, heater, air condi-tioner, etc.).

3. Remove the vent caps on the battery (if soequipped). Cover the battery with an oldcloth to reduce explosion hazard.

4. Connect the jumper cables in the sequenceillustrated (�A , �B , �C , �D ).

WCE0054

6-8 In case of emergency

Page 361: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CAUTION

● Always connect positive (�) to positive(�) and negative (�) to body ground (forexample, strut mounting bolt, enginelift bracket, etc.) — not to the battery.

● Make sure the jumper cables do nottouch moving parts in the engine com-partment and that the cable clamps donot contact any other metal.

5. Start the engine of the booster vehicle andlet it run for a few minutes.

6. Keep the engine speed of the booster ve-hicle at about 2,000 rpm and start the en-gine of the vehicle being jump started.

CAUTION

Do not keep the starter motor engaged formore than 10 seconds. If the engine doesnot start right away, place the ignitionswitch in the OFF position and wait 3 to 4seconds before trying again.

7. After starting the engine, carefully disconnectthe negative cable and then the positive cable.

8. Replace the vent caps (if so equipped). Besure to dispose of the cloth used to coverthe vent holes as it may be contaminatedwith corrosive acid.

CAUTION

● CVT models cannot be push-started ortow-started. Attempting to do so maycause transmission damage.

● Do not push start this vehicle. Thethree-way catalyst may be damaged.

If your vehicle is overheating (indicated by anextremely high temperature gauge reading) or ifyou feel a lack of engine power, detect abnormalnoise, etc., take the following steps.

WARNING

● Do not continue to drive if your vehicleoverheats. Doing so could cause enginedamage or a vehicle fire.

● To avoid the danger of being scalded,never remove the radiator cap while theengine is still hot. When the radiatorcap is removed, pressurized hot waterwill spurt out, possibly causing seriousinjury.

● Do not open the hood if steam is com-ing out.

1. Move the vehicle safely off the road, applythe parking brake and move the shift selectorto P (Park).

Do not stop the engine.

2. Turn off the air conditioner. Open all thewindows, move the heater or air conditionertemperature control to maximum hot and fancontrol to high speed.

PUSH STARTING IF YOUR VEHICLE OVERHEATS

In case of emergency 6-9

Page 362: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

3. Get out of the vehicle. Look and listen forsteam or coolant escaping from the radiatorbefore opening the hood. (If steam or cool-ant is escaping, turn off the engine.) Do notopen the hood further until no steam orcoolant can be seen.

4. Open the engine hood.

WARNING

If steam or water is coming from the en-gine, stand clear to prevent gettingburned.

5. Visually check drive belts for damage orlooseness. Also check if the cooling fan isrunning. The radiator hoses and radiatorshould not leak water. If coolant is leaking,the water pump belt is missing or loose, orthe cooling fan does not run, stop the en-gine.

WARNING

Be careful not to allow your hands, hair,jewelry or clothing to come into contactwith, or get caught in, engine belts or theengine cooling fan. The engine coolingfan can start at any time.

6. After the engine cools down, check the cool-ant level in the engine coolant reservoir tankwith the engine running. Add coolant to theengine coolant reservoir tank if necessary.Have your vehicle repaired at a NISSANdealer.

When towing your vehicle, all State (Provincial inCanada) and local regulations for towing must befollowed. Incorrect towing equipment could dam-age your vehicle. Towing instructions are avail-able from a NISSAN dealer. Local service opera-tors are generally familiar with the applicable lawsand procedures for towing. To assure propertowing and to prevent accidental damage to yourvehicle, NISSAN recommends having a serviceoperator tow your vehicle. It is advisable to havethe service operator carefully read the followingprecautions:

WARNING

● Never ride in a vehicle that is beingtowed.

● Never get under your vehicle after it hasbeen lifted by a tow truck.

CAUTION

● When towing, make sure that the trans-mission, axles, steering system andpowertrain are in working condition. Ifany of these conditions apply, dollies ora flatbed tow truck must be used.

● Always attach safety chains beforetowing.

TOWING YOUR VEHICLE

6-10 In case of emergency

Page 363: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

For information about towing your vehicle behinda recreational vehicle (RV), refer to “Flat towing”in the “Technical and consumer information” sec-tion of this manual.

TOWING RECOMMENDED BYNISSANNISSAN recommends that your vehicle be towedwith the driving (front) wheels off the ground orplace the vehicle on a flat bed truck as illustrated.

ACE0511 SCE0199A

In case of emergency 6-11

Page 364: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CAUTION

● Never tow CVT models with the frontwheels on the ground or four wheels onthe ground (forward or backward), asthis may cause serious and expensivedamage to the transmission. If it is nec-essary to tow the vehicle with the rearwheels raised always use towing dolliesunder the front wheels.

● When towing with the front wheels ontowing dollies:

– Place the ignition switch in the OFFposition, and secure the steeringwheel in a straight-ahead positionwith a rope or similar device.

– Move the shift selector to the N (Neu-tral) position.

● When towing CVT models with the rearwheels on the ground (if you do not usetowing dollies): Always release theparking brake.

● When towing CVT models with the frontwheels on the ground, dollies must beused or place the vehicle on a flat bedtruck.

VEHICLE RECOVERY (freeing a stuckvehicle)

Pulling a stuck vehicle

WARNING

To avoid vehicle damage, serious per-sonal injury or death when recovering astuck vehicle:

● Contact a professional towing serviceto recover the vehicle if you have anyquestions regarding the recoveryprocedure.

● Do not use the vehicle tie-downs to towor free a stuck vehicle.

● Only use devices specifically designedfor vehicle recovery and follow themanufacturer’s instructions.

● Always pull the recovery device straightout from the front of the vehicle. Neverpull at an angle.

● Route recovery devices so they do nottouch any part of the vehicle except theattachment point.

If your vehicle is stuck in sand, snow, mud, etc.,use a tow strap or other device designed specifi-cally for vehicle recovery. Always follow themanufacturer’s instructions for the recovery de-vice.

Do not use the tie-down hooks for towing orvehicle recovery.

WCE0190

6-12 In case of emergency

Page 365: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Rocking a stuck vehicle

WARNING

● Stand clear of a stuck vehicle.

● Do not spin your tires at high speed.This could cause them to explode andresult in serious injury. Parts of yourvehicle could also overheat and bedamaged.

If your vehicle is stuck in sand, snow, mud, etc.,use the following procedure:

1. Turn off the Vehicle Dynamic Control Sys-tem.

2. Make sure the area in front and behind thevehicle is clear of obstructions.

3. Turn the steering wheel right and left to clearan area around the front tires.

4. Slowly rock the vehicle forward and back-ward.

● Shift back and forth between R (Reverse)and D (Drive).

● Apply the accelerator as little as possibleto maintain the rocking motion.

● Release the accelerator pedal beforeshifting between R (Reverse) and D(Drive).

● Do not spin the tires above 35 MPH (55km/h).

5. If the vehicle cannot be freed after a fewtries, contact a professional towing serviceto remove the vehicle.

In case of emergency 6-13

Page 366: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

MEMO

6-14 In case of emergency

Page 367: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

7 Appearance and care

Cleaning exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2Washing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2Waxing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2Removing spots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3Underbody . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3Glass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3Aluminum alloy wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4Chrome parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4Tire dressings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4

Cleaning interior. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4

Air fresheners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5Floor mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6

Corrosion protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6Most common factors contributing to vehiclecorrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6Environmental factors influence the rate ofcorrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6To protect your vehicle from corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6

Page 368: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

In order to maintain the appearance of your ve-hicle, it is important to take proper care of it.

To protect the paint surfaces, please wash yourvehicle as soon as you can:

● after a rainfall to prevent possible damagefrom acid rain.

● after driving on coastal roads.

● when contaminants such as soot, bird drop-pings, tree sap, metal particles or bugs geton the paint surface.

● when dust or mud builds up on the surface.

Whenever possible, store or park your vehicleinside a garage or in a covered area.

When it is necessary to park outside, park in ashady area or protect the vehicle with a bodycover.

Be careful not to scratch the paint surfacewhen putting on or removing the bodycover.

WASHINGWash dirt off with a wet sponge and plenty ofwater. Clean the vehicle thoroughly using a mildsoap, a special vehicle soap or general purposedishwashing liquid mixed with clean, lukewarm(never hot) water.

CAUTION

● Do not use car washes that use acid inthe detergent. Some car washes, espe-cially brushless ones, use some acid forcleaning. The acid may react with someplastic vehicle components, causingthem to crack. This could affect theirappearance, and also could cause themnot to function properly. Always checkwith your car wash to confirm that acidis not used.

● Do not wash the vehicle with stronghousehold soap, strong chemical deter-gents, gasoline or solvents.

● Do not wash the vehicle in direct sun-light or while the vehicle body is hot, asthe surface may become water-spotted.

● Avoid using tight-napped or roughcloths, such as washing mitts. Caremust be taken when removingcaked-on dirt or other foreign sub-stances so the paint surface is notscratched or damaged.

Rinse the vehicle thoroughly with plenty of cleanwater.

Inside flanges, seams and folds on the doors,hatches and hood are particularly vulnerable to

the effects of road salt. Therefore, these areasmust be cleaned regularly. Take care that thedrain holes in the lower edge of the door areopen. Spray water under the body and in thewheel wells to loosen the dirt and wash awayroad salt.

A damp chamois can be used to dry the vehicle toavoid water spots.

WAXINGRegular waxing protects the paint surface andhelps retain new vehicle appearance. Polishing isrecommended to remove built-up wax residueand to avoid a weathered appearance beforere-applying wax.

A NISSAN dealer can assist you in choosing theproper product.

● Wax your vehicle only after a thorough wash-ing. Follow the instructions supplied with thewax.

● Do not use a wax containing any abrasives,cutting compounds or cleaners that maydamage the vehicle finish.

Machine compounding or aggressive polishingon a base coat/clear coat paint finish may dull thefinish or leave swirl marks.

CLEANING EXTERIOR

7-2 Appearance and care

Page 369: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

REMOVING SPOTSRemove tar and oil spots, industrial dust, insects,and tree sap as quickly as possible from thesurface of the paint to avoid lasting damage orstaining. Special cleaning products are availableat a NISSAN dealer or any automotive accessorystore.

UNDERBODYIn areas where road salt is used in winter, it isnecessary to clean the underbody regularly inorder to prevent dirt and salt from building up andcausing the acceleration of corrosion on the un-derbody and suspension. Before the winter pe-riod and again in the spring, the underseal mustbe checked and, if necessary, retreated. GLASS

When cleaning the rear window, it may be easierto clean if the high-mounted stop light (if soequipped) is removed first.

Be careful when removing the high-mountedstop light to reduce the risk of damaging thehigh-mounted stop light wires.

To remove the high-mounted stop light:

�1 Push toward rear of vehicle.

�2 Lift to remove.

The high-mounted stop light must be properlyreinstalled before driving your vehicle.

Use glass cleaner to remove smoke and dust filmfrom the glass surfaces. It is normal for glass tobecome coated with a film after the vehicle isparked in the hot sun. Glass cleaner and a softcloth will easily remove this film.

CAUTION

When cleaning the inside of the windows,do not use sharp-edged tools, abrasivecleaners or chlorine-based disinfectantcleaners. They could damage the electri-cal conductors, radio antenna elements orrear window defroster elements.

WAI0007

Appearance and care 7-3

Page 370: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

ALUMINUM ALLOY WHEELSWash the wheels regularly with a sponge damp-ened in a mild soap solution, especially duringwinter months in areas where road salt is used. Ifnot removed, road salt can discolor the wheels.

CAUTION

Follow the directions below to avoidstaining or discoloring the wheels:

● Do not use a cleaner that uses strongacid or alkali contents to clean thewheels.

● Do not apply wheel cleaners to thewheels when they are hot. The wheeltemperature should be the same as am-bient temperature.

● Rinse the wheel to completely removethe cleaner within 15 minutes after thecleaner is applied.

CHROME PARTSClean all chrome parts regularly with a non-abrasive chrome polish to maintain the finish.

TIRE DRESSINGSNISSAN does not recommend the use of tiredressings. Tire manufacturers apply a coating tothe tires to help reduce discoloration of the rub-ber. If a tire dressing is applied to the tires, it mayreact with the coating and form a compound. Thiscompound may come off the tire while driving andstain the vehicle paint.

If you choose to use a tire dressing, take thefollowing precautions:

● Use a water-based tire dressing. The coat-ing on the tire dissolves more easily thanwith an oil-based tire dressing.

● Apply a light coat of tire dressing to helpprevent it from entering the tiretread/grooves (where it would be difficult toremove).

● Wipe off excess tire dressing using a drytowel. Make sure the tire dressing is com-pletely removed from the tire tread/grooves.

● Allow the tire dressing to dry as recom-mended by the tire dressing manufacturer.

Occasionally remove loose dust from the interiortrim, plastic parts and seats using a vacuumcleaner or soft bristled brush. Wipe the vinyl andleather surfaces with a clean, soft cloth damp-ened in mild soap solution, then wipe clean with adry, soft cloth.

Regular care and cleaning is required in order tomaintain the appearance of the leather.

Before using any fabric protector, read the manu-facturer’s recommendations. Some fabric pro-tectors contain chemicals that may stain orbleach the seat material.

Use a cloth dampened only with water to cleanthe meter and gauge lens.

WARNING

Do not use water or acidic cleaners (hotsteam cleaners) on the seat. This candamage the seat or occupant classifica-tion sensor. This can also affect the opera-tion of the air bag system and result inserious personal injury.

CLEANING INTERIOR

7-4 Appearance and care

Page 371: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CAUTION

● Never use benzine, thinner or any simi-lar material.

● Small dirt particles can be abrasive anddamaging to leather surfaces andshould be removed promptly. Do notuse saddle soap, car waxes, polishes,oils, cleaning fluids, solvents, deter-gents or ammonia-based cleaners asthey may damage the leather’s naturalfinish.

● Never use fabric protectors unless rec-ommended by the manufacturer.

● Do not use glass or plastic cleaner onmeter or gauge lens covers. It may dam-age the lens cover.

AIR FRESHENERS

Most air fresheners use a solvent that could affectthe vehicle interior. If you use an air freshener,take the following precautions:

● Hanging-type air fresheners can cause per-manent discoloration when they contact ve-hicle interior surfaces. Place the air fresh-ener in a location that allows it to hang freeand not contact an interior surface.

● Liquid-type air fresheners typically clip onthe vents. These products can cause imme-diate damage and discoloration whenspilled on interior surfaces.

Carefully read and follow the manufacturer’s in-structions before using the air fresheners.

FLOOR MATS

WARNING

To avoid potential pedal interference thatmay result in a collision or injury:

● NEVER place a floor mat on top of an-other floor mat in the driver frontposition.

● Use only genuine NISSAN floor matsspecifically designed for use in your ve-hicle model. See your NISSAN dealerfor more information.

● Properly position the mats in the floor-well using the floor mat positioning aid.See �Floor mat positioning aid� in thissection.

The use of genuine NISSAN floor mats can ex-tend the life of your vehicle carpet and make iteasier to clean the interior. Mats should be main-tained with regular cleaning and replaced if theybecome excessively worn.

Floor mat positioning aidThis vehicle includes a front floor mat bracket toact as a floor mat positioning aid. GenuineNISSAN floor mats have been specially designedfor your vehicle model. The driver’s and passen-ger’s side floor mats have a grommet hole incor-porated in them. Position the mat by placing thefloor mat bracket hook through the floor matgrommet hole while centering the mat in thefloorwell.

Periodically check to make certain the mats areproperly positioned.

LPD0477

Appearance and care 7-5

Page 372: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

SEAT BELTSThe seat belts can be cleaned by wiping themwith a sponge dampened in a mild soap solution.Allow the belts to dry completely in the shadebefore using them. See “Seat belt maintenance”in the “Safety – Seats, seat belts and supplemen-tal restraint system” section of this manual.

WARNING

Do not allow wet seat belts to roll up in theretractor. NEVER use bleach, dye orchemical solvents to clean the seat belts,since these materials may severelyweaken the seat belt webbing.

MOST COMMON FACTORSCONTRIBUTING TO VEHICLECORROSION

● The accumulation of moisture-retaining dirtand debris in body panel sections, cavities,and other areas.

● Damage to paint and other protective coat-ings caused by gravel and stone chips orminor traffic accidents.

ENVIRONMENTAL FACTORSINFLUENCE THE RATE OFCORROSION

Moisture

Accumulation of sand, dirt and water on the ve-hicle body underside can accelerate corrosion.Wet floor coverings will not dry completely insidethe vehicle and should be removed for drying toavoid floor panel corrosion.

Relative humidity

Corrosion will be accelerated in areas of highrelative humidity, especially those areas wherethe temperatures stay above freezing and whereatmospheric pollution exists and road salt isused.

TemperatureHigh temperatures accelerate the rate of corro-sion to those parts which are not well ventilated.

Air pollutionIndustrial pollution, the presence of salt in the airin coastal areas, or heavy road salt use acceler-ates the corrosion process. Road salt also accel-erates the disintegration of paint surfaces.

TO PROTECT YOUR VEHICLEFROM CORROSION

● Wash and wax your vehicle often to keep thevehicle clean.

● Always check for minor damage to the paintand repair it as soon as possible.

● Keep drain holes at the bottom of the doorsopen to avoid water accumulation.

● Check the underbody for accumulation ofsand, dirt or salt. If present, wash with wateras soon as possible.

CORROSION PROTECTION

7-6 Appearance and care

Page 373: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CAUTION

● NEVER remove dirt, sand or other de-bris from the passenger compartmentby washing it out with a hose. Removedirt with a vacuum cleaner or broom.

● Never allow water or other liquids tocome in contact with electronic compo-nents inside the vehicle as this maydamage them.

Chemicals used for road surface de-icing areextremely corrosive. They accelerate corrosionand deterioration of underbody componentssuch as the exhaust system, fuel and brake lines,brake cables, floor pan and fenders.

In winter, the underbody must be cleanedperiodically.

For additional protection against rust and corro-sion, which may be required in some areas, con-sult a NISSAN dealer.

License plate bracket padding

1. License plate

2. Trunk

3. License plate frame

4. Padding

CAUTION

A license plate frame could vibrate andcause noise or paint damage. To avoiddamage or noise, add a soft adhesive padwith a maximum thickness of 1/8 in (4mm) to the back lower edge of the licenseplate frame.

LAI2001

Appearance and care 7-7

Page 374: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

MEMO

7-8 Appearance and care

Page 375: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

8 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Maintenance requirements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2General maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2

Explanation of general maintenance items . . . . . . . . . 8-2Maintenance precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5Engine compartment check locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6Engine cooling system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7

Checking engine coolant level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8Changing engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9

Engine oil. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9Checking engine oil level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9Changing engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10Changing engine oil filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-11

Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) fluid . . . . . . 8-12Power steering fluid. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13

Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13Windshield-washer fluid. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14

Windshield-washer fluid reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14

Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16Variable voltage control system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16Drive belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17

Spark plugs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17Replacing spark plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17

Air cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18In-cabin microfilter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18

Windshield wiper blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19Replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19

Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-21

Engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-21Passenger compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-23

Battery replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-25NISSAN Intelligent Key™ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-25

Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-27Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-27Exterior and interior lights. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-28

Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-32Tire pressure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-32Tire labeling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-36Types of tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-39Tire chains. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-40Changing wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-40

Page 376: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Your NISSAN has been designed to have mini-mum maintenance requirements with long ser-vice intervals to save you both time and money.However, some day-to-day and regular mainte-nance is essential to maintain your NISSAN’sgood mechanical condition, as well as its emis-sions and engine performance.

It is the owner’s responsibility to make sure thatthe scheduled maintenance, as well as generalmaintenance, is performed.

As the vehicle owner, you are the only one whocan ensure that your vehicle receives propermaintenance. You are a vital link in the mainte-nance chain.

Scheduled maintenance

For your convenience, both required and optionalscheduled maintenance items are described andlisted in your “NISSAN Service and MaintenanceGuide”. You must refer to that guide to ensurethat necessary maintenance is performed on yourNISSAN at regular intervals.

General maintenance

General maintenance includes those items whichshould be checked during normal day-to-day op-eration. They are essential for proper vehicle op-eration. It is your responsibility to perform thesemaintenance procedures regularly as prescribed.

Performing general maintenance checks requiresminimal mechanical skill and only a few generalautomotive tools.

These checks or inspections can be done by you,a qualified technician, or, if you prefer, a NISSANdealer.

Where to go for service

If maintenance service is required or your vehicleappears to malfunction, have the systemschecked and corrected by a NISSAN dealer.

NISSAN technicians are well-trained specialistswho are kept up-to-date with the latest serviceinformation through technical bulletins, servicetips, and in-dealership training programs. Theyare completely qualified to work on NISSAN ve-hicles before they work on your vehicle, ratherthan after they have worked on it.

You can be confident that a NISSAN dealer’sservice department performs the best job to meetthe maintenance requirements on your vehicle —in a reliable and economical way.

During the normal day-to-day operation of thevehicle, general maintenance should be per-formed regularly as prescribed in this section. Ifyou detect any unusual sounds, vibrations orsmells, be sure to check for the cause or have aNISSAN dealer do it promptly. In addition, youshould notify a NISSAN dealer if you think thatrepairs are required.

When performing any checks or maintenancework, closely observe the “Maintenance precau-tions” later in this section.

EXPLANATION OF GENERALMAINTENANCE ITEMS

Additional information on the followingitems with “ * ” is found later in this section.

Outside the vehicle

The maintenance items listed here should beperformed from time to time, unless otherwisespecified.

Doors and engine hood Check that the doorsand engine hood operate properly. Also ensurethat all latches lock securely. Lubricate hinges,latches, latch pins, rollers and links as necessary.Make sure that the secondary latch keeps thehood from opening when the primary latch isreleased.

MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS GENERAL MAINTENANCE

8-2 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 377: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

When driving in areas using road salt or othercorrosive materials, check lubrication frequently.

Lights* Clean the headlights on a regular basis.Make sure that the headlights, stop lights, taillights, turn signal lights, and other lights are alloperating properly and installed securely. Alsocheck headlight aim.

Road wheel nuts (lug nuts)* When checkingthe tires, make sure no wheel nuts are missing,and check for any loose wheel nuts. Tighten ifnecessary.

Tire rotation* Tires should be rotated every7,500 miles (12,000 km).

Tires* Check the pressure with a gauge oftenand always prior to long distance trips. If neces-sary, adjust the pressure in all tires, including thespare, to the pressure specified. Check carefullyfor damage, cuts or excessive wear.

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)transmitter components Replace the TPMStransmitter grommet seal, valve core and capwhen the tires are replaced due to wear or age.

Wheel alignment and balance If the vehicleshould pull to either side while driving on astraight and level road, or if you detect uneven orabnormal tire wear, there may be a need for wheel

alignment. If the steering wheel or seat vibrates atnormal highway speeds, wheel balancing may beneeded.

● For additional information regarding tires,refer to “Important Tire Safety Information”(US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) inthe Warranty Information Booklet.

Windshield Clean the windshield on a regularbasis. Check the windshield at least every sixmonths for cracks or other damage. Have a dam-aged windshield repaired by a qualified repairfacility.

Windshield wiper blades* Check for cracks orwear if they do not wipe properly.

Inside the vehicle

The maintenance items listed here should bechecked on a regular basis, such as when per-forming periodic maintenance, cleaning the ve-hicle, etc.

Additional information on the followingitems with an “*” is found later in this sec-tion.

Accelerator pedal Check the pedal for smoothoperation and make sure the pedal does not bindor require uneven effort. Keep the floor mat awayfrom the pedal.

Brake pedal Check the pedal for smooth opera-tion. If the brake pedal suddenly goes down fur-ther than normal, the pedal feels spongy or thevehicle seems to take longer to stop, see aNISSAN dealer immediately. Keep the floor mataway from the pedal.

Brakes Check that the brakes do not pull thevehicle to one side when applied.

Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT)P (Park) position mechanism: On a fairlysteep hill check that the vehicle is held securelywith the shift selector in the P (Park) positionwithout applying any brakes.

Parking brake Check the parking brake opera-tion regularly. The vehicle should be securely heldon a fairly steep hill with only the parking brakeapplied. If the parking brake needs adjustment,see a NISSAN dealer.

Seats Check seat position controls such as seatadjusters, seatback recliner, etc. to ensure theyoperate smoothly and all latches lock securely inevery position. Check that the head restraintsmove up and down smoothly and the lock knobs(if so equipped) hold securely in all adjustablepositions.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-3

Page 378: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Seat belts Check that all parts of the seat beltsystem (for example, buckles, anchors, adjustersand retractors) operate properly and smoothly,and are installed securely. Check the belt web-bing for cuts, fraying, wear or damage.

Steering wheel Check for changes in the steer-ing system, such as excessive freeplay, hardsteering or strange noises.

Warning lights and chimes Make sure allwarning lights and chimes are operating properly.

Windshield wiper and washer* Check thatthe wipers and washer operate properly and thatthe wipers do not streak.

Windshield defroster Check that the aircomes out of the defroster outlets properly and insufficient quantity when operating the heater orair conditioner.

Under the hood and vehicle

The maintenance items listed here should bechecked periodically (for example, each time youcheck the engine oil or refuel).

Battery* Check the fluid level in each cell. Itshould be between the MAX and MIN lines. Ve-hicles operated in high temperatures or undersevere conditions require frequent checks of thebattery fluid level.

Brake fluid level* Make sure that the brake fluidlevel is between the MIN and MAX lines on thereservoir.

Engine coolant level* Check the coolant levelwhen the engine is cold.

Engine drive belts* Make sure the drive beltsare not frayed, worn, cracked or oily.

Engine oil level* Check the level after parkingthe vehicle on a level surface with the engine off.Wait more than 10 minutes for the oil to drainback into the oil pan.

Exhaust system Make sure there are no loosesupports, cracks or holes. If the sound of theexhaust seems unusual or there is a smell ofexhaust fumes, immediately have the exhaustsystem inspected by a NISSAN dealer. See thecarbon monoxide warning in the “Starting anddriving” section of this manual.

Fluid leaks Check under the vehicle for fuel, oil,water or other fluid leaks after the vehicle hasbeen parked for a while. Water dripping from theair conditioner after use is normal. If you shouldnotice any leaks or if gasoline fumes are evident,check for the cause and have it corrected imme-diately.

Power steering fluid level* and lines Checkthe level when the fluid is cold, with the engineoff. Check the lines for proper attachment, leaks,cracks, etc.

Radiator and hoses Check the front of theradiator and clean off any dirt, insects, leaves,etc., that may have accumulated. Make sure thehoses have no cracks, deformation, rot or looseconnections.

Underbody The underbody is frequently ex-posed to corrosive substances such as thoseused on icy roads or to control dust. It is veryimportant to remove these substances from theunderbody, otherwise rust may form on the floorpan, frame, fuel lines and exhaust system. At theend of winter, the underbody should be thor-oughly flushed with plain water, in those areaswhere mud and dirt may have accumulated. Seethe “Appearance and care” section of thismanual.

Windshield-washer fluid* Check that there isadequate fluid in the reservoir.

8-4 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 379: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

When performing any inspection or maintenancework on your vehicle, always take care to preventserious accidental injury to yourself or damage tothe vehicle. The following are general precau-tions which should be closely observed.

WARNING

● Park the vehicle on a level surface, ap-ply the parking brake securely andblock the wheels to prevent the vehiclefrom moving. Move the shift selector toP (Park).

● Be sure the ignition switch is in the OFFor LOCK position when performing anyparts replacement or repairs.

● If you must work with the engine run-ning, keep your hands, clothing, hairand tools away from moving fans, beltsand any other moving parts.

● It is advisable to secure or remove anyloose clothing and remove any jewelry,such as rings, watches, etc. beforeworking on your vehicle.

● Always wear eye protection wheneveryou work on your vehicle.

● Your vehicle is equipped with an auto-matic engine cooling fan. It may comeon at any time without warning, even ifthe ignition switch is in the OFF posi-tion and the engine is not running. Toavoid injury, always disconnect thenegative battery cable before workingnear the fan.

● If you must run the engine in an en-closed space such as a garage, be surethere is proper ventilation for exhaustgases to escape.

● Never get under the vehicle while it issupported only by a jack. If it is neces-sary to work under the vehicle, supportit with safety stands.

● Keep smoking materials, flame andsparks away from the fuel tank andbattery.

● On gasoline engine models, the fuelfilter or fuel lines should be serviced bya NISSAN dealer because the fuel linesare under high pressure even when theengine is off.

CAUTION

● Do not work under the hood while theengine is hot. Turn the engine off andwait until it cools down.

● Avoid contact with used engine oil andcoolant. Improperly disposed engineoil, engine coolant and/or other vehiclefluids can damage the environment. Al-ways conform to local regulations fordisposal of vehicle fluid.

● Never leave the engine or automatictransmission related component har-nesses disconnected while the ignitionswitch is in the ON position.

● Never connect or disconnect the batteryor any transistorized component whilethe ignition switch is in the ON position.

This “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” sectiongives instructions regarding only those itemswhich are relatively easy for an owner to perform.

You should be aware that incomplete or improperservicing may result in operating difficulties orexcessive emissions, and could affect warrantycoverage. If in doubt about any servicing,have it done by a NISSAN dealer.

MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-5

Page 380: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Power steering fluid reservoir2. Engine oil filler cap3. Brake fluid reservoir4. Air cleaner5. Fuse block6. Battery7. Fuse/Fusible link box8. Engine oil dipstick9. Radiator cap10. Drive belt location11. Engine coolant reservoir12. Windshield-washer fluid reservoir

NOTE:

Side covers removed for clarity.

WDI0662

ENGINE COMPARTMENT CHECKLOCATIONS

8-6 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 381: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

To remove the engine compartment covers, un-hook the clips �A located as illustrated.

To remove the engine cover, pull the cover up-ward first �1 and then toward the front of thevehicle �2 .

The engine cooling system is filled at the factorywith a pre-diluted mixture of 50% GenuineNISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) and50% water to provide year-round anti-freeze andcoolant protection. The antifreeze solution con-tains rust and corrosion inhibitors. Additional en-gine cooling system additives are not necessary.

WARNING

● Never remove the radiator or coolantreservoir cap when the engine is hot.Wait until the engine and radiator cooldown. Serious burns could be causedby high pressure fluid escaping fromthe radiator. See precautions in “If yourvehicle overheats” found in the “In caseof emergency” section of this manual.

● The radiator is equipped with a pres-sure type radiator cap. To prevent en-gine damage, use only a genuineNISSAN radiator cap.

CAUTION

● Never use any cooling system additivessuch as radiator sealer. Additives mayclog the cooling system and causedamage to the engine, transmissionand/or cooling system.

LDI0734

ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-7

Page 382: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● When adding or replacing coolant, besure to use only Genuine NISSAN LongLife Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) orequivalent. Genuine NISSAN Long LifeAntifreeze/Coolant (blue) is pre-dilutedto provide antifreeze protection to -34°F (-37° C). If additional freeze protec-tion is needed due to weather whereyou operate your vehicle, add GenuineNISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant(blue) concentrate following the direc-tions on the container. If an equivalentcoolant other than Genuine NISSANLong Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) isused, follow the coolant manufacturer’sinstructions to maintain minimum anti-freeze protection to -34° F (-37° C). Theuse of other types of coolant solutionsother than Genuine NISSAN Long LifeAntifreeze/Coolant (blue) or equivalentmay damage the engine coolingsystem.

● The life expectancy of the factory-fillcoolant is 105,000 miles (168,000 km) or7 years. Mixing any other type of cool-ant other than Genuine NISSAN LongLife Antifreeze/Coolant (blue), includ-ing Genuine NISSAN Long LifeAntifreeze/Coolant (green), or the useof non-distilled water will reduce thelife expectancy of the factory-fill cool-ant. Refer to the Nissan Service andMaintenance Guide for more details.

CHECKING ENGINE COOLANTLEVELCheck the coolant level in the reservoir whenthe engine is cold. If the coolant level is belowthe MIN level �B , add coolant to the MAX level�A . If the reservoir is empty, check the coolantlevel in the radiator when the engine is cold. Ifthere is insufficient coolant in the radiator, fill theradiator with coolant up to the filler opening andalso add it to the reservoir up to the MAX level �A .

LDI0554

8-8 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 383: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

This vehicle contains Genuine NISSAN Long LifeAntifreeze/Coolant (blue). The life expectancy ofthe factory-fill coolant is 105,000 miles (168,000km) or 7 years. Mixing any other type of coolant orthe use of non-distilled water will reduce the lifeexpectancy of the factory-fill coolant. Refer to theNISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide formore details.

If the cooling system frequently requirescoolant, have it checked by a NISSANdealer.

CHANGING ENGINE COOLANTA NISSAN dealer can change the engine coolant.The service procedure can be found in theNISSAN Service Manual.

Improper servicing can result in reducedheater performance and engine overheat-ing.

WARNING

● To avoid the danger of being scalded,never change the coolant when the en-gine is hot.

● Never remove the radiator cap when theengine is hot. Serious burns could becaused by high pressure fluid escapingfrom the radiator.

● Avoid direct skin contact with usedcoolant. If skin contact is made, washthoroughly with soap or hand cleaneras soon as possible.

● Keep coolant out of the reach of chil-dren and pets.

Engine coolant must be disposed of properly.Check your local regulations.

CHECKING ENGINE OIL LEVEL1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and apply

the parking brake.

2. Start the engine and let it idle until it reachesoperating temperature.

3. Turn off the engine. Wait more than 10minutes for the oil to drain back intothe oil pan.

4. Remove the dipstick and wipe it clean. Re-insert it all the way.

WDI0663

ENGINE OIL

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-9

Page 384: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

5. Remove the dipstick again and check the oillevel. It should be between the H (High) andL (Low) marks �B . This is the normal oper-ating oil level range. If the oil level is belowthe L (Low) mark �A , remove the oil filler capand pour recommended oil through theopening. Do not overfill �C .

6. Recheck oil level with the dipstick.

It is normal to add some oil between oilmaintenance intervals or during thebreak-in period, depending on the severityof operating conditions.

CAUTION

Oil level should be checked regularly. Op-erating the engine with an insufficientamount of oil can damage the engine, andsuch damage is not covered by warranty.

CHANGING ENGINE OIL

1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and applythe parking brake.

2. Start the engine and let it idle until it reachesoperating temperature.

WDI0214

LDI0641

8-10 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 385: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

3. Turn the engine off and wait more than 10minutes.

4. Place a large drain pan under the drain plug�A (under the body).

5. Remove the oil filler cap �B (inside the en-gine compartment) by turning it counter-clockwise.

6. Remove the drain plug �A with a wrench byturning it counterclockwise and completelydrain the oil.

If the oil filter is to be changed, remove andreplace it at this time. See “Changing engineoil filter” later in this section.

● Waste oil must be disposed of prop-erly.

● Check your local regulations.

WARNING

● Prolonged and repeated contact withused engine oil may cause skin cancer.

● Try to avoid direct skin contact withused oil. If skin contact is made, washthoroughly with soap or hand cleaneras soon as possible.

● Keep used engine oil out of reach ofchildren.

CAUTION

Be careful not to burn yourself. The engineoil may be hot.

7. Clean and reinstall the drain plug and a newwasher. Securely tighten the drain plug witha wrench. Do not use excessive force.

Drain plug tightening torque:22 - 29 ft-lb (29 - 39 N·m)

8. Refill engine with recommended oil throughthe oil filler opening, then install the oil fillercap securely.

See “Capacities and recommendedfuel/lubricants” in the “Technical and con-sumer information” section of this manual fordrain and refill capacity.

The drain and refill capacity depends on theoil temperature and drain time. Use thesespecifications for reference only. Always usethe dipstick to determine when the properamount of oil is in the engine.

9. Start the engine. Check for leakage aroundthe drain plug and oil filter. Correct as re-quired.

10. Turn the engine off and wait more than 10minutes. Check the oil level with the dip-stick. Add engine oil if necessary.

CHANGING ENGINE OIL FILTER

1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and applythe parking brake.

2. Turn the engine off.

3. Place a large drain pan under the oil filter �A .

4. Loosen the oil filter �A with an oil filterwrench by turning it counterclockwise. Thenremove the oil filter by turning it by hand.

CAUTION

Be careful not to burn yourself. The engineoil may be hot.

LDI0642

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-11

Page 386: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

5. Wipe the engine oil filter sealing surface witha clean rag.

CAUTION

Be sure to remove any old gasket materialremaining on the sealing surface of theengine. Failure to do so could lead toengine damage.

6. Coat the gasket on the new filter with cleanengine oil.

7. Screw on the oil filter until a slight resistanceis felt, then tighten an additional 2/3 turn.

8. Start the engine and check for leakagearound the oil filter. Correct as required.

9. Turn the engine off and wait more than 10minutes. Check the oil level. Add engine oil ifnecessary.

CAUTION

● Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT FluidNS-2. Do not mix with other fluids.

● Using transmission fluid other thanGenuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-2 willdamage the CVT, which is not coveredby the warranty.

When checking or replacement of CVT fluid isrequired, we recommend your NISSAN dealer forservicing.

The fluid level should be checked using the HOTMAX range on the power steering fluid reservoirat fluid temperatures of 122° - 176°F (50° -80°C) or using the COLD MAX range on thepower steering fluid reservoir at fluid tempera-tures of 32° - 86°F (0° - 30°C).

If the fluid is at or below the MIN line, add Genu-ine NISSAN PSF to HOT MAX or COLD MAXdepending on system fluid temperature. Removethe cap and fill through the opening.

LDI0557

CONTINUOUSLY VARIABLETRANSMISSION (CVT) FLUID

POWER STEERING FLUID

8-12 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 387: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CAUTION

● DO NOT OVERFILL.

● Recommended fluid is GenuineNISSAN PSF or equivalent.

For further brake fluid specification information,refer to “Capacities and recommendedfuel/lubricants” in the “Technical and consumerinformation” section of this manual.

WARNING

● Use only new fluid from a sealed con-tainer. Old, inferior or contaminatedfluid may damage the brake system.The use of improper fluids can damagethe brake system and affect the vehi-cle’s stopping ability.

● Clean the filler cap before removing.

● Brake fluid is poisonous and should bestored carefully in marked containersout of reach of children.

CAUTION

Do not spill the fluid on any painted sur-faces. This will damage the paint. If fluid isspilled, immediately wash the surfacewith water.

BRAKE FLUIDCheck the brake fluid level in the reservoir. If thefluid level is below the MIN line or the brakewarning light comes on, add Genuine NISSANSuper Heavy Duty Brake Fluid or equivalent DOT3 fluid up to the MAX line. If fluid must be addedfrequently, the system should be checked by aNISSAN dealer.

LDI0558

BRAKE FLUID

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-13

Page 388: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WINDSHIELD-WASHER FLUIDRESERVOIR

Fill the windshield-washer fluid reservoir periodi-cally. Add windshield-washer fluid when the lowwindshield-washer fluid warning light comes on.

To fill the windshield-washer fluid reservoir, liftthe cap off the reservoir and pour the windshield-washer fluid into the reservoir opening.

Add a washer solvent to the washer for bettercleaning. In the winter season, add a windshield-washer antifreeze. Follow the manufacturer’s in-structions for the mixture ratio.

Refill the reservoir more frequently when drivingconditions require an increased amount ofwindshield-washer fluid.

Recommended fluid is Genuine NISSAN Wind-shield Washer Concentrate Cleaner & Anti-freeze or equivalent.

CAUTION

● Do not substitute engine anti-freezecoolant for windshield-washer fluid.This may result in damage to the paint.

● Do not fill the windshield-washer fluidreservoir with washer fluid concen-trates at full strength. Some methyl al-cohol based washer fluid concentratesmay permanently stain the grille ifspilled while filling the windshield-washer reservoir.

● Pre-mix washer fluid concentrates withwater to the manufacturer’s recom-mended levels before pouring the fluidinto the windshield-washer fluid reser-voir. Do not use the windshield-washerfluid reservoir to mix the washer fluidconcentrate and water.

● Keep the battery surface clean and dry.Clean the battery with a solution of bakingsoda and water.

● Make certain the terminal connections areclean and securely tightened.

● If the vehicle is not to be used for 30 days orlonger, disconnect the negative (-) batteryterminal cable to prevent discharge.

WARNING

● Do not expose the battery to flames, anelectrical spark or a cigarette. Hydro-gen gas generated by the battery is ex-plosive. Explosive gases can causeblindness or injury. Do not allow batteryfluid to contact your skin, eyes, fabricsor painted surfaces. Sulfuric acid cancause blindness or injury. After touch-ing a battery or battery cap, do nottouch or rub your eyes. Thoroughlywash your hands. If the acid contactsyour eyes, skin or clothing, immediatelyflush with water for at least 15 minutesand seek medical attention.

WDI0664

WINDSHIELD-WASHER FLUID BATTERY

8-14 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 389: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● Do not operate the vehicle if the fluid inthe battery is low. Low battery fluid cancause a higher load on the batterywhich can generate heat, reduce bat-tery life, and in some cases lead to anexplosion.

● When working on or near a battery, al-ways wear suitable eye protection andremove all jewelry.

● Battery posts, terminals and related ac-cessories contain lead and lead com-pounds. Wash hands after handling.

● Keep battery out of the reach ofchildren.

● Do not tip the battery. Keep the ventcaps tight and the battery level.

1. Remove the vent caps with a screwdriver asshown. Use a cloth to protect the batterycase.

2. Check the fluid level in each cell. If it isnecessary to add fluid, add only distilledwater to bring the level up to the bottom ofthe filler opening. Do not overfill. Reinstallthe vent caps.

WDI0224

WDI0529

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-15

Page 390: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Vehicles operated in high temperatures or undersevere conditions require frequent checks of thebattery fluid level.

JUMP STARTINGIf jump starting is necessary, see “Jump starting”in the “In case of emergency” section of thismanual. If the engine does not start by jumpstarting, the battery may have to be replaced.Contact a NISSAN dealer.

CAUTION

● Do not ground accessories directly tothe battery terminal. Doing so will by-pass the variable voltage control sys-tem and the vehicle battery may notcharge completely.

● Use electrical accessories with the en-gine running to avoid discharging thevehicle battery.

Your vehicle is equipped with a variable voltagecontrol system. This system measures theamount of electrical discharge from the batteryand controls voltage generated by the generator.

The current sensor �A is located near the batteryalong the negative battery cable. If you add elec-trical accessories to your vehicle, be sure toground them to a suitable body ground such asthe frame or engine block area.

LDI0694

VARIABLE VOLTAGE CONTROLSYSTEM

8-16 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 391: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Power steering fluid pump2. Generator3. Air conditioner compressor4. Crankshaft pulley

WARNING

Be sure the ignition switch is in the OFF orLOCK position before servicing drive belt.The engine could rotate unexpectedly.

1. Visually inspect the belt for signs of unusualwear, cuts, fraying or looseness. If the belt isin poor condition or is loose, have it replacedor adjusted by a NISSAN dealer.

2. Have the belt checked regularly for condi-tion and tension in accordance with themaintenance schedule found in the“NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide”.

REPLACING SPARK PLUGS

Iridium-tipped spark plugs

It is not necessary to replace iridium-tipped �Aspark plugs as frequently as conventional typespark plugs because they last much longer. Fol-low the maintenance log shown in the “NISSANService and Maintenance Guide”. Do not serviceiridium-tipped spark plugs by cleaning or regap-ping.

● Always replace spark plugs with rec-ommended or equivalent ones.

LDI0564 SDI1895

DRIVE BELT SPARK PLUGS

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-17

Page 392: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

Be sure the engine and ignition switch areoff and that the parking brake is engagedsecurely.

CAUTION

Be sure to use the correct socket to re-move the spark plugs. An incorrect socketcan damage the spark plugs.

If replacement is required, see your NISSANdealer for assistance.

The air cleaner filter should not be cleaned andreused. Replace it according to the maintenancelog shown in the “NISSAN Service and Mainte-nance Guide.” When replacing the filter, wipe theinside of the air cleaner filter housing and thecover with a damp cloth.

To remove the air cleaner filter, push the tabs inthe direction indicated and pull the unit upwards.

WARNING

● Operating the engine with the aircleaner removed can cause you or oth-ers to be burned. The air cleaner notonly cleans the air, it stops the flame ifthe engine backfires. If it isn’t there, andthe engine backfires, you could beburned. Do not drive with the air cleanerremoved, and be careful when workingon the engine with the air cleanerremoved.

● Never pour fuel into the throttle body orattempt to start the engine with the aircleaner removed. Doing so could resultin serious injury.

IN-CABIN MICROFILTERThe in-cabin microfilter restricts the entry of air-borne dust and pollen particles and reducessome objectionable outside odors. The filter islocated behind the glove box. Refer to the“NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide” forchange intervals.

If replacement is required, see your NISSANdealer.

LDI2072

AIR CLEANER

8-18 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 393: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

CLEANING

If your windshield is not clear after using thewindshield-washer or if a wiper blade chatterswhen running, wax or other material may be onthe blade or windshield.

Clean the outside of the windshield with a washersolution or a mild detergent. Your windshield isclean if beads do not form when rinsing with clearwater.

Clean each blade by wiping it with a cloth soakedin a washer solution or a mild detergent. Thenrinse the blades with clear water. If your wind-shield is still not clear after cleaning the bladesand using the wiper, replace the blades.

CAUTION

Worn windshield wiper blades can dam-age the windshield and impair drivervision.

REPLACING

Replace the wiper blades if they are worn.

�1 Lift the wiper arm away from the windshield.

�2 Push the release tab, then move the wiperblade down the wiper arm to remove.

�3 Remove the wiper blade.

4. Insert the new wiper blade onto the wiperarm until it clicks into place.

CAUTION

● After wiper blade replacement, returnthe wiper arm to its original position;otherwise it may be damaged when thehood is opened.

● Make sure the wiper blades contact theglass; otherwise the arms may be dam-aged from wind pressure.

WDI0194

WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADES

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-19

Page 394: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Be careful not to let anything get into the washernozzle �A . This may cause clogging or improperwindshield washer operation. If something getsinto the nozzle, remove it with a needle or smallpin �B .

If the brakes do not operate properly, have thebrakes checked by a NISSAN dealer.

Self-adjusting brakes

Your vehicle is equipped with self-adjustingbrakes.

The front and rear disc-type brakes self-adjustevery time the brake pedal is applied.

WARNING

See a NISSAN dealer for a brake systemcheck if the brake pedal height does notreturn to normal.

Brake pad wear indicators

The disc brake pads on your vehicle have audiblewear indicators. When a brake pad requires re-placement, a high pitched scraping or screech-ing sound will be heard when the vehicle is inmotion. The noise will be heard whether or not thebrake pedal is depressed. Have the brakeschecked as soon as possible if the wear indicatorsound is heard.

Under some driving or climate conditions, occa-sional brake squeak, squeal or other noise maybe heard. Occasional brake noise during light tomoderate stops is normal and does not affect thefunction or performance of the brake system.

Proper brake inspection intervals shouldbe followed. For more information regardingbrake inspections, see the appropriate mainte-nance schedule information in the “NISSAN Ser-vice and Maintenance Guide”.

WDI0337

BRAKES

8-20 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 395: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Two types of fuses are used. Type �A is used inthe fuse boxes in the engine compartment. Type�B is used in the passenger compartment fusebox.

Type A fuses are provided as spare fuses. Theyare stored in the passenger compartment fusebox.

Type A fuses can be installed in the engine com-partment and passenger compartment fuseboxes.

If a type A fuse is used to replace a type B fuse,the type A fuse will not be level with the fusepocket as shown in the illustration. This will notaffect the performance of the fuse. Make sure thefuse is installed in the fuse box securely.

Type B fuses cannot be installed in the under-hood fuse boxes. Only use type A fuses in theunderhood fuse boxes.

ENGINE COMPARTMENT

CAUTION

Never use a fuse of a higher or loweramperage rating than specified on thefuse box cover. This could damage theelectrical system or cause a fire.

If any electrical equipment does not come on,check for an open fuse.

1. Be sure the ignition switch and the headlightswitch are OFF.

2. Open the engine hood.

LDI0455 LDI0457 LDI0560

FUSES

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-21

Page 396: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

3. Remove the fuse box cover by pushing thetab and lifting the cover up.

4. Remove the fuse with the fuse puller. Thefuse puller is located in the center of the fuseblock in the passenger compartment.

5. If the fuse is open �A , replace it with a newfuse �B .

6. If a new fuse also opens, have the electricalsystem checked and repaired by a NISSANdealer.

Fusible linksIf the electrical equipment does not operate andfuses are in good condition, check the fusiblelinks. If any of these fusible links are melted,replace with only Genuine NISSAN parts.

WDI0452

8-22 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 397: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

PASSENGER COMPARTMENT

CAUTION

Never use a fuse of a higher or loweramperage rating than specified on thefuse box cover. This could damage theelectrical system or cause a fire.

If any electrical equipment does not operate,check for an open fuse.

1. Be sure the ignition switch and the headlightswitch are OFF.

2. Pull the fuse box cover to remove.

3. Remove the fuse with the fuse puller.

LDI0328

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-23

Page 398: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

4. If the fuse is open �A , replace it with anequivalent good fuse �B .

5. Push the fuse box cover to install.

6. If a new fuse also opens, have the electricalsystem checked and repaired by a NISSANdealer.

Extended storage switchIf any electrical equipment does not operate,remove the extended storage switch and checkfor an open fuse.

NOTE:

The extended storage switch is used forlong term vehicle storage. Even if the ex-tended storage switch is broken it is notnecessary to replace it. Replace only theopen fuse in the switch with a new fuse.

Type AWDI0452

Type BLDI0456 LDI2035

8-24 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 399: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

How to replace the extended storage switch:

1. To remove the extended storage switch, besure the ignition switch is in the OFF orLOCK position.

2. Be sure the headlight switch is in the OFFposition.

3. Remove the fuse box cover.

4. Pinch the locking tabs �1 found on eachside of the storage switch.

5. Pull the storage switch straight out from thefuse box �2 .

CAUTION

Be careful not to allow children to swallowthe battery or removed parts.

NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY™

LDI2001

BATTERY REPLACEMENT

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-25

Page 400: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Replace the battery in the Intelligent Key as fol-lows:

1. Remove the mechanical key from the Intelli-gent Key.

2. Insert a small screwdriver �A into the slit �Bof the corner and twist it to separate theupper part from the lower part. Use a cloth toprotect the casing.

3. Replace the battery with a new one.

Recommended battery: CR2032 or equiva-lent.

● Do not touch the internal circuit and elec-tric terminals as doing so could cause amalfunction.

● Hold the battery by the edges. Holdingthe battery across the contact points willseriously deplete the storage capacity.

● Make sure that the + side faces the bot-tom of the case.

4. Close the lid securely as illustrated �C �D .

5. Operate the buttons to check the operation.

See a NISSAN dealer if you need assistance forreplacement.

FCC Notice:

For USA:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC Rules. Operation is subject to the fol-lowing two conditions: (1) This device maynot cause harmful interference, and (2) thisdevice must accept any interference re-ceived, including interference that maycause undesired operation. Note: Changes

or modifications not expressly approved bythe party responsible for compliance couldvoid the user’s authority to operate theequipment.

For Canada:This device complies with RSS-210 of In-dustry Canada. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) this devicemay not cause interference, and (2) thisdevice must accept any interference, in-cluding interference that may cause unde-sired operation of the device.

WDI0568

8-26 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 401: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

HEADLIGHTSReplacing the xenon headlight bulb (ifso equipped)

WARNING

cHIGH VOLTAGE

When xenon headlights are on, they pro-duce a high voltage. To prevent an electricshock, never attempt to modify or disas-semble. Always have your xenon head-lights replaced at a NISSAN dealer. Foradditional information, see “Headlightand turn signal switch” in the “Instru-ments and controls” section.

Replacing the halogen headlight bulb(if so equipped)The headlight is a semi-sealed beam type whichuses a replaceable headlight (halogen) bulb. Be-cause the headlight assembly must be removedfrom the vehicle for bulb replacement, see yourNISSAN dealer.

CAUTION

● Aiming is not necessary after replacingthe bulb. When aiming adjustment isnecessary, contact a NISSAN dealer.

● Do not leave the headlight assemblyopen without a bulb installed for a longperiod of time. Dust, moisture, smoke,etc. entering the headlight body mayaffect bulb performance. Remove thebulb from the headlight assembly justbefore a replacement bulb is installed.

● Only touch the base when handling thebulb. Never touch the glass envelope.Touching the glass could significantlyaffect bulb life and/or headlightperformance.

● High pressure halogen gas is sealedinside the halogen bulb. The bulb maybreak if the glass envelope is scratchedor the bulb is dropped.

Fog may temporarily form inside the lens of theexterior lights in the rain or in a car wash. Atemperature difference between the inside andthe outside of the lens causes the fog. This is nota malfunction. If large drops of water collectinside the lens, contact a NISSAN dealer.

LIGHTS

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-27

Page 402: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

EXTERIOR AND INTERIOR LIGHTS

Item Wattage (W) Bulb No.*

Headlight assemblyHigh (Halogen) 65 9005 (HB3)Low (Halogen) (if so equipped) 55 H11Low (Xenon)** (if so equipped) 35 D2SPark/Turn 28/8 3457NAKSide marker 5 WY5W

Front fog light (if so equipped) 55 H11Front personal/map lights 8 —Glove box light 3.4 158Vanity mirror light 1.4 —Step light 3.8 194Rear personal lights 8 —Door switch illumination — LEDHigh-mounted stop light (Type A) — LEDHigh-mounted stop light (Type B) — LEDTrunk light 3.4 158Rear combination light

Tail/Stop — LEDTurn signal 21 WY21WBackup (reversing) 18 921Sidemarker 5 W5W

License plate light 5 168Foot well light 3.4 158

* Always check with the Parts Department at a NISSAN dealer for the latest parts information.

** See a NISSAN dealer for replacement.

8-28 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 403: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

1. Headlight assembly2. Map light3. Rear personal lights4. Fog light (if so equipped)5. Step light6. High-mounted stop light (Type A)7. Trunk light8. High-mounted stop light (Type B)9. License plate light10. Rear combination light

WDI0666

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-29

Page 404: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Replacement proceduresAll other lights are either type A, B, C or D. Whenreplacing a bulb, first remove the lens, lampand/or cover.

Indicates bulb removal

Indicates bulb installation

Use a cloth �1 to protect the housing.

WDI0263

Map lightsWDI0667

8-30 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 405: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Use a cloth �1 to protect the housing. Use a cloth �1 to protect the housing. Use a cloth �1 to protect the housing.Vanity mirror light

WDI0340

Step lightLDI0341

Personal lightWDI0670

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-31

Page 406: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

If you have a flat tire, see “Flat tire” in the“In case of emergency” section of thismanual.

TIRE PRESSURE

Tire Pressure Monitoring System(TPMS)

This vehicle is equipped with the TirePressure Monitoring System (TPMS). Itmonitors tire pressure of all tires exceptthe spare. When the low tire pressurewarning light is lit and the CHECK TIREPRESSURE warning appears in the ve-hicle information display, one or more ofyour tires is significantly under-inflated. Ifequipped, the system also displays pres-sure of all tires (except the spare tire) onthe display screen by sending a signalfrom a sensor that is installed in eachwheel.

The TPMS will activate only when thevehicle is driven at speeds above 16 MPH(25 km/h). Also, this system may not de-tect a sudden drop in tire pressure (forexample a flat tire while driving).

For more details, refer to “Low tire pressurewarning light” in the “Instruments and con-trols” section, “Tire pressure information” inthe “Monitor, climate, audio, phone andvoice recognition” section, “Tire PressureMonitoring System (TPMS)” in the “Start-ing and driving” section, and “Flat tire” inthe “In case of emergency” section.

Tire inflation pressure

Check the tire pressures (including thespare) often and always prior to long dis-tance trips. The recommended tire pres-sure specifications are shown on theF.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification labelor the Tire and Loading Information labelunder the �Cold Tire Pressure� heading.The Tire and Loading Information label isaffixed to the driver side center pillar. Tirepressures should be checked regularlybecause:

● Most tires naturally lose air over time.

● Tires can lose air suddenly whendriven over potholes or other objectsor if the vehicle strikes a curb whileparking.

Trunk lightWDI0343

WHEELS AND TIRES

8-32 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 407: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

The tire pressures should be checkedwhen the tires are cold. The tires areconsidered COLD after the vehicle hasbeen parked for 3 or more hours, or drivenless than 1 mile (1.6 km) at moderatespeeds.

Set the tire pressure to the normal coldtire inflation pressure when the vehiclespeed or load is reduced.

Incorrect tire pressure, including un-der inflation, may adversely affecttire life and vehicle handling.

WARNING

● Improperly inflated tires can failsuddenly and cause an accident.

● The Gross Vehicle Weight Rating(GVWR) is located on theF.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certifica-tion label. The vehicle weight ca-pacity is indicated on the Tire andLoading Information label (if soequipped). Do not load your ve-hicle beyond this capacity. Over-loading your vehicle may result inreduced tire life, unsafe operat-ing conditions due to prematuretire failure, or unfavorable han-dling characteristics and couldalso lead to a serious accident.Loading beyond the specified ca-pacity may also result in failure ofother vehicle components.

● Before taking a long trip, orwhenever you heavily load yourvehicle, use a tire pressure gaugeto ensure that the tire pressuresare at the specified level.

● Increase the cold tire inflationpressure as indicated in �Check-ing tire pressure� later in this sec-tion when using the tires speci-fied by NISSAN above 100 MPH(162 km/h) where it is legal to doso (on a race track for example).Failure to increase the cold tireinflation pressure may result intire failure, loss of control andpossible injury. After such use,readjust tire pressure.

● For additional information re-garding tires, refer to “ImportantTire Safety Information” (US) or“Tire Safety Information”(Canada) in the Warranty Infor-mation Booklet.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-33

Page 408: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Tire and loading information label

�1 Seating capacity: The maximum num-ber of occupants that can be seatedin the vehicle.

�2 Vehicle load limit: See loading infor-mation in the “Technical and con-sumer information” section.

�3 Original tire size: The size of the tiresoriginally installed on the vehicle atthe factory.

�4 Cold tire pressure: Inflate the tires tothis pressure when the tires are cold.Tires are considered COLD after thevehicle has been parked for 3 or morehours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6km) at moderate speeds. The recom-mended cold tire inflation is set by themanufacturer to provide the best bal-ance of tire wear, vehicle handling,driveability, tire noise, etc., up to thevehicle’s GVWR.

�5 Tire size – refer to “Tire labeling” inthis section.

�6 Spare tire size (if so equipped).

LDI2000

8-34 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 409: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Checking tire pressure

1. Remove the valve stem cap from thetire.

2. Press the pressure gauge squarelyonto the valve stem. Do not press toohard or force the valve stem side-ways, or air will escape. If the hissingsound of air escaping from the tire isheard while checking the pressure,reposition the gauge to eliminate thisleakage.

3. Remove the gauge.

4. Read the tire pressure on the gaugestem and compare to the specifica-tion shown on the Tire and LoadingInformation label.

5. Add air to the tire as needed. If toomuch air is added, press the core ofthe valve stem briefly with the tip ofthe gauge stem to release pressure.Recheck the pressure and add orrelease air as needed.

6. Install the valve stem cap.

7. Check the pressure of all other tires,including the spare.

LDI0393

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-35

Page 410: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Size Cold Tire Inflation Pres-sure

Front Original TireP245/45VR18 230 kPa, 33 PSIP245/40VR19 230 kPa, 33 PSIP245/40WR19 230 kPa, 33 PSI

Rear Original TireP245/45VR18 230 kPa, 33 PSIP245/40VR19 230 kPa, 33 PSIP245/40WR19 230 kPa, 33 PSI

Spare Tire (Temporary)T145/80D17 420 kPa, 60 PSIT145/80R17 420 kPa, 60 PSI

TIRE LABELING

Federal law requires tire manufacturers toplace standardized information on thesidewall of all tires. This information iden-tifies and describes the fundamentalcharacteristics of the tire and also pro-vides the tire identification number (TIN)for safety standard certification. The TINcan be used to identify the tire in case of arecall.

ExampleWDI0394

8-36 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 411: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

�1 Tire size (example: P215/65R15 95H)

1. P: The “P” indicates the tire is de-signed for passenger vehicles (not alltires have this information).

2. Three-digit number (215): This num-ber gives the width in millimeters ofthe tire from sidewall edge to side-wall edge.

3. Two-digit number (65): This number,known as the aspect ratio, gives thetire’s ratio of height to width.

4. R: The “R” stands for radial.

5. Two-digit number (15): This numberis the wheel or rim diameter in inches.

6. Two- or three-digit number (95): Thisnumber is the tire’s load index. It is ameasurement of how much weighteach tire can support. You may notfind this information on all tires be-cause it is not required by law.

7. H: Tire speed rating. You should notdrive the vehicle faster than the tirespeed rating.

ExampleWDI0395

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-37

Page 412: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

�2 TIN (Tire Identification Number) for anew tire (example: DOT XX XX XXXXXXX)

1. DOT: Abbreviation for the “Depart-ment Of Transportation”. The symbolcan be placed above, below or to theleft or right of the Tire IdentificationNumber.

2. Two-digit code: Manufacturer’sidentification mark.

3. Two-digit code: Tire size.

4. Three-digit code: Tire type code(Optional).

5. Three-digit code: Date of Manufac-ture.

6. Four numbers represent the weekand year the tire was built. For ex-ample, the numbers 3103 means the31st week of 2003. If these numbersare missing, then look on the othersidewall of the tire.

�3 Tire ply composition and material

The number of layers or plies of rubber-coated fabric in the tire. Tire manufactur-ers also must indicate the materials in thetire, which include steel, nylon, polyester,and others.

�4 Maximum permissible inflation pres-sure

This number is the greatest amount of airpressure that should be put in the tire. Donot exceed the maximum permissible in-flation pressure.

�5 Maximum load rating

This number indicates the maximum loadin kilograms and pounds that can be car-ried by the tire. When replacing the tireson the vehicle, always use a tire that hasthe same load rating as the factory in-stalled tire.

�6 Term of “tubeless” or “tube type”

Indicates whether the tire requires an in-ner tube (“tube type”) or not (“tubeless”).

ExampleWDI0396

8-38 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 413: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

�7 The word “radial”

The word “radial” is shown if the tire hasradial structure.

�8 Manufacturer or brand name

Manufacturer or brand name is shown.

Other Tire-related Terminology

In addition to the many terms that aredefined throughout this section, IntendedOutboard Sidewall is (1) the sidewall thatcontains a whitewall, bears white letteringor bears manufacturer, brand, and/ormodel name molding that is higher ordeeper than the same molding on theother sidewall of the tire, or (2) the out-ward facing sidewall of an asymmetricaltire that has a particular side that mustalways face outward when mounted on avehicle.

TYPES OF TIRES

WARNING

● When changing or replacing tires, besure all four tires are of the same type(i.e., Summer, All Season or Snow) andconstruction. A NISSAN dealer may beable to help you with information abouttire type, size, speed rating andavailability.

● Replacement tires may have a lowerspeed rating than the factory equippedtires, and may not match the potentialmaximum vehicle speed. Never exceedthe maximum speed rating of the tire.

● For additional information regardingtires, refer to “Important Tire Safety In-formation” (US) or “Tire Safety Informa-tion” (Canada) in the Warranty Informa-tion Booklet.

All season tires

NISSAN specifies All Season tires on some mod-els to provide good performance all year, includ-ing snowy and icy road conditions. All Seasontires are identified by ALL SEASON and/or M&Son the tire sidewall. Snow tires have better snowtraction than All Season tires and may be moreappropriate in some areas.

Summer tires

NISSAN specifies summer tires on some modelsto provide superior performance on dry roads.Summer tire performance is substantially re-duced in snow and ice. Summer tires do not havethe tire traction rating “M&S” on the tire sidewall.

If you plan to operate your vehicle in snowy or icyconditions, NISSAN recommends the use ofSNOW tires or ALL SEASON tires on all fourwheels.

Snow tiresIf snow tires are needed, it is necessary to selecttires equivalent in size and load rating to theoriginal equipment tires. If you do not, it canadversely affect the safety and handling of yourvehicle.

Generally, snow tires have lower speed ratingsthan factory equipped tires and may not matchthe potential maximum vehicle speed. Never ex-ceed the maximum speed rating of the tire.

If you install snow tires, they must be the samesize, brand, construction and tread pattern on allfour wheels.

For additional traction on icy roads, studded tiresmay be used. However, some U.S. states andCanadian provinces prohibit their use. Checklocal, state and provincial laws before installing

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-39

Page 414: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

studded tires. Skid and traction capabilities ofstudded snow tires on wet or dry surfaces may bepoorer than that of non-studded snow tires.

TIRE CHAINS

CAUTION

Tire chains/cables should not be installedon P245/40VR19 size tires. Installation ofthe tire chains/cables on P245/40VR19size tires will cause damage to the ve-hicle. If you plan to use tire chains/cables,you should install P245/45VR18 size tireson your vehicle.

Use of tire chains may be prohibited according tolocation. Check the local laws before installingtire chains. When installing tire chains, make surethey are the proper size for the tires on yourvehicle and are installed according to the chainmanufacturer’s suggestions. Use only SAEclass “S” chains. Class “S” chains are used onvehicles with restricted tire to vehicle clearance.Vehicles that can use Class “S” chains are de-signed to meet the minimum clearances betweenthe tire and the closest vehicle suspension orbody component required to accommodate theuse of a winter traction device (tire chains orcables). The minimum clearances are determinedusing the factory equipped tires. Other types maydamage your vehicle. Use chain tensioners when

recommended by the tire chain manufacturer toensure a tight fit. Loose end links of the tire chainmust be secured or removed to prevent the pos-sibility of whipping action damage to the fendersor underbody. If possible, avoid fully loading yourvehicle when using tire chains. In addition, driveat a reduced speed. Otherwise, your vehicle maybe damaged and/or vehicle handling and perfor-mance may be adversely affected.

Tire chains must be installed only on thefront wheels and not on the rear wheels.

Never install tire chains on a TEMPORARY USEONLY spare tire.

Do not use tire chains on dry roads. Driving withchains in such conditions can cause damage tothe various mechanisms of the vehicle due tosome overstress.

CHANGING WHEELS AND TIRES

Tire rotation

NISSAN recommends rotating the tiresevery 7,500 miles (12,000 km).

See “Flat tire” in the “In case of emer-gency” section of this manual for tire re-placing procedures.

As soon as possible, tighten thewheel nuts to the specified torquewith a torque wrench.

WDI0258

8-40 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 415: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Wheel nut tightening torque:83 ft-lb (112 N·m)

The wheel nuts must be kept tight-ened to specifications at all times. Itis recommended that wheel nuts betightened to specification at eachtire rotation interval.

WARNING

● After rotating the tires, check andadjust the tire pressure.

● Retighten the wheel nuts whenthe vehicle has been driven for600 miles (1,000 km) (also incases of a flat tire, etc.).

● Do not include the spare tire inthe tire rotation.

● For additional information re-garding tires, refer to “ImportantTire Safety Information” (US) or“Tire Safety Information”(Canada) in the Warranty Infor-mation Booklet.

1. Wear indicator2. Location mark

Tire wear and damage

WARNING

● Tires should be periodically in-spected for wear, cracking, bulg-ing or objects caught in the tread.If excessive wear, cracks, bulgingor deep cuts are found, the tire(s)should be replaced.

● The original tires have built-intread wear indicators. When thewear indicators are visible, thetire(s) should be replaced.

● Tires degrade with age and use.Have tires, including the spare,over 6 years old checked by aqualified technician becausesome tire damage may not be ob-vious. Replace the tires as neces-sary to prevent tire failure andpossible personal injury.

● Improper service of the spare tiremay result in serious personal in-jury. If it is necessary to repair thespare tire, contact a NISSANdealer.

● For additional information re-garding tires, refer to “ImportantTire Safety Information” (US) or“Tire Safety Information”(Canada) in the Warranty Infor-mation Booklet.

WDI0259

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-41

Page 416: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Replacing wheels and tires

When replacing a tire, use the same size, treaddesign, speed rating and load carrying capacityas originally equipped. Recommended types andsizes are shown in “Wheels and tires” in the“Technical and consumer information” section ofthis manual.

WARNING

● The use of tires other than those recom-mended or the mixed use of tires ofdifferent brands, construction (bias,bias-belted or radial), or tread patternscan adversely affect the ride, braking,handling, VDC system, ground clear-ance, body-to-tire clearance, tire chainclearance, speedometer calibration,headlight aim and bumper height.Some of these effects may lead to acci-dents and could result in serious per-sonal injury.

● If your vehicle was originally equippedwith 4 tires that were the same size andyou are only replacing 2 of the 4 tires,install the new tires on the rear axle.Placing new tires on the front axle maycause loss of vehicle control in somedriving conditions and cause an acci-dent and personal injury.

● If the wheels are changed for any rea-son, always replace with wheels whichhave the same off-set dimension.Wheels of a different off-set couldcause premature tire wear, degrade ve-hicle handling characteristics, affectthe VDC system and/or interferencewith the brake discs. Such interferencecan lead to decreased braking effi-ciency and/or early brake pad/shoewear. Refer to “Wheels and tires” in the“Technical and consumer information”section of this manual for wheel off-setdimensions.

● When a spare tire is mounted or a wheelis replaced, tire pressure will not beindicated, the TPMS will not functionand the low tire pressure warning lightwill flash for approximately 1 minute.The light will remain on after 1 minute.Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon aspossible for tire replacement and/orsystem resetting.

● Replacing tires with those not originallyspecified by NISSAN could affect theproper operation of the TPMS.

● Do not install a damaged or deformedwheel or tire even if it has been re-paired. Such wheels or tires could havestructural damage and could fail with-out warning.

● The use of retread tires is notrecommended.

● For additional information regardingtires, refer to “Important Tire Safety In-formation” (US) or “Tire Safety Informa-tion” (Canada) in the Warranty Informa-tion Booklet.

Wheel balanceUnbalanced wheels may affect vehicle handlingand tire life. Even with regular use, wheels can getout of balance. Therefore, they should be bal-anced as required.

Wheel balance service should be per-formed with the wheels off the vehicle.Spin balancing the wheels on the vehiclecould lead to mechanical damage.

● For additional information regardingtires, refer to “Important Tire SafetyInformation” (US) or “Tire Safety Infor-mation” (Canada) in the Warranty In-formation Booklet.

8-42 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 417: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Care of wheels

● Wash the wheels when washing the vehicleto maintain their appearance.

● Clean the inner side of the wheels when thewheel is changed or the underside of thevehicle is washed.

● Do not use abrasive cleaners when washingthe wheels.

● Inspect wheel rims regularly for dents orcorrosion. Such damage may cause loss ofpressure or poor seal at the tire bead.

● NISSAN recommends waxing the roadwheels to protect against road salt in areaswhere it is used during winter.

Spare tire (TEMPORARY USE ONLYspare tire)

Observe the following precautions if the TEM-PORARY USE ONLY spare tire must be used.Otherwise, your vehicle could be damaged orinvolved in an accident:

WARNING

● The spare tire should be used for emer-gency use only. It should be replacedwith the standard tire at the first oppor-tunity to avoid possible tire or differen-tial damage.

● Drive carefully while the TEMPORARYUSE ONLY spare tire is installed. Avoidsharp turns and abrupt braking whiledriving.

● Periodically check spare tire inflationpressure. Always keep the pressure ofthe TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tireat 60 psi (420 kPa, 4.2 bar).

● With the TEMPORARY USE ONLY sparetire installed do not drive the vehicle atspeeds faster than 50 MPH (80 km/h).

● When driving on roads covered withsnow or ice, the TEMPORARY USEONLY spare tire should be used on therear wheels and the original tire usedon the front wheels (drive wheels). Usetire chains only on the front (original)tires.

● Tire tread of the TEMPORARY USEONLY spare tire will wear at a faster ratethan the standard tire. Replace thespare tire as soon as the tread wearindicators appear.

● Do not use the spare tire on othervehicles.

● Do not use more than one spare tire atthe same time.

● Do not tow a trailer when the TEMPO-RARY USE ONLY spare tire is installed.

CAUTION

● Do not use tire chains on a TEMPO-RARY USE ONLY spare tire. Tire chainswill not fit properly and may cause dam-age to the vehicle.

● Because the TEMPORARY USE ONLYspare tire is smaller than the originaltire, ground clearance is reduced. Toavoid damage to the vehicle, do notdrive over obstacles. Also, do not drivethe vehicle through an automatic carwash since it may get caught.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-43

Page 418: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

MEMO

8-44 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Page 419: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

9 Technical and consumer information

Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . 9-2Fuel recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3Engine oil and oil filter recommendations . . . . . . . . . . 9-5Air conditioner system refrigerant and oilrecommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6

Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8Dimensions and weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8

When traveling or registering your vehicle inanother country . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9Vehicle identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9

Vehicle identification number (VIN) plate . . . . . . . . . . 9-9Vehicle identification number(chassis number) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9Engine serial number. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label . . . . . . . . . . 9-10Emission control information label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10Tire and loading information label. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11

Air conditioner specification label. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11Installing front license plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11Vehicle loading information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12

Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12Vehicle load capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12Loading tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-14Measurement of weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-14

Towing a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-15Maximum load limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-15Towing load/specification. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-18Towing safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-18Flat towing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-22

Uniform tire quality grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-23Emission control system warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24Reporting safety defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24Readiness for inspection/maintenance (I/M) test . . . . . 9-25Event Data Recorders (EDR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-25Owner’s Manual/Service Manual order information . . . 9-26

Page 420: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

The following are approximate capacities. The actual refill capacities may be slightly different. When refilling, follow the proceduredescribed in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section to determine the proper refill capacity.

Capacity (Approximate) Recommended Fluids and Lubricants

US measure Imp measure Liter

Fuel 20 gal 16-5/8 gal 75.6 Unleaded gasoline with an octane rating of at least 91 AKI (RON 96) *1

Engine oil *7Drain and Refill

With oil filter change 5-1/8 qt 4-1/4 qt 4.8 • Engine oil with API Certification Mark *2, *3• Viscosity SAE 5W-30 *2, *3Without oil filter change 4-3/4 qt 4 qt 4.5

Cooling systemWith reservoir 2-3/8 gal 2 gal 9.0 Pre-diluted Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) or equivalent

CVT fluid See a NISSAN dealer for service. Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-2 *4

Power steering fluid (PSF) Refill to the proper level according to the instructions inthe “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section.

Genuine NISSAN PSF or equivalent.*8

Brake fluid Genuine NISSAN Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid *5 or equivalent DOT 3

Multi-purpose grease — — — NLGI No. 2 (Lithium Soap base)

Air conditioning system refrigerant — — — HFC-134a (R-134a) *6

Air conditioning system oil — — — Genuine NISSAN A/C System Oil Type S or equivalent *6

Windshield-washer fluid 1-1/4 gal 1 gal 4.5 Genuine NISSAN Windshield Washer Concentrate Cleaner & Antifreeze orequivalent

*1: For further details, see “Fuel recommendation” in this section.*2: For further details, see “Engine oil and oil filter recommendation” in this section.*3: NISSAN recommends Genuine NISSAN Ester Engine Oil available at a NISSAN dealer.*4: Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-2. Using transmission fluid other than Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-2 will damage the CVT, which is not covered bythe NISSAN new vehicle limited warranty.*5: Available in mainland USA through a NISSAN dealer.*6: For further details, see “Air conditioner system refrigerant and oil recommendations” in this section.*7: For further details, see “Engine Oil” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual.*8: DEXRON™ VI type ATF may also be used.

CAPACITIES AND RECOMMENDEDFUEL/LUBRICANTS

9-2 Technical and consumer information

Page 421: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

FUEL RECOMMENDATIONNISSAN recommends the use of premium un-leaded gasoline with an octane rating of at least91 AKI (Anti-Knock Index) number (Researchoctane number 96). If unleaded premium gaso-line is not available, you may use unleaded regulargasoline with an octane rating of at least 87 AKInumber (Research octane number 91), but youmay notice a decrease in performance.

CAUTION

● Using a fuel other than that specifiedcould adversely affect the emissioncontrol system, and may also affect thewarranty coverage.

● Under no circumstances should aleaded gasoline be used, because thiswill damage the three-way catalyst.

● Do not use E-85 fuel in your vehicle.Your vehicle is not designed to run onE-85 fuel. Using E-85 fuel can damagethe fuel system components and is notcovered by the NISSAN new vehicle lim-ited warranty.

Gasoline specificationsNISSAN recommends using gasoline that meetsthe World-Wide Fuel Charter (WWFC) specifi-cations where it is available. Many of the automo-bile manufacturers developed this specificationto improve emission control system and vehicleperformance. Ask your service station manager ifthe gasoline meets the WWFC specifications.

Reformulated gasolineSome fuel suppliers are now producing reformu-lated gasolines. These gasolines are speciallydesigned to reduce vehicle emissions. NISSANsupports efforts towards cleaner air and sug-gests that you use reformulated gasoline whenavailable.

Gasoline containing oxygenatesSome fuel suppliers sell gasoline containing oxy-genates such as ethanol, MTBE and methanolwith or without advertising their presence.NISSAN does not recommend the use of fuels ofwhich the oxygenate content and the fuel com-patibility for your NISSAN cannot be readily de-termined. If in doubt, ask your service stationmanager.

If you use oxygenate-blend gasoline, please takethe following precautions as the usage of suchfuels may cause vehicle performance problemsand/or fuel system damage.

● The fuel should be unleaded and havean octane rating no lower than thatrecommended for unleaded gasoline.

● If an oxygenate-blend other thanmethanol blend is used, it should con-tain no more than 10% oxygenate.(MTBE may, however, be added up to15%.)

● If a methanol blend is used, it shouldcontain no more than 5% methanol(methyl alcohol, wood alcohol). Itshould also contain a suitable amountof appropriate cosolvents and corro-sion inhibitors. If not properly formu-lated with appropriate cosolvents andcorrosion inhibitors, such methanolblends may cause fuel system damageand/or vehicle performance problems.At this time, sufficient data is not avail-able to ensure that all methanol blendsare suitable for use in NISSAN ve-hicles.

Technical and consumer information 9-3

Page 422: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

If any driveability problems such as engine stall-ing and difficult hot-starting are experienced afterusing oxygenate-blend fuels, immediatelychange to a non-oxygenate fuel or a fuel with alow blend of MTBE.

Take care not to spill gasoline during refu-eling. Gasoline containing oxygenates cancause paint damage.

E–85 fuel

E-85 fuel is a mixture of approximately 85% fuelethanol and 15% unleaded gasoline. E-85 canonly be used in a Flexible Fuel Vehicle (FFV). Donot use E-85 in your vehicle. U.S. governmentregulations require fuel ethanol dispensingpumps to be identified by a small, square, orangeand black label with the common abbreviation orthe appropriate percentage for that region.

Aftermarket fuel additives

NISSAN does not recommend the use of anyaftermarket fuel additives (for example, fuel injec-tor cleaner, octane booster, intake valve depositremovers, etc.) which are sold commercially.Many of these additives intended for gum, varnishor deposit removal may contain active solvents orsimilar ingredients that can be harmful to the fuelsystem and engine.

Octane rating tips

Using unleaded gasoline with an octanerating lower than recommended can causepersistent, heavy “spark knock.” (“Sparkknock” is a metallic rapping noise.) If se-vere, this can lead to engine damage. If youdetect a persistent heavy spark knock evenwhen using gasoline of the stated octanerating, or if you hear steady spark knockwhile holding a steady speed on levelroads, have a NISSAN dealer correct thecondition. Failure to correct the conditionis misuse of the vehicle, for which NISSANis not responsible.

Incorrect ignition timing may result in sparkknock, after-run and/or overheating, which maycause excessive fuel consumption or enginedamage. If any of the above symptoms are en-countered, have your vehicle checked at aNISSAN dealer.

However, now and then you may noticelight spark knock for a short time whileaccelerating or driving up hills. This is not acause for concern, because you get thegreatest fuel benefit when there is lightspark knock for a short time under heavyengine load.

CAUTION

● Your vehicle is not designed to run onE-85 fuel. Using E-85 fuel in a vehiclenot specifically designed for E-85 fuelcan damage fuel system componentsand is not covered by the NISSAN newvehicle limited warranty.

● E-85 is a mixture of approximately 85%fuel ethanol and 15% unleadedgasoline.

● U.S. government regulations requireethanol dispensing pumps to be identi-fied by a small, square, orange andblack label with the common abbrevia-tion or the appropriate percentage forthat region.

9-4 Technical and consumer information

Page 423: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTERRECOMMENDATIONS

Selecting the correct oil

It is essential to choose the correct grade, qualityand viscosity engine oil to ensure satisfactoryengine life and performance. See “Capacitiesand recommended fuel/lubricants” earlier in thissection. NISSAN recommends the use of anenergy conserving oil in order to improve fueleconomy.

Select only engine oils that meet the AmericanPetroleum Institute (API) certification or Interna-tional Lubricant Standardization and Approval

Committee (ILSAC) certification and SAE vis-cosity standard. These oils have the API certifica-tion mark on the front of the container. Oils whichdo not have the specified quality label should notbe used as they could cause engine damage.

Oil additives

NISSAN does not recommend the use of oiladditives. The use of an oil additive is not neces-sary when the proper oil type is used and main-tenance intervals are followed.

Oil which may contain foreign matter or has beenpreviously used should not be used.

Oil viscosityThe engine oil viscosity or thickness changeswith temperature. Because of this, it is importantto select the engine oil viscosity based on thetemperatures at which the vehicle will be oper-ated before the next oil change. Choosing an oilviscosity other than that recommended couldcause serious engine damage.

Selecting the correct oil filterYour new NISSAN vehicle is equipped with ahigh-quality genuine NISSAN oil filter. When re-placing, use a genuine NISSAN oil filter or itsequivalent for the reason described in “Changeintervals.”

Change intervalsThe oil and oil filter change intervals for yourengine are based on the use of the specifiedquality oils and filters. Using engine oil and filtersthat are not of the specified quality, or exceedingrecommended oil and filter change intervalscould reduce engine life. Damage to the enginecaused by improper maintenance or use of incor-rect oil and filter quality and/or viscosity is notcovered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited war-ranty.

WTI0183

Technical and consumer information 9-5

Page 424: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Your engine was filled with a high-quality engineoil when it was built. You do not have to changethe oil before the first recommended changeinterval. Oil and filter change intervals dependupon how you use your vehicle.

Operation under the following conditions mayrequire more frequent oil and filter changes:

● repeated short distance driving at cold out-side temperatures

● driving in dusty conditions

● extensive idling

● towing a trailer

● stop and go commuting

Refer to the “NISSAN Service and MaintenanceGuide” for the maintenance schedule.

AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEMREFRIGERANT AND OILRECOMMENDATIONSThe air conditioner system in your NISSANvehicle must be charged with the refriger-ant HFC-134a (R-134a) and NISSAN A/Csystem oil Type S or the exact equivalents.

CAUTION

The use of any other refrigerant or oil willcause severe damage to the air condition-ing system and will require the replace-ment of all air conditioner systemcomponents.

The refrigerant HFC-134a (R-134a) in yourNISSAN vehicle does not harm the earth’s ozonelayer. Although this refrigerant does not affect theearth’s atmosphere, certain government regula-tions require the recovery and recycling of anyrefrigerant during automotive air conditioner sys-tem service. A NISSAN dealer has the trainedtechnicians and equipment needed to recoverand recycle your air conditioner system refriger-ant.

Contact a NISSAN dealer when servicing your airconditioner system.

9-6 Technical and consumer information

Page 425: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

ENGINE

Model VQ35DE

Type Gasoline, 4-cycle, DOHCCylinder arrangement 6-cylinder, V-block, Slanted at 60°Bore x Stroke in (mm) 3.760 x 3.205 (95.5 x 81.4)Displacement cu in (cm3) 213.45 (3,498)Firing order 1–2–3–4–5–6

Idle speed

No adjustment is necessary.CVT (in “N” position)Ignition timing (degree B.T.D.C. at idle speed)CO % at idle

Spark plug FXE22HR11

Spark plug gap (Nominal) in (mm) 0.043 (1.1)

Camshaft operation Timing chain

This spark ignition system complies with the Canadian standard ICES-002.

SPECIFICATIONS

Technical and consumer information 9-7

Page 426: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WHEELS AND TIRES

Wheels

18 x 8.0J

19 x 8.0J

Tires

P245/45VR18

P245/40VR19

P245/40WR19

Spare tire T145/80D17T145/80R17

Speed rating 18” V

19” V

19” W

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS

Overall length in (mm) 190.6 (4,843)Overall width in (mm) 73.2 (1,860)Overall height in (mm) 57.9 (1,472)Front Track

18 inch tire in (mm) 62.4 (1,585)19 inch tire in (mm) 62.4 (1,585)

Rear Track18 inch tire in (mm) 62.4 (1,584)19 inch tire in (mm) 62.4 (1,585)

Wheelbase in (mm) 109.3 (2,775)

Gross vehicle weight rating lb (kg) See the “F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label” onthe center pillar between thedriver’s side front and reardoors.

Gross axle weight ratingFront lb (kg)Rear lb (kg)

9-8 Technical and consumer information

Page 427: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

When planning to drive your NISSAN ve-hicle in another country, you should first findout if the fuel available is suitable for your vehi-cle’s engine.

Using fuel with an octane rating that is too lowmay cause engine damage. All gasoline vehiclesmust be operated with unleaded gasoline. There-fore, avoid taking your vehicle to areas whereappropriate fuel is not available.

When transferring the registration of yourvehicle to another country, state, provinceor district, it may be necessary to modify thevehicle to meet local laws and regulations.

The laws and regulations for motor vehicle emis-sion control and safety standards vary accordingto the country, state, province or district; there-fore, vehicle specifications may differ.

When any vehicle is to be taken into an-other country, state, province or districtand registered, its modifications, transpor-tation, and registration are the responsibil-ity of the user. NISSAN is not responsiblefor any inconvenience that may result.

VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER(VIN) PLATEThe vehicle identification number (VIN) plate isattached as shown. This number is the identifica-tion for your vehicle and is used in the vehicleregistration.

VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER(chassis number)The vehicle identification number is located asshown.

WTI0171 LTI0070

WHEN TRAVELING OR REGISTERINGYOUR VEHICLE IN ANOTHERCOUNTRY

VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION

Technical and consumer information 9-9

Page 428: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

ENGINE SERIAL NUMBERThe number is stamped on the engine as shown.

F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S.CERTIFICATION LABELThe Federal/Canadian Motor Vehicle SafetyStandard (F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S.) certification la-bel is affixed as shown. This label contains valu-able vehicle information, such as: Gross VehicleWeight Ratings (GVWR), Gross Axle WeightRating (GAWR), month and year of manufacture,Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), etc. Reviewit carefully.

EMISSION CONTROLINFORMATION LABELThe emission control information label is at-tached to the underside of the hood as shown.

WTI0049 WTI0172 WTI0173

9-10 Technical and consumer information

Page 429: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

TIRE AND LOADING INFORMATIONLABELThe cold tire pressure is shown on the Tire andLoading Information label. The label is located asshown.

AIR CONDITIONER SPECIFICATIONLABELThe air conditioner specification label is affixed tothe underside of the hood as shown.

To mount the front license plate, attach the li-cense plate bracket to the plastic finisher at thelocation marks (small dimples) using the two 6mm screws provided.

WTI0174 WTI0167 LTI2012

INSTALLING FRONT LICENSE PLATE

Technical and consumer information 9-11

Page 430: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

● It is extremely dangerous to ridein a cargo area inside a vehicle. Ina collision, people riding in theseareas are more likely to be seri-ously injured or killed.

● Do not allow people to ride in anyarea of your vehicle that is notequipped with seats and seat belts.

● Be sure everyone in your vehicleis in a seat and using a seat beltproperly.

TERMSIt is important to familiarize yourself withthe following terms before loading yourvehicle:

● Curb Weight (actual weight of yourvehicle) - vehicle weight including:standard and optional equipment, flu-ids, emergency tools, and spare tireassembly. This weight does not in-clude passengers and cargo.

● GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) - curbweight plus the combined weight ofpassengers and cargo.

● GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rat-ing) - maximum total combinedweight of the unloaded vehicle, pas-sengers, luggage, hitch, trailertongue load and any other optionalequipment. This information is lo-cated on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S.certification label.

● GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) -maximum weight (load) limit specifiedfor the front or rear axle. This informa-tion is located on theF.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certificationlabel.

● GCWR (Gross Combined Weightrating) - The maximum total weightrating of the vehicle, passengers,cargo, and trailer.

● Vehicle Capacity Weight, Load limit,Total load capacity - maximum totalweight limit specified of the load(passengers and cargo) for the ve-hicle. This is the maximum combinedweight of occupants and cargo thatcan be loaded into the vehicle. If the

vehicle is used to tow a trailer, thetrailer tongue weight must be in-cluded as part of the cargo load. Thisinformation is located on the Tire andLoading Information label.

● Cargo capacity - permissible weightof cargo, the subtracted weight ofoccupants from the load limit.

VEHICLE LOAD CAPACITY

Do not exceed the load limit of your ve-hicle shown as “The combined weight ofoccupants and cargo” on the Tire andLoading Information label. Do not exceedthe number of occupants shown as“Seating Capacity” on the Tire and Load-ing Information label.

To get “the combined weight of occu-pants and cargo”, add the weight of alloccupants, then add the total luggageweight. Examples are shown in the follow-ing illustration.

VEHICLE LOADING INFORMATION

9-12 Technical and consumer information

Page 431: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Steps for determining correct loadlimit

1. Locate the statement “The combinedweight of occupants and cargoshould never exceed XXX kg or XXXlbs” on your vehicle’s placard.

2. Determine the combined weight ofthe driver and passengers that will beriding in your vehicle.

3. Subtract the combined weight of thedriver and passengers from XXX kgor XXX lbs.

4. The resulting figure equals the avail-able amount of cargo and luggageload capacity. For example, if theXXX amount equals 1,400 lbs. andthere will be five 150 lb. passengersin your vehicle, the amount of avail-able cargo and luggage load capac-ity is 650 lbs. (1,400-750 (5 X 150)= 650 lbs) or (640-340 (5 X 70) =300 kg.)

ExampleLTI0152

Technical and consumer information 9-13

Page 432: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

5. Determine the combined weight ofluggage and cargo being loaded onthe vehicle. That weight may notsafely exceed the available cargo andluggage load capacity calculated inStep 4.

6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer,load from your trailer will be trans-ferred to your vehicle. Consult thismanual to determine how this re-duces the available cargo and lug-gage load capacity of your vehicle.

Before driving a loaded vehicle, confirmthat you do not exceed the Gross VehicleWeight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross AxleWeight Rating (GAWR) for your vehicle.See “Measurement of weights” later inthis section.

Also check tires for proper inflation pres-sures. See the Tire and Loading Informa-tion label.

LOADING TIPS

● The GVW must not exceed GVWRor GAWR as specified on theF.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certificationlabel.

● Do not load the front and rear axle tothe GAWR. Doing so will exceed theGVWR.

WARNING

● Properly secure all cargo withropes or straps to help prevent itfrom sliding or shifting. Do notplace cargo higher than the seat-backs. In a sudden stop or colli-sion, unsecured cargo couldcause personal injury.

● Do not load your vehicle anyheavier than the GVWR or themaximum front and rear GAWRs.If you do, parts of your vehiclecan break, tire damage could oc-cur, or it can change the way yourvehicle handles. This could resultin loss of control and cause per-sonal injury.

● Overloading not only can shortenthe life of your vehicle and thetire, but can also cause unsafevehicle handling and longer brak-ing distances. This may cause apremature tire failure whichcould result in a serious accidentand personal injury. Failurescaused by overloading are notcovered by the vehicle’swarranty.

MEASUREMENT OF WEIGHTS

Secure loose items to prevent weightshifts that could affect the balance of yourvehicle. When the vehicle is loaded, driveto a scale and weigh the front and the rearwheels separately to determine axleloads. Individual axle loads should not ex-ceed either of the gross axle weight rat-ings (GAWR). The total of the axle loadsshould not exceed the gross vehicleweight rating (GVWR). These ratings aregiven on the vehicle certification label. Ifweight ratings are exceeded, move or re-move items to bring all weights below theratings.

9-14 Technical and consumer information

Page 433: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

WARNING

Overloading or improper loading of atrailer and its cargo can adversely affectvehicle handling, braking and perfor-mance and may lead to accidents.

CAUTION

● Do not tow a trailer or haul a heavy loadfor the first 500 miles (800 km). Yourengine, axle or other parts could bedamaged.

● For the first 500 miles (800 km) that youtow a trailer, do not drive over 50 mph(80 km/h) and do not make starts at fullthrottle. This helps the engine and otherparts of your vehicle wear in at theheavier loads.

Your new vehicle was designed to be used pri-marily to carry passengers and cargo. Rememberthat towing a trailer places additional loads onyour vehicle’s engine, drive train, steering, brak-ing and other systems.

A NISSAN Towing Guide (U.S. only) is availableon the website at www.nissanusa.com. Thisguide includes information on trailer towing ca-pability and the special equipment required forproper towing.

MAXIMUM LOAD LIMITSMaximum trailer loadsNever allow the total trailer load to exceed thevalue specified in the “TowingLoad/Specification” chart found later in this sec-tion. The total trailer load equals trailer weightplus its cargo weight.

● When towing a trailer load of 1,000 lbs.(454 kg) or more, trailers with a brakesystem must be used.

The Gross Combined Weight Rating (GCWR)equals the combined weight of the towing vehicle(including passengers and cargo) plus the totaltrailer load. Towing loads greater than these orusing improper towing equipment could ad-versely affect vehicle handling, braking and per-formance.

The ability of your vehicle to tow a trailer is notonly related to the maximum trailer loads, but alsothe places you plan to tow. Tow weights appro-priate for level highway driving may have to bereduced for low traction situations (for example,on slippery boat ramps).

LTI0164

TOWING A TRAILER

Technical and consumer information 9-15

Page 434: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Temperature conditions also can affect towing.For example, towing a heavy trailer in high outsidetemperatures on graded roads can affect engineperformance and cause overheating. The trans-mission high fluid temperature protection mode,which helps reduce the chance of transmissiondamage, could activate and automatically de-crease engine power. Under some conditions,engine and vehicle speed could be reduced. Planyour trip carefully to account for trailer and vehicleload, weather, and road conditions.

WARNING

Overheating can result in reduced enginepower and lower vehicle speed. Also,when the high temperature mode oper-ates, engine and vehicle speed may begradually reduced. On highways, the re-duced speed may be lower than other traf-fic which could increase the chance of acollision. Be especially careful when driv-ing. If the vehicle cannot maintain a safedriving speed, pull to the side of the roadin a safe area and allow the engine to coolor the transmission to return to normaloperation. See “If your vehicle overheats”in the “In case of emergency” section ofthis manual.

CAUTION

Vehicle damage resulting from impropertowing procedures is not covered byNISSAN warranties.

Tongue loadKeep the tongue load between 10 - 15 percent ofthe total trailer load or use the trailer tongue loadspecified by the trailer manufacturer. The tongueload must be within the maximum tongue loadlimits shown in the following “TowingLoad/Specification” chart. If the tongue load be-comes excessive, rearrange cargo to allow forproper tongue load.

WTI0160

9-16 Technical and consumer information

Page 435: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Maximum Gross Vehicle Weight(GVW)/maximum Gross Axle Weight(GAW)

The GVW of the towing vehicle must not exceedthe Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)shown on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certificationlabel. The GVW equals the combined weight ofthe unloaded vehicle, passengers, luggage,hitch, trailer tongue load and any other optionalequipment. In addition, front or rear GAW mustnot exceed the Gross Axle Weight Rating(GAWR) shown on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S.certification label.

Towing capacities are calculated assuming abase vehicle with driver and any options requiredto achieve the rating. Additional passengers,cargo and/or optional equipment, such as thetrailer hitch, will add weight to the vehicle andreduce your vehicle’s maximum towing capacityand trailer tongue load.

The vehicle and trailer need to be weighed toconfirm the vehicle is within the GVWR, FrontGAWR, Rear GAWR, Gross Combined WeightRating (GCWR) and Towing capacity.

All vehicle and trailer weights can be measuredusing platform type scales commonly found attruck stops, highway weigh stations, buildingsupply centers or salvage yards.

To determine the available payload capacity fortongue load, use the following procedure.

1. Locate the GVWR on theF.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label.

2. Weigh your vehicle on the scale with all ofthe passengers and cargo that are normallyin the vehicle when towing a trailer.

3. Subtract the actual vehicle weight from theGVWR. The remaining amount is the avail-able maximum tongue load.

To determine the Gross Trailer Weight, weighyour trailer on a scale with all equipment andcargo, that are normally in the trailer when it istowed. Make sure the Gross Trailer Weight is notmore than the Gross Trailer Weight Rating shownon the trailer and is not more than the calculatedavailable maximum towing capacity.

Also weigh the front and rear axles on the scale tomake sure the Front Gross Axle Weight and RearGross Axle Weight are not more than FrontGross Axle Weight and Rear Gross Axle Weighton the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label.The cargo in the trailer and vehicle may need tobe moved or removed to meet the specified rat-ings.

Example:

● Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW) as weighedon a scale - including passengers, cargo andhitch - 4,446 lb. (2016 kg).

● Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) fromF.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label -4,546 lb. (2062 kg).

● Maximum Towing Load from “TowingLoad/Specification� chart - 1,000 lb. (454 kg).

TI1012M

Technical and consumer information 9-17

Page 436: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

4,546 lb. (2062 kg) GVWR

– 4,446 lb. (2016 kg) GVW

= 100 lb. (45 kg) Available for tongueweight

1,000 lb. (454 kg) Capacity available fortowing

100 lb. (45 kg) Available tongue weight

/ 1,000 lb. (454 kg) Available capacity

= 10 % tongue weight

The available towing capacity may be less thanthe maximum towing capacity due to the passen-ger and cargo load in the vehicle.

Remember to keep trailer tongue weight be-tween 10 - 15% of the trailer weight or within thetrailer tongue load specification recommendedby the trailer manufacturer. If the tongue loadbecomes excessive, rearrange the cargo to ob-tain the proper tongue load. Do not exceed themaximum tongue weight specification shown inthe “Towing load/specification” chart even if thecalculated available tongue weight is greaterthan 15%. If the calculated tongue weight is lessthan 10% , reduce the total trailer weight tomatch the available tongue weight.

Always verify that available capacities are withinthe required ratings.

TOWING LOAD/SPECIFICATION

TOWING LOAD / SPECIFICATION

UNIT: lb (kg)

MAXIMUM TOWINGLOAD *1

1,000 (454)

MAXIMUM TONGUELOAD

100 (45)

*1: The towing capacity values are calculatedassuming a base vehicle with driver and anyoptions required to achieve the rating. Additionalpassengers, cargo and/or optional equipmentwill add weight to the vehicle and reduce yourvehicle’s maximum towing capacity.

TOWING SAFETY

Trailer hitch

Choose a proper hitch for your vehicle and trailer.Make sure the trailer hitch is securely attached tothe vehicle, to help avoid personal injury or prop-erty damage due to sway caused by crosswinds,rough road surfaces or passing trucks.

WARNING

Trailer hitch components have specificweight ratings. Your vehicle may be ca-pable of towing a trailer heavier than theweight rating of the hitch components.Never exceed the weight rating of thehitch components. Doing so can causeserious personal injury or propertydamage.

Hitch ball

Choose a hitch ball of the proper size and weightrating for your trailer:

● The required hitch ball size is stamped onmost trailer couplers. Most hitch balls alsohave the size printed on the top of the ball.

● Choose the proper class hitch ball based onthe trailer weight.

● The diameter of the threaded shank of thehitch ball must be matched to the ball mounthole diameter. The hitch ball shank shouldbe no more than 1/16” smaller than the holein the ball mount.

9-18 Technical and consumer information

Page 437: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● The threaded shank of the hitch ball must belong enough to be properly secured to theball mount. There should be at least 2threads showing beyond the lock washerand nut.

Ball mount

The hitch ball is attached to the ball mount andthe ball mount is inserted into the hitch receiver.Choose a proper class ball mount based on thetrailer weight. Additionally, the ball mount shouldbe chosen to keep the trailer tongue level with theground.

Sway control deviceSudden maneuvers, wind gusts, and buffetingcaused by other vehicles can affect trailer han-dling. Sway control devices may be used to helpcontrol these affects. If you choose to use one,contact a reputable trailer hitch supplier to makesure the sway control device will work with thevehicle, hitch, trailer and the trailer’s brake sys-tem. Follow the instructions provided by themanufacturer for installing and using the swaycontrol device.

Class I hitchClass I trailer hitch equipment (receiver, ballmount and hitch ball) can be used to tow trailersof a maximum weight of 2,000 lb (907 kg).

You may add Class I trailer hitch equipment thathas a 2,000 lb (907 kg) maximum weight rating tothe vehicle, but your vehicle is only capable oftowing the maximum trailer weights shown in theTowing Load/Specification chart earlier in thissection.

CAUTION

● Do not use axle-mounted hitches.

● The hitch should not be attached to oraffect the operation of the impact-absorbing bumper.

● Do not modify the vehicle exhaust sys-tem, brake system, etc. to install atrailer hitch.

● To reduce the possibility of additionaldamage if your vehicle is struck fromthe rear, where practical, remove thereceiver when not in use.

● After the hitch is removed, seal the boltholes to prevent exhaust fumes, wateror dust from entering the passengercompartment.

● Regularly check that all trailer hitchmounting bolts are securely mounted.

Tire pressures

● When towing a trailer, inflate the ve-hicle tires to the recommended coldtire pressure indicated on the Tireand Loading Information label.

● Trailer tire condition, size, load ratingand proper inflation pressure shouldbe in accordance with the trailer andtire manufacturer’s specifications.

Safety chains

Always use suitable safety chains between yourvehicle and the trailer. The safety chains shouldbe crossed and should be attached to the hitch,not to the vehicle bumper or axle. Be sure to leaveenough slack in the chains to permit turningcorners.

Technical and consumer information 9-19

Page 438: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Trailer lights

CAUTION

When splicing into the vehicle electricalsystem, a commercially available power-type module/converter must be used toprovide power for all trailer lighting. Thisunit uses the vehicle battery as a directpower source for all trailer lights whileusing the vehicle tail light, stoplight andturn signal circuits as a signal source. Themodule/converter must draw no morethat 15 milliamps from the stop and taillamp circuits. Using a module/converterthat exceeds these power requirementsmay damage the vehicle’s electrical sys-tem. See a reputable trailer dealer to ob-tain the proper equipment and to have itinstalled.

Trailer lights should comply with federal and/orlocal regulations. For assistance in hooking uptrailer lights, contact a NISSAN dealer or repu-table trailer dealer.

Trailer brakes

If your trailer is equipped with a braking system,make sure it conforms to federal and/or localregulations and that it is properly installed.

WARNING

Never connect a trailer brake system di-rectly to the vehicle brake system.

Pre-towing tips

● Be certain your vehicle maintains a levelposition when a loaded and/or unloadedtrailer is hitched. Do not drive the vehicle if ithas an abnormal nose-up or nose-downcondition; check for improper tongue load,overload, worn suspension or other possiblecauses of either condition.

● Always secure items in the trailer to preventload shift while driving.

● Keep the cargo load as low as possible inthe trailer to keep the trailer center of gravitylow.

● Load the trailer so approximately 60% of thetrailer load is in the front half and 40% is inthe back half. Also make sure the load isbalanced side to side.

● Check your hitch, trailer tire pressure, ve-hicle tire pressure, trailer light operation, andtrailer wheel lug nuts every time you attach atrailer to the vehicle.

● Be certain your rearview mirrors conform toall federal, state or local regulations. If not,install any mirrors required for towing beforedriving the vehicle.

● Determine the overall height of the vehicleand trailer so the required clearance isknown.

Trailer towing tips

In order to gain skill and an understanding of thevehicle’s behavior, you should practice turning,stopping and backing up in an area which is freefrom traffic. Steering stability and braking perfor-mance will be somewhat different than undernormal driving conditions.

● Always secure items in the trailer to preventload shift while driving.

● Lock the trailer hitch coupler with a pin orlock to prevent the coupler from inadver-tently becoming unlatched.

● Avoid abrupt starts, acceleration or stops.

● Avoid sharp turns or lane changes.

● Always drive your vehicle at a moderatespeed.

9-20 Technical and consumer information

Page 439: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

● When backing up, hold the bottom of thesteering wheel with one hand. Move yourhand in the direction in which you want thetrailer to go. Make small corrections andback up slowly. If possible, have someoneguide you when you are backing up.

Always block the wheels on both vehicle andtrailer when parking. Parking on a slope is notrecommended; however, if you must do so:

CAUTION

If you move the shift selector to the P(Park) position before blocking thewheels and applying the parking brake,transmission damage could occur.

1. Apply and hold the brake pedal.

2. Have someone place blocks on the downhillside of the vehicle and trailer wheels.

3. After the wheel blocks are in place, slowlyrelease the brake pedal until the blocks ab-sorb the vehicle load.

4. Apply the parking brake.

5. Shift the transmission into P (Park).

6. Turn off the engine.

To drive away:

1. Start the vehicle.

2. Apply and hold the brake pedal.

3. Shift the transmission into gear.

4. Release the parking brake.

5. Drive slowly until the vehicle and trailer areclear from the blocks.

6. Apply and hold the brake pedal.

7. Have someone retrieve and store the blocks.

● While going downhill, the weight of thetrailer pushing on the tow vehicle may de-crease overall stability. Therefore, to main-tain adequate control, reduce your speedand use the manual shift mode (M5). Avoidlong or repeated use of the brakes whendescending a hill, as this reduces their effec-tiveness and could cause overheating. Shift-ing the manual shift mode to M5 (5th) pro-vides “engine braking”and reduces the needto brake as frequently.

● If the engine coolant temperature rises to ahigh temperature, refer to “If your vehicleoverheats” in the “In case of emergency”section of this owner’s manual.

● Trailer towing requires more fuel than normalcircumstances.

● Avoid towing a trailer for your vehicle’s first500 miles (805 km).

● For the first 500 miles (805 km) that you dotow, do not drive over 50 MPH (80 km/h).

● Have your vehicle serviced more often thanat intervals specified in the recommendedMaintenance Schedule in the “NISSAN Ser-vice and Maintenance Guide”.

● When making a turn, your trailer wheels willbe closer to the inside of the turn than yourvehicle wheels. To compensate for this,make a larger than normal turning radiusduring the turn.

● Crosswinds and rough roads will adverselyaffect vehicle/trailer handling, possibly caus-ing vehicle sway. When being passed bylarger vehicles, be prepared for possiblechanges in crosswinds that could affect ve-hicle handling.

Do the following if the trailer begins to sway:

1. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal toallow the vehicle to coast and steer asstraight ahead as the road conditions allow.This combination will help stabilize the ve-hicle.

– Do not correct trailer sway by steering orapplying the brakes.

Technical and consumer information 9-21

Page 440: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

2. When the trailer sway stops, gently apply thebrakes and pull to the side of the road in asafe area.

3. Try to rearrange the trailer load so it is bal-anced as described earlier in this section.

● Be careful when passing other vehicles.Passing while towing a trailer requires con-siderably more distance than normal pass-ing. Remember, the length of the trailer mustalso pass the other vehicle before you cansafely change lanes.

● Use the Tow Mode or downshift the trans-mission to a lower gear for engine brakingwhen driving down steep or long hills. Thiswill help slow the vehicle without applyingthe brakes.

● Avoid holding the brake pedal down too longor too frequently. This could cause thebrakes to overheat, resulting in reducedbraking efficiency.

● Increase your following distance to allow forgreater stopping distances while towing atrailer. Anticipate stops and brake gradually.

● NISSAN recommends that the cruise con-trol not be used while towing a trailer.

● Some states or provinces have specificregulations and speed limits for vehicles thatare towing trailers. Obey the local speedlimits.

● Check your hitch, trailer wiring harness con-nections, and trailer wheel lug nuts after 50miles (80 km) of travel and at every break.

● When launching a boat, don’t allow the wa-ter level to go over the exhaust tail pipe orrear bumper.

● Make sure you disconnect the trailer lightsbefore backing the trailer into the water orthe trailer lights may burn out.

When towing a trailer, transmission fluidshould be changed more frequently. Foradditional information, see the “Mainte-nance and do-it-yourself” section earlier inthis manual.

FLAT TOWING

Towing your vehicle with all four wheels on theground is sometimes called flat towing. Thismethod is sometimes used when towing a vehiclebehind a recreational vehicle, such as a motorhome.

CAUTION

● Failure to follow these guidelines canresult in severe transmission damage.

● Whenever flat towing your vehicle, al-ways tow forward, never backward.

● DO NOT tow any automatic transmis-sion vehicle with all four wheels on theground (flat towing). Doing so WILLDAMAGE internal transmission partsdue to lack of transmission lubrication.

● For emergency towing procedures referto “Towing recommended by NISSAN”in the “In case of emergency” section ofthis manual.

Continuously Variable TransmissionTo tow a vehicle equipped with a continuouslyvariable t ransmission, an appropriate vehicledolly MUST be placed under the towed vehicle’sdrive wheels. Always follow the dolly manufac-turer’s recommendations when using their prod-uct.

9-22 Technical and consumer information

Page 441: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

DOT (Department of Transportation) QualityGrades: All passenger car tires must conform tofederal safety requirements in addition to thesegrades.

Quality grades can be found where applicable onthe tire sidewall between tread shoulder andmaximum section width. For example:

Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A

Treadwear

The treadwear grade is a comparative ratingbased on the wear rate of the tire when testedunder controlled conditions on a specified gov-ernment test course. For example, a tire graded150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) timesas well on the government course as a tire graded100. The relative performance of tires dependsupon the actual conditions of their use, however,and may depart significantly from the norm due tovariations in driving habits, service practices anddifferences in road characteristics and climate.

Traction AA, A, B and C

The traction grades, from highest to lowest, areAA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent thetire’s ability to stop on wet pavement as mea-sured under controlled conditions on specifiedgovernment test surfaces of asphalt and con-crete. A tire marked C may have poor tractionperformance.

WARNING

The traction grade assigned to this tire isbased on straight-ahead braking tractiontests, and does not include acceleration,cornering, hydroplaning, or peak tractioncharacteristics.

Temperature A, B and C

The temperature grades are A (the highest), B,and C, representing the tire’s resistance to thegeneration of heat, and its ability to dissipate heatwhen tested under controlled conditions on aspecified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustainedhigh temperature can cause the material of thetire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and exces-sive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure.The grade C corresponds to a level of perfor-mance which all passenger car tires must meetunder the Federal Motor Safety Standard No.109. Grades B and A represent higher levels ofperformance on the laboratory test wheel thanthe minimum required by law.

WARNING

The temperature grade for this tire is es-tablished for a tire that is properly inflatedand not overloaded. Excessive speed,under-inflation, or excessive loading, ei-ther separately or in combination, cancause heat build-up and possible tirefailure.

UNIFORM TIRE QUALITY GRADING

Technical and consumer information 9-23

Page 442: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Your NISSAN vehicle is covered by the followingemission warranties:

For USA

1. Emission Defects Warranty

2. Emissions Performance Warranty

Details of this warranty may be found with othervehicle warranties in your Warranty InformationBooklet which comes with your NISSAN vehicle.If you did not receive a Warranty InformationBooklet, or it is lost, you may obtain a replace-ment by writing to:

● Nissan North America, Inc.Consumer Affairs DepartmentP.O. Box 685003Franklin, TN 37068-5003

For Canada

Emission Control System Warranty

Details of this warranty may be found with othervehicle warranties in your Warranty InformationBooklet which comes with your NISSAN vehicle.If you did not receive a Warranty InformationBooklet, or it is lost, you may obtain a replace-ment by writing to:

● Nissan Canada Inc.5290 Orbitor DriveMississauga, Ontario, L4W 4Z5

For USA

If you believe that your vehicle has a de-fect which could cause a crash or couldcause injury or death, you should immedi-ately inform the National Highway TrafficSafety Administration (NHTSA) in addi-tion to notifying NISSAN.

If NHTSA receives similar complaints, itmay open an investigation, and if it findsthat a safety defect exists in a group ofvehicles, it may order a recall and remedycampaign. However, NHTSA cannot be-come involved in individual problems be-tween you, your dealer, or NISSAN.

To contact NHTSA, you may call the Ve-hicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); goto http://www.safercar.gov; or write to:Administrator, NHTSA, 400 SeventhStreet, SW., Washington, D.C. 20590.You can also obtain other informationabout motor vehicle safety fromhttp://www.safercar.gov.

You may notify NISSAN by contacting ourConsumer Affairs Department, toll-free, at1-800-NISSAN-1.

For Canada

If you believe that your vehicle has a de-fect which could cause a crash or couldcause injury or death, you should immedi-ately inform Transport Canada in additionto notifying NISSAN.

If Transport Canada receives complaints,it may open an investigation, and if it findsthat a safety defect exists in a group ofvehicles, it may request that NISSAN con-duct a recall campaign. However, Trans-port Canada cannot become involved inindividual problems between you, yourdealer, or NISSAN.

You may contact Transport Canada’s De-fect Investigations and Recalls Divisiontoll free at 1-800-333-0510. You mayalso report safety defects online at:https://wwwapps.tc.gc.ca/Saf-Sec-Sur/7/PCDB-BDPP/Index.aspx.

EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMWARRANTY

REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS

9-24 Technical and consumer information

Page 443: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Additional information concerning motorvehicle safety may be obtained from Trans-port Canada’s Road Safety InformationCentre at 1-800-333-0371 or online atwww.tc.gc.ca/roadsafety (English speak-ers) or www.tc.gc.ca/securiteroutiere(French speakers).

To notify NISSAN of any safety concernsplease contact our Consumer InformationCentre toll free at 1-800-387-0122.

Due to legal requirements in some states andCanadian Provinces, your vehicle may be re-quired to be in what is called the “ready condi-tion” for an Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) test ofthe emission control system.

The vehicle is set to the “ready condition” when itis driven through certain driving patterns. Usually,the ready condition can be obtained by ordinaryusage of the vehicle.

If a powertrain system component is repaired orthe battery is disconnected, the vehicle may bereset to a “not ready” condition. Before taking theI/M test, check the vehicle’sinspection/maintenance test readiness condi-tion. Place the ignition switch in the ON positionwithout starting the engine. If the MalfunctionIndicator Light (MIL) comes on steady for 20seconds and then blinks for 10 seconds , the I/Mtest condition is “not ready”. If the MIL does notblink after 20 seconds, the I/M test condition is“ready”. Contact a NISSAN dealer to set the“ready condition” or to prepare the vehicle fortesting.

This vehicle is equipped with an Event Data Re-corder (EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is torecord, in certain crash or near crash-like situa-tions, such as an air bag deployment or hitting aroad obstacle, data that will assist in understand-ing how a vehicle’s systems performed. The EDRis designed to record data related to vehicledynamics and safety systems for a short period oftime, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in thisvehicle is designed to record such data as:

● How various systems in your vehicle wereoperating;

● Whether or not the driver and passengersafety belts were buckled/fastened;

● How far (if at all) the driver was depressingthe accelerator and/or brake pedal; and,

● How fast the vehicle was traveling.

● Sounds are not recorded.

READINESS FOR INSPECTION/MAINTENANCE (I/M) TEST

EVENT DATA RECORDERS (EDR)

Technical and consumer information 9-25

Page 444: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

These data can help provide a better understand-ing of the circumstances in which crashes andinjuries occur. NOTE: EDR data are recorded byyour vehicle only if a nontrivial crash situationoccurs; no data are recorded by the EDR undernormal driving conditions and no personal data(e.g. name, gender, age and crash location) arerecorded. However, other parties, such as lawenforcement, could combine the EDR data withthe type of personally identifying data routinelyacquired during a crash investigation.

To read data recorded by an EDR, special equip-ment is required and access to the vehicle or theEDR is needed. In addition to the vehicle manu-facturer and NISSAN dealer, other parties, suchas law enforcement, that have the special equip-ment, can read the information if they have ac-cess to the vehicle or the EDR. EDR data will onlybe accessed with the consent of the vehicleowner or lessee or as otherwise required or per-mitted by law.

A genuine NISSAN Service Manual is the bestsource of service and repair information for yourvehicle. Filled with wiring diagrams, illustrationsand step-by-step diagnostic and adjustment pro-cedures, this manual is the same one used by thefactory-trained technicians working at NISSANdealerships. Also available are genuine NISSANOwner’s Manuals, and genuine NISSAN Serviceand Owner’s Manuals for older NISSAN models.

For USA

For current pricing and availability of genuineNISSAN Service Manuals for the 2000 modelyear and later contact:

1-800-450-9491www.nissan-techinfo.com

For current pricing and availability of genuineNISSAN Service Manuals for the 1999 modelyear and prior, see a NISSAN dealer, or contact:

1-800-247-5321

For current pricing and availability of genuineNISSAN Owner’s Manuals for this model yearand prior, see a NISSAN dealer, or contact:

1-800-247-5321

For Canada

To purchase a copy of a genuine NISSAN Ser-vice Manual or Owner’s Manual please contactyour nearest NISSAN dealer. For the phone num-ber and location of a NISSAN dealer in your areacall the NISSAN Information Center at 1-800-387-0122 and a bilingual NISSAN representa-tive will assist you.

Also available are genuine NISSAN Service andOwner’s Manuals for older NISSAN models.

OWNER’S MANUAL/SERVICEMANUAL ORDER INFORMATION

9-26 Technical and consumer information

Page 445: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

10 IndexA

Air bag (See supplemental restraintsystem) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-37Air bag system

Front (See supplemental front impactair bag system) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-44

Air bag warning light. . . . . . . . . . .1-51, 2-14Air cleaner housing filter . . . . . . . . . . . .8-18Air conditioner

Air conditioner service . . . . . . . . . . .4-47Air conditioner specification label . . . . .9-11Air conditioner system refrigerant andoil recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-6Heater and air conditionercontrols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-41, 4-44Servicing air conditioner . . . . . . . . . .4-47

Alarm system(See vehicle security system) . . . . . . . . .2-25Anchor point locations . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-23Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-115Anti-lock brake warning light . . . . . .2-10, 2-11Anti-lock Braking System (ABS). . . . . . . .5-23Armrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-7Audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-16Audio system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-47

Bluetooth� audio . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-109Compact Disc (CD) changer . . . . . . .4-65Compact disc (CD) player . . . . .4-71, 4-79FM-AM radio with compact disc (CD)changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-63FM/AM/SAT radio with CD/DVD player. .4-75

FM/AM/SAT radio with compact disc (CD)player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-68

Audio SystemiPod� Player . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-92, 4-93Music Box� hard-disk drive audiosystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-96, 4-102

Audio systemRadio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-47

Audio SystemSettings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-69, 4-75

Audio systemSteering wheel audio control switch . . .4-113USB interface . . . . . . . . . . . .4-87, 4-88

Autolight switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-31Automatic

Automatic drive positioner . . . . . . . . .3-29Automatic power window switch . . . . .2-45Automatic transmission position indicatorlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-14Transmission shift selector lock release . .5-16

Automatic anti-glare inside mirror . . . . . . .3-26Automatic door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-6AUX jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-67

B

Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-14Charge warning light . . . . . . . . . . . .2-11

Before starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . .5-10Belt (See drive belt) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-17Block heater

Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-27

Bluetooth� audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-109Bluetooth� hands-free phone system. . . .4-116,

4-130Booster seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-33Brake

Anti-lock Braking System (ABS). . . . . .5-23Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-13Brake light (See stop light). . . . . . . . .8-28Brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-22Brake warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-11Brake wear indicators . . . . . . . .2-16, 8-20Parking brake operation . . . . . . . . . .5-17Self-adjusting brakes . . . . . . . . . . . .8-20

Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-20Break-in schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-19Brightness/contrast button . . . . . . .4-15, 4-31Brightness control

Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-33Bulb check/instrument panel. . . . . . . . . .2-10Bulb replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-28

C

Capacities and recommendedfuel/lubricants. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2Cargo net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-43Cargo (See vehicle loading information) . . .9-12Car phone or CB radio . . . . . . . . . . . .4-115CD care and cleaning. . . . . . . . . . . . .4-112CD changer (See audio system) . . . . . . .4-65CD player (See audio system) . . . . .4-71, 4-79Check tire pressure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-25

Page 446: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Child restraints . . . . . . .1-17, 1-18, 1-19, 1-21Precautions on child restraints . . .1-19, 1-25,1-29, 1-33Top tether strap anchor point locations . .1-23

Child safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . . . . .3-6Chimes, audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . .2-16Cleaning exterior and interior . . . . . . . . . . .7-2Clock

(models with navigation system) . . .4-11, 4-26Clock set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-11, 4-26C.M.V.S.S. certification label . . . . . . . . . .9-10Cold weather driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-26Compact disc (CD) player . . . . . . . .4-71, 4-79Console box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-42Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT). . .5-11

Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT)fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-12Driving with Continuously VariableTransmission (CVT) . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-11Transmission shift selector lock release . .5-16

Control panel buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-16Brightness/contrast button. . . . . .4-15, 4-31Enter button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4, 4-16Setting button . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-9, 4-24Without navigation system . . . . . . . . . .4-4

ControlsAudio controls (steering wheel) . . . . . .4-113Heater and air conditionercontrols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-41, 4-44

CoolantCapacities and recommendedfuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2Changing engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . .8-9Checking engine coolant level . . . . . . . .8-8Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . .2-5

Corrosion protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-6

Cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-18Cup holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-40, 2-41

D

Daytime running light system (Canada only) . .2-32Defroster switch

Rear window and outside mirror defrosterswitch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-29

Digital Versatile Disc (DVD) player . . . . . . .4-84Dimensions and weights . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-8Dimmer switch for instrument panel . . . . . .2-33Display controls(see control panel buttons) . . . . . . . .4-4, 4-16Distance to empty . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-7, 4-21Door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4Drive belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-17Drive positioner, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . .3-29Driving

Cold weather driving . . . . . . . . . . . .5-26Driving with Continuously VariableTransmission (CVT) . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-11Precautions when starting and driving . . . .5-2

E

Economy - fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-20Emission control information label . . . . . . .9-10Emission control system warranty . . . . . . .9-24Engine

Before starting the engine. . . . . . . . . .5-10Block heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-27Capacities and recommendedfuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2

Changing engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . .8-9Changing engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-10Changing engine oil filter . . . . . . . . . .8-11Checking engine coolant level . . . . . . . .8-8Checking engine oil level . . . . . . . . . . .8-9Engine compartment check locations . . . .8-6Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . .2-5Engine cooling system . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-9Engine oil and oil filter recommendation . . .9-5Engine oil pressure warning light . . . . . .2-12Engine oil viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-5Engine serial number . . . . . . . . . . . .9-10Engine specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-7Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-11

Enter button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4, 4-16Event data recorders . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-25Exhaust gas (Carbon monoxide) . . . . . . . . .5-2Extended storage switch . . . . . . . . . . . .8-24Eyeglass case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-39

F

Flashers(See hazard warning flasher switch) . . . . . .2-34Flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-2Floor mat positioning aid . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-5Fluid

Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-13Capacities and recommendedfuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT)fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-12Engine coolant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-9

10-2

Page 447: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Power steering fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-12Windshield-washer fluid. . . . . . . . . . .8-14

F.M.V.S.S. certification label. . . . . . . . . . .9-10Fog light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-34Folding rear seat. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-5Front air bag system(See supplemental restraint system) . . . . . .1-44Front seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-2Fuel

Capacities and recommendedfuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2Fuel economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-20Fuel-filler door and cap . . . . . . . . . . .3-21Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-6Fuel octane rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-4Fuel recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-3Loose fuel cap warning. . . . . . . .2-25, 3-21

Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-21Fusible links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-22

G

Garage door opener, HomeLink� UniversalTransceiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-53Gas cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-21Gauge

Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . .2-5Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-6Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5Trip odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4

General maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-2Glove box. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-41Glove box lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-41

Grocery hooks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-42

H

Hands-free phone system, Bluetooth� . . . .4-116,4-130

Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . . . . .2-34Headlight and turn signal switch . . . . . . . .2-29Headlight control switch . . . . . . . . . . . .2-30Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-27Heated seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-35, 2-37Heated steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-37Heater

Heater and air conditionercontrols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-41, 4-44Heater operation . . . . . . . . . . .4-42, 4-45

HomeLink� Universal Transceiver. . . . . . . .2-53Hood release. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-18Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-35

I

Ignition SwitchPush-Button Ignition Switch . . . . . . . . .5-7

Image viewer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-32Immobilizer system . . . . . . . . .2-26, 3-3, 5-10Important vehicle information label . . . . . . .9-10In-cabin microfilter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-18Increasing fuel economy. . . . . . . . . . . . .5-20Indicator lights and audible reminders(See warning/indicator lights and audiblereminders) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-10Inside automatic anti-glare mirror . . . . . . . .3-26Instrument brightness control . . . . . . . . . .2-33

Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .0-6, 2-2Instrument panel dimmer switch . . . . . . . .2-33Intelligent Key system

Key operating range . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-9Key operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-10Mechanical key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3Remote keyless entry operation. . . . . . .3-13Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . . . .3-17Warning signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-17

Interior light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-51Interior trunk lid release . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-20iPod� Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-92, 4-93ISOFIX child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-21

J

Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-7

K

Keyfob battery replacement . . . . . . . . . . .8-25Keyless entry

With Intelligent Key system(See Intelligent Key system). . . . . . . . .3-13

Keys, For Intelligent Key system . . . . . . . . .3-2

L

LabelsAir conditioner specification label . . . . .9-11C.M.V.S.S. certification label . . . . . . . .9-10Emission control information label . . . . .9-10Engine serial number . . . . . . . . . . . .9-10

10-3

Page 448: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

F.M.V.S.S. certification label. . . . . . . . .9-10Tire and Loading Information label . . . . .9-11Vehicle identification number (VIN) plate . .9-9Warning labels (for SRS) . . . . . . . . . .1-51

LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren)System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-21License plate

Installing the license plate . . . . . . . . . .9-11Light

Air bag warning light . . . . . . . . .1-51, 2-14Brake light (See stop light) . . . . . . . . .8-28Bulb check/instrument panel . . . . . . . .2-10Bulb replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-28Charge warning light . . . . . . . . . . . .2-11Fog light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-34Headlight and turn signal switch . . . . . .2-29Headlight control switch . . . . . . . . . .2-30Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-27Interior light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-51Light bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-27Low tire pressure warning light . . . . . . .2-12Low windshield-washer fluid warninglight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-24Passenger air bag and status light . . . . .1-46Security indicator light. . . . . . . . . . . .2-15Spotlights (See map light) . . . . . . . . .2-52Trunk light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-53Warning/indicator lights and audiblereminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-10

LightsMap lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-52

LockChild safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . . .3-6Door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4Glove box lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-41Power door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-5

Trunk lid lock opener lever. . . . . . . . . .3-19Loose fuel cap warning. . . . . . . . . .2-25, 3-21Low fuel warning light . . . . . . . . . .2-13, 2-24Low tire pressure warning light . . . . . . . . .2-12Low windshield-washer fluid warning light. . .2-24Luggage (See vehicle loading information) . .9-12

M

MaintenanceChanging the maintenance interval . .4-8, 4-22Displaying the maintenance noticereminder. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-8, 4-23General maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-2Inside the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-3Maintenance precautions . . . . . . . . . . .8-5Outside the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-2Resetting the maintenance interval . .4-8, 4-22Seat belt maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . .1-17Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-8, 4-22Under the hood and vehicle . . . . . . . . .8-4

Malfunction indicator light . . . . . . . . . . . .2-15Map lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-52Map pocket. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-39Meters and gauges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-3

Instrument brightness control . . . . . . . .2-33Mirror

Automatic anti-glare inside mirror. . . . . .3-26Outside mirror control . . . . . . . . . . . .3-28Outside mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-28Vanity mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-25

Moonroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-46Music Box� hard-disk drive audiosystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-96, 4-102

N

NISSAN Intelligent Key™ . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-7NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system . . .2-26, 3-3,

5-10NISSAN voice recognition system . . . . . .4-141

O

Octane rating (See fuel octane rating). . . . . .9-4Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4Oil

Capacities and recommendedfuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2Changing engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-10Changing engine oil filter . . . . . . . . . .8-11Checking engine oil level . . . . . . . . . . .8-9Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-9Engine oil and oil filter recommendation . . .9-5Engine oil viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-5

Outside mirror control . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-28Outside mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-28Overheat

If your vehicle overheats . . . . . . . . . . .6-9Owner’s manual order form . . . . . . . . . . .9-26Owner’s manual/service manual orderinformation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-26

P

ParkingParking brake operation . . . . . . . . . . .5-17Parking/parking on hills . . . . . . . . . . .5-21

Phone, Bluetooth� hands-free

10-4

Page 449: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-116, 4-130Power

Power door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-5Power outlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-38Power rear windows . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-45Power steering fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-12Power steering system . . . . . . . . . . .5-22Power windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-43Rear power windows . . . . . . . . . . . .2-45

PrecautionsMaintenance precautions . . . . . . . . . . .8-5Precautions on child restraints . . .1-19, 1-25,1-29, 1-33Precautions on seat belt usage . . . . . . .1-11Precautions on supplemental restraintsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-37Precautions when starting and driving . . . .5-2

Programmable features . . . . . . . . . .4-9, 4-24Push starting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-9

R

RadioCar phone or CB radio . . . . . . . . . .4-115Compact Disc (CD) changer . . . . . . . .4-65FM-AM radio with compact disc (CD)changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-63FM/AM/SAT radio with CD/DVD player . .4-75FM/AM/SAT radio with compact disc (CD)player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-68Steering wheel audio control switch . . .4-113

Readiness for inspection maintenance (I/M)test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-25Rear power windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-45Rear seat. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-5

Rear sun shade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-50RearView Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-34Rear window and outside mirror defrosterswitch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-29Recorders

Event data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-25Refrigerant recommendation . . . . . . . . . . .9-6Registering your vehicle in another country . . .9-9Reporting safety defects (US only) . . . . . . .9-24Resetting the fuel economy . . . . . . . .4-7, 4-21

S

SafetyChild safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . . .3-6Child seat belts . . . . .1-19, 1-25, 1-29, 1-33Reporting safety defects (US only) . . . . .9-24

Seat adjustmentFront power seat adjustment . . . . . . . . .1-3

Seatback pockets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-39Seat belt

Child safety. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-17Infants and small children . . . . . . . . . .1-18Injured Person . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-14Larger children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-18Precautions on seat belt usage . . . . . . .1-11Pregnant women. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-14Seat belt extenders . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-17Seat belt maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . .1-17Seat belts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-11Shoulder belt height adjustment . . . . . .1-16Three-point type with retractor . . . . . . .1-14

Seat belt warning light. . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-13

SeatsAdjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-2Automatic drive positioner. . . . . . . . . .3-29Front seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-2Heated seats . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-35, 2-37Rear seat. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-5

Security indicator light. . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-15Security system (NISSAN vehicle immobilizersystem), engine start . . . . . . . .2-26, 3-3, 5-10Self-adjusting brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-20Service manual order form . . . . . . . . . . .9-26Servicing air conditioner. . . . . . . . . . . . .4-47Setting button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-9, 4-24Shifting

Continuously Variable Transmission(CVT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-13

Shift lock release. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-16Shoulder belt height adjustment . . . . . . . .1-16Spark plug replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-17Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4Spotlights (See map light) . . . . . . . . . . .2-52SRS warning label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-51Starting

Before starting the engine. . . . . . . . . .5-10Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-7Precautions when starting and driving . . . .5-2Push starting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-9Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-11

SteeringHeated steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . .2-37Power steering fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-12Power steering system . . . . . . . . . . .5-22

Steering wheel audio control switch . . . . .4-113Stop light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-28Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-39Sunglasses case. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-39

10-5

Page 450: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Sunglasses holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-39Sunroof (see Moonroof) . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-46Sun visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-25Supplemental air bag warning light . . .1-51, 2-14Supplemental front impact air bag system . . .1-44Supplemental restraint system

Information and warning labels . . . . . . .1-51Precautions on supplemental restraintsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-37

Supplemental restraint system(Supplemental air bag system) . . . . . . . . .1-37Switch

Autolight switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-31Automatic power window switch . . . . . .2-45Fog light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-34Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . . .2-34Headlight and turn signal switch . . . . . .2-29Headlight control switch . . . . . . . . . .2-30Power door lock switch . . . . . . . . . . . .3-5Rear window and outside mirror defrosterswitch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-29Turn signal switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-33Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) offswitch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-38Windshield wiper and washer switch . . .2-28

T

Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5Temperature gauge

Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . .2-5Theft (NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system),engine start . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-26, 3-3, 5-10Three-way catalyst . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-2

TireFlat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-2Spare tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-4, 8-43Tire and Loading Information label . . . . .9-11Tire chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-40Tire placard. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-11Tire pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-32Tire rotation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-40Types of tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-39Uniform tire quality grading . . . . . . . . .9-23Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-32Wheel/tire size. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-8

Tire pressureLow tire pressure warning light . . . . . . .2-12

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) . . . .5-3Towing

Flat towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-22Towing load/specification . . . . . . . . . .9-18Tow truck towing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-10Trailer towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-15

TransceiverHomeLink� Universal Transceiver. . . . . .2-53

TransmissionContinuously Variable Transmission (CVT)fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-12Driving with Continuously VariableTransmission (CVT) . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-11Shift selector lock release. . . . . . . . . .5-16

Travel (See registering your vehicle in anothercountry) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-9Trip odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4Trunk access through the rear seat . . . . .1-5, 1-6Trunk lid lock opener lever. . . . . . . . . . . .3-19Trunk light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-53Turn signal switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-33

U

Uniform tire quality grading . . . . . . . . . . .9-23USB interface

Audio file operation . . . . . . . . . .4-87, 4-88Video file operation . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-90

V

Vanity mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-25Variable voltage control system . . . . . . . . .8-17Vehicle dimensions and weights . . . . . . . . .9-8Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) off switch . . .2-38Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) system. . . . .5-24Vehicle identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-9Vehicle identification number (VIN)(Chassis number) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-9Vehicle identification number (VIN) plate . . . .9-9Vehicle loading information . . . . . . . . . . .9-12Vehicle recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-12Vehicle security system . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-25Vehicle security system(NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system),engine start . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-26, 3-3, 5-10Ventilators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-40Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-25Voice recognition system . . . . . . . . . . .4-141

W

WarningAir bag warning light . . . . . . . . .1-51, 2-14Anti-lock brake warning light . . . . .2-10, 2-11Battery charge warning light . . . . . . . .2-11

10-6

Page 451: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

Brake warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-11Engine oil pressure warning light . . . . . .2-12Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . . .2-34Low fuel warning light . . . . . . . .2-13, 2-24Low tire pressure warning light . . . . . . .2-12Low windshield-washer fluid warninglight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-24Passenger air bag and status light . . . . .1-46Seat belt warning light. . . . . . . . . . . .2-13Vehicle security system . . . . . . . . . . .2-25Warning/indicator lights and audiblereminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-10Warning labels (for SRS) . . . . . . . . . .1-51

Warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-10Washer switch

Windshield wiper and washer switch . . .2-28Weights (See dimensions and weights) . . . . .9-8Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-32Wheel/tire size. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-8When traveling or registering your vehicle inanother country . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-9Windows

Locking passengers’ windows . . . . . . .2-45Power rear windows . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-45Power windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-43Rear power windows . . . . . . . . . . . .2-45

Windshield-washer fluid. . . . . . . . . . . . .8-14Windshield wiper and washer switch . . . . .2-28Wiper

Windshield wiper and washer switch . . .2-28Wiper blades. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-19

10-7

Page 452: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

RECOMMENDED FUEL:NISSAN recommends the use of premium un-leaded gasoline with an octane rating of at least91 AKI (Anti-Knock Index) number (Researchoctane number 96). If unleaded premium gaso-line is not available, you may use unleaded regu-lar gasoline with an octane rating of at least 87AKI number (Research octane number 91), butyou may notice a decrease in performance.

CAUTION

● Using a fuel other than that specifiedcould adversely affect the emissioncontrol system, and may also affect thewarranty coverage.

● Under no circumstances should aleaded gasoline be used, because thiswill damage the three-way catalyst.

● Do not use E-85 fuel in your vehicle.Your vehicle is not designed to run onE-85 fuel. Using E-85 fuel can damagethe fuel system components and is notcovered by the NISSAN new vehicle lim-ited warranty.

For additional information, see “Capacities andrecommended fuel/lubricants” in the “Technicaland consumer information” section.

RECOMMENDED ENGINE OIL:● Engine oil with API Certification Mark

● Viscosity SAE 5W-30

See “Engine oil and oil filter recommendation” inthe “Technical and consumer information” sec-tion of this manual.

COLD TIRE PRESSURE:See Tire and Loading Information label.

The label is typically located on the driver sidecenter pillar or on the driver’s door. For additionalinformation, see “Wheels and tires” in the “Main-tenance and do-it-yourself” section of thismanual.

RECOMMENDED NEW VEHICLEBREAK-IN PROCEDURE:During the first 1,200 miles (2,000 km) of vehicleuse, follow the recommendations outlined in the“Break-in schedule” information found in the“Starting and driving” section of this manual. Fol-low these recommendations for the future reli-ability and economy of your new vehicle. Failureto follow these recommendations may result invehicle damage or shortened engine life.

GAS STATION INFORMATION

Page 453: 2012 MAXIMA OWNER'S MANUAL

®

2012 MAXIMAOWNER’S MANUAL

For your safety, read carefully and keep in this vehicle.

2012 N

ISS

AN

MA

XIM

AA

35

-D

Printing : July 2011 (09)

Publication No.:

Printed in U.S.A. A35-DOM2E 0A35U0